gdb
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24 @syncodeindex tp cp
25
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28 @syncodeindex vr cp
29 @syncodeindex fn cp
30
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
33 @set EDITION Ninth
34
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
43 @direntry
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45 @end direntry
46
47 @copying
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 @end copying
63
64 @ifnottex
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71 @end ifset
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74 @insertcopying
75 @end ifnottex
76
77 @titlepage
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80 @sp 1
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85 @end ifset
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87 @page
88 @tex
89 {\parskip=0pt
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93 }
94 @end tex
95
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 @insertcopying
103 @page
104 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
105 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
106 software in general. We will miss him.
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163
164 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
165
166 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
167 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
168 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
169 @end ifset
170 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
171 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
172 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
173 @end ifclear
174 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
175 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
176 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
177 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
178 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
179 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
180 @value{GDBN}
181 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
182 the operating system
183 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
184 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
185 how you can copy and share GDB
186 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
187 * Index:: Index
188 @end menu
189
190 @end ifnottex
191
192 @contents
193
194 @node Summary
195 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
196
197 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
198 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
199 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
200
201 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
202 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
203
204 @itemize @bullet
205 @item
206 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
207
208 @item
209 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
210
211 @item
212 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
213
214 @item
215 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
216 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
217 @end itemize
218
219 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
220 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
221 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
222
223 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
224 @ref{D,,D}.
225
226 @cindex Modula-2
227 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
228 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
229
230 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
231 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
232
233 @cindex Pascal
234 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
235 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
236 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
237 syntax.
238
239 @cindex Fortran
240 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
241 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
242 underscore.
243
244 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
245 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
246
247 @menu
248 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
249 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
250 @end menu
251
252 @node Free Software
253 @unnumberedsec Free Software
254
255 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
256 General Public License
257 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
258 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
259 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
260 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
261 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
262 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
263
264 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
265 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
266 from anyone else.
267
268 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
269
270 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
271 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
272 include with the free software. Many of our most important
273 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
274 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
275 when an important free software package does not come with a free
276 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
277 gaps today.
278
279 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
280 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
281 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
282 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
283 them from the free software world.
284
285 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
286 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
287 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
288 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
289 contract to make it non-free.
290
291 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
292 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
293 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
294 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
295 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
296 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
297 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
298
299 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
300 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
301 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
302 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
303
304 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
305 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
306 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
307 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
308 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
309 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
310 community.
311
312 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
313 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
314 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
315 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
316 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
317 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
318 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
319 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
320 of the manual.
321
322 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
323 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
324 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
325 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
326 manual to replace it.
327
328 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
329 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
330 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
331 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
332 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
333 the free software community.
334
335 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
336 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
337 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
338 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
339 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
340 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
341 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
342 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
343 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
344
345 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
346 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
347 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
348 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
349 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
350 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
351 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
352 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
353
354 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
355 published by other publishers, at
356 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
357
358 @node Contributors
359 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
360
361 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
362 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
363 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
364 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
365 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
366 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
367 blow-by-blow account.
368
369 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
370
371 @quotation
372 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
373 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
374 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
375 @end quotation
376
377 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
378 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
379 releases:
380 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
381 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
382 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
383 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
384 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
385 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
386 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
387 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
388 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
389
390 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
391 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
392
393 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
394 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
395 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
396 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
397 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
398
399 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
400 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
401 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
402
403 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
404 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
405
406 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
407
408 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
409 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
410 support.
411 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
412 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
413 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
414 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
415 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
416 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
417 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
418 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
419 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
420 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
421 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
422 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
423 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
424 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
425 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
426 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
427
428 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
429
430 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
431 libraries.
432
433 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
434 about several machine instruction sets.
435
436 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
437 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
438 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
439 and RDI targets, respectively.
440
441 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
442 command-line editing and command history.
443
444 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
445 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
446
447 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
448 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
449 symbols.
450
451 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
452 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
453
454 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
455
456 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
457 processors.
458
459 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
460
461 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
462
463 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
464
465 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
466 watchpoints.
467
468 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
469
470 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
471
472 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
473 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
474
475 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
476 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
477 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
478 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
479 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
480 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
481 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
482
483 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
484 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
485
486 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
487 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
488 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
489 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
490 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
491 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
492 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
493 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
494 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
495 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
496 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
497 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
498 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
499 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
500 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
501
502 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
503 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
504
505 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
506 Hat.
507
508 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
509 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
510 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
511 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
512 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
513 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
514
515 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
516 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
517 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
518 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
519 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
520 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
521 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
522 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
523 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
524 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
525 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
526 Weigand.
527
528 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
529 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
530 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
531 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
532
533 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
534 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
535
536 @node Sample Session
537 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
538
539 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
540 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
541 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
542
543 @iftex
544 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
545 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
546 @end iftex
547
548 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
549 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
550
551 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
552 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
553 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
554 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
555 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
556 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
557 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
558 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
559 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
560
561 @smallexample
562 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
563 $ @b{./m4}
564 @b{define(foo,0000)}
565
566 @b{foo}
567 0000
568 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
569
570 @b{bar}
571 0000
572 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
573
574 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
575 @b{baz}
576 @b{Ctrl-d}
577 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
578 @end smallexample
579
580 @noindent
581 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
582
583 @smallexample
584 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
585 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
586 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
587 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
588 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
589 the conditions.
590 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
591 for details.
592
593 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
594 (@value{GDBP})
595 @end smallexample
596
597 @noindent
598 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
599 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
600 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
601 that examples fit in this manual.
602
603 @smallexample
604 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
605 @end smallexample
606
607 @noindent
608 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
609 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
610 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
611 @code{break} command.
612
613 @smallexample
614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
615 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
616 @end smallexample
617
618 @noindent
619 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
620 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
621 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
622
623 @smallexample
624 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
625 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
626 @b{define(foo,0000)}
627
628 @b{foo}
629 0000
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
634 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
635 context where it stops.
636
637 @smallexample
638 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
639
640 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
641 at builtin.c:879
642 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
647 the next line of the current function.
648
649 @smallexample
650 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
651 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
652 : nil,
653 @end smallexample
654
655 @noindent
656 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
657 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
658 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
659 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
660
661 @smallexample
662 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
663 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
664 at input.c:530
665 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
670 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
671 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
672 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
673 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
674 stack frame for each active subroutine.
675
676 @smallexample
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
678 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
679 at input.c:530
680 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
681 at builtin.c:882
682 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
683 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
684 at macro.c:71
685 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
686 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
687 @end smallexample
688
689 @noindent
690 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
691 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
692 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
696 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
698 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
699 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
700 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
701 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
702 : xstrdup(rq);
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
704 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
709 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
710 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
711 (@code{print}) to see their values.
712
713 @smallexample
714 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
715 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
717 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
722 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
723 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
724
725 @smallexample
726 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
727 533 xfree(rquote);
728 534
729 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
730 : xstrdup (lq);
731 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
732 : xstrdup (rq);
733 537
734 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
735 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
736 540 @}
737 541
738 542 void
739 @end smallexample
740
741 @noindent
742 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
743 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
744
745 @smallexample
746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
747 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
749 540 @}
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
751 $3 = 9
752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
753 $4 = 7
754 @end smallexample
755
756 @noindent
757 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
758 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
759 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
760 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
761 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
762 assignments.
763
764 @smallexample
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
766 $5 = 7
767 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
768 $6 = 9
769 @end smallexample
770
771 @noindent
772 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
773 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
774 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
775 example that caused trouble initially:
776
777 @smallexample
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
779 Continuing.
780
781 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
782
783 baz
784 0000
785 @end smallexample
786
787 @noindent
788 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
789 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
790 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
791
792 @smallexample
793 @b{Ctrl-d}
794 Program exited normally.
795 @end smallexample
796
797 @noindent
798 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
799 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
800 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
801
802 @smallexample
803 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
804 @end smallexample
805
806 @node Invocation
807 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
808
809 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
810 The essentials are:
811 @itemize @bullet
812 @item
813 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
814 @item
815 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
816 @end itemize
817
818 @menu
819 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
820 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
821 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
822 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
823 @end menu
824
825 @node Invoking GDB
826 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
827
828 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
829 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
830
831 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
832 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
833
834 The command-line options described here are designed
835 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
836 options may effectively be unavailable.
837
838 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
839 specifying an executable program:
840
841 @smallexample
842 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
843 @end smallexample
844
845 @noindent
846 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
847 specified:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
854 to debug a running process:
855
856 @smallexample
857 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
858 @end smallexample
859
860 @noindent
861 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
862 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
863
864 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
865 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
866 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
867 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
868 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
869
870 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
871 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
872 option processing.
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
875 @end smallexample
876 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
877 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
878
879 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
880 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
881
882 @smallexample
883 @value{GDBP} -silent
884 @end smallexample
885
886 @noindent
887 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
888 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
889
890 @noindent
891 Type
892
893 @smallexample
894 @value{GDBP} -help
895 @end smallexample
896
897 @noindent
898 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
899 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
900
901 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
902 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
903 @samp{-x} option is used.
904
905
906 @menu
907 * File Options:: Choosing files
908 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
909 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
910 @end menu
911
912 @node File Options
913 @subsection Choosing Files
914
915 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
916 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
917 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
918 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
919 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
920 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
921 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
922 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
923 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
924 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
925 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
926 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
927 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
928
929 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
930 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
931 argument and ignore it.
932
933 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
934 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
935 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
936 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
937 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
938
939 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
940 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
941 @c it.
942
943 @table @code
944 @item -symbols @var{file}
945 @itemx -s @var{file}
946 @cindex @code{--symbols}
947 @cindex @code{-s}
948 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
949
950 @item -exec @var{file}
951 @itemx -e @var{file}
952 @cindex @code{--exec}
953 @cindex @code{-e}
954 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
955 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
956
957 @item -se @var{file}
958 @cindex @code{--se}
959 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
960 file.
961
962 @item -core @var{file}
963 @itemx -c @var{file}
964 @cindex @code{--core}
965 @cindex @code{-c}
966 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
967
968 @item -pid @var{number}
969 @itemx -p @var{number}
970 @cindex @code{--pid}
971 @cindex @code{-p}
972 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
973
974 @item -command @var{file}
975 @itemx -x @var{file}
976 @cindex @code{--command}
977 @cindex @code{-x}
978 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
979 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
980 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
981
982 @item -eval-command @var{command}
983 @itemx -ex @var{command}
984 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
985 @cindex @code{-ex}
986 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
987
988 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
989 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
990
991 @smallexample
992 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
993 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
994 @end smallexample
995
996 @item -directory @var{directory}
997 @itemx -d @var{directory}
998 @cindex @code{--directory}
999 @cindex @code{-d}
1000 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1001
1002 @item -r
1003 @itemx -readnow
1004 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1005 @cindex @code{-r}
1006 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1007 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1008 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1009
1010 @end table
1011
1012 @node Mode Options
1013 @subsection Choosing Modes
1014
1015 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1016 batch mode or quiet mode.
1017
1018 @table @code
1019 @item -nx
1020 @itemx -n
1021 @cindex @code{--nx}
1022 @cindex @code{-n}
1023 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1024 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1025 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1026 Files}.
1027
1028 @item -quiet
1029 @itemx -silent
1030 @itemx -q
1031 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1032 @cindex @code{--silent}
1033 @cindex @code{-q}
1034 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1035 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1036
1037 @item -batch
1038 @cindex @code{--batch}
1039 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1040 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1041 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1042 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1043 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1044 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1045 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1046
1047 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1048 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1049 make this more useful, the message
1050
1051 @smallexample
1052 Program exited normally.
1053 @end smallexample
1054
1055 @noindent
1056 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1057 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1058 mode.
1059
1060 @item -batch-silent
1061 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1062 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1063 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1064 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1065 for an interactive session.
1066
1067 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1068 messages, for example.
1069
1070 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1071 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1072
1073 @item -return-child-result
1074 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1075 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1076 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1077
1078 @itemize @bullet
1079 @item
1080 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1081 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1082 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1083 @item
1084 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1085 @item
1086 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1087 the exit code will be -1.
1088 @end itemize
1089
1090 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1091 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1092 interface.
1093
1094 @item -nowindows
1095 @itemx -nw
1096 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1097 @cindex @code{-nw}
1098 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1099 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1100 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1101
1102 @item -windows
1103 @itemx -w
1104 @cindex @code{--windows}
1105 @cindex @code{-w}
1106 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1107 used if possible.
1108
1109 @item -cd @var{directory}
1110 @cindex @code{--cd}
1111 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1112 instead of the current directory.
1113
1114 @item -fullname
1115 @itemx -f
1116 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1117 @cindex @code{-f}
1118 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1119 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1120 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1121 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1122 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1123 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1124 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1125 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1126 frame.
1127
1128 @item -epoch
1129 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1130 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1131 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1132 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1133 separate window.
1134
1135 @item -annotate @var{level}
1136 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1137 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1138 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1139 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1140 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1141 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1142 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1143 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1144 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1145
1146 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1147 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1148
1149 @item --args
1150 @cindex @code{--args}
1151 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1152 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1153 This option stops option processing.
1154
1155 @item -baud @var{bps}
1156 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1157 @cindex @code{--baud}
1158 @cindex @code{-b}
1159 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1160 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1161
1162 @item -l @var{timeout}
1163 @cindex @code{-l}
1164 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1165 for remote debugging.
1166
1167 @item -tty @var{device}
1168 @itemx -t @var{device}
1169 @cindex @code{--tty}
1170 @cindex @code{-t}
1171 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1172 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1173
1174 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1175 @item -tui
1176 @cindex @code{--tui}
1177 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1178 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1179 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1180 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1181 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1182 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1183 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1184
1185 @c @item -xdb
1186 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1187 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1188 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1189 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1190 @c systems.
1191
1192 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1193 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1194 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1195 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1196 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1197 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1198
1199 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1200 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1201 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1202 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1203 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1204 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1205
1206 @item -write
1207 @cindex @code{--write}
1208 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1209 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1210 (@pxref{Patching}).
1211
1212 @item -statistics
1213 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1214 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1215 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1216
1217 @item -version
1218 @cindex @code{--version}
1219 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1220 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1221
1222 @end table
1223
1224 @node Startup
1225 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1226 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1227
1228 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1229
1230 @enumerate
1231 @item
1232 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1233 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1234
1235 @item
1236 @cindex init file
1237 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1238 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1239 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1240 that file.
1241
1242 @item
1243 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1244 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1245 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1246 that file.
1247
1248 @item
1249 Processes command line options and operands.
1250
1251 @item
1252 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1253 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1254 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1255 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1256 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1257 @value{GDBN}.
1258
1259 @item
1260 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1261 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1262
1263 @item
1264 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1265 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1266 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1267 @end enumerate
1268
1269 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1270 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1271 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1272 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1273 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1274 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1275
1276 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1277 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1278
1279 @cindex init file name
1280 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1281 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1282 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1283 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1284 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1285 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1286 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1287 the file to the standard name.
1288
1289
1290 @node Quitting GDB
1291 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1292 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1293 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1294
1295 @table @code
1296 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1297 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1298 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1299 @itemx q
1300 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1301 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1302 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1303 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1304 error code.
1305 @end table
1306
1307 @cindex interrupt
1308 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1309 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1310 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1311 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1312 until a time when it is safe.
1313
1314 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1315 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1316 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1317
1318 @node Shell Commands
1319 @section Shell Commands
1320
1321 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1322 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1323 just use the @code{shell} command.
1324
1325 @table @code
1326 @kindex shell
1327 @cindex shell escape
1328 @item shell @var{command string}
1329 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1330 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1331 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1332 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1333 @end table
1334
1335 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1336 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1337 @value{GDBN}:
1338
1339 @table @code
1340 @kindex make
1341 @cindex calling make
1342 @item make @var{make-args}
1343 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1344 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1345 @end table
1346
1347 @node Logging Output
1348 @section Logging Output
1349 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1350 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1351
1352 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1353 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1354
1355 @table @code
1356 @kindex set logging
1357 @item set logging on
1358 Enable logging.
1359 @item set logging off
1360 Disable logging.
1361 @cindex logging file name
1362 @item set logging file @var{file}
1363 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1364 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1365 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1366 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1367 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1368 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1369 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1370 @kindex show logging
1371 @item show logging
1372 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1373 @end table
1374
1375 @node Commands
1376 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1377
1378 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1379 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1380 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1381 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1382 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1383
1384 @menu
1385 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1386 * Completion:: Command completion
1387 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1388 @end menu
1389
1390 @node Command Syntax
1391 @section Command Syntax
1392
1393 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1394 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1395 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1396 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1397 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1398 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1399
1400 @cindex abbreviation
1401 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1402 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1403 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1404 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1405 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1406 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1407 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1408
1409 @cindex repeating commands
1410 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1411 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1412 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1413 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1414 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1415 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1416 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1417
1418 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1419 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1420 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1421
1422 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1423 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1424 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1425 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1426 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1427
1428 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1429 @cindex comment
1430 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1431 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1432 Files,,Command Files}).
1433
1434 @cindex repeating command sequences
1435 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1436 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1437 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1438 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1439 for editing.
1440
1441 @node Completion
1442 @section Command Completion
1443
1444 @cindex completion
1445 @cindex word completion
1446 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1447 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1448 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1449 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1450
1451 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1452 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1453 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1454 enter it). For example, if you type
1455
1456 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1457 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1458 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1459 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1460 @smallexample
1461 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1462 @end smallexample
1463
1464 @noindent
1465 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1466 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1467
1468 @smallexample
1469 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1470 @end smallexample
1471
1472 @noindent
1473 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1474 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1475 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1476 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1477 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1478 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1479
1480 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1481 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1482 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1483 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1484 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1485 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1486 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1487 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1488 example:
1489
1490 @smallexample
1491 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1492 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1493 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1494 make_abs_section make_function_type
1495 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1496 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1497 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1498 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1499 @end smallexample
1500
1501 @noindent
1502 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1503 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1504 command.
1505
1506 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1507 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1508 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1509 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1510 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1511
1512 @cindex quotes in commands
1513 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1514 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1515 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1516 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1517 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1518 @value{GDBN} commands.
1519
1520 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1521 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1522 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1523 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1524 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1525 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1526 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1527 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1528 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1529 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1530 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1531
1532 @smallexample
1533 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1534 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1535 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1536 @end smallexample
1537
1538 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1539 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1540 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1541 place:
1542
1543 @smallexample
1544 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1545 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1546 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1547 @end smallexample
1548
1549 @noindent
1550 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1551 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1552 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1553
1554 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1555 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1556 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1557 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1558
1559 @cindex completion of structure field names
1560 @cindex structure field name completion
1561 @cindex completion of union field names
1562 @cindex union field name completion
1563 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1564 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1565 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1566 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1567 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1568 left-hand-side:
1569
1570 @smallexample
1571 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1572 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1573 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1574 @end smallexample
1575
1576 @noindent
1577 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1578 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1579 follows:
1580
1581 @smallexample
1582 struct ui_file
1583 @{
1584 int *magic;
1585 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1586 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1587 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1588 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1589 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1590 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1591 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1592 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1593 void *to_data;
1594 @}
1595 @end smallexample
1596
1597
1598 @node Help
1599 @section Getting Help
1600 @cindex online documentation
1601 @kindex help
1602
1603 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1604 using the command @code{help}.
1605
1606 @table @code
1607 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1608 @item help
1609 @itemx h
1610 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1611 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1612
1613 @smallexample
1614 (@value{GDBP}) help
1615 List of classes of commands:
1616
1617 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1618 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1619 data -- Examining data
1620 files -- Specifying and examining files
1621 internals -- Maintenance commands
1622 obscure -- Obscure features
1623 running -- Running the program
1624 stack -- Examining the stack
1625 status -- Status inquiries
1626 support -- Support facilities
1627 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1628 stopping the program
1629 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1630
1631 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1632 commands in that class.
1633 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1634 documentation.
1635 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1636 (@value{GDBP})
1637 @end smallexample
1638 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1639
1640 @item help @var{class}
1641 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1642 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1643 help display for the class @code{status}:
1644
1645 @smallexample
1646 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1647 Status inquiries.
1648
1649 List of commands:
1650
1651 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1652 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1653 info -- Generic command for showing things
1654 about the program being debugged
1655 show -- Generic command for showing things
1656 about the debugger
1657
1658 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1659 documentation.
1660 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1661 (@value{GDBP})
1662 @end smallexample
1663
1664 @item help @var{command}
1665 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1666 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1667
1668 @kindex apropos
1669 @item apropos @var{args}
1670 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1671 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1672 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1673
1674 @smallexample
1675 apropos reload
1676 @end smallexample
1677
1678 @noindent
1679 results in:
1680
1681 @smallexample
1682 @c @group
1683 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1684 multiple times in one run
1685 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1686 multiple times in one run
1687 @c @end group
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690 @kindex complete
1691 @item complete @var{args}
1692 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1693 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1694 command you want completed. For example:
1695
1696 @smallexample
1697 complete i
1698 @end smallexample
1699
1700 @noindent results in:
1701
1702 @smallexample
1703 @group
1704 if
1705 ignore
1706 info
1707 inspect
1708 @end group
1709 @end smallexample
1710
1711 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1712 @end table
1713
1714 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1715 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1716 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1717 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1718 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1719 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1720
1721 @c @group
1722 @table @code
1723 @kindex info
1724 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1725 @item info
1726 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1727 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1728 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1729 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1730 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1731 @w{@code{help info}}.
1732
1733 @kindex set
1734 @item set
1735 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1736 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1737 @code{set prompt $}.
1738
1739 @kindex show
1740 @item show
1741 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1742 @value{GDBN} itself.
1743 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1744 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1745 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1746 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1747
1748 @kindex info set
1749 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1750 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1751 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1752 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1753 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1754 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1755 @end table
1756 @c @end group
1757
1758 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1759 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1760
1761 @table @code
1762 @kindex show version
1763 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1764 @item show version
1765 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1766 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1767 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1768 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1769 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1770 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1771 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1772 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1773 @value{GDBN}.
1774
1775 @kindex show copying
1776 @kindex info copying
1777 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1778 @item show copying
1779 @itemx info copying
1780 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1781
1782 @kindex show warranty
1783 @kindex info warranty
1784 @item show warranty
1785 @itemx info warranty
1786 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1787 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1788
1789 @end table
1790
1791 @node Running
1792 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1793
1794 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1795 debugging information when you compile it.
1796
1797 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1798 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1799 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1800 kill a child process.
1801
1802 @menu
1803 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1804 * Starting:: Starting your program
1805 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1806 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1807
1808 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1809 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1810 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1811 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1812
1813 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1814 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1815 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1816 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1817 @end menu
1818
1819 @node Compilation
1820 @section Compiling for Debugging
1821
1822 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1823 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1824 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1825 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1826 and addresses in the executable code.
1827
1828 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1829 the compiler.
1830
1831 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1832 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1833 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1834 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1835 executables containing debugging information.
1836
1837 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1838 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1839 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1840 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1841 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1842
1843 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1844 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1845 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1846
1847 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1848 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1849 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1850 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1851 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1852 provides macro information if you specify the options
1853 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1854 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1855 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1856 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1857 @option{-g} alone.
1858
1859 @need 2000
1860 @node Starting
1861 @section Starting your Program
1862 @cindex starting
1863 @cindex running
1864
1865 @table @code
1866 @kindex run
1867 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1868 @item run
1869 @itemx r
1870 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1871 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1872 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1873 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1874 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1875
1876 @end table
1877
1878 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1879 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1880 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1881 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1882 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1883 message like this one:
1884
1885 @smallexample
1886 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1887 Try "help target" or "continue".
1888 @end smallexample
1889
1890 @noindent
1891 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1892 first (@pxref{load}).
1893
1894 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1895 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1896 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1897 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1898 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1899 divided into four categories:
1900
1901 @table @asis
1902 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1903 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1904 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1905 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1906 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1907 the arguments.
1908 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1909 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1910 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1911
1912 @item The @emph{environment.}
1913 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1914 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1915 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1916 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1917
1918 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1919 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1920 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1921 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1922
1923 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1924 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1925 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1926 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1927 set a different device for your program.
1928 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1929
1930 @cindex pipes
1931 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1932 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1933 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1934 wrong program.
1935 @end table
1936
1937 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1938 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1939 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1940 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1941 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1942
1943 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1944 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1945 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1946 your current breakpoints.
1947
1948 @table @code
1949 @kindex start
1950 @item start
1951 @cindex run to main procedure
1952 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1953 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1954 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1955 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1956 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1957 procedure, depending on the language used.
1958
1959 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1960 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1961 the @samp{run} command.
1962
1963 @cindex elaboration phase
1964 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1965 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1966 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1967 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1968 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1969 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1970 will remain to halt execution.
1971
1972 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1973 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1974 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1975 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1976 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1977
1978 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1979 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1980 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1981 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1982 elaboration code before running your program.
1983
1984 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1985 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1986 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1987 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1988 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1989 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1990 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1991 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1992 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1993 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1994 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1995
1996 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1997 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1998 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1999 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2000
2001 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2002 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2003 environment:
2004
2005 @smallexample
2006 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2007 (@value{GDBP}) run
2008 @end smallexample
2009
2010 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2011 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2012
2013 @kindex set disable-randomization
2014 @item set disable-randomization
2015 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2016 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2017 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2018 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2019 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2020
2021 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2022 behavior using
2023
2024 @smallexample
2025 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2026 @end smallexample
2027
2028 @item set disable-randomization off
2029 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2030 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2031 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2032 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2033 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2034 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2035
2036 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2037 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2038 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2039 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2040 a code at its expected addresses.
2041
2042 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2043 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2044 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2045 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2046 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2047 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2048 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2049 a randomly chosen address.
2050
2051 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2052 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2053 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2054 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2055 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2056
2057 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2058 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2059
2060 @item show disable-randomization
2061 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2062 the virtual address space of the started program.
2063
2064 @end table
2065
2066 @node Arguments
2067 @section Your Program's Arguments
2068
2069 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2070 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2071 @code{run} command.
2072 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2073 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2074 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2075 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2076 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2077
2078 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2079 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2080 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2081 the program, not by the shell.
2082
2083 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2084 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2085
2086 @table @code
2087 @kindex set args
2088 @item set args
2089 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2090 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2091 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2092 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2093 it again without arguments.
2094
2095 @kindex show args
2096 @item show args
2097 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2098 @end table
2099
2100 @node Environment
2101 @section Your Program's Environment
2102
2103 @cindex environment (of your program)
2104 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2105 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2106 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2107 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2108 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2109 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2110 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2111
2112 @table @code
2113 @kindex path
2114 @item path @var{directory}
2115 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2116 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2117 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2118 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2119 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2120 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2121 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2122
2123 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2124 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2125 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2126 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2127 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2128 @var{directory} to the search path.
2129 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2130 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2131
2132 @kindex show paths
2133 @item show paths
2134 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2135 environment variable).
2136
2137 @kindex show environment
2138 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2139 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2140 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2141 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2142 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2143
2144 @kindex set environment
2145 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2146 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2147 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2148 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2149 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2150 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2151 null value.
2152 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2153 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2154
2155 For example, this command:
2156
2157 @smallexample
2158 set env USER = foo
2159 @end smallexample
2160
2161 @noindent
2162 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2163 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2164 are not actually required.)
2165
2166 @kindex unset environment
2167 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2168 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2169 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2170 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2171 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2172 @end table
2173
2174 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2175 the shell indicated
2176 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2177 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2178 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2179 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2180 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2181 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2182 @file{.profile}.
2183
2184 @node Working Directory
2185 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2186
2187 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2188 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2189 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2190 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2191 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2192 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2193
2194 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2195 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2196 Specify Files}.
2197
2198 @table @code
2199 @kindex cd
2200 @cindex change working directory
2201 @item cd @var{directory}
2202 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2203
2204 @kindex pwd
2205 @item pwd
2206 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2207 @end table
2208
2209 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2210 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2211 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2212 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2213 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2214 current working directory of the debuggee.
2215
2216 @node Input/Output
2217 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2218
2219 @cindex redirection
2220 @cindex i/o
2221 @cindex terminal
2222 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2223 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2224 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2225 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2226 running your program.
2227
2228 @table @code
2229 @kindex info terminal
2230 @item info terminal
2231 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2232 program is using.
2233 @end table
2234
2235 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2236 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2237
2238 @smallexample
2239 run > outfile
2240 @end smallexample
2241
2242 @noindent
2243 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2244
2245 @kindex tty
2246 @cindex controlling terminal
2247 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2248 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2249 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2250 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2251 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2252
2253 @smallexample
2254 tty /dev/ttyb
2255 @end smallexample
2256
2257 @noindent
2258 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2259 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2260 that as their controlling terminal.
2261
2262 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2263 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2264 terminal.
2265
2266 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2267 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2268 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2269 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2270
2271 @cindex inferior tty
2272 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2273 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2274 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2275 program.
2276
2277 @table @code
2278 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2279 @kindex set inferior-tty
2280 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2281
2282 @item show inferior-tty
2283 @kindex show inferior-tty
2284 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2285 @end table
2286
2287 @node Attach
2288 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2289 @kindex attach
2290 @cindex attach
2291
2292 @table @code
2293 @item attach @var{process-id}
2294 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2295 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2296 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2297 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2298 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2299
2300 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2301 executing the command.
2302 @end table
2303
2304 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2305 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2306 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2307 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2308
2309 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2310 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2311 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2312 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2313 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2314 Specify Files}.
2315
2316 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2317 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2318 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2319 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2320 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2321 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2322 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2323
2324 @table @code
2325 @kindex detach
2326 @item detach
2327 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2328 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2329 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2330 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2331 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2332 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2333 executing the command.
2334 @end table
2335
2336 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2337 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2338 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2339 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2340 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2341 Messages}).
2342
2343 @node Kill Process
2344 @section Killing the Child Process
2345
2346 @table @code
2347 @kindex kill
2348 @item kill
2349 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2350 @end table
2351
2352 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2353 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2354 is running.
2355
2356 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2357 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2358 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2359 outside the debugger.
2360
2361 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2362 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2363 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2364 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2365 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2366 breakpoint settings).
2367
2368 @node Inferiors and Programs
2369 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2370
2371 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2372 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2373 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2374 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2375 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2376 from multiple executables.
2377
2378 @cindex inferior
2379 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2380 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2381 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2382 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2383 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2384 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2385 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2386 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2387 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2388 threads running in it.
2389
2390 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2391 inferiors}}:
2392
2393 @table @code
2394 @kindex info inferiors
2395 @item info inferiors
2396 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2397
2398 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2399
2400 @enumerate
2401 @item
2402 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2403
2404 @item
2405 the target system's inferior identifier
2406
2407 @item
2408 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2409
2410 @end enumerate
2411
2412 @noindent
2413 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2414 indicates the current inferior.
2415
2416 For example,
2417 @end table
2418 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2419
2420 @smallexample
2421 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2422 Num Description Executable
2423 2 process 2307 hello
2424 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2425 @end smallexample
2426
2427 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2428
2429 @table @code
2430 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2431 @item inferior @var{infno}
2432 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2433 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2434 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2435 @end table
2436
2437
2438 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2439 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2440 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2441 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2442 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2443 @w{@code{remove-inferior}} command.
2444
2445 @table @code
2446 @kindex add-inferior
2447 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2448 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2449 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2450 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2451 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2452 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2453
2454 @kindex clone-inferior
2455 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2456 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2457 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2458 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2459 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2460
2461 @smallexample
2462 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2463 Num Description Executable
2464 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2465 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2466 Added inferior 2.
2467 1 inferiors added.
2468 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2469 Num Description Executable
2470 2 <null> helloworld
2471 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2472 @end smallexample
2473
2474 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2475
2476 @kindex remove-inferior
2477 @item remove-inferior @var{infno}
2478 Removes the inferior @var{infno}. It is not possible to remove an
2479 inferior that is running with this command. For those, use the
2480 @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2481
2482 @end table
2483
2484 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2485 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2486 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2487 using the @w{@code{kill inferior}} command:
2488
2489 @table @code
2490 @kindex detach inferior @var{infno}
2491 @item detach inferior @var{infno}
2492 Detach from the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2493 @var{infno}. Note that the inferior's entry still stays on the list
2494 of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its Description will
2495 show @samp{<null>}.
2496
2497 @kindex kill inferior @var{infno}
2498 @item kill inferior @var{infno}
2499 Kill the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2500 @var{infno}. Note that the inferior's entry still stays on the list
2501 of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its Description will
2502 show @samp{<null>}.
2503 @end table
2504
2505 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2506 @code{detach inferior}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferior}, or after
2507 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2508 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2509
2510
2511 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2512 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2513
2514 @table @code
2515 @kindex set print inferior-events
2516 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2517 @item set print inferior-events
2518 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2519 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2520 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2521 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2522 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2523 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2524
2525 @kindex show print inferior-events
2526 @item show print inferior-events
2527 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2528 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2529 @end table
2530
2531 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2532 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2533 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2534
2535
2536 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2537 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2538 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2539 info program-spaces}} command.
2540
2541 @table @code
2542 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2543 @item maint info program-spaces
2544 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2545 @value{GDBN}.
2546
2547 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2548
2549 @enumerate
2550 @item
2551 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2552
2553 @item
2554 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2555 the @code{file} command.
2556
2557 @end enumerate
2558
2559 @noindent
2560 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2561 indicates the current program space.
2562
2563 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2564 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2565 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2566
2567 @smallexample
2568 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2569 Id Executable
2570 2 goodbye
2571 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2572 * 1 hello
2573 @end smallexample
2574
2575 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2576 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2577 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2578 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2579 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2580
2581 @smallexample
2582 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2583 Id Executable
2584 * 1 vfork-test
2585 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2586 @end smallexample
2587
2588 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2589 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2590 @end table
2591
2592 @node Threads
2593 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2594
2595 @cindex threads of execution
2596 @cindex multiple threads
2597 @cindex switching threads
2598 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2599 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2600 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2601 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2602 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2603 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2604 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2605
2606 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2607 programs:
2608
2609 @itemize @bullet
2610 @item automatic notification of new threads
2611 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2612 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2613 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2614 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2615 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2616 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2617 messages on thread start and exit.
2618 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2619 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2620 isn't compatible with the program.
2621 @end itemize
2622
2623 @quotation
2624 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2625 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2626 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2627 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2628 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2629 like this:
2630
2631 @smallexample
2632 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2633 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2634 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2635 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2636 @end smallexample
2637 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2638 @c doesn't support threads"?
2639 @end quotation
2640
2641 @cindex focus of debugging
2642 @cindex current thread
2643 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2644 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2645 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2646 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2647 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2648
2649 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2650 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2651 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2652 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2653 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2654 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2655 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2656 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2657 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2658 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2659
2660 @smallexample
2661 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2662 @end smallexample
2663
2664 @noindent
2665 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2666 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2667 further qualifier.
2668
2669 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2670 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2671 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2672 @c program?
2673 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2674 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2675 @c threads ab initio?
2676
2677 @cindex thread number
2678 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2679 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2680 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2681
2682 @table @code
2683 @kindex info threads
2684 @item info threads
2685 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2686 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2687
2688 @enumerate
2689 @item
2690 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2691
2692 @item
2693 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2694
2695 @item
2696 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2697 @end enumerate
2698
2699 @noindent
2700 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2701 indicates the current thread.
2702
2703 For example,
2704 @end table
2705 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2706
2707 @smallexample
2708 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2709 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2710 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2711 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2712 at threadtest.c:68
2713 @end smallexample
2714
2715 On HP-UX systems:
2716
2717 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2718 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2719 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2720 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2721 thread in your program.
2722
2723 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2724 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2725 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2726 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2727 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2728 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2729 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2730 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2731 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2732 HP-UX, you see
2733
2734 @smallexample
2735 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2736 @end smallexample
2737
2738 @noindent
2739 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2740
2741 @table @code
2742 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2743 @item info threads
2744 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2745 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2746
2747 @enumerate
2748 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2749
2750 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2751
2752 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2753 @end enumerate
2754
2755 @noindent
2756 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2757 indicates the current thread.
2758
2759 For example,
2760 @end table
2761 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2762
2763 @smallexample
2764 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2765 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2766 at quicksort.c:137
2767 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2768 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2769 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2770 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2771 @end smallexample
2772
2773 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2774 Solaris-specific command:
2775
2776 @table @code
2777 @item maint info sol-threads
2778 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2779 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2780 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2781 @end table
2782
2783 @table @code
2784 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2785 @item thread @var{threadno}
2786 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2787 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2788 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2789 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2790 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2791
2792 @smallexample
2793 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2794 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2795 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2796 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2797 @end smallexample
2798
2799 @noindent
2800 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2801 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2802 threads.
2803
2804 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2805 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2806 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2807 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2808 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2809 information on convenience variables.
2810
2811 @kindex thread apply
2812 @cindex apply command to several threads
2813 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2814 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2815 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2816 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2817 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2818 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2819 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2820 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2821
2822 @kindex set print thread-events
2823 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2824 @item set print thread-events
2825 @itemx set print thread-events on
2826 @itemx set print thread-events off
2827 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2828 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2829 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2830 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2831 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2832
2833 @kindex show print thread-events
2834 @item show print thread-events
2835 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2836 have started and exited.
2837 @end table
2838
2839 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2840 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2841 programs with multiple threads.
2842
2843 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2844 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2845
2846 @table @code
2847 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2848 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2849 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2850 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2851 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2852 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2853 an empty list.
2854
2855 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2856 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2857 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2858 to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue
2859 with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory
2860 from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process.
2861
2862 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2863 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2864 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2865 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2866 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2867 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2868 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2869
2870 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2871 only on some platforms.
2872
2873 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2874 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2875 Display current libthread_db search path.
2876
2877 @kindex set debug libthread-db
2878 @kindex show debug libthread-db
2879 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
2880 @item set debug libthread-db
2881 @itemx show debug libthread-db
2882 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
2883 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
2884 @end table
2885
2886 @node Forks
2887 @section Debugging Forks
2888
2889 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2890 @cindex multiple processes
2891 @cindex processes, multiple
2892 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2893 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2894 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2895 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2896 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2897 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2898 will cause it to terminate.
2899
2900 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2901 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2902 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2903 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2904 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2905 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2906 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2907 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2908 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2909 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2910
2911 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2912 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2913 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2914 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2915
2916 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2917 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2918
2919 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2920 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2921
2922 @table @code
2923 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2924 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2925 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2926 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2927 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2928
2929 @table @code
2930 @item parent
2931 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2932 unimpeded. This is the default.
2933
2934 @item child
2935 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2936 unimpeded.
2937
2938 @end table
2939
2940 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2941 @item show follow-fork-mode
2942 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2943 @end table
2944
2945 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2946 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2947 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2948
2949 @table @code
2950 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2951 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2952 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2953 retain debugger control over them both.
2954
2955 @table @code
2956 @item on
2957 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2958 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2959 independently. This is the default.
2960
2961 @item off
2962 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2963 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2964 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2965 is held suspended.
2966
2967 @end table
2968
2969 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2970 @item show detach-on-fork
2971 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2972 @end table
2973
2974 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
2975 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
2976 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
2977 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
2978 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
2979 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
2980
2981 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2982 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferior}} command (allowing it
2983 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferior}}
2984 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2985 and Programs}.
2986
2987 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2988 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2989 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2990 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2991 the child process's @code{main}.
2992
2993 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
2994 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2995
2996 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2997 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
2998 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
2999 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3000 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3001 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3002 command.
3003
3004 @table @code
3005 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3006 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3007
3008 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3009 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3010
3011 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3012
3013 @table @code
3014 @item new
3015 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3016 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3017 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3018 original inferior.
3019
3020 For example:
3021
3022 @smallexample
3023 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3024 (gdb) info inferior
3025 Id Description Executable
3026 * 1 <null> prog1
3027 (@value{GDBP}) run
3028 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3029 Program exited normally.
3030 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3031 Id Description Executable
3032 * 2 <null> prog2
3033 1 <null> prog1
3034 @end smallexample
3035
3036 @item same
3037 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3038 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3039 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3040 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3041 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3042
3043 For example:
3044
3045 @smallexample
3046 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3047 Id Description Executable
3048 * 1 <null> prog1
3049 (@value{GDBP}) run
3050 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3051 Program exited normally.
3052 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3053 Id Description Executable
3054 * 1 <null> prog2
3055 @end smallexample
3056
3057 @end table
3058 @end table
3059
3060 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3061 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3062 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3063
3064 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3065 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3066
3067 @cindex checkpoint
3068 @cindex restart
3069 @cindex bookmark
3070 @cindex snapshot of a process
3071 @cindex rewind program state
3072
3073 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3074 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3075 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3076 later.
3077
3078 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3079 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3080 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3081 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3082 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3083
3084 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3085 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3086 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3087 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3088 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3089 start again from there.
3090
3091 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3092 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3093
3094 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3095
3096 @table @code
3097 @kindex checkpoint
3098 @item checkpoint
3099 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3100 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3101 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3102
3103 @kindex info checkpoints
3104 @item info checkpoints
3105 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3106 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3107 listed:
3108
3109 @table @code
3110 @item Checkpoint ID
3111 @item Process ID
3112 @item Code Address
3113 @item Source line, or label
3114 @end table
3115
3116 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3117 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3118 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3119 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3120 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3121 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3122 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3123
3124 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3125 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3126 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3127 the debugger.
3128
3129 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3130 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3131 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3132
3133 @end table
3134
3135 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3136 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3137 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3138 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3139 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3140 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3141 previously read data can be read again.
3142
3143 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3144 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3145 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3146 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3147 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3148 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3149
3150 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3151 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3152 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3153 different execution path this time.
3154
3155 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3156 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3157 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3158 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3159 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3160 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3161 potentially pose a problem.
3162
3163 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3164
3165 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3166 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3167 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3168 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3169 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3170 next.
3171
3172 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3173 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3174 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3175 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3176 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3177
3178 @node Stopping
3179 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3180
3181 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3182 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3183 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3184
3185 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3186 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3187 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3188 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3189 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3190 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3191 explicitly request this information at any time.
3192
3193 @table @code
3194 @kindex info program
3195 @item info program
3196 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3197 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3198 @end table
3199
3200 @menu
3201 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3202 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3203 * Signals:: Signals
3204 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3205 @end menu
3206
3207 @node Breakpoints
3208 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3209
3210 @cindex breakpoints
3211 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3212 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3213 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3214 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3215 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3216 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3217 program.
3218
3219 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3220 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3221 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3222 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3223 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3224 call).
3225
3226 @cindex watchpoints
3227 @cindex data breakpoints
3228 @cindex memory tracing
3229 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3230 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3231 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3232 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3233 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3234 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3235 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3236 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3237 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3238 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3239 same commands.
3240
3241 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3242 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3243 Automatic Display}.
3244
3245 @cindex catchpoints
3246 @cindex breakpoint on events
3247 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3248 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3249 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3250 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3251 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3252 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3253 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3254
3255 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3256 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3257 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3258 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3259 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3260 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3261 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3262 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3263 enable it again.
3264
3265 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3266 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3267 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3268 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3269 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3270 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3271 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3272
3273 @menu
3274 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3275 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3276 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3277 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3278 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3279 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3280 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3281 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3282 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3283 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3284 @end menu
3285
3286 @node Set Breaks
3287 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3288
3289 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3290 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3291 @c
3292 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3293
3294 @kindex break
3295 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3296 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3297 @cindex latest breakpoint
3298 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3299 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3300 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3301 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3302 convenience variables.
3303
3304 @table @code
3305 @item break @var{location}
3306 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3307 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3308 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3309 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3310 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3311
3312 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3313 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3314 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3315 that situation.
3316
3317 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3318 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3319 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3320
3321 @item break
3322 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3323 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3324 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3325 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3326 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3327 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3328 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3329 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3330 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3331 inside loops.
3332
3333 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3334 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3335 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3336 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3337 existed when your program stopped.
3338
3339 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3340 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3341 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3342 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3343 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3344 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3345 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3346
3347 @kindex tbreak
3348 @item tbreak @var{args}
3349 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3350 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3351 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3352 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3353
3354 @kindex hbreak
3355 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3356 @item hbreak @var{args}
3357 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3358 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3359 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3360 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3361 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3362 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3363 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3364 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3365 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3366 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3367 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3368 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3369 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3370 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3371 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3372 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3373 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3374 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3375
3376 @kindex thbreak
3377 @item thbreak @var{args}
3378 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3379 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3380 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3381 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3382 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3383 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3384 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3385 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3386
3387 @kindex rbreak
3388 @cindex regular expression
3389 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3390 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3391 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3392 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3393 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3394 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3395 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3396 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3397 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3398
3399 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3400 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3401 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3402 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3403 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3404 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3405
3406 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3407 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3408 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3409 classes.
3410
3411 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3412 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3413 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3414
3415 @smallexample
3416 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3417 @end smallexample
3418
3419 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3420 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3421 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3422 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3423 every function in a given file:
3424
3425 @smallexample
3426 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3427 @end smallexample
3428
3429 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3430 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3431
3432 @kindex info breakpoints
3433 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3434 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3435 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3436 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3437 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3438 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3439 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3440
3441 @table @emph
3442 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3443 @item Type
3444 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3445 @item Disposition
3446 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3447 @item Enabled or Disabled
3448 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3449 that are not enabled.
3450 @item Address
3451 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3452 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3453 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3454 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3455 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3456 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3457 @item What
3458 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3459 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3460 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3461 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3462 @end table
3463
3464 @noindent
3465 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3466 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3467 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3468 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3469 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3470 valid location.
3471
3472 @noindent
3473 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3474 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3475 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3476 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3477 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3478
3479 @noindent
3480 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3481 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3482 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3483 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3484 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3485 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3486 @end table
3487
3488 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3489 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3490 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3491 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3492
3493 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3494 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3495 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3496 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3497
3498 @itemize @bullet
3499 @item
3500 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3501 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3502
3503 @item
3504 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3505 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3506
3507 @item
3508 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3509 several places where that function is inlined.
3510 @end itemize
3511
3512 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3513 the relevant locations@footnote{
3514 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3515 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3516 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3517 info with line numbers for them.}.
3518
3519 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3520 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3521 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3522 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3523 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3524 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3525 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3526
3527 For example:
3528
3529 @smallexample
3530 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3531 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3532 stop only if i==1
3533 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3534 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3535 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3536 @end smallexample
3537
3538 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3539 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3540 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3541 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3542 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3543 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3544 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3545 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3546 that belong to that breakpoint.
3547
3548 @cindex pending breakpoints
3549 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3550 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3551 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3552 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3553 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3554 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3555 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3556 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3557 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3558 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3559 is not yet resolved.
3560
3561 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3562 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3563 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3564 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3565 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3566 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3567
3568 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3569 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3570 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3571 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3572
3573 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3574 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3575 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3576
3577 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3578 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3579 address specification to an address:
3580
3581 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3582 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3583 @table @code
3584 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3585 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3586 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3587
3588 @item set breakpoint pending on
3589 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3590 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3591
3592 @item set breakpoint pending off
3593 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3594 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3595 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3596
3597 @item show breakpoint pending
3598 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3599 @end table
3600
3601 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3602 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3603 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3604
3605 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3606 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3607 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3608 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3609 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3610 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3611 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3612 breakpoints.
3613
3614 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3615
3616 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3617 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3618 @table @code
3619 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3620 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3621 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3622 breakpoint must be used.
3623
3624 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3625 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3626 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3627 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3628 @end table
3629
3630 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3631 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3632 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3633 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3634 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3635 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3636 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3637 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3638 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3639
3640 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3641 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3642 @table @code
3643 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3644 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3645 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3646 removed from the target when it stops.
3647
3648 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3649 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3650 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3651 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3652 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3653
3654 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3655 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3656 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3657 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3658 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3659 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3660 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3661 @end table
3662
3663 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3664 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3665 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3666 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3667 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3668 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3669 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3670 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3671
3672
3673 @node Set Watchpoints
3674 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3675
3676 @cindex setting watchpoints
3677 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3678 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3679 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3680 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3681 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3682
3683 @itemize @bullet
3684 @item
3685 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3686
3687 @item
3688 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3689 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3690 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3691
3692 @item
3693 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3694 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3695 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3696 @end itemize
3697
3698 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3699 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3700 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3701 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3702 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3703 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3704 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3705 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3706 the expression changes.
3707
3708 @cindex software watchpoints
3709 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3710 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3711 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3712 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3713 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3714 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3715 culprit.)
3716
3717 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3718 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3719 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3720
3721 @table @code
3722 @kindex watch
3723 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3724 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3725 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3726 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3727 to watch the value of a single variable:
3728
3729 @smallexample
3730 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3731 @end smallexample
3732
3733 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3734 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3735 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3736 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3737 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3738 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3739
3740 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3741 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3742 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3743 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3744 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3745 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3746 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3747 error.
3748
3749 @kindex rwatch
3750 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3751 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3752 by the program.
3753
3754 @kindex awatch
3755 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3756 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3757 or written into by the program.
3758
3759 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3760 @item info watchpoints
3761 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3762 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3763 @end table
3764
3765 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3766 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3767 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3768 a never-changing value:
3769
3770 @smallexample
3771 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3772 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3773 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3774 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3775 @end smallexample
3776
3777 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3778 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3779 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3780 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3781 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3782 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3783
3784 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3785 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3786 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3787 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3788 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3789 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3790 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3791 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3792
3793 @table @code
3794 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3795 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3796 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3797
3798 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3799 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3800 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3801 @end table
3802
3803 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3804 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3805 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3806
3807 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3808
3809 @smallexample
3810 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3811 @end smallexample
3812
3813 @noindent
3814 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3815
3816 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3817 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3818 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3819 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3820 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3821 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3822 will print a message like this:
3823
3824 @smallexample
3825 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3826 @end smallexample
3827
3828 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3829 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3830 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3831 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3832 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3833 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3834 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3835 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3836
3837 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3838 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3839 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3840 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3841 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3842 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3843
3844 @smallexample
3845 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3846 @end smallexample
3847
3848 @noindent
3849 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3850
3851 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3852 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3853 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3854 expression with separately allocated resources.
3855
3856 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3857 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3858 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3859
3860 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3861 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3862 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3863 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3864 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3865 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3866 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3867 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3868 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3869
3870 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3871 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3872 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3873 watched expression from every thread.
3874
3875 @quotation
3876 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3877 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3878 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3879 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3880 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3881 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3882 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3883 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3884 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3885 @end quotation
3886
3887 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3888
3889 @node Set Catchpoints
3890 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3891 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3892 @cindex exception handlers
3893 @cindex event handling
3894
3895 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3896 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3897 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3898
3899 @table @code
3900 @kindex catch
3901 @item catch @var{event}
3902 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3903 @table @code
3904 @item throw
3905 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3906 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3907
3908 @item catch
3909 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3910
3911 @item exception
3912 @cindex Ada exception catching
3913 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3914 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3915 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3916 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3917 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3918
3919 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3920 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3921 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3922 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3923 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3924 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3925 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3926 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3927
3928 @item exception unhandled
3929 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3930
3931 @item assert
3932 A failed Ada assertion.
3933
3934 @item exec
3935 @cindex break on fork/exec
3936 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3937 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3938
3939 @item syscall
3940 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
3941 @cindex break on a system call.
3942 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
3943 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
3944 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
3945 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
3946 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
3947 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
3948 will be caught.
3949
3950 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
3951 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
3952 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
3953 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
3954
3955 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
3956 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
3957 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
3958 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
3959
3960 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
3961 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
3962 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
3963 available choices.
3964
3965 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
3966 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
3967 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
3968 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
3969 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
3970 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
3971 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
3972 behind the OS upgrades).
3973
3974 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
3975 arguments to it:
3976
3977 @smallexample
3978 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
3979 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
3980 (@value{GDBP}) r
3981 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3982
3983 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
3984 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3985 (@value{GDBP}) c
3986 Continuing.
3987
3988 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
3989 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3990 (@value{GDBP})
3991 @end smallexample
3992
3993 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
3994
3995 @smallexample
3996 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
3997 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
3998 (@value{GDBP}) r
3999 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4000
4001 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4002 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4003 (@value{GDBP}) c
4004 Continuing.
4005
4006 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4007 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4008 (@value{GDBP})
4009 @end smallexample
4010
4011 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4012 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4013 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4014
4015 @smallexample
4016 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4017 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4018 (@value{GDBP}) r
4019 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4020
4021 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4022 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4023 (@value{GDBP}) c
4024 Continuing.
4025
4026 Program exited normally.
4027 (@value{GDBP})
4028 @end smallexample
4029
4030 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4031 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4032 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4033 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4034
4035 @smallexample
4036 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4037 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4038 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4039 (@value{GDBP})
4040 @end smallexample
4041
4042 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4043 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4044 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4045 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4046 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4047 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4048
4049 @smallexample
4050 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4051 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4052 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4053 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4054 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4055 (@value{GDBP})
4056 @end smallexample
4057
4058 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4059
4060 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4061 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4062
4063 @smallexample
4064 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4065 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4066 @end smallexample
4067
4068 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4069
4070 @item fork
4071 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4072 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4073
4074 @item vfork
4075 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4076 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4077
4078 @end table
4079
4080 @item tcatch @var{event}
4081 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4082 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4083
4084 @end table
4085
4086 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4087
4088 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4089 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4090
4091 @itemize @bullet
4092 @item
4093 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4094 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4095 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4096 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4097 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4098 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4099 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4100 disabled within interactive calls.
4101
4102 @item
4103 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4104
4105 @item
4106 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4107 @end itemize
4108
4109 @cindex raise exceptions
4110 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4111 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4112 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4113 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4114 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4115 out where the exception was raised.
4116
4117 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4118 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4119 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4120 which has the following ANSI C interface:
4121
4122 @smallexample
4123 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4124 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4125 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4126 @end smallexample
4127
4128 @noindent
4129 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4130 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4131 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4132
4133 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4134 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4135 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4136 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4137 raised.
4138
4139
4140 @node Delete Breaks
4141 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4142
4143 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4144 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4145 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4146 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4147 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4148 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4149
4150 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4151 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4152 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4153 their breakpoint numbers.
4154
4155 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4156 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4157 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4158
4159 @table @code
4160 @kindex clear
4161 @item clear
4162 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4163 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4164 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4165 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4166
4167 @item clear @var{location}
4168 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4169 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4170 most useful ones are listed below:
4171
4172 @table @code
4173 @item clear @var{function}
4174 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4175 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4176
4177 @item clear @var{linenum}
4178 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4179 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4180 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4181 @end table
4182
4183 @cindex delete breakpoints
4184 @kindex delete
4185 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4186 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4187 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4188 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4189 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4190 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4191 @end table
4192
4193 @node Disabling
4194 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4195
4196 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4197 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4198 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4199 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4200 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4201
4202 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4203 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4204 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4205 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4206 do not know which numbers to use.
4207
4208 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4209 affects all of its locations.
4210
4211 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
4212 states of enablement:
4213
4214 @itemize @bullet
4215 @item
4216 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4217 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4218 @item
4219 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4220 @item
4221 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4222 disabled.
4223 @item
4224 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4225 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4226 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4227 @end itemize
4228
4229 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4230 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4231
4232 @table @code
4233 @kindex disable
4234 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4235 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4236 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4237 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4238 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4239 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4240 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4241
4242 @kindex enable
4243 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4244 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4245 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4246
4247 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4248 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4249 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4250
4251 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4252 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4253 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4254 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4255 @end table
4256
4257 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4258 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4259 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4260 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4261 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4262 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4263 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4264 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4265 Stepping}.)
4266
4267 @node Conditions
4268 @subsection Break Conditions
4269 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4270 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4271
4272 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4273 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4274 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4275 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4276 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4277 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4278 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4279 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4280
4281 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4282 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4283 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4284 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4285 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4286
4287 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4288 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4289 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4290 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4291 one.
4292
4293 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4294 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4295 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4296 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4297 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4298 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4299 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4300 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4301 conditions for the
4302 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4303 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4304
4305 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4306 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4307 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4308 with the @code{condition} command.
4309
4310 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4311 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4312 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4313 catchpoint.
4314
4315 @table @code
4316 @kindex condition
4317 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4318 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4319 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4320 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4321 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4322 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4323 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4324 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4325 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4326 prints an error message:
4327
4328 @smallexample
4329 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4330 @end smallexample
4331
4332 @noindent
4333 @value{GDBN} does
4334 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4335 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4336 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4337
4338 @item condition @var{bnum}
4339 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4340 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4341 @end table
4342
4343 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4344 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4345 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4346 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4347 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4348 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4349 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4350 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4351 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4352 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4353 your program reaches it.
4354
4355 @table @code
4356 @kindex ignore
4357 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4358 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4359 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4360 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4361 takes no action.
4362
4363 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4364 a count of zero.
4365
4366 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4367 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4368 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4369 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4370
4371 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4372 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4373 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4374
4375 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4376 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4377 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4378 Variables}.
4379 @end table
4380
4381 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4382
4383
4384 @node Break Commands
4385 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4386
4387 @cindex breakpoint commands
4388 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4389 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4390 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4391 enable other breakpoints.
4392
4393 @table @code
4394 @kindex commands
4395 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4396 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4397 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4398 @itemx end
4399 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4400 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4401 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4402
4403 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4404 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4405
4406 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4407 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4408 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4409 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4410 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4411 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4412 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4413 Expressions}).
4414 @end table
4415
4416 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4417 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4418
4419 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4420 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4421 that resumes execution.
4422
4423 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4424 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4425 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4426 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4427 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4428
4429 @kindex silent
4430 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4431 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4432 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4433 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4434 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4435 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4436
4437 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4438 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4439 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4440
4441 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4442 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4443
4444 @smallexample
4445 break foo if x>0
4446 commands
4447 silent
4448 printf "x is %d\n",x
4449 cont
4450 end
4451 @end smallexample
4452
4453 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4454 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4455 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4456 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4457 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4458 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4459 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4460
4461 @smallexample
4462 break 403
4463 commands
4464 silent
4465 set x = y + 4
4466 cont
4467 end
4468 @end smallexample
4469
4470 @node Save Breakpoints
4471 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4472
4473 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4474 breakpoints}} command.
4475
4476 @table @code
4477 @kindex save breakpoints
4478 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4479 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4480 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4481 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4482 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4483 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4484 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4485 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4486 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4487 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4488 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4489 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4490 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4491 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4492 that can no longer be recreated.
4493 @end table
4494
4495 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4496 @node Error in Breakpoints
4497 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4498
4499 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4500 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4501
4502 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4503 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4504 @smallexample
4505 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4506 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4507 @end smallexample
4508
4509 @noindent
4510 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4511 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4512 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4513
4514 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4515 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4516
4517 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4518 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4519 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4520
4521 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4522 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4523 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4524 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4525
4526 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4527 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4528 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4529 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4530 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4531 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4532 first in the bundle.
4533
4534 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4535 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4536 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4537 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4538 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4539 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4540 is hit.
4541
4542 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4543 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4544
4545 @smallexample
4546 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4547 @end smallexample
4548
4549 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4550 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4551 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4552 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4553 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4554 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4555 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4556 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4557
4558 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4559 adjusted breakpoints:
4560
4561 @smallexample
4562 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4563 to 0x00010410.
4564 @end smallexample
4565
4566 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4567 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4568 frequently than expected.
4569
4570 @node Continuing and Stepping
4571 @section Continuing and Stepping
4572
4573 @cindex stepping
4574 @cindex continuing
4575 @cindex resuming execution
4576 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4577 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4578 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4579 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4580 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4581 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4582 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4583 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4584
4585 @table @code
4586 @kindex continue
4587 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4588 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4589 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4590 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4591 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4592 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4593 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4594 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4595 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4596 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4597
4598 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4599 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4600 @code{continue} is ignored.
4601
4602 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4603 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4604 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4605 @code{continue}.
4606 @end table
4607
4608 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4609 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4610 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4611 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4612
4613 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4614 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4615 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4616 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4617 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4618 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4619
4620 @table @code
4621 @kindex step
4622 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4623 @item step
4624 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4625 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4626 abbreviated @code{s}.
4627
4628 @quotation
4629 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4630 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4631 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4632 @c distinction here.
4633 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4634 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4635 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4636 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4637 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4638 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4639 below.
4640 @end quotation
4641
4642 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4643 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4644 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4645 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4646 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4647 called within the line.
4648
4649 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4650 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4651 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4652 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4653 was any debugging information about the routine.
4654
4655 @item step @var{count}
4656 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4657 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4658 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4659
4660 @kindex next
4661 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4662 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4663 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4664 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4665 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4666 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4667 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4668 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4669
4670 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4671
4672
4673 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4674 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4675 @c
4676 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4677 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4678 @c function are executed without stopping.
4679
4680 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4681 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4682 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4683
4684 @kindex set step-mode
4685 @item set step-mode
4686 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4687 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4688 @itemx set step-mode on
4689 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4690 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4691 information rather than stepping over it.
4692
4693 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4694 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4695 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4696
4697 @item set step-mode off
4698 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4699 debug information. This is the default.
4700
4701 @item show step-mode
4702 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4703 source line debug information.
4704
4705 @kindex finish
4706 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4707 @item finish
4708 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4709 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4710 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4711
4712 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4713 ,Returning from a Function}).
4714
4715 @kindex until
4716 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4717 @cindex run until specified location
4718 @item until
4719 @itemx u
4720 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4721 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4722 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4723 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4724 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4725 than the address of the jump.
4726
4727 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4728 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4729 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4730 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4731 through the next iteration.
4732
4733 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4734 stack frame.
4735
4736 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4737 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4738 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4739 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4740 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4741
4742 @smallexample
4743 (@value{GDBP}) f
4744 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4745 206 expand_input();
4746 (@value{GDBP}) until
4747 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4748 @end smallexample
4749
4750 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4751 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4752 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4753 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4754 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4755 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4756 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4757
4758 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4759 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4760 argument.
4761
4762 @item until @var{location}
4763 @itemx u @var{location}
4764 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4765 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4766 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4767 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4768 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4769 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4770 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4771 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4772 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4773 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4774 invocations have returned.
4775
4776 @smallexample
4777 94 int factorial (int value)
4778 95 @{
4779 96 if (value > 1) @{
4780 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4781 98 @}
4782 99 return (value);
4783 100 @}
4784 @end smallexample
4785
4786
4787 @kindex advance @var{location}
4788 @itemx advance @var{location}
4789 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4790 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4791 @ref{Specify Location}.
4792 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4793 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4794 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4795 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4796
4797
4798 @kindex stepi
4799 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4800 @item stepi
4801 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4802 @itemx si
4803 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4804
4805 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4806 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4807 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4808 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4809
4810 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4811
4812 @need 750
4813 @kindex nexti
4814 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4815 @item nexti
4816 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4817 @itemx ni
4818 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4819 proceed until the function returns.
4820
4821 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4822 @end table
4823
4824 @node Signals
4825 @section Signals
4826 @cindex signals
4827
4828 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4829 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4830 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4831 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4832 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4833 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4834 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4835 requested an alarm).
4836
4837 @cindex fatal signals
4838 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4839 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4840 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4841 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4842 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4843 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4844
4845 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4846 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4847 signal.
4848
4849 @cindex handling signals
4850 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4851 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4852 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4853 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4854 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4855
4856 @table @code
4857 @kindex info signals
4858 @kindex info handle
4859 @item info signals
4860 @itemx info handle
4861 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4862 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4863 the defined types of signals.
4864
4865 @item info signals @var{sig}
4866 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4867
4868 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4869
4870 @kindex handle
4871 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4872 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4873 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4874 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4875 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4876 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4877 say what change to make.
4878 @end table
4879
4880 @c @group
4881 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4882 Their full names are:
4883
4884 @table @code
4885 @item nostop
4886 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4887 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4888
4889 @item stop
4890 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4891 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4892
4893 @item print
4894 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4895
4896 @item noprint
4897 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4898 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4899
4900 @item pass
4901 @itemx noignore
4902 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4903 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4904 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4905
4906 @item nopass
4907 @itemx ignore
4908 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4909 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4910 @end table
4911 @c @end group
4912
4913 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4914 program until you
4915 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4916 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4917 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4918 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4919 program sees that signal when you continue.
4920
4921 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4922 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4923 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4924 erroneous signals.
4925
4926 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4927 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4928 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4929 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4930 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4931 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4932 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4933 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4934 Program a Signal}.
4935
4936 @cindex extra signal information
4937 @anchor{extra signal information}
4938
4939 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4940 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4941 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4942 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4943 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4944 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4945 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4946 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4947 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4948 system header.
4949
4950 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4951 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4952
4953 @smallexample
4954 @group
4955 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4956 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4957 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4958 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4959 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4960 type = struct @{
4961 int si_signo;
4962 int si_errno;
4963 int si_code;
4964 union @{
4965 int _pad[28];
4966 struct @{...@} _kill;
4967 struct @{...@} _timer;
4968 struct @{...@} _rt;
4969 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4970 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4971 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4972 @} _sifields;
4973 @}
4974 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4975 type = struct @{
4976 void *si_addr;
4977 @}
4978 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4979 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4980 @end group
4981 @end smallexample
4982
4983 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4984
4985 @node Thread Stops
4986 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4987
4988 @cindex stopped threads
4989 @cindex threads, stopped
4990
4991 @cindex continuing threads
4992 @cindex threads, continuing
4993
4994 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4995 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4996 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4997 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4998 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4999 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5000 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5001 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5002 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5003
5004 @menu
5005 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5006 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5007 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5008 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5009 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5010 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5011 @end menu
5012
5013 @node All-Stop Mode
5014 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5015
5016 @cindex all-stop mode
5017
5018 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5019 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5020 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5021 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5022 underfoot.
5023
5024 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5025 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5026 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5027
5028 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5029 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5030 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5031 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5032 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5033 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5034 stops.
5035
5036 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5037 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5038 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5039 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5040
5041 @cindex automatic thread selection
5042 @cindex switching threads automatically
5043 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5044 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5045 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5046 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5047 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5048 thread.
5049
5050 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5051 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5052
5053 @table @code
5054 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5055 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5056 @cindex lock scheduler
5057 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5058 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5059 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5060 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5061 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5062 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5063 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5064 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5065 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5066 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5067 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5068 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5069
5070 @item show scheduler-locking
5071 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5072 @end table
5073
5074 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5075 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5076 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5077 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5078 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5079 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5080 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5081 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5082 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5083 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5084 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5085 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5086 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5087 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5088
5089 @table @code
5090 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5091 @item set schedule-multiple
5092 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5093 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5094 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5095 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5096 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5097 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5098
5099 @item show schedule-multiple
5100 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5101 multiple processes.
5102 @end table
5103
5104 @node Non-Stop Mode
5105 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5106
5107 @cindex non-stop mode
5108
5109 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5110 @c with more details.
5111
5112 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5113 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5114 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5115 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5116 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5117 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5118
5119 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5120 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5121 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5122 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5123 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5124 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5125 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5126 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5127 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5128 independently and simultaneously.
5129
5130 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5131 or attach to your program:
5132
5133 @smallexample
5134 # Enable the async interface.
5135 set target-async 1
5136
5137 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5138 set pagination off
5139
5140 # Finally, turn it on!
5141 set non-stop on
5142 @end smallexample
5143
5144 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5145
5146 @table @code
5147 @kindex set non-stop
5148 @item set non-stop on
5149 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5150 @item set non-stop off
5151 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5152 @kindex show non-stop
5153 @item show non-stop
5154 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5155 @end table
5156
5157 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5158 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5159 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5160 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5161 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5162 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5163 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5164 default.
5165
5166 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5167 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5168 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5169
5170 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5171 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5172 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5173 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5174 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5175
5176 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5177 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5178 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5179 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5180 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5181
5182 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5183
5184 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5185 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5186 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5187 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5188 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5189 previously current thread.
5190
5191 @node Background Execution
5192 @subsection Background Execution
5193
5194 @cindex foreground execution
5195 @cindex background execution
5196 @cindex asynchronous execution
5197 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5198
5199 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5200 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5201 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5202 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5203 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5204 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5205
5206 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5207 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5208 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5209
5210 @table @code
5211 @kindex set target-async
5212 @item set target-async on
5213 Enable asynchronous mode.
5214 @item set target-async off
5215 Disable asynchronous mode.
5216 @kindex show target-async
5217 @item show target-async
5218 Show the current target-async setting.
5219 @end table
5220
5221 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5222 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5223
5224 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5225 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5226 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5227 are:
5228
5229 @table @code
5230 @kindex run&
5231 @item run
5232 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5233
5234 @item attach
5235 @kindex attach&
5236 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5237
5238 @item step
5239 @kindex step&
5240 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5241
5242 @item stepi
5243 @kindex stepi&
5244 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5245
5246 @item next
5247 @kindex next&
5248 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5249
5250 @item nexti
5251 @kindex nexti&
5252 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5253
5254 @item continue
5255 @kindex continue&
5256 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5257
5258 @item finish
5259 @kindex finish&
5260 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5261
5262 @item until
5263 @kindex until&
5264 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5265
5266 @end table
5267
5268 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5269 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5270 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5271 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5272 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5273 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5274
5275 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5276 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5277
5278 @table @code
5279 @kindex interrupt
5280 @item interrupt
5281 @itemx interrupt -a
5282
5283 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5284 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5285 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5286 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5287 @end table
5288
5289 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5290 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5291
5292 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5293 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5294 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5295
5296 @table @code
5297 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5298 @cindex thread breakpoints
5299 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5300 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5301 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5302 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5303 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5304 specify some source line.
5305
5306 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5307 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5308 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5309 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5310 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5311
5312 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5313 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5314 program.
5315
5316 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5317 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5318 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5319
5320 @smallexample
5321 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5322 @end smallexample
5323
5324 @end table
5325
5326 @node Interrupted System Calls
5327 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5328
5329 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5330 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5331 @cindex premature return from system calls
5332 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5333 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5334 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5335 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5336 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5337 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5338 stop execution.
5339
5340 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5341 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5342 style anyways.
5343
5344 For example, do not write code like this:
5345
5346 @smallexample
5347 sleep (10);
5348 @end smallexample
5349
5350 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5351 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5352
5353 Instead, write this:
5354
5355 @smallexample
5356 int unslept = 10;
5357 while (unslept > 0)
5358 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5359 @end smallexample
5360
5361 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5362 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5363 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5364 @value{GDBN}.
5365
5366 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5367 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5368 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5369 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5370
5371 @node Observer Mode
5372 @subsection Observer Mode
5373
5374 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5375 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5376 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5377 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5378 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5379
5380 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5381 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5382 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5383 mode.
5384
5385 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5386 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5387 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
5388 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
5389 stream will still not be able to be placed.
5390
5391 @table @code
5392
5393 @kindex observer
5394 @item set observer on
5395 @itemx set observer off
5396 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
5397 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
5398 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
5399 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
5400
5401 @item show observer
5402 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
5403
5404 @kindex may-write-registers
5405 @item set may-write-registers on
5406 @itemx set may-write-registers off
5407 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
5408 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
5409 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
5410
5411 @item show may-write-registers
5412 Show the current permission to write registers.
5413
5414 @kindex may-write-memory
5415 @item set may-write-memory on
5416 @itemx set may-write-memory off
5417 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
5418 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
5419 defaults to @code{on}.
5420
5421 @item show may-write-memory
5422 Show the current permission to write memory.
5423
5424 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
5425 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
5426 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
5427 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
5428 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
5429 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5430
5431 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
5432 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
5433
5434 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
5435 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
5436 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
5437 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
5438 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5439 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
5440 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5441
5442 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
5443 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
5444
5445 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5446 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
5447 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
5448 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
5449 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5450 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
5451 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5452
5453 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5454 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
5455
5456 @kindex may-interrupt
5457 @item set may-interrupt on
5458 @itemx set may-interrupt off
5459 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
5460 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
5461 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
5462 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5463
5464 @item show may-interrupt
5465 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
5466
5467 @end table
5468
5469 @node Reverse Execution
5470 @chapter Running programs backward
5471 @cindex reverse execution
5472 @cindex running programs backward
5473
5474 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5475 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5476 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5477 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5478
5479 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5480 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5481 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5482 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5483 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5484 all target environments can support reverse execution.
5485
5486 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5487 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5488 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5489 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5490 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5491 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5492 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5493 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5494 prior values@footnote{
5495 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5496 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5497 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5498
5499 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5500 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5501 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5502 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5503 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5504 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5505 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5506 }.
5507
5508 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5509 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5510
5511 @table @code
5512 @kindex reverse-continue
5513 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5514 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5515 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5516 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5517 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5518 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5519 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5520
5521 @kindex reverse-step
5522 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5523 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5524 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5525 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5526
5527 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5528 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5529 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5530 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5531 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5532 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5533
5534 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5535 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5536
5537 @kindex reverse-stepi
5538 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5539 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5540 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5541 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5542 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5543 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5544 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5545
5546 @kindex reverse-next
5547 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5548 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5549 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5550 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5551 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5552 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5553 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5554 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5555 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5556 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5557
5558 @kindex reverse-nexti
5559 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5560 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5561 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5562 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5563 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5564 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5565 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5566 frame) is reached.
5567
5568 @kindex reverse-finish
5569 @item reverse-finish
5570 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5571 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5572 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5573 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5574
5575 @kindex set exec-direction
5576 @item set exec-direction
5577 Set the direction of target execution.
5578 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5579 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5580 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5581 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5582 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5583 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5584 @item set exec-direction forward
5585 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5586 This is the default.
5587 @end table
5588
5589
5590 @node Process Record and Replay
5591 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5592 @cindex process record and replay
5593 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5594
5595 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5596 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5597 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5598
5599 @cindex replay mode
5600 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5601 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5602 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5603 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5604 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5605 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5606 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5607 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5608 execution log.
5609
5610 @cindex record mode
5611 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5612 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5613 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5614 for future replay.
5615
5616 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5617 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5618 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5619 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5620 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5621 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5622
5623 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5624 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5625 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5626 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5627
5628 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5629 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5630
5631 @table @code
5632 @kindex target record
5633 @kindex record
5634 @kindex rec
5635 @item target record
5636 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5637 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5638 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5639 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5640 the @kbd{target record} command.
5641
5642 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5643
5644 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5645 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5646 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5647 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5648 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5649
5650 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5651 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5652 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5653 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5654 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5655 support these two modes.
5656
5657 @kindex record stop
5658 @kindex rec s
5659 @item record stop
5660 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5661 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5662 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5663
5664 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5665 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5666 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5667 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5668 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5669
5670 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5671 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5672 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5673 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5674 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5675
5676 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5677 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5678
5679 @kindex record save
5680 @item record save @var{filename}
5681 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5682 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
5683 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
5684
5685 @kindex record restore
5686 @item record restore @var{filename}
5687 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5688 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
5689
5690 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5691 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5692 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5693
5694 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5695 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5696 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5697 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5698 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5699 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5700 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5701 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5702
5703 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5704 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5705 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5706
5707 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5708 @item show record insn-number-max
5709 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5710
5711 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5712 @item set record stop-at-limit
5713 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5714 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5715 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5716 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5717 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5718 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5719
5720 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5721 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5722
5723 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5724 @item show record stop-at-limit
5725 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5726
5727 @kindex set record memory-query
5728 @item set record memory-query
5729 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
5730 changes caused by an instruction. If ON, @value{GDBN} will query
5731 whether to stop the inferior in that case.
5732
5733 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
5734 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
5735 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
5736 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
5737 results.
5738
5739 @kindex show record memory-query
5740 @item show record memory-query
5741 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
5742
5743 @kindex info record
5744 @item info record
5745 Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
5746 in-memory execution log buffer, including:
5747
5748 @itemize @bullet
5749 @item
5750 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
5751 @item
5752 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
5753 @item
5754 Highest recorded instruction number.
5755 @item
5756 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
5757 @item
5758 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
5759 @item
5760 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
5761 @end itemize
5762
5763 @kindex record delete
5764 @kindex rec del
5765 @item record delete
5766 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5767 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5768 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5769 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5770 @end table
5771
5772
5773 @node Stack
5774 @chapter Examining the Stack
5775
5776 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5777 stopped and how it got there.
5778
5779 @cindex call stack
5780 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5781 is generated.
5782 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5783 the arguments of the call,
5784 and the local variables of the function being called.
5785 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5786 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5787 stack}.
5788
5789 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5790 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5791
5792 @cindex selected frame
5793 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5794 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5795 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5796 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5797 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5798 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5799
5800 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5801 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5802 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5803
5804 @menu
5805 * Frames:: Stack frames
5806 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5807 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5808 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5809
5810 @end menu
5811
5812 @node Frames
5813 @section Stack Frames
5814
5815 @cindex frame, definition
5816 @cindex stack frame
5817 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5818 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5819 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5820 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5821 which the function is executing.
5822
5823 @cindex initial frame
5824 @cindex outermost frame
5825 @cindex innermost frame
5826 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5827 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5828 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5829 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5830 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5831 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5832 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5833 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5834
5835 @cindex frame pointer
5836 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5837 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5838 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5839 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5840 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5841 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5842
5843 @cindex frame number
5844 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5845 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5846 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5847 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5848 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5849
5850 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5851 @c underflow problems.
5852 @cindex frameless execution
5853 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5854 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5855 @smallexample
5856 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5857 @end smallexample
5858 generates functions without a frame.)
5859 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5860 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5861 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5862 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5863 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5864 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5865 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5866
5867 @table @code
5868 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5869 @cindex current stack frame
5870 @item frame @var{args}
5871 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5872 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5873 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5874 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5875
5876 @kindex select-frame
5877 @cindex selecting frame silently
5878 @item select-frame
5879 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5880 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5881 @code{frame}.
5882 @end table
5883
5884 @node Backtrace
5885 @section Backtraces
5886
5887 @cindex traceback
5888 @cindex call stack traces
5889 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5890 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5891 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5892 stack.
5893
5894 @table @code
5895 @kindex backtrace
5896 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5897 @item backtrace
5898 @itemx bt
5899 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5900 frames in the stack.
5901
5902 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5903 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5904
5905 @item backtrace @var{n}
5906 @itemx bt @var{n}
5907 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5908
5909 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5910 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5911 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5912
5913 @item backtrace full
5914 @itemx bt full
5915 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5916 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5917 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5918 number of frames to print, as described above.
5919 @end table
5920
5921 @kindex where
5922 @kindex info stack
5923 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5924 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5925
5926 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5927 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5928 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5929 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5930 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5931 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5932 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5933 multi-threaded program.
5934
5935 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5936 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5937 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5938 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5939 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5940 line number.
5941
5942 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5943 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5944
5945 @smallexample
5946 @group
5947 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5948 at builtin.c:993
5949 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5950 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5951 at macro.c:71
5952 (More stack frames follow...)
5953 @end group
5954 @end smallexample
5955
5956 @noindent
5957 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5958 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5959 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5960
5961 @noindent
5962 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5963 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5964 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5965 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5966 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5967
5968 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5969 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5970 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5971 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5972 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5973 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5974 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5975 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5976 such a backtrace might look like:
5977
5978 @smallexample
5979 @group
5980 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5981 at builtin.c:993
5982 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5983 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5984 at macro.c:71
5985 (More stack frames follow...)
5986 @end group
5987 @end smallexample
5988
5989 @noindent
5990 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5991 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5992
5993 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5994 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5995 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5996
5997 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5998 @cindex program entry point
5999 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6000 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6001 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6002 @code{main}@footnote{
6003 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6004 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6005 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6006 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6007 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6008 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6009
6010 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6011 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6012
6013 @table @code
6014 @item set backtrace past-main
6015 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6016 @kindex set backtrace
6017 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6018
6019 @item set backtrace past-main off
6020 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6021 default.
6022
6023 @item show backtrace past-main
6024 @kindex show backtrace
6025 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6026
6027 @item set backtrace past-entry
6028 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6029 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6030 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6031 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6032
6033 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6034 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6035 application. This is the default.
6036
6037 @item show backtrace past-entry
6038 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6039
6040 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6041 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6042 @cindex backtrace limit
6043 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
6044 unlimited.
6045
6046 @item show backtrace limit
6047 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6048 @end table
6049
6050 @node Selection
6051 @section Selecting a Frame
6052
6053 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
6054 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
6055 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
6056 of the stack frame just selected.
6057
6058 @table @code
6059 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
6060 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
6061 @item frame @var{n}
6062 @itemx f @var{n}
6063 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
6064 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
6065 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
6066 @code{main}.
6067
6068 @item frame @var{addr}
6069 @itemx f @var{addr}
6070 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
6071 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
6072 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
6073 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
6074 switches between them.
6075
6076 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
6077 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
6078
6079 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
6080 pointer and a program counter.
6081
6082 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
6083 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
6084
6085 @kindex up
6086 @item up @var{n}
6087 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6088 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
6089 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
6090
6091 @kindex down
6092 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
6093 @item down @var{n}
6094 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6095 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
6096 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
6097 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
6098 @end table
6099
6100 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
6101 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
6102 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
6103 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
6104
6105 @need 1000
6106 For example:
6107
6108 @smallexample
6109 @group
6110 (@value{GDBP}) up
6111 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
6112 at env.c:10
6113 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
6114 @end group
6115 @end smallexample
6116
6117 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
6118 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
6119 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
6120 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
6121 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
6122 for details.
6123
6124 @table @code
6125 @kindex down-silently
6126 @kindex up-silently
6127 @item up-silently @var{n}
6128 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
6129 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
6130 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
6131 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
6132 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
6133 distracting.
6134 @end table
6135
6136 @node Frame Info
6137 @section Information About a Frame
6138
6139 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
6140 stack frame.
6141
6142 @table @code
6143 @item frame
6144 @itemx f
6145 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
6146 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
6147 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
6148 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
6149 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6150
6151 @kindex info frame
6152 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
6153 @item info frame
6154 @itemx info f
6155 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
6156 including:
6157
6158 @itemize @bullet
6159 @item
6160 the address of the frame
6161 @item
6162 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
6163 @item
6164 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
6165 @item
6166 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
6167 @item
6168 the address of the frame's arguments
6169 @item
6170 the address of the frame's local variables
6171 @item
6172 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
6173 @item
6174 which registers were saved in the frame
6175 @end itemize
6176
6177 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
6178 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
6179 the usual conventions.
6180
6181 @item info frame @var{addr}
6182 @itemx info f @var{addr}
6183 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
6184 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
6185 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
6186 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
6187 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6188
6189 @kindex info args
6190 @item info args
6191 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
6192
6193 @item info locals
6194 @kindex info locals
6195 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
6196 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
6197 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
6198
6199 @kindex info catch
6200 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
6201 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
6202 @item info catch
6203 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
6204 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
6205 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
6206 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
6207 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
6208
6209 @end table
6210
6211
6212 @node Source
6213 @chapter Examining Source Files
6214
6215 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
6216 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
6217 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
6218 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
6219 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
6220 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
6221 source files by explicit command.
6222
6223 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6224 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6225 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6226
6227 @menu
6228 * List:: Printing source lines
6229 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6230 * Edit:: Editing source files
6231 * Search:: Searching source files
6232 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6233 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6234 @end menu
6235
6236 @node List
6237 @section Printing Source Lines
6238
6239 @kindex list
6240 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6241 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6242 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6243 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6244 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6245
6246 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6247
6248 @table @code
6249 @item list @var{linenum}
6250 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6251 current source file.
6252
6253 @item list @var{function}
6254 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6255 @var{function}.
6256
6257 @item list
6258 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6259 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6260 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6261 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6262 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6263
6264 @item list -
6265 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6266 @end table
6267
6268 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6269 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6270 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6271
6272 @table @code
6273 @kindex set listsize
6274 @item set listsize @var{count}
6275 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6276 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6277
6278 @kindex show listsize
6279 @item show listsize
6280 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6281 @end table
6282
6283 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6284 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6285 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6286 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6287 each repetition moves up in the source file.
6288
6289 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6290 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6291 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6292 to specify some source line.
6293
6294 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6295
6296 @table @code
6297 @item list @var{linespec}
6298 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6299
6300 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
6301 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6302 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6303 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6304 the same source file as the first linespec.
6305
6306 @item list ,@var{last}
6307 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6308
6309 @item list @var{first},
6310 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6311
6312 @item list +
6313 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6314
6315 @item list -
6316 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6317
6318 @item list
6319 As described in the preceding table.
6320 @end table
6321
6322 @node Specify Location
6323 @section Specifying a Location
6324 @cindex specifying location
6325 @cindex linespec
6326
6327 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6328 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6329 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6330 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6331
6332 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6333 @value{GDBN} understands:
6334
6335 @table @code
6336 @item @var{linenum}
6337 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6338
6339 @item -@var{offset}
6340 @itemx +@var{offset}
6341 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6342 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6343 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6344 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6345 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6346 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6347 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6348 linespec.
6349
6350 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6351 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6352
6353 @item @var{function}
6354 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6355 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6356
6357 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6358 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6359 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6360 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6361 functions in different source files.
6362
6363 @item @var{label}
6364 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
6365 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
6366 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
6367 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
6368 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
6369
6370 @item *@var{address}
6371 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6372 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6373 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6374 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6375 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6376 source files.
6377
6378 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6379 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6380 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6381 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6382 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6383 of @var{address}:
6384
6385 @table @code
6386 @item @var{expression}
6387 Any expression valid in the current working language.
6388
6389 @item @var{funcaddr}
6390 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6391 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6392 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6393 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6394 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6395 (although the Pascal form also works).
6396
6397 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6398 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6399
6400 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6401 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6402 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6403 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6404 functions with identical names in different source files.
6405 @end table
6406
6407 @end table
6408
6409
6410 @node Edit
6411 @section Editing Source Files
6412 @cindex editing source files
6413
6414 @kindex edit
6415 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6416 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6417 The editing program of your choice
6418 is invoked with the current line set to
6419 the active line in the program.
6420 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6421 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6422
6423 @table @code
6424 @item edit @var{location}
6425 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6426 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6427 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6428 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6429 command most commonly used:
6430
6431 @table @code
6432 @item edit @var{number}
6433 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6434
6435 @item edit @var{function}
6436 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6437 @end table
6438
6439 @end table
6440
6441 @subsection Choosing your Editor
6442 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6443 @footnote{
6444 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6445 following command-line syntax:
6446 @smallexample
6447 ex +@var{number} file
6448 @end smallexample
6449 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6450 the file where to start editing.}.
6451 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6452 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6453 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6454 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6455 @smallexample
6456 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
6457 export EDITOR
6458 gdb @dots{}
6459 @end smallexample
6460 or in the @code{csh} shell,
6461 @smallexample
6462 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6463 gdb @dots{}
6464 @end smallexample
6465
6466 @node Search
6467 @section Searching Source Files
6468 @cindex searching source files
6469
6470 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6471 regular expression.
6472
6473 @table @code
6474 @kindex search
6475 @kindex forward-search
6476 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
6477 @itemx search @var{regexp}
6478 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6479 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6480 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6481 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6482 @code{fo}.
6483
6484 @kindex reverse-search
6485 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6486 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6487 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6488 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6489 this command as @code{rev}.
6490 @end table
6491
6492 @node Source Path
6493 @section Specifying Source Directories
6494
6495 @cindex source path
6496 @cindex directories for source files
6497 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6498 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6499 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6500 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6501 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6502 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6503 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6504
6505 For example, suppose an executable references the file
6506 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6507 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6508 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6509 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6510 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6511 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6512 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6513 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6514 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6515 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6516
6517 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
6518 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
6519 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
6520 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
6521 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
6522 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
6523
6524 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
6525 source files.
6526
6527 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
6528 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
6529 each line is in the file.
6530
6531 @kindex directory
6532 @kindex dir
6533 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
6534 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
6535 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
6536
6537 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
6538 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
6539
6540 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
6541 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
6542 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
6543 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
6544 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
6545 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
6546 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
6547 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
6548 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
6549 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
6550 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
6551 name to look up the sources.
6552
6553 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
6554 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
6555 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
6556 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
6557 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
6558 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
6559 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6560 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6561
6562 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6563 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6564 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6565 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6566 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6567 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6568 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6569
6570 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6571 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6572 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6573 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6574 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6575 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6576 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6577 command.
6578
6579 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6580 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6581 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6582 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6583 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6584 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6585 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6586
6587 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6588 @cindex default source path substitution
6589 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6590 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6591 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6592 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6593 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6594 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6595 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6596 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6597 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6598 together.
6599
6600 @table @code
6601 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6602 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6603 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6604 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6605 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6606 part of absolute file names) or
6607 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6608 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6609
6610 @kindex cdir
6611 @kindex cwd
6612 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6613 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6614 @cindex compilation directory
6615 @cindex current directory
6616 @cindex working directory
6617 @cindex directory, current
6618 @cindex directory, compilation
6619 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6620 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6621 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6622 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6623 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6624 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6625
6626 @item directory
6627 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6628
6629 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6630 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6631
6632 @item set directories @var{path-list}
6633 @kindex set directories
6634 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
6635 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
6636
6637 @item show directories
6638 @kindex show directories
6639 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6640
6641 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6642 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6643 @kindex set substitute-path
6644 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6645 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6646 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6647
6648 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6649 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6650
6651 @smallexample
6652 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6653 @end smallexample
6654
6655 @noindent
6656 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6657 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6658 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6659
6660 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6661 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6662 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6663 the substitution.
6664
6665 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6666
6667 @smallexample
6668 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6669 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6670 @end smallexample
6671
6672 @noindent
6673 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6674 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6675 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6676 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6677
6678
6679 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6680 @kindex unset substitute-path
6681 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6682 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6683 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6684
6685 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6686
6687 @item show substitute-path [path]
6688 @kindex show substitute-path
6689 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6690 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6691
6692 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6693 rules.
6694
6695 @end table
6696
6697 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6698 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6699 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6700
6701 @enumerate
6702 @item
6703 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6704
6705 @item
6706 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6707 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6708 directories in one command.
6709 @end enumerate
6710
6711 @node Machine Code
6712 @section Source and Machine Code
6713 @cindex source line and its code address
6714
6715 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6716 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6717 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6718 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6719 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6720 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6721 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6722 well as hex.
6723
6724 @table @code
6725 @kindex info line
6726 @item info line @var{linespec}
6727 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6728 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6729 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6730 @end table
6731
6732 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6733 the object code for the first line of function
6734 @code{m4_changequote}:
6735
6736 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6737 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6738 @smallexample
6739 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6740 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6741 @end smallexample
6742
6743 @noindent
6744 @cindex code address and its source line
6745 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6746 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6747 @smallexample
6748 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6749 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6750 @end smallexample
6751
6752 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6753 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6754 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6755 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6756 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6757 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6758 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6759 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6760 Variables}).
6761
6762 @table @code
6763 @kindex disassemble
6764 @cindex assembly instructions
6765 @cindex instructions, assembly
6766 @cindex machine instructions
6767 @cindex listing machine instructions
6768 @item disassemble
6769 @itemx disassemble /m
6770 @itemx disassemble /r
6771 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6772 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6773 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6774 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6775 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6776 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6777 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6778 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
6779 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
6780 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
6781
6782 @table @code
6783 @item @var{start},@var{end}
6784 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
6785 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
6786 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
6787 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
6788 @end table
6789
6790 @noindent
6791 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
6792 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
6793
6794 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
6795 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
6796
6797 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
6798 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
6799 @end table
6800
6801 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6802 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6803
6804 @smallexample
6805 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
6806 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6807 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6808 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6809 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6810 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6811 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6812 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6813 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6814 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6815 End of assembler dump.
6816 @end smallexample
6817
6818 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
6819 program is stopped just after function prologue:
6820
6821 @smallexample
6822 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6823 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6824 5 @{
6825 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
6826 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6827 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6828 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6829 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6830
6831 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6832 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6833 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6834
6835 7 return 0;
6836 8 @}
6837 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6838 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
6839 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
6840
6841 End of assembler dump.
6842 @end smallexample
6843
6844 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
6845
6846 @smallexample
6847 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
6848 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
6849 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
6850 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
6851 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
6852 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
6853 End of assembler dump.
6854 @end smallexample
6855
6856 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6857 mnemonics or other syntax.
6858
6859 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6860 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6861 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6862 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6863 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6864
6865 @table @code
6866 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6867 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6868 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6869 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6870 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6871 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6872
6873 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6874 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6875 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6876 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6877
6878 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6879 @item show disassembly-flavor
6880 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6881 @end table
6882
6883 @table @code
6884 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6885 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6886 @item set disassemble-next-line
6887 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6888 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6889 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6890 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6891 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6892 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6893 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6894 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6895 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6896 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6897 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6898 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6899 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6900 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6901 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6902 instruction.
6903 @end table
6904
6905
6906 @node Data
6907 @chapter Examining Data
6908
6909 @cindex printing data
6910 @cindex examining data
6911 @kindex print
6912 @kindex inspect
6913 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6914 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6915 @c different window or something like that.
6916 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6917 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6918 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6919 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6920 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
6921 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
6922
6923 @table @code
6924 @item print @var{expr}
6925 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6926 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6927 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6928 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6929 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6930 Formats}.
6931
6932 @item print
6933 @itemx print /@var{f}
6934 @cindex reprint the last value
6935 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6936 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6937 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6938 @end table
6939
6940 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6941 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6942 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6943
6944 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6945 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6946 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6947 Table}.
6948
6949 @menu
6950 * Expressions:: Expressions
6951 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6952 * Variables:: Program variables
6953 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6954 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6955 * Memory:: Examining memory
6956 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6957 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6958 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
6959 * Value History:: Value history
6960 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6961 * Registers:: Registers
6962 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6963 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6964 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6965 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6966 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6967 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6968 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6969 character set than GDB does
6970 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6971 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6972 @end menu
6973
6974 @node Expressions
6975 @section Expressions
6976
6977 @cindex expressions
6978 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6979 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6980 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6981 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6982 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6983 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6984 @ref{Compilation}.
6985
6986 @cindex arrays in expressions
6987 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6988 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6989 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6990 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6991 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6992 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6993
6994 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6995 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6996 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6997 languages.
6998
6999 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
7000 expressions regardless of your programming language.
7001
7002 @cindex casts, in expressions
7003 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
7004 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
7005 at that address in memory.
7006 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
7007
7008 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
7009 to programming languages:
7010
7011 @table @code
7012 @item @@
7013 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
7014 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
7015
7016 @item ::
7017 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
7018 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
7019
7020 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
7021 @cindex type casting memory
7022 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
7023 @cindex casts, to view memory
7024 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
7025 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
7026 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
7027 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
7028 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
7029 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
7030 @end table
7031
7032 @node Ambiguous Expressions
7033 @section Ambiguous Expressions
7034 @cindex ambiguous expressions
7035
7036 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
7037 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
7038 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
7039 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
7040 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
7041 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
7042 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
7043
7044 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
7045 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
7046 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
7047 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
7048 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
7049 as well.
7050
7051 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
7052 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
7053 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
7054 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
7055 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
7056 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
7057 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
7058 choices.
7059
7060 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
7061 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
7062 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
7063
7064 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
7065 @smallexample
7066 @group
7067 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
7068 [0] cancel
7069 [1] all
7070 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
7071 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
7072 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
7073 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
7074 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
7075 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
7076 > 2 4 6
7077 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
7078 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
7079 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
7080 Multiple breakpoints were set.
7081 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
7082 breakpoints.
7083 (@value{GDBP})
7084 @end group
7085 @end smallexample
7086
7087 @table @code
7088 @kindex set multiple-symbols
7089 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
7090 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
7091
7092 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
7093 is ambiguous.
7094
7095 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
7096 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
7097 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
7098 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
7099 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
7100 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
7101 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
7102 in the use of the menu.
7103
7104 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
7105 when an ambiguity is detected.
7106
7107 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
7108 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
7109
7110 @kindex show multiple-symbols
7111 @item show multiple-symbols
7112 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
7113 @end table
7114
7115 @node Variables
7116 @section Program Variables
7117
7118 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
7119 in your program.
7120
7121 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
7122 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
7123
7124 @itemize @bullet
7125 @item
7126 global (or file-static)
7127 @end itemize
7128
7129 @noindent or
7130
7131 @itemize @bullet
7132 @item
7133 visible according to the scope rules of the
7134 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
7135 @end itemize
7136
7137 @noindent This means that in the function
7138
7139 @smallexample
7140 foo (a)
7141 int a;
7142 @{
7143 bar (a);
7144 @{
7145 int b = test ();
7146 bar (b);
7147 @}
7148 @}
7149 @end smallexample
7150
7151 @noindent
7152 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
7153 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
7154 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
7155 the block where @code{b} is declared.
7156
7157 @cindex variable name conflict
7158 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
7159 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
7160 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
7161 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
7162 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
7163 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
7164 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
7165
7166 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
7167 @ifnotinfo
7168 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
7169 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
7170 @end ifnotinfo
7171 @smallexample
7172 @var{file}::@var{variable}
7173 @var{function}::@var{variable}
7174 @end smallexample
7175
7176 @noindent
7177 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
7178 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
7179 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
7180 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
7181
7182 @smallexample
7183 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
7184 @end smallexample
7185
7186 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
7187 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
7188 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
7189 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
7190 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
7191 @c conflict?? --mew
7192
7193 @cindex wrong values
7194 @cindex variable values, wrong
7195 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
7196 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
7197 @quotation
7198 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
7199 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
7200 scope, and just before exit.
7201 @end quotation
7202 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
7203 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
7204 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
7205 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
7206 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
7207 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
7208 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
7209 variable definitions may be gone.
7210
7211 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
7212 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
7213 when compiling.
7214
7215 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
7216 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
7217 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
7218 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
7219 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
7220 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
7221 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
7222
7223 @smallexample
7224 No symbol "foo" in current context.
7225 @end smallexample
7226
7227 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
7228 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
7229 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
7230 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
7231 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
7232 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
7233 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
7234 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
7235 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
7236 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
7237 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
7238
7239 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
7240 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
7241 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
7242 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
7243
7244 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
7245 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
7246 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
7247 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
7248 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
7249 For program code
7250
7251 @smallexample
7252 char var0[] = "A";
7253 signed char var1[] = "A";
7254 @end smallexample
7255
7256 You get during debugging
7257 @smallexample
7258 (gdb) print var0
7259 $1 = "A"
7260 (gdb) print var1
7261 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
7262 @end smallexample
7263
7264 @node Arrays
7265 @section Artificial Arrays
7266
7267 @cindex artificial array
7268 @cindex arrays
7269 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7270 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7271 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7272 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7273 program.
7274
7275 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7276 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7277 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7278 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7279 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7280 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7281 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7282 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7283 example. If a program says
7284
7285 @smallexample
7286 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7287 @end smallexample
7288
7289 @noindent
7290 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7291
7292 @smallexample
7293 p *array@@len
7294 @end smallexample
7295
7296 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7297 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7298 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7299 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7300 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7301
7302 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7303 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7304 The value need not be in memory:
7305 @smallexample
7306 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7307 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7308 @end smallexample
7309
7310 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7311 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7312 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7313 @smallexample
7314 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7315 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7316 @end smallexample
7317
7318 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
7319 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
7320 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
7321 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
7322 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7323 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
7324 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
7325 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
7326 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
7327 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
7328
7329 @smallexample
7330 set $i = 0
7331 p dtab[$i++]->fv
7332 @key{RET}
7333 @key{RET}
7334 @dots{}
7335 @end smallexample
7336
7337 @node Output Formats
7338 @section Output Formats
7339
7340 @cindex formatted output
7341 @cindex output formats
7342 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
7343 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
7344 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
7345 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
7346 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
7347
7348 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
7349 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
7350 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
7351 letters supported are:
7352
7353 @table @code
7354 @item x
7355 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
7356 hexadecimal.
7357
7358 @item d
7359 Print as integer in signed decimal.
7360
7361 @item u
7362 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
7363
7364 @item o
7365 Print as integer in octal.
7366
7367 @item t
7368 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
7369 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
7370 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
7371 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
7372
7373 @item a
7374 @cindex unknown address, locating
7375 @cindex locate address
7376 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
7377 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
7378 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
7379
7380 @smallexample
7381 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
7382 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
7383 @end smallexample
7384
7385 @noindent
7386 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
7387 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
7388
7389 @item c
7390 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
7391 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
7392 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
7393 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
7394
7395 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
7396 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
7397 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
7398 data.
7399
7400 @item f
7401 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
7402 using typical floating point syntax.
7403
7404 @item s
7405 @cindex printing strings
7406 @cindex printing byte arrays
7407 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
7408 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
7409 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
7410 natural types.
7411
7412 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
7413 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
7414 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
7415 array.
7416
7417 @item r
7418 @cindex raw printing
7419 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
7420 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
7421 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
7422 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
7423 pretty-printer which might exist.
7424 @end table
7425
7426 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
7427
7428 @smallexample
7429 p/x $pc
7430 @end smallexample
7431
7432 @noindent
7433 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
7434 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
7435
7436 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
7437 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
7438 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
7439
7440 @node Memory
7441 @section Examining Memory
7442
7443 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
7444 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
7445
7446 @cindex examining memory
7447 @table @code
7448 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
7449 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
7450 @itemx x @var{addr}
7451 @itemx x
7452 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
7453 @end table
7454
7455 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
7456 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
7457 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
7458 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
7459 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
7460
7461 @table @r
7462 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
7463 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
7464 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
7465 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
7466 @c 4.1.2.
7467
7468 @item @var{f}, the display format
7469 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
7470 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
7471 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
7472 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
7473 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
7474
7475 @item @var{u}, the unit size
7476 The unit size is any of
7477
7478 @table @code
7479 @item b
7480 Bytes.
7481 @item h
7482 Halfwords (two bytes).
7483 @item w
7484 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
7485 @item g
7486 Giant words (eight bytes).
7487 @end table
7488
7489 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
7490 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
7491 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
7492 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
7493 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
7494 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
7495 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
7496 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
7497 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
7498 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
7499 be altered.
7500
7501 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
7502 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
7503 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
7504 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
7505 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
7506 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
7507 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
7508 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
7509 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
7510 a value from memory).
7511 @end table
7512
7513 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
7514 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
7515 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
7516 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
7517 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
7518
7519 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
7520 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
7521 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
7522 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
7523 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
7524
7525 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
7526 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
7527 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
7528 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
7529 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
7530 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
7531 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
7532 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
7533 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
7534
7535 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
7536 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
7537 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
7538 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
7539 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
7540 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
7541 for successive uses of @code{x}.
7542
7543 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
7544 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
7545
7546 @smallexample
7547 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
7548 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
7549 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
7550 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
7551 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
7552 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
7553 @end smallexample
7554
7555 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
7556 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
7557 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
7558 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
7559 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
7560 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
7561 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
7562 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
7563 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
7564
7565 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
7566 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
7567 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
7568
7569 @cindex remote memory comparison
7570 @cindex verify remote memory image
7571 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
7572 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
7573 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
7574 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
7575 situations.
7576
7577 @table @code
7578 @kindex compare-sections
7579 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
7580 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
7581 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
7582 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
7583 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
7584 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
7585 remote request.
7586 @end table
7587
7588 @node Auto Display
7589 @section Automatic Display
7590 @cindex automatic display
7591 @cindex display of expressions
7592
7593 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
7594 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
7595 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
7596 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
7597 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
7598 The automatic display looks like this:
7599
7600 @smallexample
7601 2: foo = 38
7602 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
7603 @end smallexample
7604
7605 @noindent
7606 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
7607 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
7608 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
7609 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
7610 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
7611 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
7612
7613 @table @code
7614 @kindex display
7615 @item display @var{expr}
7616 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
7617 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7618
7619 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
7620
7621 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7622 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7623 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7624 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7625 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7626
7627 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7628 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7629 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7630 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7631 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7632 @end table
7633
7634 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7635 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7636 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7637
7638 @table @code
7639 @kindex delete display
7640 @kindex undisplay
7641 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7642 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7643 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
7644
7645 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7646 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7647
7648 @kindex disable display
7649 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7650 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7651 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7652 enabled again later.
7653
7654 @kindex enable display
7655 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7656 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7657 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7658
7659 @item display
7660 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7661 done when your program stops.
7662
7663 @kindex info display
7664 @item info display
7665 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7666 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7667 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7668 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7669 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7670 @end table
7671
7672 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7673 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7674 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7675 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7676 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7677 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7678 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7679 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7680 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7681 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7682 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7683
7684 @node Print Settings
7685 @section Print Settings
7686
7687 @cindex format options
7688 @cindex print settings
7689 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7690 and symbols are printed.
7691
7692 @noindent
7693 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7694
7695 @table @code
7696 @kindex set print
7697 @item set print address
7698 @itemx set print address on
7699 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7700 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7701 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7702 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7703 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7704 @code{set print address on}:
7705
7706 @smallexample
7707 @group
7708 (@value{GDBP}) f
7709 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7710 at input.c:530
7711 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7712 @end group
7713 @end smallexample
7714
7715 @item set print address off
7716 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7717 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7718
7719 @smallexample
7720 @group
7721 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7722 (@value{GDBP}) f
7723 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7724 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7725 @end group
7726 @end smallexample
7727
7728 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7729 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7730 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7731 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7732
7733 @kindex show print
7734 @item show print address
7735 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7736 @end table
7737
7738 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7739 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7740 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7741 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7742 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7743 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7744 it prints a symbolic address:
7745
7746 @table @code
7747 @item set print symbol-filename on
7748 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7749 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7750 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7751 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7752
7753 @item set print symbol-filename off
7754 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7755 default.
7756
7757 @item show print symbol-filename
7758 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7759 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7760 @end table
7761
7762 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7763 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7764 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7765
7766 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7767 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7768
7769 @table @code
7770 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7771 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7772 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7773 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7774 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7775 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7776
7777 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7778 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7779 symbolic address.
7780 @end table
7781
7782 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7783 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7784 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7785 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7786 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7787 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7788 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7789 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7790
7791 @smallexample
7792 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7793 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7794 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7795 @end smallexample
7796
7797 @quotation
7798 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7799 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7800 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7801 @end quotation
7802
7803 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7804
7805 @table @code
7806 @item set print array
7807 @itemx set print array on
7808 @cindex pretty print arrays
7809 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7810 but uses more space. The default is off.
7811
7812 @item set print array off
7813 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7814
7815 @item show print array
7816 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7817 arrays.
7818
7819 @cindex print array indexes
7820 @item set print array-indexes
7821 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7822 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7823 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7824 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7825
7826 @item set print array-indexes off
7827 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7828
7829 @item show print array-indexes
7830 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7831 arrays.
7832
7833 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7834 @cindex number of array elements to print
7835 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7836 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7837 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7838 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7839 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7840 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7841 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7842
7843 @item show print elements
7844 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7845 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7846
7847 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7848 @kindex set print frame-arguments
7849 @cindex printing frame argument values
7850 @cindex print all frame argument values
7851 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7852 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7853 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7854 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7855 values are:
7856
7857 @table @code
7858 @item all
7859 The values of all arguments are printed.
7860
7861 @item scalars
7862 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7863 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7864 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7865 only scalar arguments are shown:
7866
7867 @smallexample
7868 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7869 at frame-args.c:23
7870 @end smallexample
7871
7872 @item none
7873 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7874 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7875
7876 @smallexample
7877 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7878 at frame-args.c:23
7879 @end smallexample
7880 @end table
7881
7882 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7883 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7884 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7885 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7886 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7887 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7888 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7889 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7890 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7891 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7892
7893 @item show print frame-arguments
7894 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7895
7896 @item set print repeats
7897 @cindex repeated array elements
7898 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7899 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7900 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7901 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7902 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7903 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7904 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7905
7906 @item show print repeats
7907 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7908 elements.
7909
7910 @item set print null-stop
7911 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7912 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7913 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7914 contain only short strings.
7915 The default is off.
7916
7917 @item show print null-stop
7918 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7919 @sc{null} character.
7920
7921 @item set print pretty on
7922 @cindex print structures in indented form
7923 @cindex indentation in structure display
7924 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7925 per line, like this:
7926
7927 @smallexample
7928 @group
7929 $1 = @{
7930 next = 0x0,
7931 flags = @{
7932 sweet = 1,
7933 sour = 1
7934 @},
7935 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7936 @}
7937 @end group
7938 @end smallexample
7939
7940 @item set print pretty off
7941 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7942
7943 @smallexample
7944 @group
7945 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7946 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7947 @end group
7948 @end smallexample
7949
7950 @noindent
7951 This is the default format.
7952
7953 @item show print pretty
7954 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7955
7956 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7957 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7958 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7959 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7960 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7961 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7962 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7963 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7964
7965 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7966 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7967 international character sets, and is the default.
7968
7969 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7970 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7971
7972 @item set print union on
7973 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7974 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7975 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7976
7977 @item set print union off
7978 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7979 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7980 instead.
7981
7982 @item show print union
7983 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7984 structures and other unions.
7985
7986 For example, given the declarations
7987
7988 @smallexample
7989 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7990 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7991 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7992 Bug_forms;
7993
7994 struct thing @{
7995 Species it;
7996 union @{
7997 Tree_forms tree;
7998 Bug_forms bug;
7999 @} form;
8000 @};
8001
8002 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
8003 @end smallexample
8004
8005 @noindent
8006 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
8007
8008 @smallexample
8009 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
8010 @end smallexample
8011
8012 @noindent
8013 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
8014
8015 @smallexample
8016 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
8017 @end smallexample
8018
8019 @noindent
8020 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
8021 and in Pascal.
8022 @end table
8023
8024 @need 1000
8025 @noindent
8026 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
8027
8028 @table @code
8029 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
8030 @item set print demangle
8031 @itemx set print demangle on
8032 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
8033 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
8034 linkage. The default is on.
8035
8036 @item show print demangle
8037 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
8038
8039 @item set print asm-demangle
8040 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
8041 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
8042 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
8043 The default is off.
8044
8045 @item show print asm-demangle
8046 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
8047 or demangled form.
8048
8049 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
8050 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
8051 @kindex set demangle-style
8052 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
8053 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
8054 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
8055
8056 @table @code
8057 @item auto
8058 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
8059
8060 @item gnu
8061 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
8062 This is the default.
8063
8064 @item hp
8065 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
8066
8067 @item lucid
8068 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
8069
8070 @item arm
8071 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
8072 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
8073 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
8074 require further enhancement to permit that.
8075
8076 @end table
8077 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
8078
8079 @item show demangle-style
8080 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
8081
8082 @item set print object
8083 @itemx set print object on
8084 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
8085 @cindex display derived types
8086 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
8087 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
8088 the virtual function table.
8089
8090 @item set print object off
8091 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
8092 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
8093
8094 @item show print object
8095 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
8096
8097 @item set print static-members
8098 @itemx set print static-members on
8099 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
8100 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
8101
8102 @item set print static-members off
8103 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
8104
8105 @item show print static-members
8106 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
8107
8108 @item set print pascal_static-members
8109 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
8110 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
8111 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
8112 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
8113
8114 @item set print pascal_static-members off
8115 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
8116
8117 @item show print pascal_static-members
8118 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
8119
8120 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
8121 @item set print vtbl
8122 @itemx set print vtbl on
8123 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
8124 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
8125 @cindex VTBL display
8126 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
8127 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8128 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8129
8130 @item set print vtbl off
8131 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
8132
8133 @item show print vtbl
8134 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
8135 @end table
8136
8137 @node Pretty Printing
8138 @section Pretty Printing
8139
8140 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
8141 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
8142 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
8143
8144 @menu
8145 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
8146 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
8147 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
8148 @end menu
8149
8150 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
8151 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
8152
8153 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
8154 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
8155 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
8156
8157 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
8158 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
8159 pretty-printers with their names.
8160 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
8161 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
8162 Each such subprinter has its own name.
8163 The format of the name is @var{printer-name}:@var{subprinter-name}.
8164
8165 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
8166 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
8167 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
8168 do anything special.
8169
8170 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
8171
8172 @itemize @bullet
8173 @item
8174 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
8175 all inferiors.
8176
8177 @item
8178 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
8179 when debugging that program.
8180 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
8181
8182 @item
8183 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
8184 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
8185 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
8186 @end itemize
8187
8188 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
8189 pretty-printers are selected,
8190
8191 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
8192 for new types.
8193
8194 @node Pretty-Printer Example
8195 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
8196
8197 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
8198
8199 @smallexample
8200 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8201 $1 = @{
8202 static npos = 4294967295,
8203 _M_dataplus = @{
8204 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
8205 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
8206 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
8207 @},
8208 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
8209 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
8210 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
8211 @}
8212 @}
8213 @end smallexample
8214
8215 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
8216
8217 @smallexample
8218 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8219 $2 = "abcd"
8220 @end smallexample
8221
8222 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
8223 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
8224 @cindex pretty-printer commands
8225
8226 @table @code
8227 @kindex info pretty-printer
8228 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8229 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
8230 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
8231
8232 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
8233 whose pretty-printers to list.
8234 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
8235 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
8236 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
8237 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
8238 looks up a printer from these three objects.
8239
8240 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
8241 to list.
8242
8243 @kindex disable pretty-printer
8244 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8245 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8246 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
8247
8248 @kindex enable pretty-printer
8249 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8250 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8251 @end table
8252
8253 Example:
8254
8255 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
8256 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
8257 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
8258 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
8259
8260 @smallexample
8261 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8262 library1.so:
8263 foo
8264 library2.so:
8265 bar
8266 bar1
8267 bar2
8268 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8269 library2.so:
8270 bar
8271 bar1
8272 bar2
8273 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
8274 1 printer disabled
8275 2 of 3 printers enabled
8276 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8277 library1.so:
8278 foo [disabled]
8279 library2.so:
8280 bar
8281 bar1
8282 bar2
8283 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
8284 1 printer disabled
8285 1 of 3 printers enabled
8286 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8287 library1.so:
8288 foo [disabled]
8289 library2.so:
8290 bar
8291 bar1 [disabled]
8292 bar2
8293 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
8294 1 printer disabled
8295 0 of 3 printers enabled
8296 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8297 library1.so:
8298 foo [disabled]
8299 library2.so:
8300 bar [disabled]
8301 bar1 [disabled]
8302 bar2
8303 @end smallexample
8304
8305 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
8306 as can each individual subprinter.
8307
8308 @node Value History
8309 @section Value History
8310
8311 @cindex value history
8312 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
8313 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
8314 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
8315 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
8316 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
8317 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
8318 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
8319 symbol table.
8320
8321 @cindex @code{$}
8322 @cindex @code{$$}
8323 @cindex history number
8324 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
8325 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
8326 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
8327 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
8328 history number.
8329
8330 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
8331 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
8332 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
8333 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
8334 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
8335 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
8336 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
8337
8338 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
8339 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
8340
8341 @smallexample
8342 p *$
8343 @end smallexample
8344
8345 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
8346 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
8347
8348 @smallexample
8349 p *$.next
8350 @end smallexample
8351
8352 @noindent
8353 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
8354 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
8355
8356 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
8357 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
8358
8359 @smallexample
8360 print x
8361 set x=5
8362 @end smallexample
8363
8364 @noindent
8365 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
8366 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
8367
8368 @table @code
8369 @kindex show values
8370 @item show values
8371 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
8372 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
8373 values} does not change the history.
8374
8375 @item show values @var{n}
8376 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
8377
8378 @item show values +
8379 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
8380 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
8381 @end table
8382
8383 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
8384 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
8385
8386 @node Convenience Vars
8387 @section Convenience Variables
8388
8389 @cindex convenience variables
8390 @cindex user-defined variables
8391 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
8392 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
8393 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
8394 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
8395 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
8396
8397 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
8398 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
8399 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8400 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
8401 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
8402
8403 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
8404 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
8405 For example:
8406
8407 @smallexample
8408 set $foo = *object_ptr
8409 @end smallexample
8410
8411 @noindent
8412 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
8413 @code{object_ptr}.
8414
8415 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
8416 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
8417 value with another assignment at any time.
8418
8419 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
8420 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
8421 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
8422 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
8423
8424 @table @code
8425 @kindex show convenience
8426 @cindex show all user variables
8427 @item show convenience
8428 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
8429 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
8430
8431 @kindex init-if-undefined
8432 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
8433 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
8434 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
8435 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
8436 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
8437 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
8438 override default values used in a command script.
8439
8440 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
8441 any side-effects do not occur.
8442 @end table
8443
8444 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
8445 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
8446 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
8447
8448 @smallexample
8449 set $i = 0
8450 print bar[$i++]->contents
8451 @end smallexample
8452
8453 @noindent
8454 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
8455
8456 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
8457 values likely to be useful.
8458
8459 @table @code
8460 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
8461 @item $_
8462 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
8463 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
8464 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
8465 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
8466 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
8467 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
8468 to the type of @code{$__}.
8469
8470 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
8471 @item $__
8472 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
8473 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
8474 to match the format in which the data was printed.
8475
8476 @item $_exitcode
8477 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
8478 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
8479 the program being debugged terminates.
8480
8481 @item $_sdata
8482 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
8483 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
8484 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
8485 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
8486 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
8487
8488 @item $_siginfo
8489 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
8490 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
8491 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
8492 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
8493 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
8494
8495 @item $_tlb
8496 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
8497 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
8498 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
8499 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
8500 @xref{General Query Packets}.
8501 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
8502
8503 @end table
8504
8505 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
8506 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
8507 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
8508
8509 @cindex convenience functions
8510 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
8511 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
8512 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
8513 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
8514 @value{GDBN}.
8515
8516 @table @code
8517 @item help function
8518 @kindex help function
8519 @cindex show all convenience functions
8520 Print a list of all convenience functions.
8521 @end table
8522
8523 @node Registers
8524 @section Registers
8525
8526 @cindex registers
8527 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
8528 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
8529 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
8530 your machine.
8531
8532 @table @code
8533 @kindex info registers
8534 @item info registers
8535 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
8536 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8537
8538 @kindex info all-registers
8539 @cindex floating point registers
8540 @item info all-registers
8541 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
8542 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8543
8544 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
8545 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
8546 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
8547 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
8548 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
8549 @end table
8550
8551 @cindex stack pointer register
8552 @cindex program counter register
8553 @cindex process status register
8554 @cindex frame pointer register
8555 @cindex standard registers
8556 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
8557 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
8558 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
8559 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
8560 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
8561 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
8562 register that contains the processor status. For example,
8563 you could print the program counter in hex with
8564
8565 @smallexample
8566 p/x $pc
8567 @end smallexample
8568
8569 @noindent
8570 or print the instruction to be executed next with
8571
8572 @smallexample
8573 x/i $pc
8574 @end smallexample
8575
8576 @noindent
8577 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
8578 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
8579 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
8580 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
8581 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
8582 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
8583 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
8584
8585 @smallexample
8586 set $sp += 4
8587 @end smallexample
8588
8589 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
8590 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
8591 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
8592 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
8593 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
8594 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
8595 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
8596
8597 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
8598 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
8599 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
8600 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
8601 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
8602 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
8603 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
8604
8605 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
8606 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
8607 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
8608 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
8609 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
8610 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
8611 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
8612 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
8613 prints the data in both formats.
8614
8615 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
8616 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
8617 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
8618 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
8619 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
8620 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
8621 registers in @code{struct} notation:
8622
8623 @smallexample
8624 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
8625 $1 = @{
8626 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
8627 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
8628 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
8629 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
8630 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
8631 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
8632 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
8633 @}
8634 @end smallexample
8635
8636 @noindent
8637 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
8638 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
8639 value to a @code{struct} member:
8640
8641 @smallexample
8642 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
8643 @end smallexample
8644
8645 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
8646 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
8647 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
8648 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
8649 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
8650 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
8651
8652 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
8653 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
8654 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
8655 frame makes no difference.
8656
8657 @node Floating Point Hardware
8658 @section Floating Point Hardware
8659 @cindex floating point
8660
8661 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
8662 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
8663
8664 @table @code
8665 @kindex info float
8666 @item info float
8667 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
8668 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
8669 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
8670 the ARM and x86 machines.
8671 @end table
8672
8673 @node Vector Unit
8674 @section Vector Unit
8675 @cindex vector unit
8676
8677 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
8678 more information about the status of the vector unit.
8679
8680 @table @code
8681 @kindex info vector
8682 @item info vector
8683 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
8684 layout vary depending on the hardware.
8685 @end table
8686
8687 @node OS Information
8688 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
8689 @cindex OS information
8690
8691 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
8692 you debug your program.
8693
8694 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
8695 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
8696 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
8697 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
8698 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
8699 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
8700 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
8701 structure.
8702
8703 @table @code
8704 @item info udot
8705 @kindex info udot
8706 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
8707 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
8708 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
8709 the @code{examine} command.
8710 @end table
8711
8712 @cindex auxiliary vector
8713 @cindex vector, auxiliary
8714 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
8715 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
8716 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
8717 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
8718 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
8719 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
8720 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
8721 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
8722 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
8723 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
8724 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
8725
8726 @table @code
8727 @kindex info auxv
8728 @item info auxv
8729 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
8730 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
8731 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
8732 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
8733 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
8734 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
8735 an unrecognized tag.
8736 @end table
8737
8738 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
8739 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
8740 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
8741 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
8742
8743 @table @code
8744 @kindex info os
8745 @item info os
8746 List the types of OS information available for the target. If the
8747 target does not return a list of possible types, this command will
8748 report an error.
8749
8750 @kindex info os processes
8751 @item info os processes
8752 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
8753 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
8754 the command corresponding to the process.
8755 @end table
8756
8757 @node Memory Region Attributes
8758 @section Memory Region Attributes
8759 @cindex memory region attributes
8760
8761 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
8762 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
8763 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
8764 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
8765 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
8766 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
8767 user can override the fetched regions.
8768
8769 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
8770 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
8771 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
8772 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
8773 all memory.
8774
8775 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
8776 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
8777
8778 @table @code
8779 @kindex mem
8780 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
8781 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
8782 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
8783 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
8784 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
8785 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
8786
8787 @item mem auto
8788 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
8789 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
8790
8791 @kindex delete mem
8792 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8793 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
8794 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
8795
8796 @kindex disable mem
8797 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8798 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8799 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
8800 It may be enabled again later.
8801
8802 @kindex enable mem
8803 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8804 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8805
8806 @kindex info mem
8807 @item info mem
8808 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
8809 for each region:
8810
8811 @table @emph
8812 @item Memory Region Number
8813 @item Enabled or Disabled.
8814 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
8815 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
8816
8817 @item Lo Address
8818 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
8819
8820 @item Hi Address
8821 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
8822
8823 @item Attributes
8824 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
8825 @end table
8826 @end table
8827
8828
8829 @subsection Attributes
8830
8831 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
8832 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
8833 write accesses to a memory region.
8834
8835 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
8836 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
8837 etc.@: from accessing memory.
8838
8839 @table @code
8840 @item ro
8841 Memory is read only.
8842 @item wo
8843 Memory is write only.
8844 @item rw
8845 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
8846 @end table
8847
8848 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
8849 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
8850 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
8851 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
8852 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
8853
8854 @table @code
8855 @item 8
8856 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
8857 @item 16
8858 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
8859 @item 32
8860 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
8861 @item 64
8862 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
8863 @end table
8864
8865 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
8866 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8867 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
8868 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
8869 @c
8870 @c @table @code
8871 @c @item hwbreak
8872 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
8873 @c @item swbreak (default)
8874 @c @end table
8875
8876 @subsubsection Data Cache
8877 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
8878 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
8879 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
8880 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
8881 registers.
8882
8883 @table @code
8884 @item cache
8885 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
8886 @item nocache
8887 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
8888 @end table
8889
8890 @subsection Memory Access Checking
8891 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
8892 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
8893 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
8894 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
8895
8896 @table @code
8897 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
8898 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
8899 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
8900 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
8901 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
8902 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
8903 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
8904 The default value is @code{on}.
8905 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
8906 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
8907 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
8908 @end table
8909
8910
8911 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
8912 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8913 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
8914 @c
8915 @c @table @code
8916 @c @item verify
8917 @c @item noverify (default)
8918 @c @end table
8919
8920 @node Dump/Restore Files
8921 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
8922 @cindex dump/restore files
8923 @cindex append data to a file
8924 @cindex dump data to a file
8925 @cindex restore data from a file
8926
8927 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
8928 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
8929 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
8930 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
8931 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8932 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8933 files.
8934
8935 @table @code
8936
8937 @kindex dump
8938 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8939 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8940 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8941 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8942
8943 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8944 @table @code
8945 @item binary
8946 Raw binary form.
8947 @item ihex
8948 Intel hex format.
8949 @item srec
8950 Motorola S-record format.
8951 @item tekhex
8952 Tektronix Hex format.
8953 @end table
8954
8955 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8956 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8957 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8958 form.
8959
8960 @kindex append
8961 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8962 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8963 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8964 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8965 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8966
8967 @kindex restore
8968 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8969 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8970 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8971 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8972 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8973
8974 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
8975 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
8976 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
8977 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
8978 from that location.
8979
8980 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
8981 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
8982 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
8983 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
8984
8985 @end table
8986
8987 @node Core File Generation
8988 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
8989 @cindex dump core from inferior
8990
8991 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
8992 image of a running process and its process status (register values
8993 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
8994 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
8995 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
8996 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
8997 the post-mortem debugging mode.
8998
8999 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
9000 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
9001 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
9002
9003 @table @code
9004 @kindex gcore
9005 @kindex generate-core-file
9006 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
9007 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
9008 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
9009 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
9010 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
9011 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
9012
9013 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
9014 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
9015 @end table
9016
9017 @node Character Sets
9018 @section Character Sets
9019 @cindex character sets
9020 @cindex charset
9021 @cindex translating between character sets
9022 @cindex host character set
9023 @cindex target character set
9024
9025 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
9026 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
9027 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
9028 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
9029 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
9030 @dfn{target character set}.
9031
9032 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
9033 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
9034 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
9035 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
9036 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
9037 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
9038 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
9039 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
9040 character and string literals in expressions.
9041
9042 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
9043 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
9044 target-charset} command, described below.
9045
9046 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
9047 support:
9048
9049 @table @code
9050 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
9051 @kindex set target-charset
9052 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
9053 list of supported target character sets, type
9054 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9055
9056 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
9057 @kindex set host-charset
9058 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
9059
9060 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
9061 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
9062 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
9063 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
9064 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
9065
9066 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
9067 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9068 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
9069
9070 @item set charset @var{charset}
9071 @kindex set charset
9072 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
9073 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9074 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
9075 for both host and target.
9076
9077 @item show charset
9078 @kindex show charset
9079 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
9080
9081 @item show host-charset
9082 @kindex show host-charset
9083 Show the name of the current host character set.
9084
9085 @item show target-charset
9086 @kindex show target-charset
9087 Show the name of the current target character set.
9088
9089 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
9090 @kindex set target-wide-charset
9091 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
9092 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
9093 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
9094 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9095
9096 @item show target-wide-charset
9097 @kindex show target-wide-charset
9098 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
9099 @end table
9100
9101 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
9102 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
9103 @file{charset-test.c}:
9104
9105 @smallexample
9106 #include <stdio.h>
9107
9108 char ascii_hello[]
9109 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
9110 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
9111 char ibm1047_hello[]
9112 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
9113 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
9114
9115 main ()
9116 @{
9117 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9118 @}
9119 @end smallexample
9120
9121 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
9122 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
9123 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
9124
9125 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
9126
9127 @smallexample
9128 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
9129 $ gdb -nw charset-test
9130 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
9131 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9132 @dots{}
9133 (@value{GDBP})
9134 @end smallexample
9135
9136 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
9137 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
9138 strings:
9139
9140 @smallexample
9141 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9142 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
9143 (@value{GDBP})
9144 @end smallexample
9145
9146 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
9147 initial character set:
9148 @smallexample
9149 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
9150 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9151 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
9152 (@value{GDBP})
9153 @end smallexample
9154
9155 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
9156 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
9157 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
9158 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
9159 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
9160
9161 @smallexample
9162 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9163 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
9164 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9165 $2 = 72 'H'
9166 (@value{GDBP})
9167 @end smallexample
9168
9169 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
9170 literals you use in expressions:
9171
9172 @smallexample
9173 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9174 $3 = 43 '+'
9175 (@value{GDBP})
9176 @end smallexample
9177
9178 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
9179 character.
9180
9181 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
9182 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
9183 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
9184
9185 @smallexample
9186 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9187 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
9188 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9189 $5 = 200 '\310'
9190 (@value{GDBP})
9191 @end smallexample
9192
9193 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
9194 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
9195
9196 @smallexample
9197 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9198 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
9199 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9200 @end smallexample
9201
9202 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
9203 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
9204 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
9205 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
9206 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
9207
9208 @smallexample
9209 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
9210 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9211 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
9212 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
9213 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9214 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
9215 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9216 $7 = 72 '\110'
9217 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9218 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
9219 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9220 $9 = 200 'H'
9221 (@value{GDBP})
9222 @end smallexample
9223
9224 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
9225 string literals you use in expressions:
9226
9227 @smallexample
9228 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9229 $10 = 78 '+'
9230 (@value{GDBP})
9231 @end smallexample
9232
9233 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
9234 character.
9235
9236 @node Caching Remote Data
9237 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
9238 @cindex caching data of remote targets
9239
9240 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
9241 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
9242 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
9243 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
9244 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
9245 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
9246 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
9247 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
9248 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
9249 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
9250 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
9251 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
9252 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
9253 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
9254 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
9255
9256 @table @code
9257 @kindex set remotecache
9258 @item set remotecache on
9259 @itemx set remotecache off
9260 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
9261 with old scripts.
9262
9263 @kindex show remotecache
9264 @item show remotecache
9265 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
9266
9267 @kindex set stack-cache
9268 @item set stack-cache on
9269 @itemx set stack-cache off
9270 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
9271 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
9272
9273 @kindex show stack-cache
9274 @item show stack-cache
9275 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
9276
9277 @kindex info dcache
9278 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
9279 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
9280 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
9281 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
9282 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
9283 operation.
9284
9285 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
9286 printed in hex.
9287 @end table
9288
9289 @node Searching Memory
9290 @section Search Memory
9291 @cindex searching memory
9292
9293 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
9294 @code{find} command.
9295
9296 @table @code
9297 @kindex find
9298 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9299 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9300 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
9301 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
9302 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
9303 @end table
9304
9305 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
9306 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
9307
9308 @table @r
9309 @item @var{s}, search query size
9310 The size of each search query value.
9311
9312 @table @code
9313 @item b
9314 bytes
9315 @item h
9316 halfwords (two bytes)
9317 @item w
9318 words (four bytes)
9319 @item g
9320 giant words (eight bytes)
9321 @end table
9322
9323 All values are interpreted in the current language.
9324 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
9325 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
9326
9327 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
9328 value's type in the current language.
9329 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
9330 pattern as a mixture of types.
9331 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
9332 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
9333 which is typically four bytes.
9334
9335 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
9336 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
9337 @end table
9338
9339 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
9340 (@code{"}).
9341 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
9342 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
9343
9344 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
9345 number of matches found.
9346
9347 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
9348 @samp{$_}.
9349 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
9350
9351 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
9352
9353 @smallexample
9354 void
9355 hello ()
9356 @{
9357 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
9358 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
9359 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
9360 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
9361 printf ("%s\n", hello);
9362 @}
9363 @end smallexample
9364
9365 @noindent
9366 you get during debugging:
9367
9368 @smallexample
9369 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
9370 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9371 1 pattern found
9372 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
9373 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9374 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9375 2 patterns found
9376 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
9377 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9378 1 pattern found
9379 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
9380 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
9381 1 pattern found
9382 (gdb) print $numfound
9383 $1 = 1
9384 (gdb) print $_
9385 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
9386 @end smallexample
9387
9388 @node Optimized Code
9389 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
9390 @cindex optimized code, debugging
9391 @cindex debugging optimized code
9392
9393 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
9394 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
9395 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
9396 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
9397 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
9398 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
9399 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
9400
9401 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
9402 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
9403 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
9404 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
9405
9406 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
9407 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
9408 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
9409 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
9410 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
9411 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
9412
9413 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
9414 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
9415 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
9416 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
9417 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
9418
9419 @menu
9420 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
9421 @end menu
9422
9423 @node Inline Functions
9424 @section Inline Functions
9425 @cindex inline functions, debugging
9426
9427 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
9428 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
9429 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
9430 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
9431 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
9432 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
9433 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
9434 @code{info frame} command.
9435
9436 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
9437 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
9438 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
9439 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
9440 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
9441 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
9442 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
9443 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
9444 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
9445 local variables in the caller.
9446
9447 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
9448 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
9449 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
9450 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
9451 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
9452 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
9453 instructions are executed.
9454
9455 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
9456 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
9457 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
9458 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
9459
9460 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
9461 function calls are the same as normal calls:
9462
9463 @itemize @bullet
9464 @item
9465 You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
9466 either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
9467 breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
9468 will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
9469 set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
9470 function instead.
9471
9472 @item
9473 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
9474 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
9475 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
9476 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
9477 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
9478 or inside the inlined function instead.
9479
9480 @item
9481 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
9482 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
9483 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
9484 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
9485
9486 @end itemize
9487
9488
9489 @node Macros
9490 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
9491
9492 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
9493 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
9494 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
9495 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
9496 where it was defined.
9497
9498 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
9499 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
9500 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
9501 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
9502
9503 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
9504 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
9505 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
9506 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
9507 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
9508 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
9509 see @ref{List}.
9510
9511 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
9512 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
9513 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
9514
9515 @table @code
9516
9517 @kindex macro expand
9518 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
9519 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
9520 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
9521 @item macro expand @var{expression}
9522 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
9523 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
9524 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
9525 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
9526 it can be any string of tokens.
9527
9528 @kindex macro exp1
9529 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
9530 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
9531 @cindex expand macro once
9532 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
9533 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
9534 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
9535 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
9536 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
9537 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
9538 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
9539 can be any string of tokens.
9540
9541 @kindex info macro
9542 @cindex macro definition, showing
9543 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
9544 @item info macro @var{macro}
9545 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
9546 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
9547
9548 @kindex macro define
9549 @cindex user-defined macros
9550 @cindex defining macros interactively
9551 @cindex macros, user-defined
9552 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
9553 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
9554 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
9555 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
9556 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
9557 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
9558 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
9559 @var{arglist}.
9560
9561 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
9562 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
9563 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
9564 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
9565 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
9566
9567 @kindex macro undef
9568 @item macro undef @var{macro}
9569 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
9570 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
9571 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
9572 in the program being debugged.
9573
9574 @kindex macro list
9575 @item macro list
9576 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
9577 @end table
9578
9579 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
9580 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
9581 show our source files:
9582
9583 @smallexample
9584 $ cat sample.c
9585 #include <stdio.h>
9586 #include "sample.h"
9587
9588 #define M 42
9589 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9590
9591 main ()
9592 @{
9593 #define N 28
9594 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9595 #undef N
9596 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9597 #define N 1729
9598 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9599 @}
9600 $ cat sample.h
9601 #define Q <
9602 $
9603 @end smallexample
9604
9605 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
9606 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
9607 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
9608 information.
9609
9610 @smallexample
9611 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
9612 $
9613 @end smallexample
9614
9615 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
9616
9617 @smallexample
9618 $ gdb -nw sample
9619 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
9620 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9621 GDB is free software, @dots{}
9622 (@value{GDBP})
9623 @end smallexample
9624
9625 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
9626 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
9627 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
9628
9629 @smallexample
9630 (@value{GDBP}) list main
9631 3
9632 4 #define M 42
9633 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9634 6
9635 7 main ()
9636 8 @{
9637 9 #define N 28
9638 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9639 11 #undef N
9640 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9641 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
9642 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
9643 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9644 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
9645 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
9646 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
9647 #define Q <
9648 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
9649 expands to: (42 + 1)
9650 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
9651 expands to: once (M + 1)
9652 (@value{GDBP})
9653 @end smallexample
9654
9655 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
9656 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
9657 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
9658 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
9659
9660 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
9661 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
9662
9663 @smallexample
9664 (@value{GDBP}) break main
9665 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
9666 (@value{GDBP}) run
9667 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
9668
9669 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
9670 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9671 (@value{GDBP})
9672 @end smallexample
9673
9674 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
9675
9676 @smallexample
9677 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9678 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
9679 #define N 28
9680 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9681 expands to: 28 < 42
9682 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9683 $1 = 1
9684 (@value{GDBP})
9685 @end smallexample
9686
9687 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
9688 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
9689 thereof) in force at each point:
9690
9691 @smallexample
9692 (@value{GDBP}) next
9693 Hello, world!
9694 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9695 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9696 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
9697 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
9698 (@value{GDBP}) next
9699 We're so creative.
9700 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9701 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9702 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
9703 #define N 1729
9704 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9705 expands to: 1729 < 42
9706 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9707 $2 = 0
9708 (@value{GDBP})
9709 @end smallexample
9710
9711 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
9712 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
9713 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
9714 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
9715
9716 @smallexample
9717 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
9718 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
9719 -D__STDC__=1
9720 (@value{GDBP})
9721 @end smallexample
9722
9723
9724 @node Tracepoints
9725 @chapter Tracepoints
9726 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
9727 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
9728
9729 @cindex tracepoints
9730 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
9731 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
9732 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
9733 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
9734 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
9735 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
9736 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
9737
9738 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
9739 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
9740 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
9741 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
9742 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
9743 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
9744 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
9745 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
9746 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
9747 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
9748 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
9749
9750 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
9751 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
9752 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
9753 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
9754 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
9755 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
9756 Packets}.
9757
9758 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
9759 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
9760 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
9761
9762 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
9763
9764 @menu
9765 * Set Tracepoints::
9766 * Analyze Collected Data::
9767 * Tracepoint Variables::
9768 * Trace Files::
9769 @end menu
9770
9771 @node Set Tracepoints
9772 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
9773
9774 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
9775 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
9776 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
9777 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
9778 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
9779 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
9780 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
9781
9782 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
9783 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
9784 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
9785 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
9786 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
9787 tracepoint was hit.
9788
9789 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
9790 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
9791 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
9792 either.
9793
9794 @cindex fast tracepoints
9795 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
9796 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
9797 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
9798
9799 @cindex static tracepoints
9800 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
9801 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
9802 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
9803 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
9804 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
9805 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
9806 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
9807 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
9808 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
9809 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
9810 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
9811 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
9812 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
9813 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namelly, support for collecting
9814 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
9815 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
9816 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
9817 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
9818 static tracepoint marker.
9819
9820 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
9821 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
9822
9823 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
9824 conditions and actions.
9825
9826 @menu
9827 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
9828 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
9829 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
9830 * Tracepoint Conditions::
9831 * Trace State Variables::
9832 * Tracepoint Actions::
9833 * Listing Tracepoints::
9834 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
9835 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
9836 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
9837 @end menu
9838
9839 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
9840 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
9841
9842 @table @code
9843 @cindex set tracepoint
9844 @kindex trace
9845 @item trace @var{location}
9846 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
9847 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
9848 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
9849 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
9850 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
9851 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
9852 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
9853 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
9854 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
9855
9856 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
9857
9858 @smallexample
9859 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
9860
9861 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
9862
9863 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
9864
9865 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
9866
9867 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
9868 @end smallexample
9869
9870 @noindent
9871 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
9872
9873 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
9874 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
9875 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
9876 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
9877 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
9878 information on tracepoint conditions.
9879
9880 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9881 @cindex set fast tracepoint
9882 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
9883 @kindex ftrace
9884 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
9885 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
9886 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
9887 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
9888 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
9889 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
9890 message.
9891
9892 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
9893 @code{trace}.
9894
9895 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9896 @cindex set static tracepoint
9897 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
9898 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
9899 @kindex strace
9900 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
9901 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
9902 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
9903 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
9904 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
9905
9906 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
9907 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
9908 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
9909 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
9910 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
9911 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
9912 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
9913 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
9914 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
9915 tracing engine:
9916
9917 @smallexample
9918 main ()
9919 @{
9920 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
9921 @}
9922 @end smallexample
9923
9924 @noindent
9925 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
9926 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
9927
9928 @smallexample
9929 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
9930 Cnt Enb ID Address What
9931 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
9932 Data: "str %s"
9933 [etc...]
9934 @end smallexample
9935
9936 @noindent
9937 so you may probe the marker above with:
9938
9939 @smallexample
9940 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
9941 @end smallexample
9942
9943 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
9944 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
9945 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
9946 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
9947 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
9948 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
9949 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
9950 the @samp{Data:} field.
9951
9952 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
9953 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
9954 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
9955
9956 @vindex $tpnum
9957 @cindex last tracepoint number
9958 @cindex recent tracepoint number
9959 @cindex tracepoint number
9960 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
9961 of the most recently set tracepoint.
9962
9963 @kindex delete tracepoint
9964 @cindex tracepoint deletion
9965 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9966 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
9967 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
9968 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
9969
9970 Examples:
9971
9972 @smallexample
9973 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
9974
9975 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
9976 @end smallexample
9977
9978 @noindent
9979 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
9980 @end table
9981
9982 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9983 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9984
9985 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
9986
9987 @table @code
9988 @kindex disable tracepoint
9989 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9990 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
9991 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
9992 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
9993 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
9994
9995 @kindex enable tracepoint
9996 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9997 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
9998 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
9999 run.
10000 @end table
10001
10002 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
10003 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
10004
10005 @table @code
10006 @kindex passcount
10007 @cindex tracepoint pass count
10008 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
10009 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
10010 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
10011 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
10012 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
10013 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
10014 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
10015 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
10016 user.
10017
10018 Examples:
10019
10020 @smallexample
10021 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
10022 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
10023
10024 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
10025 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
10026 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10027 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
10028 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
10029 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
10030 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
10031 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
10032 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
10033 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
10034 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
10035 @end smallexample
10036 @end table
10037
10038 @node Tracepoint Conditions
10039 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
10040 @cindex conditional tracepoints
10041 @cindex tracepoint conditions
10042
10043 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
10044 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
10045 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
10046 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
10047 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
10048 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
10049 is true.
10050
10051 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
10052 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
10053 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
10054 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
10055 just as with breakpoints.
10056
10057 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
10058 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
10059 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}
10060 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
10061 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
10062 accesses, and so forth.
10063
10064 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
10065 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
10066 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
10067 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
10068 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
10069 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
10070 search through.
10071
10072 @smallexample
10073 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
10074 @end smallexample
10075
10076 @node Trace State Variables
10077 @subsection Trace State Variables
10078 @cindex trace state variables
10079
10080 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
10081 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
10082 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
10083 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
10084 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
10085 integers.
10086
10087 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
10088 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
10089 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
10090 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
10091
10092 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
10093 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
10094 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
10095 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
10096 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
10097 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
10098 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
10099 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
10100 variable with the same name.
10101
10102 @table @code
10103
10104 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
10105 @kindex tvariable
10106 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
10107 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
10108 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
10109 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
10110 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
10111 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
10112 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
10113 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
10114 value. The default initial value is 0.
10115
10116 @item info tvariables
10117 @kindex info tvariables
10118 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
10119 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
10120 currently running.
10121
10122 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
10123 @kindex delete tvariable
10124 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
10125 are specified.
10126
10127 @end table
10128
10129 @node Tracepoint Actions
10130 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
10131
10132 @table @code
10133 @kindex actions
10134 @cindex tracepoint actions
10135 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10136 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
10137 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
10138 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
10139 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
10140 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
10141 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
10142 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
10143 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
10144 @code{while-stepping}.
10145
10146 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
10147 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
10148 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
10149
10150 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
10151 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
10152 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
10153
10154 @smallexample
10155 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
10156
10157 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
10158
10159 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
10160 @end smallexample
10161
10162 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
10163 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
10164 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
10165 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
10166 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
10167 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
10168 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
10169 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
10170
10171 @smallexample
10172 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10173 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10174 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
10175 > collect bar,baz
10176 > collect $regs
10177 > while-stepping 12
10178 > collect $pc, arr[i]
10179 > end
10180 end
10181 @end smallexample
10182
10183 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
10184 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10185 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
10186 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
10187 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
10188 special arguments are supported:
10189
10190 @table @code
10191 @item $regs
10192 Collect all registers.
10193
10194 @item $args
10195 Collect all function arguments.
10196
10197 @item $locals
10198 Collect all local variables.
10199
10200 @item $_sdata
10201 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
10202 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
10203 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
10204 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
10205 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
10206 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
10207 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
10208 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
10209 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
10210
10211 @smallexample
10212 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
10213 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
10214 @end smallexample
10215
10216 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
10217 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
10218 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
10219 @value{GDBN}.
10220 @end table
10221
10222 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
10223 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
10224 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
10225
10226 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
10227 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
10228
10229 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
10230 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10231 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
10232 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
10233 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
10234 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
10235 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
10236 action were used.
10237
10238 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
10239 @item while-stepping @var{n}
10240 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
10241 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
10242 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
10243 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
10244
10245 @smallexample
10246 > while-stepping 12
10247 > collect $regs, myglobal
10248 > end
10249 >
10250 @end smallexample
10251
10252 @noindent
10253 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
10254 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
10255 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
10256 @code{stepping}.
10257
10258 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10259 @kindex set default-collect
10260 @cindex default collection action
10261 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
10262 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
10263 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
10264 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
10265 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
10266 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
10267
10268 @item show default-collect
10269 @kindex show default-collect
10270 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
10271 tracepoint hit.
10272
10273 @end table
10274
10275 @node Listing Tracepoints
10276 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
10277
10278 @table @code
10279 @kindex info tracepoints
10280 @kindex info tp
10281 @cindex information about tracepoints
10282 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10283 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
10284 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
10285 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
10286 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
10287 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
10288
10289 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
10290 tracing:
10291
10292 @itemize @bullet
10293 @item
10294 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
10295 @end itemize
10296
10297 @smallexample
10298 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
10299 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
10300 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
10301 while-stepping 20
10302 collect globfoo, $regs
10303 end
10304 collect globfoo2
10305 end
10306 pass count 1200
10307 (@value{GDBP})
10308 @end smallexample
10309
10310 @noindent
10311 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
10312 @end table
10313
10314 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10315 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10316
10317 @table @code
10318 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
10319 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
10320 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
10321 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
10322 program.
10323
10324 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
10325
10326 @table @emph
10327 @item Count
10328 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
10329 stable identifier.
10330 @item ID
10331 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
10332 @item Enabled or Disabled
10333 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
10334 that are not enabled.
10335 @item Address
10336 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
10337 @item What
10338 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
10339 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
10340 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
10341 will be left blank.
10342 @end table
10343
10344 @noindent
10345 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
10346
10347 @table @emph
10348 @item Data
10349 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
10350 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
10351 marker call.
10352 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
10353 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
10354 @end table
10355
10356 @smallexample
10357 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
10358 Cnt ID Enb Address What
10359 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
10360 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
10361 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
10362 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
10363 Data: str %s
10364 (@value{GDBP})
10365 @end smallexample
10366 @end table
10367
10368 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10369 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10370
10371 @table @code
10372 @kindex tstart
10373 @cindex start a new trace experiment
10374 @cindex collected data discarded
10375 @item tstart
10376 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
10377 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
10378 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
10379 experiment.
10380
10381 @kindex tstop
10382 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
10383 @item tstop
10384 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
10385 stops collecting data.
10386
10387 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
10388 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
10389 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
10390
10391 @kindex tstatus
10392 @cindex status of trace data collection
10393 @cindex trace experiment, status of
10394 @item tstatus
10395 This command displays the status of the current trace data
10396 collection.
10397 @end table
10398
10399 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
10400
10401 @smallexample
10402 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
10403 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10404 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
10405 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
10406 > while-stepping 11
10407 > collect $regs
10408 > end
10409 > end
10410 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10411 [time passes @dots{}]
10412 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
10413 @end smallexample
10414
10415 @cindex disconnected tracing
10416 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
10417 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
10418 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
10419 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
10420 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
10421 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
10422 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
10423 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
10424
10425 @table @code
10426 @item set disconnected-tracing on
10427 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
10428 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
10429 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
10430 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
10431 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
10432 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
10433 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
10434
10435 @item show disconnected-tracing
10436 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
10437 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
10438
10439 @end table
10440
10441 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
10442 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
10443 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
10444 it will continue after reconnection.
10445
10446 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
10447 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
10448 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
10449 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
10450 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
10451 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
10452 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
10453 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
10454 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
10455 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
10456
10457 @cindex circular trace buffer
10458 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
10459 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
10460 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
10461 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
10462 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
10463 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
10464 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
10465 @samp{circular_trace_buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
10466 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
10467 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
10468 the next run.
10469
10470 @table @code
10471 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
10472 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
10473 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
10474 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
10475 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
10476 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
10477 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
10478
10479 @item show circular-trace-buffer
10480 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
10481 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
10482 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
10483 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
10484 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
10485
10486 @end table
10487
10488 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
10489 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
10490
10491 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
10492 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
10493 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
10494 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
10495 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
10496 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
10497 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
10498 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
10499 mentioned here.
10500
10501 @itemize @bullet
10502
10503 @item
10504 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
10505 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
10506 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
10507 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
10508 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
10509 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
10510 cannot be collected either.
10511
10512 @item
10513 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
10514 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
10515 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
10516 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
10517 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
10518 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
10519 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
10520 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
10521 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
10522 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
10523
10524 @item
10525 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
10526 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
10527 in a misleading way.
10528
10529 @item
10530 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
10531 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
10532 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
10533 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
10534 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
10535 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
10536 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
10537 by @code{ptr}.
10538
10539 @item
10540 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
10541 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
10542 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*$esp@@300}
10543 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
10544 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
10545 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
10546 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
10547 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
10548 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
10549 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
10550 invalid address.
10551
10552 @item
10553 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
10554 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
10555 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
10556 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
10557 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
10558 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
10559 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
10560 it to zero.
10561
10562 @end itemize
10563
10564 @node Analyze Collected Data
10565 @section Using the Collected Data
10566
10567 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
10568 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
10569 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
10570 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
10571 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
10572 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
10573 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
10574 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
10575 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
10576 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
10577 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
10578 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
10579 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
10580 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
10581 the buffer will fail.
10582
10583 @menu
10584 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
10585 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
10586 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
10587 @end menu
10588
10589 @node tfind
10590 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
10591
10592 @kindex tfind
10593 @cindex select trace snapshot
10594 @cindex find trace snapshot
10595 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
10596 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
10597 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
10598 snapshot is selected.
10599
10600 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
10601
10602 @table @code
10603 @item tfind start
10604 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
10605 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
10606
10607 @item tfind none
10608 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
10609
10610 @item tfind end
10611 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
10612
10613 @item tfind
10614 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
10615
10616 @item tfind -
10617 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
10618 retracing earlier steps.
10619
10620 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
10621 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
10622 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
10623 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
10624 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
10625
10626 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
10627 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
10628 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
10629 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
10630 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
10631
10632 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10633 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
10634 addresses (exclusive).
10635
10636 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10637 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
10638 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
10639
10640 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
10641 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
10642 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
10643 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
10644 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
10645 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
10646 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
10647 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
10648 @end table
10649
10650 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
10651 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
10652 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
10653 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
10654 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
10655 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
10656 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
10657 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
10658 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
10659 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
10660 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
10661 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
10662 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
10663 tracepoint as the current one.
10664
10665 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
10666 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
10667 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
10668 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
10669 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
10670
10671 @smallexample
10672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10673 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10674 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
10675 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
10676 > tfind
10677 > end
10678
10679 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
10680 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
10681 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
10682 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
10683 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
10684 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
10685 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
10686 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
10687 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
10688 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
10689 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
10690 @end smallexample
10691
10692 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
10693 the buffer:
10694
10695 @smallexample
10696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10698 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
10699 > tfind line
10700 > end
10701
10702 Frame 0, X = 1
10703 Frame 7, X = 2
10704 Frame 13, X = 255
10705 @end smallexample
10706
10707 @node tdump
10708 @subsection @code{tdump}
10709 @kindex tdump
10710 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
10711 @cindex tracepoint data, display
10712
10713 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
10714 the current trace snapshot.
10715
10716 @smallexample
10717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
10718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10719 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
10720 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
10721 > end
10722
10723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10724
10725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
10726 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
10727 at gdb_test.c:444
10728 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
10729
10730 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
10731 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
10732 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
10733 d1 0x18 24
10734 d2 0x80 128
10735 d3 0x33 51
10736 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
10737 d5 0x22 34
10738 d6 0xe0 224
10739 d7 0x380035 3670069
10740 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
10741 a1 0x3000668 50333288
10742 a2 0x100 256
10743 a3 0x322000 3284992
10744 a4 0x3000698 50333336
10745 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
10746 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
10747 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
10748 ps 0x0 0
10749 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
10750 fpcontrol 0x0 0
10751 fpstatus 0x0 0
10752 fpiaddr 0x0 0
10753 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
10754 p1 = (void *) 0x11
10755 p2 = (void *) 0x22
10756 p3 = (void *) 0x33
10757 p4 = (void *) 0x44
10758 p5 = (void *) 0x55
10759 p6 = (void *) 0x66
10760 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
10761
10762 (@value{GDBP})
10763 @end smallexample
10764
10765 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
10766 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
10767 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
10768 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
10769
10770 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
10771 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
10772 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
10773 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
10774 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
10775 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
10776 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
10777 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
10778 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
10779 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
10780
10781 @node save tracepoints
10782 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
10783 @kindex save tracepoints
10784 @kindex save-tracepoints
10785 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
10786
10787 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
10788 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
10789 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
10790 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
10791 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
10792 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
10793
10794 @node Tracepoint Variables
10795 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
10796 @cindex tracepoint variables
10797 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
10798
10799 @table @code
10800 @vindex $trace_frame
10801 @item (int) $trace_frame
10802 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
10803 snapshot is selected.
10804
10805 @vindex $tracepoint
10806 @item (int) $tracepoint
10807 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
10808
10809 @vindex $trace_line
10810 @item (int) $trace_line
10811 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
10812
10813 @vindex $trace_file
10814 @item (char []) $trace_file
10815 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
10816
10817 @vindex $trace_func
10818 @item (char []) $trace_func
10819 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
10820 @end table
10821
10822 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
10823 use @code{output} instead.
10824
10825 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
10826 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
10827 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
10828 which are managed by the target.
10829
10830 @smallexample
10831 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10832
10833 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
10834 > output $trace_file
10835 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
10836 > tfind
10837 > end
10838 @end smallexample
10839
10840 @node Trace Files
10841 @section Using Trace Files
10842 @cindex trace files
10843
10844 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
10845 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
10846 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
10847 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
10848 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
10849
10850 @table @code
10851
10852 @kindex tsave
10853 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
10854 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
10855 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
10856 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
10857 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
10858 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
10859 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
10860 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
10861 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
10862
10863 @kindex target tfile
10864 @kindex tfile
10865 @item target tfile @var{filename}
10866 Use the file named @var{filename} as a source of trace data. Commands
10867 that examine data work as they do with a live target, but it is not
10868 possible to run any new trace experiments. @code{tstatus} will report
10869 the state of the trace run at the moment the data was saved, as well
10870 as the current trace frame you are examining. @var{filename} must be
10871 on a filesystem accessible to the host.
10872
10873 @end table
10874
10875 @node Overlays
10876 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
10877 @cindex overlays
10878
10879 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
10880 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
10881 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
10882 use overlays.
10883
10884 @menu
10885 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
10886 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
10887 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
10888 mapped by asking the inferior.
10889 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
10890 @end menu
10891
10892 @node How Overlays Work
10893 @section How Overlays Work
10894 @cindex mapped overlays
10895 @cindex unmapped overlays
10896 @cindex load address, overlay's
10897 @cindex mapped address
10898 @cindex overlay area
10899
10900 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
10901 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
10902 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
10903 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
10904 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
10905
10906 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
10907 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
10908 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
10909 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
10910 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
10911 largest overlay as well.
10912
10913 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
10914 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
10915 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
10916 there.
10917
10918 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
10919 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
10920 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
10921
10922 @smallexample
10923 @group
10924 Data Instruction Larger
10925 Address Space Address Space Address Space
10926 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
10927 | | | | | |
10928 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
10929 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
10930 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
10931 | and heap | | | | | |
10932 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
10933 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
10934 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
10935 | | | | | |
10936 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
10937 address | | | | | |
10938 | overlay | <-' | | |
10939 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
10940 | | <---. | | load address
10941 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
10942 | | | |
10943 +-----------+ | |
10944 +-----------+
10945 | |
10946 +-----------+
10947
10948 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
10949 @end group
10950 @end smallexample
10951
10952 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
10953 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
10954 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
10955 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
10956 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
10957 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
10958 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
10959 program and the overlay area.
10960
10961 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
10962 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
10963 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
10964 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
10965 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
10966 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
10967 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
10968
10969 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
10970 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
10971 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
10972
10973 @itemize @bullet
10974
10975 @item
10976 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
10977 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
10978 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
10979 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
10980
10981 @item
10982 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
10983 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
10984 your program's performance.
10985
10986 @item
10987 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
10988 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
10989 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
10990 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
10991 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
10992 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
10993 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
10994
10995 @item
10996 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
10997 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
10998 instruction and data spaces.
10999
11000 @end itemize
11001
11002 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
11003 improved in many ways:
11004
11005 @itemize @bullet
11006
11007 @item
11008 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
11009 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
11010 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
11011 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
11012 area in the usual way.
11013
11014 @item
11015 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
11016 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
11017
11018 @item
11019 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
11020 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
11021 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
11022 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
11023 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
11024 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
11025 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
11026
11027 @end itemize
11028
11029
11030 @node Overlay Commands
11031 @section Overlay Commands
11032
11033 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
11034 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
11035 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
11036 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
11037 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
11038 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
11039
11040 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
11041 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
11042
11043 @table @code
11044 @item overlay off
11045 @kindex overlay
11046 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
11047 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
11048 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
11049 overlay support is disabled.
11050
11051 @item overlay manual
11052 @cindex manual overlay debugging
11053 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11054 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
11055 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
11056 commands described below.
11057
11058 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
11059 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
11060 @cindex map an overlay
11061 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
11062 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
11063 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
11064 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
11065 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
11066 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
11067
11068 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
11069 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
11070 @cindex unmap an overlay
11071 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
11072 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
11073 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
11074 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
11075
11076 @item overlay auto
11077 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11078 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
11079 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
11080 Overlay Debugging}.
11081
11082 @item overlay load-target
11083 @itemx overlay load
11084 @cindex reloading the overlay table
11085 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
11086 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
11087 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
11088 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
11089 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
11090
11091 @item overlay list-overlays
11092 @itemx overlay list
11093 @cindex listing mapped overlays
11094 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
11095 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
11096
11097 @end table
11098
11099 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
11100 of the function the address falls in:
11101
11102 @smallexample
11103 (@value{GDBP}) print main
11104 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
11105 @end smallexample
11106 @noindent
11107 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
11108 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
11109 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
11110 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
11111
11112 @smallexample
11113 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11114 No sections are mapped.
11115 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11116 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
11117 @end smallexample
11118 @noindent
11119 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
11120 name normally:
11121
11122 @smallexample
11123 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11124 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
11125 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
11126 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11127 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
11128 @end smallexample
11129
11130 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
11131 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
11132 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
11133 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
11134 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
11135
11136 @itemize @bullet
11137 @item
11138 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
11139 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
11140 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
11141 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
11142 @item
11143 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
11144 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
11145 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
11146 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
11147 breakpoints properly.
11148 @end itemize
11149
11150
11151 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
11152 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
11153 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
11154
11155 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
11156 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
11157 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
11158 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
11159 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
11160 current state of the overlays.
11161
11162 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
11163 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
11164
11165 @table @asis
11166
11167 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
11168 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
11169
11170 @smallexample
11171 struct
11172 @{
11173 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
11174 unsigned long vma;
11175
11176 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
11177 unsigned long size;
11178
11179 /* The overlay's load address. */
11180 unsigned long lma;
11181
11182 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
11183 zero otherwise. */
11184 unsigned long mapped;
11185 @}
11186 @end smallexample
11187
11188 @item @code{_novlys}:
11189 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
11190 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
11191
11192 @end table
11193
11194 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
11195 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
11196 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
11197 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
11198 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
11199 currently mapped.
11200
11201 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
11202 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
11203 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
11204 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
11205 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
11206 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
11207 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
11208 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
11209 are not being executed.
11210
11211 @node Overlay Sample Program
11212 @section Overlay Sample Program
11213 @cindex overlay example program
11214
11215 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
11216 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
11217 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
11218 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
11219 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
11220 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
11221 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
11222
11223 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
11224 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
11225 suite. The program consists of the following files from
11226 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
11227
11228 @table @file
11229 @item overlays.c
11230 The main program file.
11231 @item ovlymgr.c
11232 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
11233 @item foo.c
11234 @itemx bar.c
11235 @itemx baz.c
11236 @itemx grbx.c
11237 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
11238 @item d10v.ld
11239 @itemx m32r.ld
11240 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
11241 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
11242 @end table
11243
11244 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
11245 cross-compiler like this:
11246
11247 @smallexample
11248 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
11249 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
11250 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
11251 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
11252 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
11253 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
11254 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
11255 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
11256 @end smallexample
11257
11258 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
11259 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
11260 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
11261
11262
11263 @node Languages
11264 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
11265 @cindex languages
11266
11267 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
11268 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
11269 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
11270 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
11271 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
11272 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
11273
11274 @cindex working language
11275 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
11276 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
11277 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
11278 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
11279 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
11280 language}.
11281
11282 @menu
11283 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
11284 * Show:: Displaying the language
11285 * Checks:: Type and range checks
11286 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
11287 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
11288 @end menu
11289
11290 @node Setting
11291 @section Switching Between Source Languages
11292
11293 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
11294 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
11295 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
11296 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
11297 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
11298 are printed, etc.
11299
11300 In addition to the working language, every source file that
11301 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
11302 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
11303 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
11304 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
11305 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
11306 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
11307 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
11308 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
11309 Displaying the Language}.
11310
11311 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
11312 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
11313 another language. In that case, make the
11314 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
11315 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
11316 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
11317
11318 @menu
11319 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
11320 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
11321 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
11322 @end menu
11323
11324 @node Filenames
11325 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
11326
11327 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
11328 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
11329
11330 @table @file
11331 @item .ada
11332 @itemx .ads
11333 @itemx .adb
11334 @itemx .a
11335 Ada source file.
11336
11337 @item .c
11338 C source file
11339
11340 @item .C
11341 @itemx .cc
11342 @itemx .cp
11343 @itemx .cpp
11344 @itemx .cxx
11345 @itemx .c++
11346 C@t{++} source file
11347
11348 @item .d
11349 D source file
11350
11351 @item .m
11352 Objective-C source file
11353
11354 @item .f
11355 @itemx .F
11356 Fortran source file
11357
11358 @item .mod
11359 Modula-2 source file
11360
11361 @item .s
11362 @itemx .S
11363 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
11364 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
11365 @end table
11366
11367 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
11368 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
11369
11370 @node Manually
11371 @subsection Setting the Working Language
11372
11373 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
11374 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
11375 your program.
11376
11377 @kindex set language
11378 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
11379 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
11380 a language, such as
11381 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
11382 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
11383
11384 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
11385 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
11386 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
11387 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
11388 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
11389 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
11390 command such as:
11391
11392 @smallexample
11393 print a = b + c
11394 @end smallexample
11395
11396 @noindent
11397 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
11398 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
11399 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
11400 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
11401
11402 @node Automatically
11403 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
11404
11405 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
11406 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
11407 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
11408 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
11409 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
11410 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
11411 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
11412 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
11413 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
11414
11415 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
11416 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
11417 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
11418 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
11419 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
11420
11421 @node Show
11422 @section Displaying the Language
11423
11424 The following commands help you find out which language is the
11425 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
11426
11427 @table @code
11428 @item show language
11429 @kindex show language
11430 Display the current working language. This is the
11431 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
11432 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
11433
11434 @item info frame
11435 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
11436 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
11437 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
11438 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
11439 information listed here.
11440
11441 @item info source
11442 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
11443 Display the source language of this source file.
11444 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
11445 information listed here.
11446 @end table
11447
11448 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
11449 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
11450 with a language explicitly:
11451
11452 @table @code
11453 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
11454 @kindex set extension-language
11455 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
11456 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
11457
11458 @item info extensions
11459 @kindex info extensions
11460 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
11461 @end table
11462
11463 @node Checks
11464 @section Type and Range Checking
11465
11466 @quotation
11467 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
11468 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
11469 section documents the intended facilities.
11470 @end quotation
11471 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
11472
11473 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
11474 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
11475 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
11476 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
11477 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
11478 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
11479 errors when your program is running.
11480
11481 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
11482 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
11483 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
11484 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
11485 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
11486 automatically based on your program's source language.
11487 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
11488 settings of supported languages.
11489
11490 @menu
11491 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
11492 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
11493 @end menu
11494
11495 @cindex type checking
11496 @cindex checks, type
11497 @node Type Checking
11498 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
11499
11500 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
11501 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
11502 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
11503 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
11504
11505 @smallexample
11506 1 + 2 @result{} 3
11507 @exdent but
11508 @error{} 1 + 2.3
11509 @end smallexample
11510
11511 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
11512 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
11513
11514 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
11515 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
11516 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
11517 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
11518 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
11519 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
11520 also issues a warning.
11521
11522 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
11523 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
11524 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
11525 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
11526 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
11527 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
11528
11529 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
11530 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
11531 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
11532 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
11533 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
11534 details on specific languages.
11535
11536 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
11537
11538 @kindex set check type
11539 @kindex show check type
11540 @table @code
11541 @item set check type auto
11542 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
11543 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11544 each language.
11545
11546 @item set check type on
11547 @itemx set check type off
11548 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11549 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
11550 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
11551 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
11552 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
11553
11554 @item set check type warn
11555 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
11556 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
11557 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
11558 numbers and structures.
11559
11560 @item show type
11561 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
11562 is setting it automatically.
11563 @end table
11564
11565 @cindex range checking
11566 @cindex checks, range
11567 @node Range Checking
11568 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
11569
11570 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
11571 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
11572 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
11573 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
11574 not exceed the bounds of the array.
11575
11576 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
11577 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
11578 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
11579 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
11580
11581 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
11582 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
11583 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
11584 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
11585 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
11586 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
11587
11588 @smallexample
11589 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
11590 @end smallexample
11591
11592 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
11593 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
11594 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
11595
11596 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
11597
11598 @kindex set check range
11599 @kindex show check range
11600 @table @code
11601 @item set check range auto
11602 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
11603 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11604 each language.
11605
11606 @item set check range on
11607 @itemx set check range off
11608 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11609 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
11610 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
11611 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
11612
11613 @item set check range warn
11614 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
11615 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
11616 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
11617 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
11618 systems).
11619
11620 @item show range
11621 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
11622 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
11623 @end table
11624
11625 @node Supported Languages
11626 @section Supported Languages
11627
11628 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, OpenCL C, Pascal,
11629 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
11630 @c This is false ...
11631 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
11632 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
11633 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
11634 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
11635 language.
11636
11637 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
11638 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
11639 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
11640 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
11641 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
11642 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
11643 language reference or tutorial.
11644
11645 @menu
11646 * C:: C and C@t{++}
11647 * D:: D
11648 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
11649 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
11650 * Fortran:: Fortran
11651 * Pascal:: Pascal
11652 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
11653 * Ada:: Ada
11654 @end menu
11655
11656 @node C
11657 @subsection C and C@t{++}
11658
11659 @cindex C and C@t{++}
11660 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
11661
11662 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
11663 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
11664 together.
11665
11666 @cindex C@t{++}
11667 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
11668 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
11669 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
11670 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
11671 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
11672 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
11673 compiler (@code{aCC}).
11674
11675 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
11676 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
11677 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
11678 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
11679 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
11680 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
11681
11682 @menu
11683 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
11684 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
11685 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
11686 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
11687 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
11688 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
11689 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
11690 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
11691 @end menu
11692
11693 @node C Operators
11694 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
11695
11696 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
11697
11698 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11699 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11700 often defined on groups of types.
11701
11702 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
11703
11704 @itemize @bullet
11705
11706 @item
11707 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
11708 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
11709
11710 @item
11711 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
11712 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
11713
11714 @item
11715 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
11716
11717 @item
11718 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
11719
11720 @end itemize
11721
11722 @noindent
11723 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
11724 in order of increasing precedence:
11725
11726 @table @code
11727 @item ,
11728 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
11729 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
11730 expression being the last expression evaluated.
11731
11732 @item =
11733 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
11734 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
11735
11736 @item @var{op}=
11737 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
11738 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
11739 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
11740 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
11741 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
11742
11743 @item ?:
11744 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
11745 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
11746 integral type.
11747
11748 @item ||
11749 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11750
11751 @item &&
11752 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11753
11754 @item |
11755 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11756
11757 @item ^
11758 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11759
11760 @item &
11761 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11762
11763 @item ==@r{, }!=
11764 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
11765 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
11766
11767 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
11768 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
11769 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
11770 and non-zero for true.
11771
11772 @item <<@r{, }>>
11773 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
11774
11775 @item @@
11776 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11777
11778 @item +@r{, }-
11779 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
11780 pointer types.
11781
11782 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
11783 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
11784 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
11785 integral types.
11786
11787 @item ++@r{, }--
11788 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
11789 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
11790 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
11791 operation takes place.
11792
11793 @item *
11794 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
11795 @code{++}.
11796
11797 @item &
11798 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
11799
11800 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
11801 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
11802 to examine the address
11803 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
11804 stored.
11805
11806 @item -
11807 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
11808 precedence as @code{++}.
11809
11810 @item !
11811 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11812 @code{++}.
11813
11814 @item ~
11815 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11816 @code{++}.
11817
11818
11819 @item .@r{, }->
11820 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
11821 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
11822 pointer based on the stored type information.
11823 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
11824
11825 @item .*@r{, }->*
11826 Dereferences of pointers to members.
11827
11828 @item []
11829 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
11830 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11831
11832 @item ()
11833 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11834
11835 @item ::
11836 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
11837 and @code{class} types.
11838
11839 @item ::
11840 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
11841 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
11842 above.
11843 @end table
11844
11845 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
11846 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
11847 predefined meaning.
11848
11849 @node C Constants
11850 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
11851
11852 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
11853
11854 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
11855 following ways:
11856
11857 @itemize @bullet
11858 @item
11859 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
11860 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
11861 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
11862 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
11863 @code{long} value.
11864
11865 @item
11866 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
11867 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
11868 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
11869 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
11870 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
11871 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
11872 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
11873 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
11874 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
11875 constant.
11876
11877 @item
11878 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
11879 integral equivalents.
11880
11881 @item
11882 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
11883 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
11884 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
11885 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
11886 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
11887 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
11888 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
11889 @samp{\n} for newline.
11890
11891 @item
11892 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
11893 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
11894 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
11895 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
11896 characters.
11897
11898 @item
11899 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
11900 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
11901
11902 @item
11903 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
11904 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
11905 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
11906 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
11907 @end itemize
11908
11909 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
11910 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
11911
11912 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
11913 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
11914
11915 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
11916 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
11917 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
11918 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
11919 @quotation
11920 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
11921 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
11922 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
11923 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
11924 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
11925 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
11926 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
11927 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
11928 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
11929 C@t{++} code.
11930 @end quotation
11931
11932 @enumerate
11933
11934 @cindex member functions
11935 @item
11936 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
11937
11938 @smallexample
11939 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
11940 @end smallexample
11941
11942 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
11943 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
11944 @item
11945 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
11946 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
11947 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
11948 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
11949
11950 @cindex call overloaded functions
11951 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
11952 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
11953 @item
11954 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
11955 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
11956 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
11957 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
11958 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
11959 default arguments.
11960
11961 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
11962 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
11963 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
11964 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
11965 number of function arguments.
11966
11967 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
11968 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
11969 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
11970
11971 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
11972 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
11973 @smallexample
11974 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
11975 @end smallexample
11976
11977 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
11978 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
11979
11980 @cindex reference declarations
11981 @item
11982 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
11983 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
11984 dereferenced.
11985
11986 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
11987 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
11988 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
11989 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
11990 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
11991
11992 @item
11993 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
11994 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
11995 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
11996 necessary, for example in an expression like
11997 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
11998 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
11999 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
12000 @end enumerate
12001
12002 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
12003 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
12004 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
12005 invoking user-defined operators.
12006
12007 @node C Defaults
12008 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
12009
12010 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
12011
12012 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
12013 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
12014 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12015 selects the working language.
12016
12017 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
12018 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
12019 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
12020 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
12021 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
12022 for further details.
12023
12024 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
12025 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
12026 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
12027
12028 @node C Checks
12029 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
12030
12031 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
12032
12033 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
12034 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
12035 considers two variables type equivalent if:
12036
12037 @itemize @bullet
12038 @item
12039 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
12040 enumerated tag.
12041
12042 @item
12043 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
12044 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
12045
12046 @ignore
12047 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
12048 @c FIXME--beers?
12049 @item
12050 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
12051 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
12052 compilers.)
12053 @end ignore
12054 @end itemize
12055
12056 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
12057 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
12058 that is not itself an array.
12059
12060 @node Debugging C
12061 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
12062
12063 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
12064 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
12065 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
12066 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
12067
12068 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
12069 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
12070 ,Expressions}.
12071
12072 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
12073 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
12074
12075 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
12076
12077 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
12078 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
12079
12080 @table @code
12081 @cindex break in overloaded functions
12082 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
12083 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
12084 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
12085 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
12086 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
12087
12088 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
12089 @item rbreak @var{regex}
12090 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
12091 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
12092 classes.
12093 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12094
12095 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
12096 @item catch throw
12097 @itemx catch catch
12098 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
12099 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
12100
12101 @cindex inheritance
12102 @item ptype @var{typename}
12103 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
12104 @var{typename}.
12105 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
12106
12107 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
12108 @item set print demangle
12109 @itemx show print demangle
12110 @itemx set print asm-demangle
12111 @itemx show print asm-demangle
12112 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
12113 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
12114 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12115
12116 @item set print object
12117 @itemx show print object
12118 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
12119 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12120
12121 @item set print vtbl
12122 @itemx show print vtbl
12123 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
12124 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12125 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
12126 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
12127
12128 @kindex set overload-resolution
12129 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
12130 @item set overload-resolution on
12131 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
12132 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
12133 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
12134 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
12135 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
12136 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
12137
12138 @item set overload-resolution off
12139 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
12140 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12141 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
12142 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
12143 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12144 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
12145 argument types.
12146
12147 @kindex show overload-resolution
12148 @item show overload-resolution
12149 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
12150
12151 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
12152 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
12153 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
12154 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
12155 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
12156 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
12157 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
12158 @end table
12159
12160 @node Decimal Floating Point
12161 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
12162 @cindex decimal floating point format
12163
12164 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
12165 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
12166 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
12167 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
12168
12169 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
12170 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
12171 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
12172 target.
12173
12174 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
12175 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
12176 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
12177
12178 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
12179 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
12180 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
12181
12182 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
12183 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
12184 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
12185
12186 @node D
12187 @subsection D
12188
12189 @cindex D
12190 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
12191 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
12192 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
12193
12194 @node Objective-C
12195 @subsection Objective-C
12196
12197 @cindex Objective-C
12198 This section provides information about some commands and command
12199 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
12200 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
12201 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
12202
12203 @menu
12204 * Method Names in Commands::
12205 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
12206 @end menu
12207
12208 @node Method Names in Commands
12209 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
12210
12211 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
12212 names as line specifications:
12213
12214 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
12215 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
12216 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
12217 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
12218 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
12219 @itemize
12220 @item @code{clear}
12221 @item @code{break}
12222 @item @code{info line}
12223 @item @code{jump}
12224 @item @code{list}
12225 @end itemize
12226
12227 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
12228
12229 @smallexample
12230 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
12231 @end smallexample
12232
12233 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
12234 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
12235 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
12236 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
12237 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
12238 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
12239 debugged, enter:
12240
12241 @smallexample
12242 break -[Fruit create]
12243 @end smallexample
12244
12245 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
12246 enter:
12247
12248 @smallexample
12249 list +[NSText initialize]
12250 @end smallexample
12251
12252 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
12253 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
12254 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
12255 is also possible to specify just a method name:
12256
12257 @smallexample
12258 break create
12259 @end smallexample
12260
12261 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
12262 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
12263 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
12264 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
12265 none apply.
12266
12267 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
12268 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
12269
12270 @smallexample
12271 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
12272 @end smallexample
12273
12274 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
12275 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
12276 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
12277 @kindex print-object
12278 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
12279
12280 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
12281
12282 @smallexample
12283 print -[@var{object} hash]
12284 @end smallexample
12285
12286 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
12287 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
12288 @noindent
12289 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
12290 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
12291 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
12292 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
12293 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
12294 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
12295
12296 @node OpenCL C
12297 @subsection OpenCL C
12298
12299 @cindex OpenCL C
12300 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
12301
12302 @menu
12303 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
12304 * OpenCL C Expressions::
12305 * OpenCL C Operators::
12306 @end menu
12307
12308 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
12309 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
12310
12311 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
12312 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
12313 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
12314 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
12315 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
12316
12317 @node OpenCL C Expressions
12318 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
12319
12320 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
12321 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
12322 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
12323 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
12324
12325 @node OpenCL C Operators
12326 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
12327
12328 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
12329 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
12330 vector data types.
12331
12332 @node Fortran
12333 @subsection Fortran
12334 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
12335
12336 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
12337 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
12338
12339 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
12340 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
12341 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
12342 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
12343 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
12344 underscore.
12345
12346 @menu
12347 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
12348 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
12349 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
12350 @end menu
12351
12352 @node Fortran Operators
12353 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
12354
12355 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
12356
12357 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12358 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
12359 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
12360
12361 @table @code
12362 @item **
12363 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
12364 of the second one.
12365
12366 @item :
12367 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
12368 represent a section of array.
12369
12370 @item %
12371 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
12372 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
12373 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
12374 union type.
12375 @end table
12376
12377 @node Fortran Defaults
12378 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
12379
12380 @cindex Fortran Defaults
12381
12382 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
12383 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
12384 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
12385 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
12386
12387 @node Special Fortran Commands
12388 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
12389
12390 @cindex Special Fortran commands
12391
12392 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
12393 such as displaying common blocks.
12394
12395 @table @code
12396 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
12397 @kindex info common
12398 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
12399 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
12400 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
12401 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
12402 printed.
12403 @end table
12404
12405 @node Pascal
12406 @subsection Pascal
12407
12408 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
12409 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
12410 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
12411 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
12412 syntax.
12413
12414 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
12415 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
12416 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
12417
12418 @node Modula-2
12419 @subsection Modula-2
12420
12421 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
12422
12423 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
12424 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
12425 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
12426 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
12427 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
12428 table.
12429
12430 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
12431 @menu
12432 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
12433 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
12434 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
12435 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
12436 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
12437 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
12438 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
12439 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12440 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
12441 @end menu
12442
12443 @node M2 Operators
12444 @subsubsection Operators
12445 @cindex Modula-2 operators
12446
12447 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12448 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
12449 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
12450 following definitions hold:
12451
12452 @itemize @bullet
12453
12454 @item
12455 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
12456 their subranges.
12457
12458 @item
12459 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
12460
12461 @item
12462 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
12463
12464 @item
12465 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
12466 @var{type}}.
12467
12468 @item
12469 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
12470
12471 @item
12472 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
12473
12474 @item
12475 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
12476 @end itemize
12477
12478 @noindent
12479 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
12480 increasing precedence:
12481
12482 @table @code
12483 @item ,
12484 Function argument or array index separator.
12485
12486 @item :=
12487 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
12488 @var{value}.
12489
12490 @item <@r{, }>
12491 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
12492 types.
12493
12494 @item <=@r{, }>=
12495 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
12496 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
12497 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
12498
12499 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
12500 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
12501 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
12502 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
12503 comment character.
12504
12505 @item IN
12506 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
12507 Same precedence as @code{<}.
12508
12509 @item OR
12510 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
12511
12512 @item AND@r{, }&
12513 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
12514
12515 @item @@
12516 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
12517
12518 @item +@r{, }-
12519 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
12520 and difference on set types.
12521
12522 @item *
12523 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
12524 on set types.
12525
12526 @item /
12527 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
12528 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
12529
12530 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
12531 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
12532 precedence as @code{*}.
12533
12534 @item -
12535 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
12536
12537 @item ^
12538 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
12539
12540 @item NOT
12541 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
12542 @code{^}.
12543
12544 @item .
12545 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
12546 precedence as @code{^}.
12547
12548 @item []
12549 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
12550
12551 @item ()
12552 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
12553 as @code{^}.
12554
12555 @item ::@r{, }.
12556 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
12557 @end table
12558
12559 @quotation
12560 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
12561 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
12562 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
12563 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
12564 @end quotation
12565
12566
12567 @node Built-In Func/Proc
12568 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
12569 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
12570
12571 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
12572 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
12573
12574 @table @var
12575
12576 @item a
12577 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
12578
12579 @item c
12580 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
12581
12582 @item i
12583 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
12584
12585 @item m
12586 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
12587 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
12588 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
12589
12590 @item n
12591 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
12592
12593 @item r
12594 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
12595
12596 @item t
12597 represents a type.
12598
12599 @item v
12600 represents a variable.
12601
12602 @item x
12603 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
12604 explanation of the function for details.
12605 @end table
12606
12607 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
12608
12609 @table @code
12610 @item ABS(@var{n})
12611 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
12612
12613 @item CAP(@var{c})
12614 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
12615 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
12616
12617 @item CHR(@var{i})
12618 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12619
12620 @item DEC(@var{v})
12621 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12622
12623 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
12624 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12625 new value.
12626
12627 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12628 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
12629 set.
12630
12631 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
12632 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
12633
12634 @item HIGH(@var{a})
12635 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
12636
12637 @item INC(@var{v})
12638 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12639
12640 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
12641 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12642 new value.
12643
12644 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12645 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
12646 there. Returns the new set.
12647
12648 @item MAX(@var{t})
12649 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
12650
12651 @item MIN(@var{t})
12652 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
12653
12654 @item ODD(@var{i})
12655 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
12656
12657 @item ORD(@var{x})
12658 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
12659 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
12660 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
12661 integral, character and enumerated types.
12662
12663 @item SIZE(@var{x})
12664 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12665
12666 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
12667 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
12668
12669 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
12670 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12671
12672 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
12673 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12674 @end table
12675
12676 @quotation
12677 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
12678 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
12679 an error.
12680 @end quotation
12681
12682 @cindex Modula-2 constants
12683 @node M2 Constants
12684 @subsubsection Constants
12685
12686 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
12687 ways:
12688
12689 @itemize @bullet
12690
12691 @item
12692 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
12693 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
12694 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
12695 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
12696
12697 @item
12698 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
12699 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
12700 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
12701 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
12702 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
12703 digits.
12704
12705 @item
12706 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
12707 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
12708 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
12709 followed by a @samp{C}.
12710
12711 @item
12712 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
12713 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
12714 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
12715 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
12716 sequences.
12717
12718 @item
12719 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
12720
12721 @item
12722 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
12723 @code{FALSE}.
12724
12725 @item
12726 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
12727
12728 @item
12729 Set constants are not yet supported.
12730 @end itemize
12731
12732 @node M2 Types
12733 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
12734 @cindex Modula-2 types
12735
12736 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
12737 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
12738 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
12739 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
12740 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
12741 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
12742
12743 The first example contains the following section of code:
12744
12745 @smallexample
12746 VAR
12747 s: SET OF CHAR ;
12748 r: [20..40] ;
12749 @end smallexample
12750
12751 @noindent
12752 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
12753 @code{r} and @code{s}.
12754
12755 @smallexample
12756 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12757 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
12758 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12759 SET OF CHAR
12760 (@value{GDBP}) print r
12761 21
12762 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
12763 [20..40]
12764 @end smallexample
12765
12766 @noindent
12767 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
12768
12769 @smallexample
12770 VAR
12771 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
12772 @end smallexample
12773
12774 @noindent
12775 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
12776
12777 @smallexample
12778 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12779 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
12780 @end smallexample
12781
12782 @noindent
12783 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
12784 expressions using the debugger.
12785
12786 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
12787 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
12788
12789 @smallexample
12790 VAR
12791 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
12792 @end smallexample
12793
12794 @smallexample
12795 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12796 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
12797 @end smallexample
12798
12799 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
12800 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
12801 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
12802 above.
12803
12804 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
12805
12806 @smallexample
12807 TYPE
12808 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
12809 t = [blue..yellow] ;
12810 VAR
12811 s: t ;
12812 BEGIN
12813 s := blue ;
12814 @end smallexample
12815
12816 @noindent
12817 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
12818 and value of a variable.
12819
12820 @smallexample
12821 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12822 $1 = blue
12823 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
12824 type = [blue..yellow]
12825 @end smallexample
12826
12827 @noindent
12828 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
12829 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
12830 their @code{C} counterparts.
12831
12832 @smallexample
12833 VAR
12834 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12835 BEGIN
12836 s[1] := 1 ;
12837 @end smallexample
12838
12839 @smallexample
12840 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12841 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
12842 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12843 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12844 @end smallexample
12845
12846 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
12847 pointer types as shown in this example:
12848
12849 @smallexample
12850 VAR
12851 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12852 BEGIN
12853 NEW(s) ;
12854 s^[1] := 1 ;
12855 @end smallexample
12856
12857 @noindent
12858 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
12859
12860 @smallexample
12861 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12862 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12863 @end smallexample
12864
12865 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
12866 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
12867 types:
12868
12869 @smallexample
12870 TYPE
12871 foo = RECORD
12872 f1: CARDINAL ;
12873 f2: CHAR ;
12874 f3: myarray ;
12875 END ;
12876
12877 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
12878 myrange = [-2..2] ;
12879 VAR
12880 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
12881 @end smallexample
12882
12883 @noindent
12884 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
12885 below.
12886
12887 @smallexample
12888 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12889 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
12890 f1 : CARDINAL;
12891 f2 : CHAR;
12892 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
12893 END
12894 @end smallexample
12895
12896 @node M2 Defaults
12897 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
12898 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
12899
12900 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
12901 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
12902 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12903 selected the working language.
12904
12905 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
12906 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
12907 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
12908 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
12909
12910 @node Deviations
12911 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
12912 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
12913
12914 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
12915 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
12916
12917 @itemize @bullet
12918 @item
12919 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
12920 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
12921 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
12922 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
12923 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
12924 returned a pointer.)
12925
12926 @item
12927 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
12928 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
12929 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
12930 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
12931
12932 @item
12933 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
12934 argument.
12935
12936 @item
12937 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
12938 @end itemize
12939
12940 @node M2 Checks
12941 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
12942 @cindex Modula-2 checks
12943
12944 @quotation
12945 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
12946 range checking.
12947 @end quotation
12948 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
12949
12950 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
12951
12952 @itemize @bullet
12953 @item
12954 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
12955 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
12956
12957 @item
12958 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
12959 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
12960 @end itemize
12961
12962 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
12963 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
12964
12965 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
12966 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
12967
12968 @node M2 Scope
12969 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12970 @cindex scope
12971 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
12972 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
12973 @ifinfo
12974 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
12975 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
12976 @end ifinfo
12977 @ifnotinfo
12978 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
12979 @end ifnotinfo
12980
12981 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
12982 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
12983 similar syntax:
12984
12985 @smallexample
12986
12987 @var{module} . @var{id}
12988 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
12989 @end smallexample
12990
12991 @noindent
12992 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
12993 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
12994 identifier within your program, except another module.
12995
12996 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
12997 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
12998 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
12999 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
13000
13001 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
13002 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
13003 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
13004 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
13005 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
13006 @var{module}.
13007
13008 @node GDB/M2
13009 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
13010
13011 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
13012 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
13013 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
13014 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
13015 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
13016 analogue in Modula-2.
13017
13018 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
13019 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
13020 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
13021 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
13022 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
13023 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
13024
13025 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
13026 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
13027 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
13028
13029 @node Ada
13030 @subsection Ada
13031 @cindex Ada
13032
13033 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
13034 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
13035 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
13036 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
13037 to be difficult.
13038
13039
13040 @cindex expressions in Ada
13041 @menu
13042 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
13043 and semantics supported by Ada mode
13044 in @value{GDBN}.
13045 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
13046 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
13047 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
13048 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
13049 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13050 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
13051 Profile
13052 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
13053 @end menu
13054
13055 @node Ada Mode Intro
13056 @subsubsection Introduction
13057 @cindex Ada mode, general
13058
13059 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
13060 syntax, with some extensions.
13061 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
13062
13063 @itemize @bullet
13064 @item
13065 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
13066 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
13067 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
13068 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
13069
13070 @item
13071 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
13072 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13073
13074 @item
13075 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13076 @end itemize
13077
13078 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
13079 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
13080 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
13081 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
13082 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
13083
13084 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
13085 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
13086 was translated from an Ada source file.
13087
13088 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
13089 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
13090 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
13091 middle (to allow based literals).
13092
13093 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
13094 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
13095 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
13096 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
13097 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
13098 functions to procedures elsewhere.
13099
13100 @node Omissions from Ada
13101 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
13102 @cindex Ada, omissions from
13103
13104 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
13105
13106 @itemize @bullet
13107 @item
13108 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
13109
13110 @itemize @minus
13111 @item
13112 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
13113 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
13114
13115 @item
13116 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
13117
13118 @item
13119 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
13120
13121 @item
13122 @t{'Tag}.
13123
13124 @item
13125 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
13126 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
13127
13128 @item
13129 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
13130 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
13131
13132 @item
13133 @t{'Address}.
13134 @end itemize
13135
13136 @item
13137 The names in
13138 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
13139 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
13140 not currently available.
13141
13142 @item
13143 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
13144 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
13145 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
13146 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
13147 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
13148 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
13149 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
13150 indeterminate values.
13151
13152 @item
13153 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
13154 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
13155 are not implemented.
13156
13157 @item
13158 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
13159 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
13160 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
13161 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
13162 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
13163
13164 @smallexample
13165 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
13166 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
13167 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
13168 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
13169 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
13170 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
13171 @end smallexample
13172
13173 Changing a
13174 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
13175 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
13176 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
13177 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
13178 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
13179 declared to have a type such as:
13180
13181 @smallexample
13182 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
13183 Id : Integer;
13184 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
13185 end record;
13186 @end smallexample
13187
13188 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
13189 assignments:
13190
13191 @smallexample
13192 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
13193 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
13194 @end smallexample
13195
13196 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
13197 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
13198 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
13199 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
13200 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
13201 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
13202 redundant component associations, although which component values are
13203 assigned in such cases is not defined.
13204
13205 @item
13206 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
13207
13208 @item
13209 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
13210 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
13211 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
13212 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
13213 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
13214 the proper resolution.
13215
13216 @item
13217 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
13218
13219 @item
13220 Entry calls are not implemented.
13221
13222 @item
13223 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
13224 formats are not supported.
13225
13226 @item
13227 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
13228
13229 @item
13230 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
13231 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
13232 context.
13233 Should your program
13234 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
13235 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
13236 @end itemize
13237
13238 @node Additions to Ada
13239 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
13240 @cindex Ada, deviations from
13241
13242 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
13243 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
13244
13245 @itemize @bullet
13246 @item
13247 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
13248 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
13249 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
13250 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
13251 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
13252 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
13253 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
13254 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
13255
13256 @item
13257 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
13258 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
13259 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
13260
13261 @item
13262 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
13263 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
13264
13265 @item
13266 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
13267 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
13268 @end itemize
13269
13270 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
13271 additions specific to Ada:
13272
13273 @itemize @bullet
13274 @item
13275 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
13276 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
13277
13278 @smallexample
13279 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
13280 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
13281 @end smallexample
13282
13283 @item
13284 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
13285 the value of its right-hand operand.
13286 This allows, for example,
13287 complex conditional breaks:
13288
13289 @smallexample
13290 (@value{GDBP}) break f
13291 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
13292 @end smallexample
13293
13294 @item
13295 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
13296 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
13297 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
13298 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
13299 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
13300 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
13301 in strings. For example,
13302 @smallexample
13303 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
13304 @end smallexample
13305 @noindent
13306 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
13307 after each period.
13308
13309 @item
13310 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
13311 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
13312 to write
13313
13314 @smallexample
13315 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
13316 @end smallexample
13317
13318 @item
13319 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
13320 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
13321 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
13322 of 3 might print as
13323
13324 @smallexample
13325 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
13326 @end smallexample
13327
13328 @noindent
13329 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
13330 clause.
13331
13332 @item
13333 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
13334 multi-character subsequence of
13335 their names (an exact match gets preference).
13336 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
13337 in place of @t{a'length}.
13338
13339 @item
13340 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
13341 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
13342 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
13343 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
13344 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
13345 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
13346 For example,
13347 @smallexample
13348 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
13349 @end smallexample
13350
13351 @item
13352 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
13353 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
13354 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
13355 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
13356 object.
13357
13358 @end itemize
13359
13360 @node Stopping Before Main Program
13361 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
13362
13363 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
13364 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
13365 before reaching the main procedure.
13366 As defined in the Ada Reference
13367 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
13368 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
13369 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
13370 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
13371
13372 @node Ada Tasks
13373 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
13374 @cindex Ada, tasking
13375
13376 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
13377 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
13378
13379 @table @code
13380 @kindex info tasks
13381 @item info tasks
13382 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
13383
13384
13385 @smallexample
13386 @iftex
13387 @leftskip=0.5cm
13388 @end iftex
13389 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13390 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13391 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13392 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
13393 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
13394 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
13395
13396 @end smallexample
13397
13398 @noindent
13399 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
13400 task currently being inspected.
13401
13402 @table @asis
13403 @item ID
13404 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
13405
13406 @item TID
13407 The Ada task ID.
13408
13409 @item P-ID
13410 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
13411
13412 @item Pri
13413 The base priority of the task.
13414
13415 @item State
13416 Current state of the task.
13417
13418 @table @code
13419 @item Unactivated
13420 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
13421 executing.
13422
13423 @item Runnable
13424 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
13425 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
13426
13427 @item Terminated
13428 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
13429 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
13430 terminated themselves.
13431
13432 @item Child Activation Wait
13433 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
13434
13435 @item Accept Statement
13436 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
13437
13438 @item Waiting on entry call
13439 The task is waiting on an entry call.
13440
13441 @item Async Select Wait
13442 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
13443 select statement.
13444
13445 @item Delay Sleep
13446 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
13447 alternative open.
13448
13449 @item Child Termination Wait
13450 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
13451 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
13452 waiting on a terminate Phase.
13453
13454 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
13455 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
13456 finish terminating.
13457
13458 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
13459 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
13460 @end table
13461
13462 @item Name
13463 Name of the task in the program.
13464
13465 @end table
13466
13467 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
13468 @item info task @var{taskno}
13469 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
13470 the following example:
13471 @smallexample
13472 @iftex
13473 @leftskip=0.5cm
13474 @end iftex
13475 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13476 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13477 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13478 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
13479 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
13480 Ada Task: 0x807c468
13481 Name: task_1
13482 Thread: 0x807f378
13483 Parent: 1 (main_task)
13484 Base Priority: 15
13485 State: Runnable
13486 @end smallexample
13487
13488 @item task
13489 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
13490 @cindex current Ada task ID
13491 This command prints the ID of the current task.
13492
13493 @smallexample
13494 @iftex
13495 @leftskip=0.5cm
13496 @end iftex
13497 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13498 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13499 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13500 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
13501 (@value{GDBP}) task
13502 [Current task is 2]
13503 @end smallexample
13504
13505 @item task @var{taskno}
13506 @cindex Ada task switching
13507 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
13508 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
13509 from the current task to the given task.
13510
13511 @smallexample
13512 @iftex
13513 @leftskip=0.5cm
13514 @end iftex
13515 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13516 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13517 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13518 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
13519 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
13520 [Switching to task 1]
13521 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
13522 (@value{GDBP}) bt
13523 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
13524 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
13525 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
13526 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
13527 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
13528 @end smallexample
13529
13530 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
13531 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
13532 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
13533 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
13534 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
13535 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
13536 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
13537 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
13538 in @ref{Specify Location}.
13539
13540 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
13541 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
13542 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
13543 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
13544 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
13545
13546 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
13547 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
13548 program.
13549
13550 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
13551 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
13552 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
13553
13554 For example,
13555
13556 @smallexample
13557 @iftex
13558 @leftskip=0.5cm
13559 @end iftex
13560 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13561 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13562 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13563 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
13564 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13565 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
13566 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
13567 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
13568 (@value{GDBP}) cont
13569 Continuing.
13570 task # 1 running
13571 task # 2 running
13572
13573 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
13574 15 flush;
13575 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13576 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13577 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13578 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
13579 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13580 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
13581 @end smallexample
13582 @end table
13583
13584 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
13585 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13586 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
13587
13588 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
13589 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
13590 the platform being used.
13591 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
13592 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
13593 as usual.
13594
13595 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
13596 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
13597 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
13598 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
13599 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
13600 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
13601
13602 @node Ravenscar Profile
13603 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
13604 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
13605
13606 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
13607 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
13608 requirements.
13609
13610 @table @code
13611 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
13612 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
13613 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
13614 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
13615 Profile. This is the default.
13616
13617 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
13618 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
13619 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
13620 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
13621 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
13622 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
13623 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
13624
13625 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
13626 @item show ravenscar task-switching
13627 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
13628 using the Ravenscar Profile.
13629
13630 @end table
13631
13632 @node Ada Glitches
13633 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
13634 @cindex Ada, problems
13635
13636 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
13637 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
13638 @value{GDBN},
13639 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
13640 and the GNU Ada compiler.
13641
13642 @itemize @bullet
13643 @item
13644 Currently, the debugger
13645 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
13646 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
13647 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
13648 to get it printed properly.
13649
13650 @item
13651 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
13652 storage are invisible to the debugger.
13653
13654 @item
13655 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
13656 argument lists are treated as positional).
13657
13658 @item
13659 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
13660
13661 @item
13662 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
13663 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
13664 the host machine.
13665
13666 @item
13667 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
13668 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
13669 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
13670 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
13671 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
13672 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
13673 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
13674 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
13675 you can usually resolve the confusion
13676 by qualifying the problematic names with package
13677 @code{Standard} explicitly.
13678 @end itemize
13679
13680 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
13681 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
13682 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
13683 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
13684 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
13685 enabled.
13686
13687 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13688 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13689 @table @code
13690
13691 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
13692 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
13693 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
13694 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
13695 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
13696 This is the default.
13697
13698 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
13699 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
13700 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
13701 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
13702 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
13703 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
13704 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
13705
13706 @end table
13707
13708 @node Unsupported Languages
13709 @section Unsupported Languages
13710
13711 @cindex unsupported languages
13712 @cindex minimal language
13713 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
13714 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
13715 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
13716 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
13717 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
13718 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
13719
13720 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
13721 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
13722 language.
13723
13724 @node Symbols
13725 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
13726
13727 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
13728 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
13729 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
13730 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
13731 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
13732 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
13733 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13734
13735 @cindex symbol names
13736 @cindex names of symbols
13737 @cindex quoting names
13738 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
13739 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
13740 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
13741 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
13742 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
13743 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
13744 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
13745 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
13746
13747 @smallexample
13748 p 'foo.c'::x
13749 @end smallexample
13750
13751 @noindent
13752 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
13753
13754 @table @code
13755 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
13756 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
13757 @kindex set case-sensitive
13758 @item set case-sensitive on
13759 @itemx set case-sensitive off
13760 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
13761 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
13762 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
13763 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
13764 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
13765 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
13766 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
13767 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
13768 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
13769 case-insensitive matches.
13770
13771 @kindex show case-sensitive
13772 @item show case-sensitive
13773 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
13774 lookups.
13775
13776 @kindex info address
13777 @cindex address of a symbol
13778 @item info address @var{symbol}
13779 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
13780 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
13781 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
13782 is always stored.
13783
13784 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
13785 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
13786 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
13787
13788 @kindex info symbol
13789 @cindex symbol from address
13790 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
13791 @item info symbol @var{addr}
13792 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
13793 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
13794 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
13795
13796 @smallexample
13797 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
13798 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
13799 @end smallexample
13800
13801 @noindent
13802 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
13803 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
13804
13805 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
13806 library containing the symbol is also printed:
13807
13808 @smallexample
13809 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
13810 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
13811 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
13812 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
13813 @end smallexample
13814
13815 @kindex whatis
13816 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
13817 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
13818 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
13819 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
13820 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
13821 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
13822 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
13823 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
13824 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
13825 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
13826 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13827
13828 @kindex ptype
13829 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
13830 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
13831 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
13832 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13833
13834 For example, for this variable declaration:
13835
13836 @smallexample
13837 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
13838 @end smallexample
13839
13840 @noindent
13841 the two commands give this output:
13842
13843 @smallexample
13844 @group
13845 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
13846 type = struct complex
13847 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
13848 type = struct complex @{
13849 double real;
13850 double imag;
13851 @}
13852 @end group
13853 @end smallexample
13854
13855 @noindent
13856 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
13857 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
13858
13859 @cindex incomplete type
13860 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
13861 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
13862 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
13863 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
13864 given these declarations:
13865
13866 @smallexample
13867 struct foo;
13868 struct foo *fooptr;
13869 @end smallexample
13870
13871 @noindent
13872 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
13873
13874 @smallexample
13875 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
13876 $1 = <incomplete type>
13877 @end smallexample
13878
13879 @noindent
13880 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
13881 completely specified.
13882
13883 @kindex info types
13884 @item info types @var{regexp}
13885 @itemx info types
13886 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
13887 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
13888 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
13889 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
13890 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
13891 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
13892 name is @code{value}.
13893
13894 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
13895 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
13896 lists all source files where a type is defined.
13897
13898 @kindex info scope
13899 @cindex local variables
13900 @item info scope @var{location}
13901 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
13902 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
13903 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
13904 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
13905 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
13906
13907 @smallexample
13908 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
13909 Scope for command_line_handler:
13910 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
13911 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
13912 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
13913 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
13914 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
13915 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
13916 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
13917 @end smallexample
13918
13919 @noindent
13920 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
13921 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
13922 collect}.
13923
13924 @kindex info source
13925 @item info source
13926 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
13927 the function containing the current point of execution:
13928 @itemize @bullet
13929 @item
13930 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
13931 @item
13932 the directory it was compiled in,
13933 @item
13934 its length, in lines,
13935 @item
13936 which programming language it is written in,
13937 @item
13938 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
13939 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
13940 @item
13941 whether the debugging information includes information about
13942 preprocessor macros.
13943 @end itemize
13944
13945
13946 @kindex info sources
13947 @item info sources
13948 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
13949 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
13950 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
13951
13952 @kindex info functions
13953 @item info functions
13954 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
13955
13956 @item info functions @var{regexp}
13957 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
13958 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
13959 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
13960 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
13961 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
13962 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
13963 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
13964
13965 @kindex info variables
13966 @item info variables
13967 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
13968 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
13969
13970 @item info variables @var{regexp}
13971 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
13972 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
13973 @var{regexp}.
13974
13975 @kindex info classes
13976 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
13977 @item info classes
13978 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
13979 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
13980 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13981 expression.
13982
13983 @kindex info selectors
13984 @item info selectors
13985 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
13986 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
13987 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13988 expression.
13989
13990 @ignore
13991 This was never implemented.
13992 @kindex info methods
13993 @item info methods
13994 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
13995 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
13996 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
13997 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
13998 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
13999 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
14000 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
14001 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
14002 @end ignore
14003
14004 @cindex reloading symbols
14005 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
14006 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
14007 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
14008 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
14009 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
14010
14011 @table @code
14012 @kindex set symbol-reloading
14013 @item set symbol-reloading on
14014 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
14015 object file with a particular name is seen again.
14016
14017 @item set symbol-reloading off
14018 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
14019 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
14020 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
14021 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
14022 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
14023 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
14024 name.
14025
14026 @kindex show symbol-reloading
14027 @item show symbol-reloading
14028 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
14029 @end table
14030
14031 @cindex opaque data types
14032 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
14033 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
14034 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
14035 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
14036 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
14037 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
14038 another source file. The default is on.
14039
14040 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
14041 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
14042
14043 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
14044 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
14045 is printed as follows:
14046 @smallexample
14047 @{<no data fields>@}
14048 @end smallexample
14049
14050 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
14051 @item show opaque-type-resolution
14052 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
14053
14054 @kindex maint print symbols
14055 @cindex symbol dump
14056 @kindex maint print psymbols
14057 @cindex partial symbol dump
14058 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
14059 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
14060 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
14061 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
14062 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
14063 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
14064 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
14065 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
14066 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
14067 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
14068 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
14069 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
14070 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
14071 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
14072 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
14073 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
14074 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
14075
14076 @kindex maint info symtabs
14077 @kindex maint info psymtabs
14078 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
14079 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14080 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14081 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14082 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14083 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14084
14085 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
14086 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
14087 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
14088 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
14089 structure in more detail. For example:
14090
14091 @smallexample
14092 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
14093 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14094 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14095 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14096 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
14097 readin no
14098 fullname (null)
14099 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
14100 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
14101 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
14102 dependencies (none)
14103 @}
14104 @}
14105 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14106 (@value{GDBP})
14107 @end smallexample
14108 @noindent
14109 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
14110 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
14111 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
14112 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
14113 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
14114
14115 @smallexample
14116 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
14117 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
14118 line 1574.
14119 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14120 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14121 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14122 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14123 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
14124 dirname (null)
14125 fullname (null)
14126 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
14127 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
14128 debugformat DWARF 2
14129 @}
14130 @}
14131 (@value{GDBP})
14132 @end smallexample
14133 @end table
14134
14135
14136 @node Altering
14137 @chapter Altering Execution
14138
14139 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
14140 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
14141 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
14142 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
14143 program.
14144
14145 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
14146 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
14147 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
14148
14149 @menu
14150 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
14151 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
14152 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
14153 * Returning:: Returning from a function
14154 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
14155 * Patching:: Patching your program
14156 @end menu
14157
14158 @node Assignment
14159 @section Assignment to Variables
14160
14161 @cindex assignment
14162 @cindex setting variables
14163 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
14164 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
14165
14166 @smallexample
14167 print x=4
14168 @end smallexample
14169
14170 @noindent
14171 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
14172 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
14173 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
14174 information on operators in supported languages.
14175
14176 @kindex set variable
14177 @cindex variables, setting
14178 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
14179 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
14180 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
14181 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
14182 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
14183
14184 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
14185 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
14186 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
14187 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
14188 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
14189 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
14190 command @code{set width}:
14191
14192 @smallexample
14193 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
14194 type = double
14195 (@value{GDBP}) p width
14196 $4 = 13
14197 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
14198 Invalid syntax in expression.
14199 @end smallexample
14200
14201 @noindent
14202 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
14203 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
14204
14205 @smallexample
14206 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
14207 @end smallexample
14208
14209 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
14210 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
14211 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
14212 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
14213 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
14214 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
14215
14216 @smallexample
14217 @group
14218 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
14219 type = double
14220 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14221 $1 = 1
14222 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
14223 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14224 $2 = 1
14225 (@value{GDBP}) r
14226 The program being debugged has been started already.
14227 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
14228 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
14229 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
14230 Invalid bfd target.
14231 (@value{GDBP}) show g
14232 The current BFD target is "=4".
14233 @end group
14234 @end smallexample
14235
14236 @noindent
14237 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
14238 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
14239 @code{g}, use
14240
14241 @smallexample
14242 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
14243 @end smallexample
14244
14245 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
14246 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
14247 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
14248 same length or shorter.
14249 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
14250 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
14251
14252 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
14253 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
14254 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
14255 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
14256 and representation in memory), and
14257
14258 @smallexample
14259 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
14260 @end smallexample
14261
14262 @noindent
14263 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
14264
14265 @node Jumping
14266 @section Continuing at a Different Address
14267
14268 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
14269 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
14270 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
14271
14272 @table @code
14273 @kindex jump
14274 @item jump @var{linespec}
14275 @itemx jump @var{location}
14276 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
14277 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
14278 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
14279 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
14280 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
14281 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14282
14283 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
14284 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
14285 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
14286 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
14287 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
14288 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
14289 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
14290 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
14291 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
14292 @end table
14293
14294 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
14295 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
14296 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
14297 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
14298 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
14299 example,
14300
14301 @smallexample
14302 set $pc = 0x485
14303 @end smallexample
14304
14305 @noindent
14306 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
14307 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
14308 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
14309
14310 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
14311 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
14312 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
14313 detail.
14314
14315 @c @group
14316 @node Signaling
14317 @section Giving your Program a Signal
14318 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
14319
14320 @table @code
14321 @kindex signal
14322 @item signal @var{signal}
14323 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
14324 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
14325 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
14326 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
14327
14328 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
14329 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
14330 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
14331 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
14332 signal.
14333
14334 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
14335 after executing the command.
14336 @end table
14337 @c @end group
14338
14339 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
14340 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
14341 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
14342 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
14343 passes the signal directly to your program.
14344
14345
14346 @node Returning
14347 @section Returning from a Function
14348
14349 @table @code
14350 @cindex returning from a function
14351 @kindex return
14352 @item return
14353 @itemx return @var{expression}
14354 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
14355 command. If you give an
14356 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
14357 value.
14358 @end table
14359
14360 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
14361 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
14362 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
14363 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
14364
14365 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
14366 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
14367 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
14368 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
14369 of functions.
14370
14371 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
14372 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
14373 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
14374 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
14375 selected stack frame returns naturally.
14376
14377 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
14378 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
14379 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
14380 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
14381 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
14382 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
14383 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
14384 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
14385 assignment into the right register(s).
14386
14387 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
14388 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
14389 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
14390 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
14391 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
14392 into a @code{long long int}:
14393
14394 @smallexample
14395 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
14396 29 return 31;
14397 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14398 Make func return now? (y or n) y
14399 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
14400 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
14401 (@value{GDBP})
14402 @end smallexample
14403
14404 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
14405 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
14406 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
14407 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
14408 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
14409 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
14410 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
14411 an appropriate cast explicitly:
14412
14413 @smallexample
14414 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
14415 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14416 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
14417 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
14418 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
14419 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
14420 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
14421 (@value{GDBP})
14422 @end smallexample
14423
14424 @node Calling
14425 @section Calling Program Functions
14426
14427 @table @code
14428 @cindex calling functions
14429 @cindex inferior functions, calling
14430 @item print @var{expr}
14431 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
14432 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
14433 debugged.
14434
14435 @kindex call
14436 @item call @var{expr}
14437 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
14438 returned values.
14439
14440 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
14441 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
14442 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
14443 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
14444 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
14445 value history.
14446 @end table
14447
14448 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
14449 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
14450 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
14451 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
14452
14453 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
14454 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
14455 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
14456 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
14457 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
14458 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
14459 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
14460 in that case is controlled by the
14461 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
14462
14463 @table @code
14464 @item set unwindonsignal
14465 @kindex set unwindonsignal
14466 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
14467 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
14468 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
14469 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
14470 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
14471 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
14472 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
14473 received.
14474
14475 @item show unwindonsignal
14476 @kindex show unwindonsignal
14477 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
14478 @value{GDBN}.
14479
14480 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
14481 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
14482 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
14483 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
14484 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
14485 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
14486 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
14487 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
14488 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
14489 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
14490
14491 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
14492 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
14493 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
14494 @value{GDBN}.
14495
14496 @end table
14497
14498 @cindex weak alias functions
14499 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
14500 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
14501 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
14502 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
14503 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
14504 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
14505 function instead.
14506
14507 @node Patching
14508 @section Patching Programs
14509
14510 @cindex patching binaries
14511 @cindex writing into executables
14512 @cindex writing into corefiles
14513
14514 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
14515 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
14516 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
14517 patching your program's binary.
14518
14519 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
14520 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
14521 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
14522 repairs.
14523
14524 @table @code
14525 @kindex set write
14526 @item set write on
14527 @itemx set write off
14528 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
14529 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
14530 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
14531
14532 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
14533 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
14534 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
14535
14536 @item show write
14537 @kindex show write
14538 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
14539 as well as reading.
14540 @end table
14541
14542 @node GDB Files
14543 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
14544
14545 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
14546 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
14547 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
14548 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
14549
14550 @menu
14551 * Files:: Commands to specify files
14552 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
14553 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
14554 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
14555 * Data Files:: GDB data files
14556 @end menu
14557
14558 @node Files
14559 @section Commands to Specify Files
14560
14561 @cindex symbol table
14562 @cindex core dump file
14563
14564 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
14565 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
14566 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
14567 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
14568
14569 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
14570 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
14571 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
14572 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
14573 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
14574 new files are useful.
14575
14576 @table @code
14577 @cindex executable file
14578 @kindex file
14579 @item file @var{filename}
14580 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
14581 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
14582 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
14583 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
14584 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
14585 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
14586 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
14587 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
14588
14589 @cindex unlinked object files
14590 @cindex patching object files
14591 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
14592 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
14593 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
14594 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
14595 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
14596 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
14597 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
14598 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
14599
14600 @item file
14601 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
14602 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
14603
14604 @kindex exec-file
14605 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14606 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
14607 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
14608 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
14609 discard information on the executable file.
14610
14611 @kindex symbol-file
14612 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14613 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
14614 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
14615 table and program to run from the same file.
14616
14617 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
14618 program's symbol table.
14619
14620 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
14621 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
14622 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
14623 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
14624 @value{GDBN}.
14625
14626 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
14627 executing it once.
14628
14629 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
14630 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
14631 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
14632 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
14633 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
14634 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
14635 optimized code.
14636
14637 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
14638 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
14639 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
14640 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
14641 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
14642
14643 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
14644 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
14645 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
14646 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
14647 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
14648 Warnings and Messages}.)
14649
14650 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
14651 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
14652 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
14653 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
14654 in stabs format.
14655
14656 @kindex readnow
14657 @cindex reading symbols immediately
14658 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
14659 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14660 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14661 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
14662 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
14663 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
14664 entire symbol table available.
14665
14666 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
14667 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
14668 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
14669 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
14670 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
14671 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
14672 @c files.
14673
14674 @kindex core-file
14675 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
14676 @itemx core
14677 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
14678 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
14679 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
14680 executable file itself for other parts.
14681
14682 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
14683 to be used.
14684
14685 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
14686 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
14687 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
14688 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
14689 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
14690
14691 @kindex add-symbol-file
14692 @cindex dynamic linking
14693 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
14694 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
14695 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
14696 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
14697 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
14698 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
14699 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
14700 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
14701 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
14702 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
14703 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
14704 @var{address} as an expression.
14705
14706 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
14707 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
14708 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
14709 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
14710 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
14711
14712 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
14713 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
14714 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
14715 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
14716 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
14717 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
14718 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
14719 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
14720 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
14721
14722 @itemize @bullet
14723 @item
14724 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
14725 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
14726 @item
14727 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
14728 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
14729 @item
14730 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
14731 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
14732 @end itemize
14733
14734 @noindent
14735 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
14736 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
14737 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
14738 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
14739 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
14740 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
14741 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
14742 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
14743 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
14744 way.
14745
14746 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
14747
14748 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
14749 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
14750 @cindex load symbols from memory
14751 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
14752 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
14753 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
14754 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
14755 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
14756 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
14757 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
14758 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
14759 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
14760
14761 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
14762 @kindex assf
14763 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
14764 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
14765 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
14766 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
14767 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
14768 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
14769 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
14770 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
14771 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
14772 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
14773
14774 @kindex section
14775 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
14776 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
14777 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
14778 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
14779 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
14780 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
14781 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
14782 their addresses.
14783
14784 @kindex info files
14785 @kindex info target
14786 @item info files
14787 @itemx info target
14788 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
14789 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
14790 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
14791 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
14792 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
14793 current ones.
14794
14795 @kindex maint info sections
14796 @item maint info sections
14797 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
14798 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
14799 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
14800 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
14801 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
14802 may be arbitrarily combined):
14803
14804 @table @code
14805 @item ALLOBJ
14806 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
14807 @item @var{sections}
14808 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
14809 @item @var{section-flags}
14810 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
14811 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
14812 @table @code
14813 @item ALLOC
14814 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
14815 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
14816 @item LOAD
14817 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
14818 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
14819 @item RELOC
14820 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
14821 @item READONLY
14822 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
14823 @item CODE
14824 Section contains executable code only.
14825 @item DATA
14826 Section contains data only (no executable code).
14827 @item ROM
14828 Section will reside in ROM.
14829 @item CONSTRUCTOR
14830 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
14831 @item HAS_CONTENTS
14832 Section is not empty.
14833 @item NEVER_LOAD
14834 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
14835 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
14836 A notification to the linker that the section contains
14837 COFF shared library information.
14838 @item IS_COMMON
14839 Section contains common symbols.
14840 @end table
14841 @end table
14842 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
14843 @cindex read-only sections
14844 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
14845 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
14846 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
14847 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
14848 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
14849 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
14850 enhancement to debugging performance.
14851
14852 The default is off.
14853
14854 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
14855 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
14856 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
14857 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
14858
14859 @item show trust-readonly-sections
14860 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
14861 @end table
14862
14863 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
14864 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
14865 name and remembers it that way.
14866
14867 @cindex shared libraries
14868 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
14869 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
14870 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
14871
14872 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
14873 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
14874
14875 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
14876 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
14877 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
14878 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
14879 debugging a core file).
14880
14881 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
14882 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
14883
14884 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
14885 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
14886 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
14887
14888 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
14889 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
14890 particularly large or there are many of them.
14891
14892 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
14893 commands:
14894
14895 @table @code
14896 @kindex set auto-solib-add
14897 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
14898 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
14899 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
14900 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
14901 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
14902 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
14903 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
14904
14905 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
14906 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
14907 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
14908 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
14909 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
14910 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
14911 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
14912 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
14913 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
14914
14915 @kindex show auto-solib-add
14916 @item show auto-solib-add
14917 Display the current autoloading mode.
14918 @end table
14919
14920 @cindex load shared library
14921 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
14922 command:
14923
14924 @table @code
14925 @kindex info sharedlibrary
14926 @kindex info share
14927 @item info share @var{regex}
14928 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14929 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
14930 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
14931 all shared libraries that are loaded.
14932
14933 @kindex sharedlibrary
14934 @kindex share
14935 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14936 @itemx share @var{regex}
14937 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
14938 Unix regular expression.
14939 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
14940 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
14941 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
14942 loaded.
14943
14944 @item nosharedlibrary
14945 @kindex nosharedlibrary
14946 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
14947 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
14948 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
14949 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
14950 discarded.
14951 @end table
14952
14953 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
14954 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
14955 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
14956
14957 @table @code
14958 @item set stop-on-solib-events
14959 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
14960 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
14961 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
14962 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
14963 shared library.
14964
14965 @item show stop-on-solib-events
14966 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
14967 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
14968 library events happen.
14969 @end table
14970
14971 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
14972 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
14973 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
14974 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
14975 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
14976 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
14977 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
14978 not.
14979
14980 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
14981 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
14982 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
14983 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
14984 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
14985
14986 @table @code
14987 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
14988 @cindex system root, alternate
14989 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
14990 @kindex set sysroot
14991 @item set sysroot @var{path}
14992 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
14993 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
14994 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
14995 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
14996 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
14997 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
14998 under @var{path}.
14999
15000 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
15001 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
15002 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
15003 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
15004 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
15005 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
15006 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
15007 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
15008 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
15009
15010 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
15011 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
15012 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
15013 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
15014 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
15015
15016 @smallexample
15017 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
15018 @end smallexample
15019
15020 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
15021 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
15022 system:
15023
15024 @smallexample
15025 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
15026 @end smallexample
15027
15028 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
15029 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
15030 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
15031 colons:
15032
15033 @smallexample
15034 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
15035 @end smallexample
15036
15037 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
15038 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
15039 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
15040 @samp{z}):
15041
15042 @smallexample
15043 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
15044 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15045 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15046 @end smallexample
15047
15048 @noindent
15049 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
15050 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
15051 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
15052
15053 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
15054 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
15055
15056 @smallexample
15057 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
15058 @end smallexample
15059
15060 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
15061 if you don't want or need to.
15062
15063 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
15064 sysroot}.
15065
15066 @cindex default system root
15067 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
15068 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
15069 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
15070 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15071 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
15072 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15073 location.
15074
15075 @kindex show sysroot
15076 @item show sysroot
15077 Display the current shared library prefix.
15078
15079 @kindex set solib-search-path
15080 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
15081 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
15082 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
15083 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
15084 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
15085 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
15086 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
15087 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
15088 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
15089 of shared library symbols.
15090
15091 @kindex show solib-search-path
15092 @item show solib-search-path
15093 Display the current shared library search path.
15094
15095 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
15096 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
15097 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
15098 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
15099 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
15100
15101 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
15102 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
15103 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
15104 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
15105 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
15106 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
15107 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
15108 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
15109 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
15110 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
15111 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
15112 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
15113 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
15114 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
15115 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
15116 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
15117 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
15118 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
15119 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
15120 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
15121 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
15122 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
15123
15124 @table @code
15125 @item unix
15126 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
15127 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
15128 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
15129 the forward slash.
15130
15131 @item dos-based
15132 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
15133 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
15134 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
15135 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
15136 considered directory separators.
15137
15138 @item auto
15139 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
15140 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
15141 This is the default.
15142 @end table
15143 @end table
15144
15145
15146 @node Separate Debug Files
15147 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
15148 @cindex separate debugging information files
15149 @cindex debugging information in separate files
15150 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
15151 @cindex debugging information directory, global
15152 @cindex global debugging information directory
15153 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
15154 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
15155
15156 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
15157 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
15158 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
15159 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
15160 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
15161 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
15162 install only when they need to debug a problem.
15163
15164 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
15165 file:
15166
15167 @itemize @bullet
15168 @item
15169 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
15170 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
15171 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
15172 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
15173 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
15174 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
15175 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
15176 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
15177
15178 @item
15179 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
15180 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
15181 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
15182 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
15183 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
15184 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
15185 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
15186 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
15187 below.
15188 @end itemize
15189
15190 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
15191 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
15192
15193 @itemize @bullet
15194 @item
15195 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
15196 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
15197 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
15198 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
15199 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
15200
15201 @item
15202 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
15203 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
15204 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
15205 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
15206 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
15207 hex characters, not 10.)
15208 @end itemize
15209
15210 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
15211 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
15212 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
15213 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
15214 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
15215 debug information files, in the indicated order:
15216
15217 @itemize @minus
15218 @item
15219 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
15220 @item
15221 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
15222 @item
15223 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
15224 @item
15225 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
15226 @end itemize
15227
15228 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
15229 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
15230
15231 @table @code
15232
15233 @kindex set debug-file-directory
15234 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
15235 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15236 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple directory components can be set
15237 concatenating them by a directory separator.
15238
15239 @kindex show debug-file-directory
15240 @item show debug-file-directory
15241 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15242 information files.
15243
15244 @end table
15245
15246 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
15247 @cindex debug link sections
15248 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
15249 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
15250
15251 @itemize
15252 @item
15253 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
15254 a zero byte,
15255 @item
15256 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
15257 boundary within the section, and
15258 @item
15259 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
15260 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
15261 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
15262 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
15263 @end itemize
15264
15265 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
15266 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
15267 described above.
15268
15269 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
15270 @cindex build ID sections
15271 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
15272 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
15273 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
15274 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
15275 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
15276 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
15277 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
15278 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
15279 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
15280
15281 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
15282 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
15283 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
15284 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
15285 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
15286 in an ordinary executable.
15287
15288 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
15289 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
15290 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
15291 following commands:
15292
15293 @smallexample
15294 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
15295 @kbd{strip -g foo}
15296 @end smallexample
15297
15298 @noindent
15299 These commands remove the debugging
15300 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
15301 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
15302 two files:
15303
15304 @itemize @bullet
15305 @item
15306 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
15307 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
15308
15309 @smallexample
15310 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
15311 @end smallexample
15312
15313 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
15314 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
15315 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
15316 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
15317
15318 @item
15319 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
15320 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
15321 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
15322 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
15323 @end itemize
15324
15325 @noindent
15326
15327 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
15328 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
15329 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
15330
15331 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
15332 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
15333 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
15334 @c different ways!
15335 @ifhtml
15336 @display
15337 @html
15338 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
15339 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
15340 @end html
15341 @end display
15342 @end ifhtml
15343 @ifnothtml
15344 @display
15345 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
15346 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
15347 @end display
15348 @end ifnothtml
15349
15350 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
15351 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
15352 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
15353 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
15354 CRC.
15355
15356 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
15357 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
15358 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
15359 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
15360 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
15361 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
15362
15363 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
15364 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
15365 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
15366 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
15367 @code{0xffffffff}.
15368
15369 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
15370 @smallexample
15371 unsigned long
15372 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
15373 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
15374 @{
15375 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
15376 @{
15377 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
15378 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
15379 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
15380 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
15381 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
15382 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
15383 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
15384 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
15385 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
15386 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
15387 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
15388 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
15389 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
15390 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
15391 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
15392 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
15393 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
15394 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
15395 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
15396 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
15397 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
15398 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
15399 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
15400 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
15401 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
15402 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
15403 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
15404 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
15405 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
15406 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
15407 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
15408 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
15409 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
15410 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
15411 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
15412 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
15413 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
15414 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
15415 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
15416 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
15417 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
15418 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
15419 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
15420 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
15421 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
15422 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
15423 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
15424 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
15425 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
15426 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
15427 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
15428 0x2d02ef8d
15429 @};
15430 unsigned char *end;
15431
15432 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15433 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
15434 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
15435 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15436 @}
15437 @end smallexample
15438
15439 @noindent
15440 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
15441
15442
15443 @node Index Files
15444 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
15445 @cindex index files
15446 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
15447
15448 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
15449 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
15450 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
15451 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
15452 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
15453 startup.
15454
15455 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
15456 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
15457 using @command{objcopy}.
15458
15459 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
15460
15461 @table @code
15462 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
15463 @kindex save gdb-index
15464 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
15465 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
15466 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
15467 @var{directory}.
15468 @end table
15469
15470 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
15471 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
15472
15473 @smallexample
15474 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
15475 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
15476 @end smallexample
15477
15478 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
15479 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
15480 currently work for programs using Ada.
15481
15482 @node Symbol Errors
15483 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
15484
15485 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
15486 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
15487 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
15488 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
15489 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
15490 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
15491 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
15492 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
15493 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
15494 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
15495 Messages}).
15496
15497 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
15498
15499 @table @code
15500 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
15501
15502 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
15503 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
15504 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
15505 in its outer scope blocks.
15506
15507 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
15508 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
15509 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
15510 function.
15511
15512 @item block at @var{address} out of order
15513
15514 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
15515 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
15516 do so.
15517
15518 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
15519 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
15520 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
15521 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
15522 Messages}.)
15523
15524 @item bad block start address patched
15525
15526 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
15527 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
15528 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
15529
15530 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
15531 starting on the previous source line.
15532
15533 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
15534
15535 @cindex foo
15536 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
15537 larger than the size of the string table.
15538
15539 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
15540 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
15541 with this name.
15542
15543 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
15544
15545 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
15546 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
15547 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
15548
15549 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
15550 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
15551 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
15552 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
15553 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
15554 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
15555
15556 @item stub type has NULL name
15557
15558 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
15559
15560 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
15561 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
15562 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
15563 it.
15564
15565 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
15566
15567 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
15568
15569 @end table
15570
15571 @node Data Files
15572 @section GDB Data Files
15573
15574 @cindex prefix for data files
15575 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
15576 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
15577
15578 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
15579 is currently using.
15580
15581 @table @code
15582 @kindex set data-directory
15583 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
15584 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
15585 to @var{directory}.
15586
15587 @kindex show data-directory
15588 @item show data-directory
15589 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
15590 @end table
15591
15592 @cindex default data directory
15593 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
15594 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
15595 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
15596 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15597 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
15598 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15599 location.
15600
15601 @node Targets
15602 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
15603
15604 @cindex debugging target
15605 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
15606
15607 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
15608 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
15609 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
15610 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
15611 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
15612 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
15613 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
15614 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
15615
15616 @cindex target architecture
15617 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
15618 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
15619 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
15620 command.
15621
15622 @table @code
15623 @kindex set architecture
15624 @kindex show architecture
15625 @item set architecture @var{arch}
15626 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
15627 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
15628 supported architectures.
15629
15630 @item show architecture
15631 Show the current target architecture.
15632
15633 @item set processor
15634 @itemx processor
15635 @kindex set processor
15636 @kindex show processor
15637 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
15638 and @code{show architecture}.
15639 @end table
15640
15641 @menu
15642 * Active Targets:: Active targets
15643 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
15644 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
15645 @end menu
15646
15647 @node Active Targets
15648 @section Active Targets
15649
15650 @cindex stacking targets
15651 @cindex active targets
15652 @cindex multiple targets
15653
15654 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
15655 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
15656 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
15657 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
15658 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
15659 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
15660 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
15661 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
15662 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
15663
15664 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
15665 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
15666 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
15667 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
15668
15669 @node Target Commands
15670 @section Commands for Managing Targets
15671
15672 @table @code
15673 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
15674 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
15675 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
15676 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
15677 protocol of the target machine.
15678
15679 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
15680 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
15681 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
15682
15683 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
15684 after executing the command.
15685
15686 @kindex help target
15687 @item help target
15688 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
15689 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
15690 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15691
15692 @item help target @var{name}
15693 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
15694 select it.
15695
15696 @kindex set gnutarget
15697 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
15698 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
15699 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
15700 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
15701 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
15702 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
15703
15704 @quotation
15705 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
15706 you must know the actual BFD name.
15707 @end quotation
15708
15709 @noindent
15710 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
15711
15712 @kindex show gnutarget
15713 @item show gnutarget
15714 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
15715 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
15716 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
15717 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
15718 @end table
15719
15720 @cindex common targets
15721 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
15722 configuration):
15723
15724 @table @code
15725 @kindex target
15726 @item target exec @var{program}
15727 @cindex executable file target
15728 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
15729 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
15730
15731 @item target core @var{filename}
15732 @cindex core dump file target
15733 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
15734 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
15735
15736 @item target remote @var{medium}
15737 @cindex remote target
15738 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
15739 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
15740 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
15741
15742 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
15743 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
15744
15745 @smallexample
15746 target remote /dev/ttya
15747 @end smallexample
15748
15749 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
15750 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
15751 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
15752 clobbered by the download.
15753
15754 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
15755 @cindex built-in simulator target
15756 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
15757 In general,
15758 @smallexample
15759 target sim
15760 load
15761 run
15762 @end smallexample
15763 @noindent
15764 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
15765 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
15766 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
15767 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
15768 Processors}.
15769
15770 @end table
15771
15772 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
15773
15774 @table @code
15775
15776 @item target nrom @var{dev}
15777 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
15778 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
15779
15780 @end table
15781
15782 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
15783 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
15784
15785 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
15786 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
15787 various aspects of this process.
15788
15789 @table @code
15790
15791 @item set hash
15792 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15793 @cindex hash mark while downloading
15794 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
15795 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
15796 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
15797 monitor.
15798
15799 @item show hash
15800 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15801 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
15802
15803 @item set debug monitor
15804 @kindex set debug monitor
15805 @cindex display remote monitor communications
15806 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
15807 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15808
15809 @item show debug monitor
15810 @kindex show debug monitor
15811 Show the current status of displaying communications between
15812 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15813 @end table
15814
15815 @table @code
15816
15817 @kindex load @var{filename}
15818 @item load @var{filename}
15819 @anchor{load}
15820 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
15821 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
15822 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
15823 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
15824 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
15825 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
15826
15827 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
15828 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
15829 target is @dots{}}''
15830
15831 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
15832 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
15833 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
15834 specifies a fixed address.
15835 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
15836
15837 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
15838 load programs into flash memory.
15839
15840 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
15841 @end table
15842
15843 @node Byte Order
15844 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
15845
15846 @cindex choosing target byte order
15847 @cindex target byte order
15848
15849 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
15850 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
15851 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
15852 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
15853 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
15854 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
15855
15856 @table @code
15857 @kindex set endian
15858 @item set endian big
15859 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
15860
15861 @item set endian little
15862 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
15863
15864 @item set endian auto
15865 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
15866 executable.
15867
15868 @item show endian
15869 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
15870
15871 @end table
15872
15873 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
15874 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
15875 target system.
15876
15877
15878 @node Remote Debugging
15879 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
15880 @cindex remote debugging
15881
15882 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
15883 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
15884 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
15885 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
15886 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
15887
15888 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
15889 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
15890 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
15891 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
15892 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
15893 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
15894
15895 Other remote targets may be available in your
15896 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
15897
15898 @menu
15899 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
15900 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
15901 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
15902 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
15903 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
15904 @end menu
15905
15906 @node Connecting
15907 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
15908
15909 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
15910 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
15911 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
15912 program as the first argument.
15913
15914 @cindex @code{target remote}
15915 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
15916 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
15917 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
15918 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
15919 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
15920 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
15921
15922 @table @code
15923
15924 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
15925 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
15926 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
15927 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
15928
15929 @smallexample
15930 target remote /dev/ttyb
15931 @end smallexample
15932
15933 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
15934 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
15935 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
15936 @code{target} command.
15937
15938 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
15939 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15940 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
15941 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
15942 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
15943 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
15944 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
15945 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
15946 target.
15947
15948 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
15949 @code{manyfarms}:
15950
15951 @smallexample
15952 target remote manyfarms:2828
15953 @end smallexample
15954
15955 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
15956 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
15957 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
15958 port 1234 on your local machine:
15959
15960 @smallexample
15961 target remote :1234
15962 @end smallexample
15963 @noindent
15964
15965 Note that the colon is still required here.
15966
15967 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15968 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
15969 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
15970 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
15971
15972 @smallexample
15973 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
15974 @end smallexample
15975
15976 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
15977 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
15978 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
15979 cause havoc with your debugging session.
15980
15981 @item target remote | @var{command}
15982 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
15983 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
15984 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
15985 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
15986 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
15987 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
15988 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
15989 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
15990
15991 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
15992 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
15993 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
15994
15995 @end table
15996
15997 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
15998 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
15999 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
16000 need to use @kbd{run}.
16001
16002 @cindex interrupting remote programs
16003 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
16004 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
16005 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
16006 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
16007 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
16008 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
16009
16010 @smallexample
16011 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
16012 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
16013 @end smallexample
16014
16015 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
16016 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
16017 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
16018 goes back to waiting.
16019
16020 @table @code
16021 @kindex detach (remote)
16022 @item detach
16023 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
16024 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
16025 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
16026 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
16027 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
16028
16029 @kindex disconnect
16030 @item disconnect
16031 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
16032 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
16033 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
16034 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
16035 another target.
16036
16037 @cindex send command to remote monitor
16038 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
16039 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
16040 @kindex monitor
16041 @item monitor @var{cmd}
16042 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
16043 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
16044 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
16045 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
16046 and implement.
16047 @end table
16048
16049 @node File Transfer
16050 @section Sending files to a remote system
16051 @cindex remote target, file transfer
16052 @cindex file transfer
16053 @cindex sending files to remote systems
16054
16055 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
16056 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
16057 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
16058 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
16059 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
16060 the only way to upload or download files.
16061
16062 Not all remote targets support these commands.
16063
16064 @table @code
16065 @kindex remote put
16066 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
16067 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
16068 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
16069
16070 @kindex remote get
16071 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
16072 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
16073 on the host system.
16074
16075 @kindex remote delete
16076 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
16077 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
16078
16079 @end table
16080
16081 @node Server
16082 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
16083
16084 @kindex gdbserver
16085 @cindex remote connection without stubs
16086 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
16087 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
16088 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
16089
16090 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
16091 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
16092 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
16093 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
16094 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
16095 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
16096 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
16097 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
16098 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
16099 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
16100 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
16101 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
16102 choice for debugging.
16103
16104 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
16105 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
16106 protocol.
16107
16108 @quotation
16109 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
16110 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
16111 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
16112 target system with the same privileges as the user running
16113 @code{gdbserver}.
16114 @end quotation
16115
16116 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
16117 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
16118
16119 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
16120 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
16121 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
16122 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
16123 system does all the symbol handling.
16124
16125 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
16126 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
16127 syntax is:
16128
16129 @smallexample
16130 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
16131 @end smallexample
16132
16133 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
16134 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
16135 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
16136 @file{/dev/com1}:
16137
16138 @smallexample
16139 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
16140 @end smallexample
16141
16142 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
16143 with it.
16144
16145 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
16146
16147 @smallexample
16148 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
16149 @end smallexample
16150
16151 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
16152 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
16153 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
16154 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
16155 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
16156 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
16157 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
16158 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
16159 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
16160 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
16161 @code{target remote} command.
16162
16163 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
16164
16165 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
16166 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
16167
16168 @smallexample
16169 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
16170 @end smallexample
16171
16172 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
16173 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
16174
16175 @pindex pidof
16176 @cindex attach to a program by name
16177 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
16178 @code{pidof} utility:
16179
16180 @smallexample
16181 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
16182 @end smallexample
16183
16184 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
16185 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
16186 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
16187
16188 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
16189 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
16190 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
16191
16192 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
16193 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
16194 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
16195 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
16196
16197 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
16198 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
16199 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
16200 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
16201 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
16202 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
16203 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
16204 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
16205 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
16206
16207 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
16208 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
16209 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
16210 the program you want to debug.
16211
16212 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
16213 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
16214 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
16215
16216 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
16217
16218 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
16219 status information about the debugging process. The
16220 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
16221 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
16222 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
16223
16224 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
16225 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
16226 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
16227 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
16228
16229 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
16230 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
16231 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
16232 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
16233
16234 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
16235 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
16236 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
16237 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
16238
16239 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
16240 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
16241 environment:
16242
16243 @smallexample
16244 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
16245 @end smallexample
16246
16247 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
16248
16249 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
16250
16251 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
16252 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
16253 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
16254 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
16255
16256 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
16257 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
16258 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
16259 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
16260 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
16261 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
16262 programs.
16263
16264 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
16265 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
16266 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
16267 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
16268 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
16269 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
16270 already on the target.
16271
16272 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
16273 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
16274 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
16275
16276 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
16277 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
16278 Here are the available commands.
16279
16280 @table @code
16281 @item monitor help
16282 List the available monitor commands.
16283
16284 @item monitor set debug 0
16285 @itemx monitor set debug 1
16286 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
16287
16288 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
16289 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
16290 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
16291 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
16292
16293 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
16294 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
16295 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
16296 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
16297 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
16298 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to an empty list.
16299
16300 @item monitor exit
16301 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
16302 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
16303 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
16304 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
16305 of a multi-process mode debug session.
16306
16307 @end table
16308
16309 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16310 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16311
16312 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
16313 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
16314
16315 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
16316 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
16317 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
16318 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
16319 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
16320 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
16321 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
16322 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
16323 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
16324 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
16325 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
16326 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
16327
16328 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
16329
16330 @table @code
16331 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
16332
16333 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
16334 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
16335 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
16336
16337 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
16338
16339 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
16340 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
16341 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
16342 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
16343 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
16344 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
16345
16346 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
16347
16348 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
16349 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
16350 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
16351 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
16352 command for that. For example:
16353
16354 @smallexample
16355 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
16356 @end smallexample
16357
16358 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
16359 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
16360 @end table
16361
16362 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
16363 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
16364 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
16365 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
16366 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
16367 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
16368 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
16369 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
16370 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
16371 @code{gdbserver} like so:
16372
16373 @smallexample
16374 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
16375 @end smallexample
16376
16377 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
16378
16379 @smallexample
16380 $ gdb myprogram
16381 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
16382 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
16383 (@value{GDBP}) b main
16384 (@value{GDBP}) continue
16385 @end smallexample
16386
16387 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
16388 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
16389 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
16390 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
16391 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
16392 tracing.
16393
16394 @node Remote Configuration
16395 @section Remote Configuration
16396
16397 @kindex set remote
16398 @kindex show remote
16399 This section documents the configuration options available when
16400 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
16401 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
16402 system-call-allowed}.
16403
16404 @table @code
16405 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
16406 @cindex address size for remote targets
16407 @cindex bits in remote address
16408 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
16409 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
16410 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
16411 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
16412
16413 @item show remoteaddresssize
16414 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
16415
16416 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
16417 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
16418 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
16419 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
16420 remote targets.
16421
16422 @item show remotebaud
16423 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
16424
16425 @item set remotebreak
16426 @cindex interrupt remote programs
16427 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
16428 @anchor{set remotebreak}
16429 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
16430 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
16431 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
16432 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
16433 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
16434
16435 @item show remotebreak
16436 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
16437 interrupt the remote program.
16438
16439 @item set remoteflow on
16440 @itemx set remoteflow off
16441 @kindex set remoteflow
16442 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
16443 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
16444
16445 @item show remoteflow
16446 @kindex show remoteflow
16447 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
16448
16449 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
16450 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
16451 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
16452 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
16453 @code{ascii}.
16454
16455 @item show remotelogbase
16456 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
16457 protocol.
16458
16459 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
16460 @cindex record serial communications on file
16461 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
16462 default is not to record at all.
16463
16464 @item show remotelogfile.
16465 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
16466 serial communications.
16467
16468 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
16469 @cindex timeout for serial communications
16470 @cindex remote timeout
16471 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
16472 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
16473
16474 @item show remotetimeout
16475 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
16476 responses.
16477
16478 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
16479 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
16480 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
16481 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
16482 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
16483 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
16484 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
16485 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
16486
16487 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
16488 @itemx show remote exec-file
16489 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
16490 @cindex executable file, for remote target
16491 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
16492 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
16493 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
16494 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
16495
16496 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
16497 @cindex interrupt remote programs
16498 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
16499 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
16500 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
16501 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
16502 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
16503 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
16504 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
16505 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
16506
16507 @item show interrupt-sequence
16508 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
16509 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
16510 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
16511 also known as Magic SysRq g.
16512
16513 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
16514 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
16515 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
16516 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
16517 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
16518 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
16519
16520 @item show interrupt-on-connect
16521 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
16522 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
16523
16524 @kindex set tcp
16525 @kindex show tcp
16526 @item set tcp auto-retry on
16527 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
16528 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
16529 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
16530 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
16531 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
16532 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
16533 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
16534 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
16535
16536 @item set tcp auto-retry off
16537 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
16538
16539 @item show tcp auto-retry
16540 Show the current auto-retry setting.
16541
16542 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
16543 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
16544 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
16545 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
16546 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
16547 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
16548 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
16549 value.
16550
16551 @item show tcp connect-timeout
16552 Show the current connection timeout setting.
16553 @end table
16554
16555 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
16556 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
16557 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
16558 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
16559 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
16560 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
16561 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
16562 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
16563 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
16564
16565 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
16566 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
16567 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
16568 @value{GDBN} developers.
16569
16570 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
16571 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
16572 are:
16573
16574 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
16575 @item Command Name
16576 @tab Remote Packet
16577 @tab Related Features
16578
16579 @item @code{fetch-register}
16580 @tab @code{p}
16581 @tab @code{info registers}
16582
16583 @item @code{set-register}
16584 @tab @code{P}
16585 @tab @code{set}
16586
16587 @item @code{binary-download}
16588 @tab @code{X}
16589 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
16590
16591 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
16592 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
16593 @tab @code{info auxv}
16594
16595 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
16596 @tab @code{qSymbol}
16597 @tab Detecting multiple threads
16598
16599 @item @code{attach}
16600 @tab @code{vAttach}
16601 @tab @code{attach}
16602
16603 @item @code{verbose-resume}
16604 @tab @code{vCont}
16605 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
16606
16607 @item @code{run}
16608 @tab @code{vRun}
16609 @tab @code{run}
16610
16611 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
16612 @tab @code{Z0}
16613 @tab @code{break}
16614
16615 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
16616 @tab @code{Z1}
16617 @tab @code{hbreak}
16618
16619 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
16620 @tab @code{Z2}
16621 @tab @code{watch}
16622
16623 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
16624 @tab @code{Z3}
16625 @tab @code{rwatch}
16626
16627 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
16628 @tab @code{Z4}
16629 @tab @code{awatch}
16630
16631 @item @code{target-features}
16632 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
16633 @tab @code{set architecture}
16634
16635 @item @code{library-info}
16636 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
16637 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
16638
16639 @item @code{memory-map}
16640 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
16641 @tab @code{info mem}
16642
16643 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
16644 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
16645 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
16646
16647 @item @code{read-spu-object}
16648 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
16649 @tab @code{info spu}
16650
16651 @item @code{write-spu-object}
16652 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
16653 @tab @code{info spu}
16654
16655 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
16656 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
16657 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
16658
16659 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
16660 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
16661 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
16662
16663 @item @code{threads}
16664 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
16665 @tab @code{info threads}
16666
16667 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
16668 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
16669 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
16670
16671 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
16672 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
16673 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
16674
16675 @item @code{search-memory}
16676 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
16677 @tab @code{find}
16678
16679 @item @code{supported-packets}
16680 @tab @code{qSupported}
16681 @tab Remote communications parameters
16682
16683 @item @code{pass-signals}
16684 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
16685 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
16686
16687 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
16688 @tab @code{vFile:close}
16689 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16690
16691 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
16692 @tab @code{vFile:open}
16693 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16694
16695 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
16696 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
16697 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16698
16699 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
16700 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
16701 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16702
16703 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
16704 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
16705 @tab @code{remote delete}
16706
16707 @item @code{noack-packet}
16708 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
16709 @tab Packet acknowledgment
16710
16711 @item @code{osdata}
16712 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
16713 @tab @code{info os}
16714
16715 @item @code{query-attached}
16716 @tab @code{qAttached}
16717 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
16718 @end multitable
16719
16720 @node Remote Stub
16721 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
16722
16723 @cindex debugging stub, example
16724 @cindex remote stub, example
16725 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
16726 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
16727 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
16728 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
16729 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
16730 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
16731 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
16732 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
16733
16734 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
16735 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
16736 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
16737 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
16738 program, you need:
16739
16740 @enumerate
16741 @item
16742 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
16743 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
16744 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
16745
16746 @item
16747 A C subroutine library to support your program's
16748 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
16749
16750 @item
16751 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
16752 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
16753 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
16754 documentation.
16755 @end enumerate
16756
16757 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
16758 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
16759 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
16760
16761 @table @emph
16762 @item On the host,
16763 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
16764 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
16765 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16766
16767 @item On the target,
16768 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
16769 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
16770 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
16771
16772 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
16773 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
16774 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
16775 @end table
16776
16777 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
16778 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
16779 @sc{sparc} boards.
16780
16781 @cindex remote serial stub list
16782 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
16783
16784 @table @code
16785
16786 @item i386-stub.c
16787 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
16788 @cindex Intel
16789 @cindex i386
16790 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
16791
16792 @item m68k-stub.c
16793 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
16794 @cindex Motorola 680x0
16795 @cindex m680x0
16796 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
16797
16798 @item sh-stub.c
16799 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
16800 @cindex Renesas
16801 @cindex SH
16802 For Renesas SH architectures.
16803
16804 @item sparc-stub.c
16805 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
16806 @cindex Sparc
16807 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
16808
16809 @item sparcl-stub.c
16810 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
16811 @cindex Fujitsu
16812 @cindex SparcLite
16813 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
16814
16815 @end table
16816
16817 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
16818 recently added stubs.
16819
16820 @menu
16821 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
16822 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
16823 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
16824 @end menu
16825
16826 @node Stub Contents
16827 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
16828
16829 @cindex remote serial stub
16830 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
16831 subroutines:
16832
16833 @table @code
16834 @item set_debug_traps
16835 @findex set_debug_traps
16836 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
16837 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
16838 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
16839 beginning of your program.
16840
16841 @item handle_exception
16842 @findex handle_exception
16843 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
16844 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
16845 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
16846 run when a trap is triggered.
16847
16848 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
16849 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
16850 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
16851 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
16852 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
16853 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
16854 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
16855 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
16856 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
16857 machine.
16858
16859 @item breakpoint
16860 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
16861 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
16862 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
16863 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
16864 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
16865 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
16866 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
16867 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
16868 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
16869 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
16870 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
16871
16872 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
16873 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
16874 start of your debugging session.
16875 @end table
16876
16877 @node Bootstrapping
16878 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
16879
16880 @cindex remote stub, support routines
16881 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
16882 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
16883 debugging target machine.
16884
16885 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
16886 serial port.
16887
16888 @table @code
16889 @item int getDebugChar()
16890 @findex getDebugChar
16891 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
16892 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
16893 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16894
16895 @item void putDebugChar(int)
16896 @findex putDebugChar
16897 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
16898 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
16899 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16900 @end table
16901
16902 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
16903 @cindex interrupting remote targets
16904 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
16905 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
16906 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
16907 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
16908 remote system to stop.
16909
16910 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
16911 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
16912 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
16913 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
16914
16915 Other routines you need to supply are:
16916
16917 @table @code
16918 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
16919 @findex exceptionHandler
16920 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
16921 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
16922 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
16923 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
16924 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
16925 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
16926 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
16927 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
16928 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
16929 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
16930 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
16931 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
16932 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
16933
16934 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
16935 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
16936 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
16937 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
16938 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
16939
16940 @item void flush_i_cache()
16941 @findex flush_i_cache
16942 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
16943 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
16944 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
16945
16946 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
16947 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
16948 @end table
16949
16950 @noindent
16951 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
16952
16953 @table @code
16954 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
16955 @findex memset
16956 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
16957 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
16958 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
16959 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
16960 @end table
16961
16962 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
16963 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
16964 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
16965 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
16966
16967
16968 @node Debug Session
16969 @subsection Putting it All Together
16970
16971 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
16972 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
16973 steps.
16974
16975 @enumerate
16976 @item
16977 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
16978 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
16979 @display
16980 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
16981 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
16982 @end display
16983
16984 @item
16985 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
16986
16987 @smallexample
16988 set_debug_traps();
16989 breakpoint();
16990 @end smallexample
16991
16992 @item
16993 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
16994 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
16995
16996 @smallexample
16997 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
16998 @end smallexample
16999
17000 @noindent
17001 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
17002 function in your program, that function is called when
17003 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
17004 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
17005 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
17006
17007 @item
17008 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
17009 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
17010
17011 @item
17012 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
17013 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
17014
17015 @item
17016 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
17017 @c document that. FIXME.
17018 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
17019 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
17020
17021 @item
17022 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
17023 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
17024
17025 @end enumerate
17026
17027 @node Configurations
17028 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
17029
17030 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
17031 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
17032 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
17033
17034 There are three major categories of configurations: native
17035 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
17036 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
17037 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
17038 are quite different from each other.
17039
17040 @menu
17041 * Native::
17042 * Embedded OS::
17043 * Embedded Processors::
17044 * Architectures::
17045 @end menu
17046
17047 @node Native
17048 @section Native
17049
17050 This section describes details specific to particular native
17051 configurations.
17052
17053 @menu
17054 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
17055 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
17056 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
17057 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
17058 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
17059 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
17060 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
17061 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
17062 @end menu
17063
17064 @node HP-UX
17065 @subsection HP-UX
17066
17067 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
17068 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
17069 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
17070
17071
17072 @node BSD libkvm Interface
17073 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
17074
17075 @cindex libkvm
17076 @cindex kernel memory image
17077 @cindex kernel crash dump
17078
17079 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
17080 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
17081 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
17082 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
17083 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
17084 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
17085 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
17086 @code{kvm} target:
17087
17088 @smallexample
17089 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
17090 @end smallexample
17091
17092 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
17093 argument:
17094
17095 @smallexample
17096 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
17097 @end smallexample
17098
17099 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
17100 available:
17101
17102 @table @code
17103 @kindex kvm
17104 @item kvm pcb
17105 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
17106
17107 @item kvm proc
17108 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
17109 modern FreeBSD systems.
17110 @end table
17111
17112 @node SVR4 Process Information
17113 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
17114 @cindex /proc
17115 @cindex examine process image
17116 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
17117
17118 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
17119 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
17120 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
17121 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
17122 proc} is available to report information about the process running
17123 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
17124 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
17125 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
17126 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
17127
17128 @table @code
17129 @kindex info proc
17130 @cindex process ID
17131 @item info proc
17132 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
17133 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
17134 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
17135 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
17136 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
17137 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
17138 executable file's absolute file name.
17139
17140 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
17141 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
17142 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
17143 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
17144 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
17145 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
17146
17147 @item info proc mappings
17148 @cindex memory address space mappings
17149 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
17150 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
17151 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
17152 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
17153 memory access rights to that range.
17154
17155 @item info proc stat
17156 @itemx info proc status
17157 @cindex process detailed status information
17158 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
17159 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
17160 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
17161 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
17162 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
17163 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
17164 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
17165
17166 @item info proc all
17167 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
17168 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
17169
17170 @ignore
17171 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
17172 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
17173 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
17174 @kindex info proc times
17175 @item info proc times
17176 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
17177 its children.
17178
17179 @kindex info proc id
17180 @item info proc id
17181 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
17182 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
17183 @end ignore
17184
17185 @item set procfs-trace
17186 @kindex set procfs-trace
17187 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
17188 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
17189
17190 @item show procfs-trace
17191 @kindex show procfs-trace
17192 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
17193
17194 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
17195 @kindex set procfs-file
17196 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
17197 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
17198 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
17199 standard output.
17200
17201 @item show procfs-file
17202 @kindex show procfs-file
17203 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
17204
17205 @item proc-trace-entry
17206 @itemx proc-trace-exit
17207 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
17208 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
17209 @kindex proc-trace-entry
17210 @kindex proc-trace-exit
17211 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
17212 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
17213 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
17214 from the @code{syscall} interface.
17215
17216 @item info pidlist
17217 @kindex info pidlist
17218 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
17219 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
17220 processes and all the threads within each process.
17221
17222 @item info meminfo
17223 @kindex info meminfo
17224 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
17225 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
17226 @end table
17227
17228 @node DJGPP Native
17229 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
17230 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
17231 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
17232 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
17233
17234 @cindex DPMI
17235 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
17236 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
17237 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
17238 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
17239
17240 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
17241 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
17242 subsection describes those commands.
17243
17244 @table @code
17245 @kindex info dos
17246 @item info dos
17247 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
17248 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17249
17250 @kindex sysinfo
17251 @cindex MS-DOS system info
17252 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
17253 @item info dos sysinfo
17254 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
17255 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
17256 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
17257
17258 @cindex GDT
17259 @cindex LDT
17260 @cindex IDT
17261 @cindex segment descriptor tables
17262 @cindex descriptor tables display
17263 @item info dos gdt
17264 @itemx info dos ldt
17265 @itemx info dos idt
17266 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
17267 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
17268 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
17269 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
17270 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
17271 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
17272 rights.
17273
17274 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
17275 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
17276 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
17277 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
17278 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
17279
17280 @cindex garbled pointers
17281 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
17282 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
17283 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
17284 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
17285 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
17286 debugged program's data segment:
17287
17288 @smallexample
17289 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
17290 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
17291 @end smallexample
17292
17293 @noindent
17294 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
17295 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
17296
17297 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
17298 @item info dos pde
17299 @itemx info dos pte
17300 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
17301 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
17302 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
17303 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
17304 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
17305 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
17306 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
17307 that is currently in use.
17308
17309 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
17310 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
17311 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
17312 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
17313 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
17314 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
17315 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
17316
17317 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
17318 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
17319 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
17320 controller.
17321
17322 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
17323
17324 @cindex physical address from linear address
17325 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
17326 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
17327 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
17328 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
17329 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
17330 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
17331 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
17332
17333 @smallexample
17334 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
17335 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
17336 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
17337 @end smallexample
17338
17339 @noindent
17340 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
17341 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
17342 attributes of that page.
17343
17344 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
17345 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
17346 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
17347 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
17348 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
17349 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
17350
17351 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
17352 transfer buffer:
17353
17354 @smallexample
17355 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
17356 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
17357 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
17358 @end smallexample
17359
17360 @noindent
17361 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
17362 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
17363 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
17364 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
17365 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
17366
17367 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
17368 @end table
17369
17370 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
17371 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
17372 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
17373 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
17374
17375 @table @code
17376 @kindex set com1base
17377 @kindex set com1irq
17378 @kindex set com2base
17379 @kindex set com2irq
17380 @kindex set com3base
17381 @kindex set com3irq
17382 @kindex set com4base
17383 @kindex set com4irq
17384 @item set com1base @var{addr}
17385 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
17386 port.
17387
17388 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
17389 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
17390 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
17391
17392 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
17393 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
17394 other 3 COM ports.
17395
17396 @kindex show com1base
17397 @kindex show com1irq
17398 @kindex show com2base
17399 @kindex show com2irq
17400 @kindex show com3base
17401 @kindex show com3irq
17402 @kindex show com4base
17403 @kindex show com4irq
17404 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
17405 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
17406 lines used by the COM ports.
17407
17408 @item info serial
17409 @kindex info serial
17410 @cindex DOS serial port status
17411 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
17412 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
17413 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
17414 counts of various errors encountered so far.
17415 @end table
17416
17417
17418 @node Cygwin Native
17419 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
17420 @cindex MS Windows debugging
17421 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
17422 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
17423
17424 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
17425 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
17426
17427 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
17428 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
17429 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
17430 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
17431 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
17432 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
17433 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
17434 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
17435
17436 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
17437 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
17438 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
17439
17440 @table @code
17441 @kindex info w32
17442 @item info w32
17443 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
17444 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17445
17446 @item info w32 selector
17447 This command displays information returned by
17448 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
17449 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
17450 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
17451 Without argument, this command displays information
17452 about the six segment registers.
17453
17454 @item info w32 thread-information-block
17455 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
17456 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
17457 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
17458
17459 @kindex info dll
17460 @item info dll
17461 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
17462
17463 @kindex dll-symbols
17464 @item dll-symbols
17465 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
17466 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
17467
17468 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
17469 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
17470 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
17471 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
17472 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
17473 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
17474 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
17475 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
17476 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
17477 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
17478 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
17479
17480 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
17481 @item show cygwin-exceptions
17482 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
17483 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
17484
17485 @kindex set new-console
17486 @item set new-console @var{mode}
17487 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
17488 be started in a new console on next start.
17489 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
17490 be started in the same console as the debugger.
17491
17492 @kindex show new-console
17493 @item show new-console
17494 Displays whether a new console is used
17495 when the debuggee is started.
17496
17497 @kindex set new-group
17498 @item set new-group @var{mode}
17499 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
17500 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
17501 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
17502 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
17503
17504 @kindex show new-group
17505 @item show new-group
17506 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
17507
17508 @kindex set debugevents
17509 @item set debugevents
17510 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
17511 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
17512 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
17513 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
17514 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
17515
17516 @kindex set debugexec
17517 @item set debugexec
17518 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
17519 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
17520
17521 @kindex set debugexceptions
17522 @item set debugexceptions
17523 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
17524 debuggee seen by the debugger.
17525
17526 @kindex set debugmemory
17527 @item set debugmemory
17528 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
17529 and writes by the debugger.
17530
17531 @kindex set shell
17532 @item set shell
17533 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
17534 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
17535
17536 @kindex show shell
17537 @item show shell
17538 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
17539
17540 @end table
17541
17542 @menu
17543 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
17544 @end menu
17545
17546 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
17547 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
17548 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
17549 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
17550
17551 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
17552 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
17553 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
17554 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
17555 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
17556 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
17557 ``minimal symbols''.
17558
17559 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
17560 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
17561 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
17562 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
17563 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
17564 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
17565 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
17566 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
17567 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
17568 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
17569
17570 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
17571
17572 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
17573 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
17574 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
17575 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
17576 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
17577 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
17578 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
17579 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
17580 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
17581
17582 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
17583 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
17584 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
17585 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
17586 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
17587 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
17588
17589 @smallexample
17590 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
17591 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
17592
17593 Non-debugging symbols:
17594 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
17595 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
17596 @end smallexample
17597
17598 @smallexample
17599 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
17600 All functions matching regular expression "!":
17601
17602 Non-debugging symbols:
17603 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
17604 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
17605 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
17606 [etc...]
17607 @end smallexample
17608
17609 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
17610
17611 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
17612 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
17613 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
17614 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
17615 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
17616 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
17617 a function within a DLL without a running program.
17618
17619 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
17620 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
17621 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
17622 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
17623 problem:
17624
17625 @smallexample
17626 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
17627 $1 = 268572168
17628 @end smallexample
17629
17630 @smallexample
17631 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
17632 0x10021610: "\230y\""
17633 @end smallexample
17634
17635 And two possible solutions:
17636
17637 @smallexample
17638 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
17639 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17640 @end smallexample
17641
17642 @smallexample
17643 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
17644 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
17645 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
17646 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
17647 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
17648 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17649 @end smallexample
17650
17651 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
17652 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
17653 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
17654 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
17655 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
17656
17657 @smallexample
17658 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
17659 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
17660 @end smallexample
17661
17662 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
17663 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
17664 safe.
17665
17666 @node Hurd Native
17667 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
17668 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
17669
17670 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
17671 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
17672
17673 @table @code
17674 @item set signals
17675 @itemx set sigs
17676 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
17677 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17678 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
17679 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
17680 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
17681 @code{signals}.
17682
17683 @item show signals
17684 @itemx show sigs
17685 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
17686 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17687 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
17688
17689 @item set signal-thread
17690 @itemx set sigthread
17691 @kindex set signal-thread
17692 @kindex set sigthread
17693 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
17694 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
17695 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
17696 signal-thread}.
17697
17698 @item show signal-thread
17699 @itemx show sigthread
17700 @kindex show signal-thread
17701 @kindex show sigthread
17702 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
17703 delivered a signal.
17704
17705 @item set stopped
17706 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17707 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
17708 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
17709 continued by delivering a signal to it.
17710
17711 @item show stopped
17712 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17713 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
17714 stopped.
17715
17716 @item set exceptions
17717 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17718 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
17719 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
17720 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
17721 trapping on.
17722
17723 @item show exceptions
17724 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17725 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
17726
17727 @item set task pause
17728 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
17729 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17730 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17731 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
17732 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
17733 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
17734 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
17735 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
17736 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
17737
17738 @item show task pause
17739 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
17740 Show the current state of task suspension.
17741
17742 @item set task detach-suspend-count
17743 @cindex task suspend count
17744 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17745 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
17746 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
17747
17748 @item show task detach-suspend-count
17749 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
17750
17751 @item set task exception-port
17752 @itemx set task excp
17753 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17754 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
17755 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
17756 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
17757
17758 @item set noninvasive
17759 @cindex noninvasive task options
17760 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
17761 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
17762 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
17763 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
17764
17765 @item info send-rights
17766 @itemx info receive-rights
17767 @itemx info port-rights
17768 @itemx info port-sets
17769 @itemx info dead-names
17770 @itemx info ports
17771 @itemx info psets
17772 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17773 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17774 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17775 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17776 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17777 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
17778 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
17779 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
17780 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
17781
17782 @item set thread pause
17783 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
17784 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17785 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17786 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
17787 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
17788 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
17789 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
17790 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
17791 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
17792 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
17793 only the current thread.
17794
17795 @item show thread pause
17796 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
17797 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
17798
17799 @item set thread run
17800 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17801
17802 @item show thread run
17803 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17804
17805 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
17806 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17807 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17808 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
17809 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
17810 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
17811 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
17812
17813 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
17814 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
17815 detaching.
17816
17817 @item set thread exception-port
17818 @itemx set thread excp
17819 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
17820 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
17821 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
17822
17823 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
17824 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
17825 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
17826 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
17827
17828 @item set thread default
17829 @itemx show thread default
17830 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17831 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
17832 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
17833 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
17834 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
17835 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
17836 the non-default commands.
17837 @end table
17838
17839
17840 @node Neutrino
17841 @subsection QNX Neutrino
17842 @cindex QNX Neutrino
17843
17844 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
17845 Neutrino target:
17846
17847 @table @code
17848 @item set debug nto-debug
17849 @kindex set debug nto-debug
17850 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
17851 Neutrino support.
17852
17853 @item show debug nto-debug
17854 @kindex show debug nto-debug
17855 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
17856 @end table
17857
17858 @node Darwin
17859 @subsection Darwin
17860 @cindex Darwin
17861
17862 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
17863
17864 @table @code
17865 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
17866 @kindex set debug darwin
17867 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
17868 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
17869
17870 @item show debug darwin
17871 @kindex show debug darwin
17872 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
17873
17874 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
17875 @kindex set debug mach-o
17876 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
17877 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
17878 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
17879 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
17880 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
17881 usage.
17882
17883 @item show debug mach-o
17884 @kindex show debug mach-o
17885 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
17886
17887 @item set mach-exceptions on
17888 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
17889 @kindex set mach-exceptions
17890 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
17891 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
17892 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
17893 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
17894
17895 @item show mach-exceptions
17896 @kindex show mach-exceptions
17897 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
17898 @end table
17899
17900
17901 @node Embedded OS
17902 @section Embedded Operating Systems
17903
17904 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
17905 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
17906 architectures.
17907
17908 @menu
17909 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17910 @end menu
17911
17912 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
17913 various real-time operating systems.
17914
17915 @node VxWorks
17916 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17917
17918 @cindex VxWorks
17919
17920 @table @code
17921
17922 @kindex target vxworks
17923 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
17924 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
17925 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
17926
17927 @end table
17928
17929 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
17930 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
17931
17932 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
17933 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
17934 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
17935 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
17936 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
17937 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
17938 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
17939
17940 @table @code
17941 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
17942 @kindex vxworks-timeout
17943 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
17944 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
17945 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
17946 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
17947 of a thin network line.
17948 @end table
17949
17950 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
17951 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
17952 procedures.
17953
17954 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
17955 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
17956 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
17957 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
17958 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
17959 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
17960 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
17961 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
17962 manual.
17963 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
17964
17965 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
17966 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
17967 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
17968 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
17969
17970 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
17971
17972 @smallexample
17973 (vxgdb)
17974 @end smallexample
17975
17976 @menu
17977 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
17978 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
17979 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
17980 @end menu
17981
17982 @node VxWorks Connection
17983 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
17984
17985 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
17986 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
17987
17988 @smallexample
17989 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
17990 @end smallexample
17991
17992 @need 750
17993 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
17994
17995 @smallexample
17996 Attaching remote machine across net...
17997 Connected to tt.
17998 @end smallexample
17999
18000 @need 1000
18001 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
18002 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
18003 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
18004 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
18005 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
18006
18007 @smallexample
18008 prog.o: No such file or directory.
18009 @end smallexample
18010
18011 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
18012 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
18013 command again.
18014
18015 @node VxWorks Download
18016 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
18017
18018 @cindex download to VxWorks
18019 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
18020 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
18021 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
18022 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
18023 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
18024 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
18025 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
18026 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
18027 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
18028 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
18029 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
18030 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
18031 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
18032 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
18033 program, type this on VxWorks:
18034
18035 @smallexample
18036 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
18037 @end smallexample
18038
18039 @noindent
18040 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18041
18042 @smallexample
18043 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
18044 (vxgdb) load prog.o
18045 @end smallexample
18046
18047 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
18048
18049 @smallexample
18050 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
18051 @end smallexample
18052
18053 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
18054 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
18055 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
18056 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
18057 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
18058 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
18059 table.)
18060
18061 @node VxWorks Attach
18062 @subsubsection Running Tasks
18063
18064 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
18065 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
18066 follows:
18067
18068 @smallexample
18069 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
18070 @end smallexample
18071
18072 @noindent
18073 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
18074 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
18075 the time of attachment.
18076
18077 @node Embedded Processors
18078 @section Embedded Processors
18079
18080 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
18081 configurations.
18082
18083 @cindex send command to simulator
18084 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
18085 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
18086
18087 @table @code
18088 @item sim @var{command}
18089 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
18090 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
18091 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
18092 acceptable commands.
18093 @end table
18094
18095
18096 @menu
18097 * ARM:: ARM RDI
18098 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
18099 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
18100 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
18101 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
18102 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
18103 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
18104 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
18105 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
18106 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
18107 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
18108 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
18109 * CRIS:: CRIS
18110 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
18111 @end menu
18112
18113 @node ARM
18114 @subsection ARM
18115 @cindex ARM RDI
18116
18117 @table @code
18118 @kindex target rdi
18119 @item target rdi @var{dev}
18120 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
18121 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
18122 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
18123
18124 @kindex target rdp
18125 @item target rdp @var{dev}
18126 ARM Demon monitor.
18127
18128 @end table
18129
18130 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
18131
18132 @table @code
18133 @item set arm disassembler
18134 @kindex set arm
18135 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
18136 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
18137
18138 @item show arm disassembler
18139 @kindex show arm
18140 Show the current disassembly style.
18141
18142 @item set arm apcs32
18143 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
18144 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
18145
18146 @item show arm apcs32
18147 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
18148
18149 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
18150 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
18151 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
18152
18153 @table @code
18154 @item auto
18155 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
18156 @item softfpa
18157 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
18158 processors.
18159 @item fpa
18160 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
18161 @item softvfp
18162 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
18163 @item vfp
18164 VFP co-processor.
18165 @end table
18166
18167 @item show arm fpu
18168 Show the current type of the FPU.
18169
18170 @item set arm abi
18171 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
18172
18173 @item show arm abi
18174 Show the currently used ABI.
18175
18176 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18177 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
18178 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
18179 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
18180 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
18181 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
18182 register).
18183
18184 @item show arm fallback-mode
18185 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
18186
18187 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18188 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
18189 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
18190 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
18191 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
18192
18193 @item show arm force-mode
18194 Show the current forced instruction mode.
18195
18196 @item set debug arm
18197 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
18198 target support subsystem.
18199
18200 @item show debug arm
18201 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
18202 @end table
18203
18204 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
18205 using the RDI interface:
18206
18207 @table @code
18208 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18209 @kindex rdilogfile
18210 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
18211 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
18212 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
18213 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
18214 @file{rdi.log}.
18215
18216 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
18217 @kindex rdilogenable
18218 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
18219 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
18220 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
18221 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
18222 are logged to a file.
18223
18224 @item set rdiromatzero
18225 @kindex set rdiromatzero
18226 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
18227 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
18228 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
18229 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
18230 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
18231
18232 @item show rdiromatzero
18233 @kindex show rdiromatzero
18234 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
18235
18236 @item set rdiheartbeat
18237 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
18238 @cindex RDI heartbeat
18239 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
18240 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
18241 well as the Angel monitor.
18242
18243 @item show rdiheartbeat
18244 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
18245 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
18246 @end table
18247
18248 @table @code
18249 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18250 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
18251
18252 @table @code
18253 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
18254 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
18255 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
18256 The default value is @code{all}.
18257
18258 @table @code
18259 @item none
18260 @item demon
18261 @item angel
18262 @item redboot
18263 @item all
18264 @end table
18265 @end table
18266 @end table
18267
18268 @node M32R/D
18269 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
18270
18271 @table @code
18272 @kindex target m32r
18273 @item target m32r @var{dev}
18274 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
18275
18276 @kindex target m32rsdi
18277 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
18278 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
18279 @end table
18280
18281 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
18282
18283 @table @code
18284 @item set download-path @var{path}
18285 @kindex set download-path
18286 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
18287 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18288
18289 @item show download-path
18290 @kindex show download-path
18291 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18292
18293 @item set board-address @var{addr}
18294 @kindex set board-address
18295 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
18296 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
18297
18298 @item show board-address
18299 @kindex show board-address
18300 Show the current IP address of the target board.
18301
18302 @item set server-address @var{addr}
18303 @kindex set server-address
18304 @cindex download server address (M32R)
18305 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
18306 host machine.
18307
18308 @item show server-address
18309 @kindex show server-address
18310 Display the IP address of the download server.
18311
18312 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18313 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
18314 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
18315 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
18316 executable file is uploaded.
18317
18318 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18319 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
18320 Test the @code{upload} command.
18321 @end table
18322
18323 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
18324
18325 @table @code
18326 @item sdireset
18327 @kindex sdireset
18328 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
18329 This command resets the SDI connection.
18330
18331 @item sdistatus
18332 @kindex sdistatus
18333 This command shows the SDI connection status.
18334
18335 @item debug_chaos
18336 @kindex debug_chaos
18337 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
18338 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
18339
18340 @item use_debug_dma
18341 @kindex use_debug_dma
18342 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
18343
18344 @item use_mon_code
18345 @kindex use_mon_code
18346 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
18347
18348 @item use_ib_break
18349 @kindex use_ib_break
18350 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
18351
18352 @item use_dbt_break
18353 @kindex use_dbt_break
18354 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
18355 @end table
18356
18357 @node M68K
18358 @subsection M68k
18359
18360 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
18361 target command for the following ROM monitor.
18362
18363 @table @code
18364
18365 @kindex target dbug
18366 @item target dbug @var{dev}
18367 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
18368
18369 @end table
18370
18371 @node MicroBlaze
18372 @subsection MicroBlaze
18373 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
18374 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
18375
18376 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
18377 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
18378 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
18379 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
18380 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
18381 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
18382 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
18383 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
18384 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
18385 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
18386 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
18387
18388 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
18389
18390 @table @code
18391 @item target remote :1234
18392 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
18393 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
18394
18395 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
18396 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
18397 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
18398
18399 @item load
18400 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
18401
18402 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
18403 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
18404
18405 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
18406 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
18407 @end table
18408
18409 @node MIPS Embedded
18410 @subsection MIPS Embedded
18411
18412 @cindex MIPS boards
18413 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
18414 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
18415 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
18416
18417 @need 1000
18418 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
18419
18420 @table @code
18421 @item target mips @var{port}
18422 @kindex target mips @var{port}
18423 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
18424 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
18425 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
18426 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
18427 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
18428 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
18429
18430 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
18431 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
18432 debugger:
18433
18434 @smallexample
18435 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
18436 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
18437 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
18438 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
18439 (@value{GDBP}) run
18440 @end smallexample
18441
18442 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
18443 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
18444 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
18445 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
18446 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
18447
18448 @item target pmon @var{port}
18449 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
18450 PMON ROM monitor.
18451
18452 @item target ddb @var{port}
18453 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
18454 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
18455
18456 @item target lsi @var{port}
18457 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
18458 LSI variant of PMON.
18459
18460 @kindex target r3900
18461 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
18462 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
18463
18464 @kindex target array
18465 @item target array @var{dev}
18466 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
18467
18468 @end table
18469
18470
18471 @noindent
18472 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
18473
18474 @table @code
18475 @item set mipsfpu double
18476 @itemx set mipsfpu single
18477 @itemx set mipsfpu none
18478 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
18479 @itemx show mipsfpu
18480 @kindex set mipsfpu
18481 @kindex show mipsfpu
18482 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
18483 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
18484 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
18485 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
18486 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
18487 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
18488 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
18489 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
18490 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
18491 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
18492 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
18493 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
18494 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
18495
18496 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
18497 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
18498 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
18499
18500 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
18501 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
18502
18503 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
18504 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
18505 @itemx show timeout
18506 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
18507 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
18508 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
18509 @kindex set timeout
18510 @kindex show timeout
18511 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
18512 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
18513 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
18514 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
18515 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
18516 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
18517 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
18518 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
18519 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
18520 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
18521
18522 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
18523 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
18524 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
18525 to run before stopping.
18526
18527 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
18528 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
18529 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
18530 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
18531 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
18532 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
18533
18534 @item show syn-garbage-limit
18535 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
18536 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
18537 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
18538
18539 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
18540 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
18541 @cindex remote monitor prompt
18542 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
18543 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
18544 @table @asis
18545 @item pmon target
18546 @samp{PMON}
18547 @item ddb target
18548 @samp{NEC010}
18549 @item lsi target
18550 @samp{PMON>}
18551 @end table
18552
18553 @item show monitor-prompt
18554 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
18555 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
18556 remote monitor.
18557
18558 @item set monitor-warnings
18559 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
18560 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
18561 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
18562 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
18563 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
18564
18565 @item show monitor-warnings
18566 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
18567 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
18568
18569 @item pmon @var{command}
18570 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
18571 @cindex send PMON command
18572 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
18573 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
18574 @end table
18575
18576 @node OpenRISC 1000
18577 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
18578 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
18579
18580 @cindex or1k boards
18581 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
18582 about platform and commands.
18583
18584 @table @code
18585
18586 @kindex target jtag
18587 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
18588
18589 Connects to remote JTAG server.
18590 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
18591 connected via parallel port to the board.
18592
18593 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
18594
18595 @kindex or1ksim
18596 @item or1ksim @var{command}
18597 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
18598 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
18599
18600 @kindex info or1k spr
18601 @item info or1k spr
18602 Displays spr groups.
18603
18604 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
18605 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
18606 Displays register names in selected group.
18607
18608 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
18609 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
18610 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
18611 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
18612 Shows information about specified spr register.
18613
18614 @kindex spr
18615 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
18616 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
18617 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
18618 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
18619 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
18620 @end table
18621
18622 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
18623 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
18624 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
18625 triggers can be set using:
18626 @table @code
18627 @item $LEA/$LDATA
18628 Load effective address/data
18629 @item $SEA/$SDATA
18630 Store effective address/data
18631 @item $AEA/$ADATA
18632 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
18633 @item $FETCH
18634 Fetch data
18635 @end table
18636
18637 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
18638 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
18639
18640 @code{htrace} commands:
18641 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
18642 @table @code
18643 @kindex hwatch
18644 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
18645 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
18646 or Data. For example:
18647
18648 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18649
18650 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18651
18652 @kindex htrace
18653 @item htrace info
18654 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
18655
18656 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
18657 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
18658
18659 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
18660 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
18661
18662 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
18663 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
18664
18665 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
18666 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
18667 triggered.
18668
18669 @item htrace enable
18670 @itemx htrace disable
18671 Enables/disables the HW trace.
18672
18673 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
18674 Clears currently recorded trace data.
18675
18676 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
18677 will be written there.
18678
18679 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
18680 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
18681
18682 @item htrace mode continuous
18683 Set continuous trace mode.
18684
18685 @item htrace mode suspend
18686 Set suspend trace mode.
18687
18688 @end table
18689
18690 @node PowerPC Embedded
18691 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
18692
18693 @cindex DVC register
18694 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
18695 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
18696
18697 @smallexample
18698 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
18699 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
18700 @end smallexample
18701
18702 The DVC register will be automatically used whenever @value{GDBN} detects
18703 such pattern in a condition expression. This feature is available in native
18704 @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34 or newer.
18705
18706 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
18707
18708 @table @code
18709 @kindex set powerpc
18710 @item set powerpc soft-float
18711 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
18712 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
18713 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
18714 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18715
18716 @item set powerpc vector-abi
18717 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
18718 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
18719 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
18720 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
18721 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
18722 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
18723 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18724
18725 @kindex target dink32
18726 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
18727 DINK32 ROM monitor.
18728
18729 @kindex target ppcbug
18730 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
18731 @kindex target ppcbug1
18732 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
18733 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
18734
18735 @kindex target sds
18736 @item target sds @var{dev}
18737 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
18738 @end table
18739
18740 @cindex SDS protocol
18741 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
18742 by @value{GDBN}:
18743
18744 @table @code
18745 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
18746 @kindex set sdstimeout
18747 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
18748 default is 2 seconds.
18749
18750 @item show sdstimeout
18751 @kindex show sdstimeout
18752 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
18753
18754 @item sds @var{command}
18755 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
18756 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
18757 @end table
18758
18759
18760 @node PA
18761 @subsection HP PA Embedded
18762
18763 @table @code
18764
18765 @kindex target op50n
18766 @item target op50n @var{dev}
18767 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
18768
18769 @kindex target w89k
18770 @item target w89k @var{dev}
18771 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
18772
18773 @end table
18774
18775 @node Sparclet
18776 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
18777
18778 @cindex Sparclet
18779
18780 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
18781 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
18782 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
18783 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
18784 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
18785
18786 @table @code
18787 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
18788 @kindex remotetimeout
18789 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
18790 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
18791 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
18792 @end table
18793
18794 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
18795 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
18796 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
18797 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
18798 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
18799
18800 @smallexample
18801 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
18802 @end smallexample
18803
18804 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
18805
18806 @smallexample
18807 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
18808 @end smallexample
18809
18810 @cindex running, on Sparclet
18811 Once you have set
18812 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
18813 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
18814 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
18815
18816 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
18817
18818 @smallexample
18819 (gdbslet)
18820 @end smallexample
18821
18822 @menu
18823 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
18824 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
18825 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
18826 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
18827 @end menu
18828
18829 @node Sparclet File
18830 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
18831
18832 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
18833
18834 @smallexample
18835 (gdbslet) file prog
18836 @end smallexample
18837
18838 @need 1000
18839 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
18840 @value{GDBN} locates
18841 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
18842 path.
18843 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
18844 files will be searched as well.
18845 @value{GDBN} locates
18846 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
18847 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
18848 If it fails
18849 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
18850
18851 @smallexample
18852 prog: No such file or directory.
18853 @end smallexample
18854
18855 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
18856 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
18857 @code{target} command again.
18858
18859 @node Sparclet Connection
18860 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
18861
18862 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
18863 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
18864
18865 @smallexample
18866 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
18867 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
18868 main () at ../prog.c:3
18869 @end smallexample
18870
18871 @need 750
18872 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
18873
18874 @smallexample
18875 Connected to ttya.
18876 @end smallexample
18877
18878 @node Sparclet Download
18879 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
18880
18881 @cindex download to Sparclet
18882 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
18883 you can use the @value{GDBN}
18884 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
18885 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
18886 command.
18887 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
18888 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
18889 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
18890 of each of the file's sections.
18891 For instance, if the program
18892 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
18893 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18894
18895 @smallexample
18896 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
18897 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
18898 @end smallexample
18899
18900 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
18901 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
18902 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
18903
18904 @node Sparclet Execution
18905 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
18906
18907 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
18908 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
18909 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
18910 manual for the list of commands.
18911
18912 @smallexample
18913 (gdbslet) b main
18914 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
18915 (gdbslet) run
18916 Starting program: prog
18917 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
18918 3 char *symarg = 0;
18919 (gdbslet) step
18920 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
18921 (gdbslet)
18922 @end smallexample
18923
18924 @node Sparclite
18925 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
18926
18927 @table @code
18928
18929 @kindex target sparclite
18930 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
18931 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
18932 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
18933 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
18934 remote protocol.
18935
18936 @end table
18937
18938 @node Z8000
18939 @subsection Zilog Z8000
18940
18941 @cindex Z8000
18942 @cindex simulator, Z8000
18943 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
18944
18945 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
18946 a Z8000 simulator.
18947
18948 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
18949 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
18950 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
18951 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
18952
18953 @table @code
18954 @item target sim @var{args}
18955 @kindex sim
18956 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
18957 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
18958 options, specify them via @var{args}.
18959 @end table
18960
18961 @noindent
18962 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
18963 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
18964 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
18965 to run your program, and so on.
18966
18967 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
18968 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
18969 additional items of information as specially named registers:
18970
18971 @table @code
18972
18973 @item cycles
18974 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
18975
18976 @item insts
18977 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
18978
18979 @item time
18980 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
18981
18982 @end table
18983
18984 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
18985 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
18986 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
18987 simulated clock ticks.
18988
18989 @node AVR
18990 @subsection Atmel AVR
18991 @cindex AVR
18992
18993 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
18994 following AVR-specific commands:
18995
18996 @table @code
18997 @item info io_registers
18998 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
18999 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
19000 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
19001 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
19002 @end table
19003
19004 @node CRIS
19005 @subsection CRIS
19006 @cindex CRIS
19007
19008 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
19009 following CRIS-specific commands:
19010
19011 @table @code
19012 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
19013 @cindex CRIS version
19014 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
19015 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
19016 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
19017
19018 @item show cris-version
19019 Show the current CRIS version.
19020
19021 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
19022 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
19023 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
19024 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
19025 @code{R59}.
19026
19027 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
19028 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
19029
19030 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
19031 @cindex CRIS mode
19032 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
19033 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
19034 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
19035
19036 @item show cris-mode
19037 Show the current CRIS mode.
19038 @end table
19039
19040 @node Super-H
19041 @subsection Renesas Super-H
19042 @cindex Super-H
19043
19044 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
19045 commands:
19046
19047 @table @code
19048 @item regs
19049 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
19050 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
19051
19052 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
19053 @kindex set sh calling-convention
19054 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
19055 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
19056 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
19057 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
19058 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
19059 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
19060 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
19061 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
19062 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
19063 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
19064
19065 @item show sh calling-convention
19066 @kindex show sh calling-convention
19067 Show the current calling convention setting.
19068
19069 @end table
19070
19071
19072 @node Architectures
19073 @section Architectures
19074
19075 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
19076 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
19077
19078 @menu
19079 * i386::
19080 * A29K::
19081 * Alpha::
19082 * MIPS::
19083 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
19084 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19085 * PowerPC::
19086 @end menu
19087
19088 @node i386
19089 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
19090
19091 @table @code
19092 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
19093 @kindex set struct-convention
19094 @cindex struct return convention
19095 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
19096 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
19097 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
19098 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
19099 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
19100 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
19101 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
19102 be returned in a register.
19103
19104 @item show struct-convention
19105 @kindex show struct-convention
19106 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
19107 from functions.
19108 @end table
19109
19110 @node A29K
19111 @subsection A29K
19112
19113 @table @code
19114
19115 @kindex set rstack_high_address
19116 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
19117 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
19118 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
19119 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
19120 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
19121 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
19122 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
19123 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
19124 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
19125 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
19126 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
19127 hexadecimal.
19128
19129 @kindex show rstack_high_address
19130 @item show rstack_high_address
19131 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
19132 processors.
19133
19134 @end table
19135
19136 @node Alpha
19137 @subsection Alpha
19138
19139 See the following section.
19140
19141 @node MIPS
19142 @subsection MIPS
19143
19144 @cindex stack on Alpha
19145 @cindex stack on MIPS
19146 @cindex Alpha stack
19147 @cindex MIPS stack
19148 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
19149 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
19150 find the beginning of a function.
19151
19152 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
19153 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
19154 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
19155 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
19156 commands:
19157
19158 @table @code
19159 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
19160 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
19161 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
19162 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
19163 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
19164 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
19165 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
19166 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
19167
19168 @item show heuristic-fence-post
19169 Display the current limit.
19170 @end table
19171
19172 @noindent
19173 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
19174 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
19175
19176 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
19177 programs:
19178
19179 @table @code
19180 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
19181 @kindex set mips abi
19182 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
19183 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
19184 values of @var{arg} are:
19185
19186 @table @samp
19187 @item auto
19188 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
19189 default).
19190 @item o32
19191 @item o64
19192 @item n32
19193 @item n64
19194 @item eabi32
19195 @item eabi64
19196 @item auto
19197 @end table
19198
19199 @item show mips abi
19200 @kindex show mips abi
19201 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
19202
19203 @item set mipsfpu
19204 @itemx show mipsfpu
19205 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
19206
19207 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
19208 @kindex set mips mask-address
19209 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
19210 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
19211 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
19212 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
19213 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
19214
19215 @item show mips mask-address
19216 @kindex show mips mask-address
19217 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
19218 not.
19219
19220 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19221 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19222 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
19223 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
19224 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
19225 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
19226
19227 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19228 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19229 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
19230
19231 @item set debug mips
19232 @kindex set debug mips
19233 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
19234 target code in @value{GDBN}.
19235
19236 @item show debug mips
19237 @kindex show debug mips
19238 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
19239 @end table
19240
19241
19242 @node HPPA
19243 @subsection HPPA
19244 @cindex HPPA support
19245
19246 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
19247 following special commands:
19248
19249 @table @code
19250 @item set debug hppa
19251 @kindex set debug hppa
19252 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
19253 messages are to be displayed.
19254
19255 @item show debug hppa
19256 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
19257
19258 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
19259 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
19260 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
19261 given @var{address}.
19262
19263 @end table
19264
19265
19266 @node SPU
19267 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19268 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
19269 @cindex SPU
19270
19271 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
19272 it provides the following special commands:
19273
19274 @table @code
19275 @item info spu event
19276 @kindex info spu
19277 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
19278 and pending event status.
19279
19280 @item info spu signal
19281 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
19282 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
19283 notification channels.
19284
19285 @item info spu mailbox
19286 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
19287 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
19288 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
19289
19290 @item info spu dma
19291 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19292 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19293 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19294
19295 @item info spu proxydma
19296 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19297 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19298 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19299
19300 @end table
19301
19302 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
19303 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
19304 special commands:
19305
19306 @table @code
19307 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
19308 @kindex set spu
19309 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
19310 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
19311 function. The default is @code{off}.
19312
19313 @item show spu stop-on-load
19314 @kindex show spu
19315 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
19316
19317 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
19318 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
19319 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
19320 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
19321 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
19322 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
19323
19324 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
19325 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
19326
19327 @end table
19328
19329 @node PowerPC
19330 @subsection PowerPC
19331 @cindex PowerPC architecture
19332
19333 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
19334 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
19335 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
19336 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
19337 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
19338
19339 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
19340 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
19341 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
19342
19343 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
19344 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
19345
19346
19347 @node Controlling GDB
19348 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
19349
19350 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
19351 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
19352 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
19353 described here.
19354
19355 @menu
19356 * Prompt:: Prompt
19357 * Editing:: Command editing
19358 * Command History:: Command history
19359 * Screen Size:: Screen size
19360 * Numbers:: Numbers
19361 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
19362 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
19363 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
19364 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
19365 @end menu
19366
19367 @node Prompt
19368 @section Prompt
19369
19370 @cindex prompt
19371
19372 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
19373 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
19374 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
19375 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
19376 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
19377 which one you are talking to.
19378
19379 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
19380 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
19381 or a prompt that does not.
19382
19383 @table @code
19384 @kindex set prompt
19385 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
19386 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
19387
19388 @kindex show prompt
19389 @item show prompt
19390 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
19391 @end table
19392
19393 @node Editing
19394 @section Command Editing
19395 @cindex readline
19396 @cindex command line editing
19397
19398 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
19399 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
19400 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
19401 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
19402 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
19403 debugging sessions.
19404
19405 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
19406 command @code{set}.
19407
19408 @table @code
19409 @kindex set editing
19410 @cindex editing
19411 @item set editing
19412 @itemx set editing on
19413 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
19414
19415 @item set editing off
19416 Disable command line editing.
19417
19418 @kindex show editing
19419 @item show editing
19420 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
19421 @end table
19422
19423 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19424 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
19425 @end ifset
19426 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19427 @xref{Command Line Editing},
19428 @end ifclear
19429 for more details about the Readline
19430 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
19431 encouraged to read that chapter.
19432
19433 @node Command History
19434 @section Command History
19435 @cindex command history
19436
19437 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
19438 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
19439 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
19440 history facility.
19441
19442 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
19443 package, to provide the history facility.
19444 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19445 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
19446 @end ifset
19447 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19448 @xref{Using History Interactively},
19449 @end ifclear
19450 for the detailed description of the History library.
19451
19452 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
19453 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
19454 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
19455 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
19456 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
19457 pressed on a line by itself.
19458
19459 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
19460 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
19461 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
19462 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
19463
19464 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
19465 history.
19466
19467 @table @code
19468 @cindex history substitution
19469 @cindex history file
19470 @kindex set history filename
19471 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
19472 @item set history filename @var{fname}
19473 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
19474 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
19475 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
19476 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
19477 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
19478 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
19479 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
19480 is not set.
19481
19482 @cindex save command history
19483 @kindex set history save
19484 @item set history save
19485 @itemx set history save on
19486 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
19487 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
19488
19489 @item set history save off
19490 Stop recording command history in a file.
19491
19492 @cindex history size
19493 @kindex set history size
19494 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
19495 @item set history size @var{size}
19496 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
19497 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
19498 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
19499 @end table
19500
19501 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
19502 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19503 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
19504 @end ifset
19505 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19506 @xref{Event Designators},
19507 @end ifclear
19508 for more details.
19509
19510 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
19511 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
19512 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
19513 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
19514 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
19515 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
19516 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
19517 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
19518
19519 The commands to control history expansion are:
19520
19521 @table @code
19522 @item set history expansion on
19523 @itemx set history expansion
19524 @kindex set history expansion
19525 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
19526
19527 @item set history expansion off
19528 Disable history expansion.
19529
19530 @c @group
19531 @kindex show history
19532 @item show history
19533 @itemx show history filename
19534 @itemx show history save
19535 @itemx show history size
19536 @itemx show history expansion
19537 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
19538 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
19539 @c @end group
19540 @end table
19541
19542 @table @code
19543 @kindex show commands
19544 @cindex show last commands
19545 @cindex display command history
19546 @item show commands
19547 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
19548
19549 @item show commands @var{n}
19550 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
19551
19552 @item show commands +
19553 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
19554 @end table
19555
19556 @node Screen Size
19557 @section Screen Size
19558 @cindex size of screen
19559 @cindex pauses in output
19560
19561 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
19562 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
19563 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
19564 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
19565 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
19566 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
19567 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
19568 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
19569
19570 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
19571 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
19572 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
19573 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
19574 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
19575 width} commands:
19576
19577 @table @code
19578 @kindex set height
19579 @kindex set width
19580 @kindex show width
19581 @kindex show height
19582 @item set height @var{lpp}
19583 @itemx show height
19584 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
19585 @itemx show width
19586 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
19587 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
19588 commands display the current settings.
19589
19590 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
19591 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
19592 file or to an editor buffer.
19593
19594 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
19595 from wrapping its output.
19596
19597 @item set pagination on
19598 @itemx set pagination off
19599 @kindex set pagination
19600 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
19601 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}. Note that
19602 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
19603 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
19604
19605 @item show pagination
19606 @kindex show pagination
19607 Show the current pagination mode.
19608 @end table
19609
19610 @node Numbers
19611 @section Numbers
19612 @cindex number representation
19613 @cindex entering numbers
19614
19615 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
19616 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
19617 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
19618 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
19619 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
19620 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
19621 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
19622 both input and output with the commands described below.
19623
19624 @table @code
19625 @kindex set input-radix
19626 @item set input-radix @var{base}
19627 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
19628 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
19629 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
19630 example, any of
19631
19632 @smallexample
19633 set input-radix 012
19634 set input-radix 10.
19635 set input-radix 0xa
19636 @end smallexample
19637
19638 @noindent
19639 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
19640 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
19641 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
19642 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
19643 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
19644 change the radix.
19645
19646 @kindex set output-radix
19647 @item set output-radix @var{base}
19648 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
19649 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
19650 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
19651
19652 @kindex show input-radix
19653 @item show input-radix
19654 Display the current default base for numeric input.
19655
19656 @kindex show output-radix
19657 @item show output-radix
19658 Display the current default base for numeric display.
19659
19660 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
19661 @itemx show radix
19662 @kindex set radix
19663 @kindex show radix
19664 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
19665 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
19666 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
19667 default value of 10.
19668
19669 @end table
19670
19671 @node ABI
19672 @section Configuring the Current ABI
19673
19674 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
19675 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
19676 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
19677 current ABI.
19678
19679 @cindex OS ABI
19680 @kindex set osabi
19681 @kindex show osabi
19682
19683 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
19684 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
19685 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
19686 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
19687 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
19688 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
19689 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
19690 platform provides.
19691
19692 @table @code
19693 @item show osabi
19694 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
19695
19696 @item set osabi
19697 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
19698
19699 @item set osabi @var{abi}
19700 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
19701 @end table
19702
19703 @cindex float promotion
19704
19705 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
19706 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
19707 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
19708 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
19709 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
19710 @code{double} and then passed.
19711
19712 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
19713 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
19714 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
19715
19716 @table @code
19717 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
19718 @item set coerce-float-to-double
19719 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
19720 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
19721 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
19722
19723 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
19724 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
19725 functions.
19726
19727 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
19728 @item show coerce-float-to-double
19729 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
19730 @end table
19731
19732 @kindex set cp-abi
19733 @kindex show cp-abi
19734 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
19735 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
19736 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
19737 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
19738 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
19739 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
19740 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
19741 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
19742 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
19743 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
19744 ``auto''.
19745
19746 @table @code
19747 @item show cp-abi
19748 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
19749
19750 @item set cp-abi
19751 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
19752
19753 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
19754 @itemx set cp-abi auto
19755 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
19756 @end table
19757
19758 @node Messages/Warnings
19759 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
19760
19761 @cindex verbose operation
19762 @cindex optional warnings
19763 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
19764 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
19765 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
19766 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
19767
19768 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
19769 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
19770 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
19771
19772 @table @code
19773 @kindex set verbose
19774 @item set verbose on
19775 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19776
19777 @item set verbose off
19778 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19779
19780 @kindex show verbose
19781 @item show verbose
19782 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
19783 @end table
19784
19785 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
19786 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
19787 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
19788 Symbol Files}).
19789
19790 @table @code
19791
19792 @kindex set complaints
19793 @item set complaints @var{limit}
19794 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
19795 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
19796 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
19797 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
19798
19799 @kindex show complaints
19800 @item show complaints
19801 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
19802
19803 @end table
19804
19805 @anchor{confirmation requests}
19806 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
19807 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
19808 you try to run a program which is already running:
19809
19810 @smallexample
19811 (@value{GDBP}) run
19812 The program being debugged has been started already.
19813 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
19814 @end smallexample
19815
19816 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
19817 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
19818
19819 @table @code
19820
19821 @kindex set confirm
19822 @cindex flinching
19823 @cindex confirmation
19824 @cindex stupid questions
19825 @item set confirm off
19826 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
19827 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
19828 automatically disables confirmation requests.
19829
19830 @item set confirm on
19831 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
19832
19833 @kindex show confirm
19834 @item show confirm
19835 Displays state of confirmation requests.
19836
19837 @end table
19838
19839 @cindex command tracing
19840 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
19841 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
19842 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
19843 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
19844
19845 @table @code
19846 @kindex set trace-commands
19847 @cindex command scripts, debugging
19848 @item set trace-commands on
19849 Enable command tracing.
19850 @item set trace-commands off
19851 Disable command tracing.
19852 @item show trace-commands
19853 Display the current state of command tracing.
19854 @end table
19855
19856 @node Debugging Output
19857 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
19858 @cindex optional debugging messages
19859
19860 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
19861 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
19862 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
19863 section documents those commands.
19864
19865 @table @code
19866 @kindex set exec-done-display
19867 @item set exec-done-display
19868 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
19869 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
19870 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
19871 @kindex show exec-done-display
19872 @item show exec-done-display
19873 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
19874 notification.
19875 @kindex set debug
19876 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
19877 @cindex architecture debugging info
19878 @item set debug arch
19879 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
19880 @kindex show debug
19881 @item show debug arch
19882 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
19883 @item set debug aix-thread
19884 @cindex AIX threads
19885 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
19886 module.
19887 @item show debug aix-thread
19888 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
19889 @item set debug dwarf2-die
19890 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
19891 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
19892 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
19893 A value of zero turns off the display.
19894 @item show debug dwarf2-die
19895 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
19896 @item set debug displaced
19897 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
19898 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
19899 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
19900 @item show debug displaced
19901 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
19902 related to displaced stepping.
19903 @item set debug event
19904 @cindex event debugging info
19905 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
19906 default is off.
19907 @item show debug event
19908 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
19909 info.
19910 @item set debug expression
19911 @cindex expression debugging info
19912 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
19913 expression parsing. The default is off.
19914 @item show debug expression
19915 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
19916 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
19917 @item set debug frame
19918 @cindex frame debugging info
19919 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
19920 default is off.
19921 @item show debug frame
19922 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
19923 info.
19924 @item set debug gnu-nat
19925 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
19926 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
19927 @item show debug gnu-nat
19928 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
19929 @item set debug infrun
19930 @cindex inferior debugging info
19931 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
19932 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
19933 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
19934 @item show debug infrun
19935 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
19936 @item set debug lin-lwp
19937 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
19938 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
19939 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
19940 @item show debug lin-lwp
19941 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
19942 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
19943 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
19944 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
19945 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
19946 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
19947 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
19948 @item set debug observer
19949 @cindex observer debugging info
19950 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
19951 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
19952 @item show debug observer
19953 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
19954 @item set debug overload
19955 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
19956 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
19957 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
19958 is off.
19959 @item show debug overload
19960 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
19961 debugging info.
19962 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
19963 @cindex debug expression parser
19964 @item set debug parser
19965 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
19966 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
19967 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
19968 details. The default is off.
19969 @item show debug parser
19970 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
19971 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
19972 @cindex serial connections, debugging
19973 @cindex debug remote protocol
19974 @cindex remote protocol debugging
19975 @cindex display remote packets
19976 @item set debug remote
19977 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
19978 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
19979 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
19980 @item show debug remote
19981 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
19982 @item set debug serial
19983 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
19984 default is off.
19985 @item show debug serial
19986 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
19987 info.
19988 @item set debug solib-frv
19989 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
19990 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
19991 @item show debug solib-frv
19992 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
19993 messages.
19994 @item set debug target
19995 @cindex target debugging info
19996 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
19997 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
19998 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
19999 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
20000 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
20001 @item show debug target
20002 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
20003 info.
20004 @item set debug timestamp
20005 @cindex timestampping debugging info
20006 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
20007 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
20008 message.
20009 @item show debug timestamp
20010 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
20011 debugging info.
20012 @item set debugvarobj
20013 @cindex variable object debugging info
20014 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
20015 info. The default is off.
20016 @item show debugvarobj
20017 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
20018 debugging info.
20019 @item set debug xml
20020 @cindex XML parser debugging
20021 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
20022 @item show debug xml
20023 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
20024 @end table
20025
20026 @node Other Misc Settings
20027 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
20028 @cindex miscellaneous settings
20029
20030 @table @code
20031 @kindex set interactive-mode
20032 @item set interactive-mode
20033 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate interactively.
20034 If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate non-interactively,
20035 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} guesses which mode to use,
20036 based on whether the debugger was started in a terminal or not.
20037
20038 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
20039 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
20040 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
20041 inside a cygwin window.
20042
20043 @kindex show interactive-mode
20044 @item show interactive-mode
20045 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
20046 @end table
20047
20048 @node Extending GDB
20049 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
20050 @cindex extending GDB
20051
20052 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
20053 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
20054 Python scripting language.
20055
20056 To facilitate the use of these extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable
20057 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
20058 can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at
20059 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
20060 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20061 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
20062
20063 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
20064 setting:
20065
20066 @table @code
20067 @kindex set script-extension
20068 @kindex show script-extension
20069 @item set script-extension off
20070 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20071
20072 @item set script-extension soft
20073 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20074 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
20075 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
20076 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
20077
20078 @item set script-extension strict
20079 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20080 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
20081 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
20082
20083 @item show script-extension
20084 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
20085
20086 @end table
20087
20088 @menu
20089 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
20090 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20091 @end menu
20092
20093 @node Sequences
20094 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
20095
20096 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
20097 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
20098 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
20099 files.
20100
20101 @menu
20102 * Define:: How to define your own commands
20103 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
20104 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
20105 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
20106 @end menu
20107
20108 @node Define
20109 @subsection User-defined Commands
20110
20111 @cindex user-defined command
20112 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
20113 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
20114 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
20115 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
20116 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
20117 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
20118
20119 @smallexample
20120 define adder
20121 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20122 end
20123 @end smallexample
20124
20125 @noindent
20126 To execute the command use:
20127
20128 @smallexample
20129 adder 1 2 3
20130 @end smallexample
20131
20132 @noindent
20133 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
20134 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
20135 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
20136 functions calls.
20137
20138 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
20139 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
20140 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
20141 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
20142
20143 @smallexample
20144 define adder
20145 if $argc == 2
20146 print $arg0 + $arg1
20147 end
20148 if $argc == 3
20149 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20150 end
20151 end
20152 @end smallexample
20153
20154 @table @code
20155
20156 @kindex define
20157 @item define @var{commandname}
20158 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
20159 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
20160 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
20161 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
20162 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
20163 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
20164
20165 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
20166 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
20167 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20168
20169 @kindex document
20170 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
20171 @item document @var{commandname}
20172 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
20173 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
20174 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
20175 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
20176 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
20177 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
20178
20179 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
20180 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
20181 does not change the documentation.
20182
20183 @kindex dont-repeat
20184 @cindex don't repeat command
20185 @item dont-repeat
20186 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
20187 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
20188 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
20189
20190 @kindex help user-defined
20191 @item help user-defined
20192 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
20193 (if any) for each.
20194
20195 @kindex show user
20196 @item show user
20197 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
20198 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
20199 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
20200 definitions for all user-defined commands.
20201
20202 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
20203 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
20204 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
20205 @item show max-user-call-depth
20206 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
20207 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
20208 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
20209 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20210 @end table
20211
20212 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
20213 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
20214
20215 When user-defined commands are executed, the
20216 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
20217 stops execution of the user-defined command.
20218
20219 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
20220 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
20221 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
20222 messages when used in a user-defined command.
20223
20224 @node Hooks
20225 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
20226 @cindex command hooks
20227 @cindex hooks, for commands
20228 @cindex hooks, pre-command
20229
20230 @kindex hook
20231 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
20232 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
20233 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
20234 before that command.
20235
20236 @cindex hooks, post-command
20237 @kindex hookpost
20238 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
20239 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
20240 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
20241 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
20242 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
20243
20244 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
20245 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
20246
20247 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
20248 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
20249
20250 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
20251 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
20252 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
20253 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
20254 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
20255
20256 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
20257 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
20258 you could define:
20259
20260 @smallexample
20261 define hook-stop
20262 handle SIGALRM nopass
20263 end
20264
20265 define hook-run
20266 handle SIGALRM pass
20267 end
20268
20269 define hook-continue
20270 handle SIGALRM pass
20271 end
20272 @end smallexample
20273
20274 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
20275 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
20276 you could define:
20277
20278 @smallexample
20279 define hook-echo
20280 echo <<<---
20281 end
20282
20283 define hookpost-echo
20284 echo --->>>\n
20285 end
20286
20287 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
20288 <<<---Hello World--->>>
20289 (@value{GDBP})
20290
20291 @end smallexample
20292
20293 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
20294 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
20295 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
20296 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
20297 @c or not?
20298 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
20299 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
20300 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
20301
20302 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
20303 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
20304 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
20305
20306 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
20307 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
20308
20309 @node Command Files
20310 @subsection Command Files
20311
20312 @cindex command files
20313 @cindex scripting commands
20314 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
20315 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
20316 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
20317 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
20318 terminal.
20319
20320 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
20321 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
20322 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
20323 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
20324 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
20325
20326 @table @code
20327 @kindex source
20328 @cindex execute commands from a file
20329 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
20330 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
20331 @end table
20332
20333 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
20334 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
20335 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
20336 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
20337 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
20338
20339 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
20340 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
20341 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
20342 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
20343 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
20344 is not relevant to scripts.
20345
20346 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
20347 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
20348 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
20349 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
20350 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
20351 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
20352 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
20353 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
20354 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
20355 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
20356 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
20357 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
20358 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
20359 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
20360
20361 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
20362 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
20363 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
20364
20365 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
20366 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
20367 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
20368 when called from command files.
20369
20370 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
20371 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
20372 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
20373 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
20374 the next command.
20375
20376 @smallexample
20377 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
20378 @end smallexample
20379
20380 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
20381 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
20382 would be directed to @file{log}.
20383
20384 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
20385 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
20386 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
20387 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
20388 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
20389 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
20390 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
20391 conditionally, etc.
20392
20393 @table @code
20394 @kindex if
20395 @kindex else
20396 @item if
20397 @itemx else
20398 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
20399 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
20400 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
20401 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
20402 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
20403 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
20404 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20405
20406 @kindex while
20407 @item while
20408 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
20409 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
20410 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
20411 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
20412 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
20413 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
20414
20415 @kindex loop_break
20416 @item loop_break
20417 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
20418 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
20419 line.
20420
20421 @kindex loop_continue
20422 @item loop_continue
20423 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
20424 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
20425 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
20426 the controlling expression.
20427
20428 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
20429 @item end
20430 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
20431 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
20432 @end table
20433
20434
20435 @node Output
20436 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
20437
20438 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
20439 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
20440 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
20441 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
20442 want.
20443
20444 @table @code
20445 @kindex echo
20446 @item echo @var{text}
20447 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
20448 @c because it is not in ANSI.
20449 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
20450 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
20451 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
20452 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
20453 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
20454 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
20455 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
20456 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
20457 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
20458
20459 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
20460 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
20461
20462 @smallexample
20463 echo This is some text\n\
20464 which is continued\n\
20465 onto several lines.\n
20466 @end smallexample
20467
20468 produces the same output as
20469
20470 @smallexample
20471 echo This is some text\n
20472 echo which is continued\n
20473 echo onto several lines.\n
20474 @end smallexample
20475
20476 @kindex output
20477 @item output @var{expression}
20478 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
20479 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
20480 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
20481 on expressions.
20482
20483 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
20484 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
20485 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
20486 Formats}, for more information.
20487
20488 @kindex printf
20489 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
20490 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
20491 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
20492 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
20493 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
20494 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
20495 executing the code below:
20496
20497 @smallexample
20498 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
20499 @end smallexample
20500
20501 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
20502 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
20503 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
20504 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
20505 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
20506 printed.
20507
20508 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
20509
20510 @smallexample
20511 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
20512 @end smallexample
20513
20514 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
20515 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
20516 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
20517
20518 @itemize @bullet
20519 @item
20520 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
20521
20522 @item
20523 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
20524 width.
20525
20526 @item
20527 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
20528 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
20529
20530 @item
20531 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
20532 supported.
20533
20534 @item
20535 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
20536
20537 @item
20538 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
20539 @end itemize
20540
20541 @noindent
20542 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
20543 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
20544 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
20545 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
20546
20547 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
20548 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
20549 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
20550 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
20551 supported.
20552
20553 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
20554 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
20555 together with a floating point specifier.
20556 letters:
20557
20558 @itemize @bullet
20559 @item
20560 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
20561
20562 @item
20563 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
20564
20565 @item
20566 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
20567 @end itemize
20568
20569 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
20570 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
20571 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
20572
20573 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
20574 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
20575
20576 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
20577 @smallexample
20578 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
20579 @end smallexample
20580
20581 @kindex eval
20582 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
20583 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
20584 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
20585
20586 @end table
20587
20588 @node Python
20589 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20590 @cindex python scripting
20591 @cindex scripting with python
20592
20593 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
20594 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
20595 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
20596
20597 @cindex python directory
20598 Python scripts used by @value{GDBN} should be installed in
20599 @file{@var{data-directory}/python}, where @var{data-directory} is
20600 the data directory as determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).
20601 This directory, known as the @dfn{python directory},
20602 is automatically added to the Python Search Path in order to allow
20603 the Python interpreter to locate all scripts installed at this location.
20604
20605 @menu
20606 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
20607 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
20608 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
20609 * Python modules:: Python modules provided by @value{GDBN}.
20610 @end menu
20611
20612 @node Python Commands
20613 @subsection Python Commands
20614 @cindex python commands
20615 @cindex commands to access python
20616
20617 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
20618 and one related setting:
20619
20620 @table @code
20621 @kindex python
20622 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
20623 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
20624
20625 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
20626 argument as a Python command. For example:
20627
20628 @smallexample
20629 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
20630 23
20631 @end smallexample
20632
20633 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
20634 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
20635 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
20636 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
20637 containing @code{end}. For example:
20638
20639 @smallexample
20640 (@value{GDBP}) python
20641 Type python script
20642 End with a line saying just "end".
20643 >print 23
20644 >end
20645 23
20646 @end smallexample
20647
20648 @kindex maint set python print-stack
20649 @item maint set python print-stack
20650 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
20651 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
20652 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
20653 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
20654 disabled.
20655 @end table
20656
20657 It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
20658 interpreter:
20659
20660 @table @code
20661 @item source @file{script-name}
20662 The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
20663 to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
20664 the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
20665
20666 @item python execfile ("script-name")
20667 This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
20668 and thus is always available.
20669 @end table
20670
20671 @node Python API
20672 @subsection Python API
20673 @cindex python api
20674 @cindex programming in python
20675
20676 @cindex python stdout
20677 @cindex python pagination
20678 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
20679 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
20680 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
20681 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
20682 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
20683
20684 @menu
20685 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
20686 * Exception Handling::
20687 * Values From Inferior::
20688 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
20689 * Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
20690 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
20691 * Writing a Pretty-Printer:: Writing a Pretty-Printer.
20692 * Inferiors In Python:: Python representation of inferiors (processes)
20693 * Threads In Python:: Accessing inferior threads from Python.
20694 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
20695 * Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
20696 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
20697 * Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
20698 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
20699 * Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
20700 * Blocks In Python:: Accessing frame blocks from Python.
20701 * Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
20702 * Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
20703 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
20704 * Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
20705 @end menu
20706
20707 @node Basic Python
20708 @subsubsection Basic Python
20709
20710 @cindex python functions
20711 @cindex python module
20712 @cindex gdb module
20713 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
20714 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
20715 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
20716 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
20717
20718 @findex gdb.PYTHONDIR
20719 @defvar PYTHONDIR
20720 A string containing the python directory (@pxref{Python}).
20721 @end defvar
20722
20723 @findex gdb.execute
20724 @defun execute command [from_tty] [to_string]
20725 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
20726 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
20727 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
20728
20729 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
20730 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
20731 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
20732
20733 By default, any output produced by @var{command} is sent to
20734 @value{GDBN}'s standard output. If the @var{to_string} parameter is
20735 @code{True}, then output will be collected by @code{gdb.execute} and
20736 returned as a string. The default is @code{False}, in which case the
20737 return value is @code{None}. If @var{to_string} is @code{True}, the
20738 @value{GDBN} virtual terminal will be temporarily set to unlimited width
20739 and height, and its pagination will be disabled; @pxref{Screen Size}.
20740 @end defun
20741
20742 @findex gdb.breakpoints
20743 @defun breakpoints
20744 Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
20745 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
20746 @end defun
20747
20748 @findex gdb.parameter
20749 @defun parameter parameter
20750 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
20751 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
20752 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
20753 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
20754
20755 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
20756 @code{gdb.error} (@pxref{Exception Handling}). Otherwise, the
20757 parameter's value is converted to a Python value of the appropriate
20758 type, and returned.
20759 @end defun
20760
20761 @findex gdb.history
20762 @defun history number
20763 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
20764 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
20765 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
20766 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
20767 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
20768 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
20769 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{gdb.error} exception will be
20770 raised.
20771
20772 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
20773 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
20774 @end defun
20775
20776 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
20777 @defun parse_and_eval expression
20778 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
20779 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20780 @var{expression} must be a string.
20781
20782 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
20783 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
20784 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
20785 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
20786 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20787 @end defun
20788
20789 @findex gdb.post_event
20790 @defun post_event event
20791 Put @var{event}, a callable object taking no arguments, into
20792 @value{GDBN}'s internal event queue. This callable will be invoked at
20793 some later point, during @value{GDBN}'s event processing. Events
20794 posted using @code{post_event} will be run in the order in which they
20795 were posted; however, there is no way to know when they will be
20796 processed relative to other events inside @value{GDBN}.
20797
20798 @value{GDBN} is not thread-safe. If your Python program uses multiple
20799 threads, you must be careful to only call @value{GDBN}-specific
20800 functions in the main @value{GDBN} thread. @code{post_event} ensures
20801 this. For example:
20802
20803 @smallexample
20804 (@value{GDBP}) python
20805 >import threading
20806 >
20807 >class Writer():
20808 > def __init__(self, message):
20809 > self.message = message;
20810 > def __call__(self):
20811 > gdb.write(self.message)
20812 >
20813 >class MyThread1 (threading.Thread):
20814 > def run (self):
20815 > gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello "))
20816 >
20817 >class MyThread2 (threading.Thread):
20818 > def run (self):
20819 > gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n"))
20820 >
20821 >MyThread1().start()
20822 >MyThread2().start()
20823 >end
20824 (@value{GDBP}) Hello World
20825 @end smallexample
20826 @end defun
20827
20828 @findex gdb.write
20829 @defun write string
20830 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
20831 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
20832 call this function.
20833 @end defun
20834
20835 @findex gdb.flush
20836 @defun flush
20837 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
20838 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
20839 function.
20840 @end defun
20841
20842 @findex gdb.target_charset
20843 @defun target_charset
20844 Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
20845 Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
20846 that @samp{auto} is never returned.
20847 @end defun
20848
20849 @findex gdb.target_wide_charset
20850 @defun target_wide_charset
20851 Return the name of the current target wide character set
20852 (@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
20853 @code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
20854 never returned.
20855 @end defun
20856
20857 @findex gdb.solib_name
20858 @defun solib_name address
20859 Return the name of the shared library holding the given @var{address}
20860 as a string, or @code{None}.
20861 @end defun
20862
20863 @findex gdb.decode_line
20864 @defun decode_line @r{[}expression@r{]}
20865 Return locations of the line specified by @var{expression}, or of the
20866 current line if no argument was given. This function returns a Python
20867 tuple containing two elements. The first element contains a string
20868 holding any unparsed section of @var{expression} (or @code{None} if
20869 the expression has been fully parsed). The second element contains
20870 either @code{None} or another tuple that contains all the locations
20871 that match the expression represented as @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line}
20872 objects (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}). If @var{expression} is
20873 provided, it is decoded the way that @value{GDBN}'s inbuilt
20874 @code{break} or @code{edit} commands do (@pxref{Specify Location}).
20875 @end defun
20876
20877 @node Exception Handling
20878 @subsubsection Exception Handling
20879 @cindex python exceptions
20880 @cindex exceptions, python
20881
20882 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
20883 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
20884 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
20885 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
20886 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
20887 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
20888 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
20889
20890 @smallexample
20891 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
20892 Traceback (most recent call last):
20893 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
20894 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
20895 @end smallexample
20896
20897 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by
20898 Python code are converted to Python exceptions. The type of the
20899 Python exception depends on the error.
20900
20901 @ftable @code
20902 @item gdb.error
20903 This is the base class for most exceptions generated by @value{GDBN}.
20904 It is derived from @code{RuntimeError}, for compatibility with earlier
20905 versions of @value{GDBN}.
20906
20907 If an error occurring in @value{GDBN} does not fit into some more
20908 specific category, then the generated exception will have this type.
20909
20910 @item gdb.MemoryError
20911 This is a subclass of @code{gdb.error} which is thrown when an
20912 operation tried to access invalid memory in the inferior.
20913
20914 @item KeyboardInterrupt
20915 User interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
20916 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception.
20917 @end ftable
20918
20919 In all cases, your exception handler will see the @value{GDBN} error
20920 message as its value and the Python call stack backtrace at the Python
20921 statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
20922 traceback.
20923
20924 @findex gdb.GdbError
20925 When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
20926 it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
20927 traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
20928 command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
20929 to handle this case. Example:
20930
20931 @smallexample
20932 (gdb) python
20933 >class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
20934 > """Greet the whole world."""
20935 > def __init__ (self):
20936 > super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
20937 > def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
20938 > argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
20939 > if len (argv) != 0:
20940 > raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
20941 > print "Hello, World!"
20942 >HelloWorld ()
20943 >end
20944 (gdb) hello-world 42
20945 hello-world takes no arguments
20946 @end smallexample
20947
20948 @node Values From Inferior
20949 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
20950 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
20951 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
20952
20953 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
20954 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
20955 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
20956 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
20957 fetching values when necessary.
20958
20959 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
20960 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
20961 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
20962
20963 @smallexample
20964 bar = some_val + 2
20965 @end smallexample
20966
20967 @noindent
20968 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
20969 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
20970
20971 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
20972 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
20973 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
20974 can access its @code{foo} element with:
20975
20976 @smallexample
20977 bar = some_val['foo']
20978 @end smallexample
20979
20980 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
20981
20982 A @code{gdb.Value} that represents a function can be executed via
20983 inferior function call. Any arguments provided to the call must match
20984 the function's prototype, and must be provided in the order specified
20985 by that prototype.
20986
20987 For example, @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance
20988 representing a function that takes two integers as arguments. To
20989 execute this function, call it like so:
20990
20991 @smallexample
20992 result = some_val (10,20)
20993 @end smallexample
20994
20995 Any values returned from a function call will be stored as a
20996 @code{gdb.Value}.
20997
20998 The following attributes are provided:
20999
21000 @table @code
21001 @defivar Value address
21002 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
21003 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
21004 this attribute holds @code{None}.
21005 @end defivar
21006
21007 @cindex optimized out value in Python
21008 @defivar Value is_optimized_out
21009 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
21010 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
21011 @end defivar
21012
21013 @defivar Value type
21014 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
21015 @code{gdb.Type} object (@pxref{Types In Python}).
21016 @end defivar
21017
21018 @defivar Value dynamic_type
21019 The dynamic type of this @code{gdb.Value}. This uses C@t{++} run-time
21020 type information (@acronym{RTTI}) to determine the dynamic type of the
21021 value. If this value is of class type, it will return the class in
21022 which the value is embedded, if any. If this value is of pointer or
21023 reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type of the
21024 referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type,
21025 respectively. In all other cases, it will return the value's static
21026 type.
21027
21028 Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C@t{++} program
21029 that includes @acronym{RTTI} for the object in question. Otherwise,
21030 it will just return the static type of the value as in @kbd{ptype foo}
21031 (@pxref{Symbols, ptype}).
21032 @end defivar
21033 @end table
21034
21035 The following methods are provided:
21036
21037 @table @code
21038 @defmethod Value __init__ @var{val}
21039 Many Python values can be converted directly to a @code{gdb.Value} via
21040 this object initializer. Specifically:
21041
21042 @table @asis
21043 @item Python boolean
21044 A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current
21045 language.
21046
21047 @item Python integer
21048 A Python integer is converted to the C @code{long} type for the
21049 current architecture.
21050
21051 @item Python long
21052 A Python long is converted to the C @code{long long} type for the
21053 current architecture.
21054
21055 @item Python float
21056 A Python float is converted to the C @code{double} type for the
21057 current architecture.
21058
21059 @item Python string
21060 A Python string is converted to a target string, using the current
21061 target encoding.
21062
21063 @item @code{gdb.Value}
21064 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.Value}, then a copy of the value is made.
21065
21066 @item @code{gdb.LazyString}
21067 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings In
21068 Python}), then the lazy string's @code{value} method is called, and
21069 its result is used.
21070 @end table
21071 @end defmethod
21072
21073 @defmethod Value cast type
21074 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
21075 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
21076 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
21077 reason, this method throws an exception.
21078 @end defmethod
21079
21080 @defmethod Value dereference
21081 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
21082 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
21083 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
21084
21085 @smallexample
21086 int *foo;
21087 @end smallexample
21088
21089 @noindent
21090 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
21091 @code{foo} points to like this:
21092
21093 @smallexample
21094 bar = foo.dereference ()
21095 @end smallexample
21096
21097 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
21098 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
21099 @end defmethod
21100
21101 @defmethod Value dynamic_cast type
21102 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{dynamic_cast}
21103 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21104 @end defmethod
21105
21106 @defmethod Value reinterpret_cast type
21107 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{reinterpret_cast}
21108 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21109 @end defmethod
21110
21111 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
21112 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21113 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
21114 throw an exception.
21115
21116 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
21117 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
21118 language.
21119
21120 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
21121 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
21122 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
21123 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
21124 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
21125
21126 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21127 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
21128 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
21129 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
21130 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
21131 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
21132 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
21133 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
21134 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
21135
21136 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
21137 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
21138
21139 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21140 fetched and converted to the given length.
21141 @end defmethod
21142
21143 @defmethod Value lazy_string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
21144 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21145 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
21146 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
21147
21148 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21149 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
21150 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
21151 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
21152 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
21153
21154 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
21155 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
21156 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
21157 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
21158 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
21159 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
21160
21161 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21162 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
21163 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
21164 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
21165 @end defmethod
21166 @end table
21167
21168 @node Types In Python
21169 @subsubsection Types In Python
21170 @cindex types in Python
21171 @cindex Python, working with types
21172
21173 @tindex gdb.Type
21174 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
21175 @code{gdb.Type}.
21176
21177 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21178 module:
21179
21180 @findex gdb.lookup_type
21181 @defun lookup_type name [block]
21182 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
21183 type to look up. It must be a string.
21184
21185 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
21186 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
21187
21188 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
21189 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
21190 @end defun
21191
21192 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
21193
21194 @table @code
21195 @defivar Type code
21196 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
21197 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
21198 @end defivar
21199
21200 @defivar Type sizeof
21201 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
21202 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
21203 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
21204 @end defivar
21205
21206 @defivar Type tag
21207 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
21208 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
21209 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
21210 @code{None} is returned.
21211 @end defivar
21212 @end table
21213
21214 The following methods are provided:
21215
21216 @table @code
21217 @defmethod Type fields
21218 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
21219 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
21220 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
21221 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
21222 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
21223 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
21224
21225 Each field is an object, with some pre-defined attributes:
21226 @table @code
21227 @item bitpos
21228 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
21229 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
21230 position of the field.
21231
21232 @item name
21233 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
21234
21235 @item artificial
21236 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
21237 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
21238 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
21239
21240 @item is_base_class
21241 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
21242 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
21243 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
21244 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
21245
21246 @item bitsize
21247 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
21248 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
21249 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
21250
21251 @item type
21252 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
21253 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
21254 @end table
21255 @end defmethod
21256
21257 @defmethod Type array @var{n1} @r{[}@var{n2}@r{]}
21258 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an array of this
21259 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
21260 the array; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
21261 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the array, and the
21262 second argument is the upper bound of the array. An array's length
21263 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
21264 @end defmethod
21265
21266 @defmethod Type const
21267 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
21268 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
21269 @end defmethod
21270
21271 @defmethod Type volatile
21272 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
21273 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
21274 @end defmethod
21275
21276 @defmethod Type unqualified
21277 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
21278 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
21279 @code{volatile}.
21280 @end defmethod
21281
21282 @defmethod Type range
21283 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
21284 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
21285 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
21286 @code{gdb.error} exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
21287 @end defmethod
21288
21289 @defmethod Type reference
21290 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
21291 type.
21292 @end defmethod
21293
21294 @defmethod Type pointer
21295 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
21296 type.
21297 @end defmethod
21298
21299 @defmethod Type strip_typedefs
21300 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
21301 after removing all layers of typedefs.
21302 @end defmethod
21303
21304 @defmethod Type target
21305 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
21306 of this type.
21307
21308 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
21309 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
21310 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
21311 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
21312 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
21313 target type is the aliased type.
21314
21315 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
21316 exception.
21317 @end defmethod
21318
21319 @defmethod Type template_argument n [block]
21320 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
21321 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
21322 @var{n}th template argument.
21323
21324 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
21325 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
21326
21327 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
21328 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
21329 @end defmethod
21330 @end table
21331
21332
21333 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
21334 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
21335 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
21336
21337 @table @code
21338 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
21339 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
21340 @item TYPE_CODE_PTR
21341 The type is a pointer.
21342
21343 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21344 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21345 @item TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21346 The type is an array.
21347
21348 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21349 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21350 @item TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21351 The type is a structure.
21352
21353 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
21354 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
21355 @item TYPE_CODE_UNION
21356 The type is a union.
21357
21358 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21359 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21360 @item TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21361 The type is an enum.
21362
21363 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21364 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21365 @item TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21366 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
21367
21368 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21369 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21370 @item TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21371 The type is a function.
21372
21373 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
21374 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
21375 @item TYPE_CODE_INT
21376 The type is an integer type.
21377
21378 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
21379 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
21380 @item TYPE_CODE_FLT
21381 A floating point type.
21382
21383 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
21384 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
21385 @item TYPE_CODE_VOID
21386 The special type @code{void}.
21387
21388 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
21389 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
21390 @item TYPE_CODE_SET
21391 A Pascal set type.
21392
21393 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21394 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21395 @item TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21396 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
21397
21398 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
21399 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
21400 @item TYPE_CODE_STRING
21401 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
21402 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
21403
21404 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21405 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21406 @item TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21407 A string of bits.
21408
21409 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21410 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21411 @item TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21412 An unknown or erroneous type.
21413
21414 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21415 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21416 @item TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21417 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
21418
21419 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21420 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21421 @item TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21422 A pointer-to-member-function.
21423
21424 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21425 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21426 @item TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21427 A pointer-to-member.
21428
21429 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
21430 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
21431 @item TYPE_CODE_REF
21432 A reference type.
21433
21434 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21435 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21436 @item TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21437 A character type.
21438
21439 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21440 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21441 @item TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21442 A boolean type.
21443
21444 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21445 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21446 @item TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21447 A complex float type.
21448
21449 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21450 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21451 @item TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21452 A typedef to some other type.
21453
21454 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21455 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21456 @item TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21457 A C@t{++} namespace.
21458
21459 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21460 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21461 @item TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21462 A decimal floating point type.
21463
21464 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21465 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21466 @item TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21467 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
21468 convenience functions.
21469 @end table
21470
21471 Further support for types is provided in the @code{gdb.types}
21472 Python module (@pxref{gdb.types}).
21473
21474 @node Pretty Printing API
21475 @subsubsection Pretty Printing API
21476
21477 An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
21478
21479 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
21480 specific interface, defined here.
21481
21482 @defop Operation {pretty printer} children (self)
21483 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
21484 children of the pretty-printer's value.
21485
21486 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
21487 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
21488 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
21489 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
21490 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
21491
21492 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
21493 as though the value has no children.
21494 @end defop
21495
21496 @defop Operation {pretty printer} display_hint (self)
21497 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
21498 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
21499 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
21500 printed.
21501
21502 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
21503 string.
21504
21505 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
21506
21507 @table @samp
21508 @item array
21509 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
21510 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
21511 @code{set print array}.
21512
21513 @item map
21514 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
21515 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
21516 values.
21517
21518 @item string
21519 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
21520 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
21521 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
21522 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
21523 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
21524 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
21525 @end table
21526 @end defop
21527
21528 @defop Operation {pretty printer} to_string (self)
21529 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
21530 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
21531
21532 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
21533 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
21534 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
21535 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
21536 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
21537 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
21538 the result of @code{children}.
21539
21540 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
21541
21542 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
21543 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
21544 another pretty-printer.
21545
21546 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
21547 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
21548 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
21549 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
21550 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
21551
21552 Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
21553 are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
21554
21555 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
21556 @end defop
21557
21558 @value{GDBN} provides a function which can be used to look up the
21559 default pretty-printer for a @code{gdb.Value}:
21560
21561 @findex gdb.default_visualizer
21562 @defun default_visualizer value
21563 This function takes a @code{gdb.Value} object as an argument. If a
21564 pretty-printer for this value exists, then it is returned. If no such
21565 printer exists, then this returns @code{None}.
21566 @end defun
21567
21568 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
21569 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
21570
21571 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
21572 functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition
21573 as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list are called @code{global}
21574 printers, they're available when debugging all inferiors.
21575 Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
21576 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
21577 attribute.
21578
21579 Each function on these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
21580 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
21581 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
21582 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
21583 @code{None}.
21584
21585 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
21586 @code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
21587 each enabled lookup routine in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile}
21588 until it receives a pretty-printer object.
21589 If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
21590 searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
21591 calling each enabled function until an object is returned.
21592 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
21593 @code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an
21594 object is returned.
21595
21596 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
21597 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
21598 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
21599 object is returned.
21600
21601 For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work.
21602 For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and
21603 the pretty-printer is out of date.
21604
21605 The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that
21606 @value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual
21607 printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on,
21608 a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed
21609 with a broken printer.
21610
21611 Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled}
21612 attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute
21613 is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise
21614 the printer is enabled.
21615
21616 @node Writing a Pretty-Printer
21617 @subsubsection Writing a Pretty-Printer
21618 @cindex writing a pretty-printer
21619
21620 A pretty-printer consists of two parts: a lookup function to detect
21621 if the type is supported, and the printer itself.
21622
21623 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
21624 written. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for details on the API this class
21625 must provide.
21626
21627 @smallexample
21628 class StdStringPrinter(object):
21629 "Print a std::string"
21630
21631 def __init__(self, val):
21632 self.val = val
21633
21634 def to_string(self):
21635 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
21636
21637 def display_hint(self):
21638 return 'string'
21639 @end smallexample
21640
21641 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
21642 example above might be written.
21643
21644 @smallexample
21645 def str_lookup_function(val):
21646 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
21647 if lookup_tag == None:
21648 return None
21649 regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
21650 if regex.match(lookup_tag):
21651 return StdStringPrinter(val)
21652 return None
21653 @end smallexample
21654
21655 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
21656 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
21657 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
21658 returns @code{None}.
21659
21660 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
21661 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
21662 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
21663 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
21664 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
21665 different names.
21666
21667 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
21668 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
21669 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
21670 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
21671 the current objfile.
21672
21673 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
21674 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
21675 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
21676 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
21677 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
21678 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
21679 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
21680 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
21681 inferior.
21682
21683 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
21684 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
21685
21686 @smallexample
21687 def register_printers(objfile):
21688 objfile.pretty_printers.add(str_lookup_function)
21689 @end smallexample
21690
21691 @noindent
21692 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
21693
21694 @smallexample
21695 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
21696 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile())
21697 @end smallexample
21698
21699 The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer.
21700 There are a few things that can be improved on.
21701 The printer doesn't have a name, making it hard to identify in a
21702 list of installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but
21703 lookup functions can have arbitrary, even identical, names.
21704
21705 Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has
21706 several types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type
21707 in the library, but one could also have a single lookup function recognize
21708 several types. The latter is the conventional way this is handled.
21709 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
21710 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
21711
21712 The @code{gdb.printing} module provides a formal way of solving these
21713 problems (@pxref{gdb.printing}).
21714 Here is another example that handles multiple types.
21715
21716 These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
21717
21718 @smallexample
21719 struct foo @{ int a, b; @};
21720 struct bar @{ struct foo x, y; @};
21721 @end smallexample
21722
21723 Here are the printers:
21724
21725 @smallexample
21726 class fooPrinter:
21727 """Print a foo object."""
21728
21729 def __init__(self, val):
21730 self.val = val
21731
21732 def to_string(self):
21733 return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) +
21734 "> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">")
21735
21736 class barPrinter:
21737 """Print a bar object."""
21738
21739 def __init__(self, val):
21740 self.val = val
21741
21742 def to_string(self):
21743 return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) +
21744 "> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">")
21745 @end smallexample
21746
21747 This example doesn't need a lookup function, that is handled by the
21748 @code{gdb.printing} module. Instead a function is provided to build up
21749 the object that handles the lookup.
21750
21751 @smallexample
21752 import gdb.printing
21753
21754 def build_pretty_printer():
21755 pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter(
21756 "my_library")
21757 pp.add_printer('foo', '^foo$', fooPrinter)
21758 pp.add_printer('bar', '^bar$', barPrinter)
21759 return pp
21760 @end smallexample
21761
21762 And here is the autoload support:
21763
21764 @smallexample
21765 import gdb.printing
21766 import my_library
21767 gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer(
21768 gdb.current_objfile(),
21769 my_library.build_pretty_printer())
21770 @end smallexample
21771
21772 Finally, when this printer is loaded into @value{GDBN}, here is the
21773 corresponding output of @samp{info pretty-printer}:
21774
21775 @smallexample
21776 (gdb) info pretty-printer
21777 my_library.so:
21778 my_library
21779 foo
21780 bar
21781 @end smallexample
21782
21783 @node Inferiors In Python
21784 @subsubsection Inferiors In Python
21785 @cindex inferiors in python
21786
21787 @findex gdb.Inferior
21788 Programs which are being run under @value{GDBN} are called inferiors
21789 (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). Python scripts can access
21790 information about and manipulate inferiors controlled by @value{GDBN}
21791 via objects of the @code{gdb.Inferior} class.
21792
21793 The following inferior-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21794 module:
21795
21796 @defun inferiors
21797 Return a tuple containing all inferior objects.
21798 @end defun
21799
21800 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following attributes:
21801
21802 @table @code
21803 @defivar Inferior num
21804 ID of inferior, as assigned by GDB.
21805 @end defivar
21806
21807 @defivar Inferior pid
21808 Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating
21809 system.
21810 @end defivar
21811
21812 @defivar Inferior was_attached
21813 Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using `attach', or
21814 started by @value{GDBN} itself.
21815 @end defivar
21816 @end table
21817
21818 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following methods:
21819
21820 @table @code
21821 @defmethod Inferior threads
21822 This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid
21823 when it is called. If there are no valid threads, the method will
21824 return an empty tuple.
21825 @end defmethod
21826
21827 @findex gdb.read_memory
21828 @defmethod Inferior read_memory address length
21829 Read @var{length} bytes of memory from the inferior, starting at
21830 @var{address}. Returns a buffer object, which behaves much like an array
21831 or a string. It can be modified and given to the @code{gdb.write_memory}
21832 function.
21833 @end defmethod
21834
21835 @findex gdb.write_memory
21836 @defmethod Inferior write_memory address buffer @r{[}length@r{]}
21837 Write the contents of @var{buffer} to the inferior, starting at
21838 @var{address}. The @var{buffer} parameter must be a Python object
21839 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
21840 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. If given, @var{length}
21841 determines the number of bytes from @var{buffer} to be written.
21842 @end defmethod
21843
21844 @findex gdb.search_memory
21845 @defmethod Inferior search_memory address length pattern
21846 Search a region of the inferior memory starting at @var{address} with
21847 the given @var{length} using the search pattern supplied in
21848 @var{pattern}. The @var{pattern} parameter must be a Python object
21849 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
21850 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. Returns a Python @code{Long}
21851 containing the address where the pattern was found, or @code{None} if
21852 the pattern could not be found.
21853 @end defmethod
21854 @end table
21855
21856 @node Threads In Python
21857 @subsubsection Threads In Python
21858 @cindex threads in python
21859
21860 @findex gdb.InferiorThread
21861 Python scripts can access information about, and manipulate inferior threads
21862 controlled by @value{GDBN}, via objects of the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} class.
21863
21864 The following thread-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21865 module:
21866
21867 @findex gdb.selected_thread
21868 @defun selected_thread
21869 This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there
21870 is no selected thread, this will return @code{None}.
21871 @end defun
21872
21873 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following attributes:
21874
21875 @table @code
21876 @defivar InferiorThread num
21877 ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB.
21878 @end defivar
21879
21880 @defivar InferiorThread ptid
21881 ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a
21882 tuple containing three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second
21883 is the Lightweight Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID).
21884 Either the LWPID or TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system
21885 does not use that identifier.
21886 @end defivar
21887 @end table
21888
21889 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following methods:
21890
21891 @table @code
21892 @defmethod InferiorThread switch
21893 This changes @value{GDBN}'s currently selected thread to the one represented
21894 by this object.
21895 @end defmethod
21896
21897 @defmethod InferiorThread is_stopped
21898 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped.
21899 @end defmethod
21900
21901 @defmethod InferiorThread is_running
21902 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running.
21903 @end defmethod
21904
21905 @defmethod InferiorThread is_exited
21906 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited.
21907 @end defmethod
21908 @end table
21909
21910 @node Commands In Python
21911 @subsubsection Commands In Python
21912
21913 @cindex commands in python
21914 @cindex python commands
21915 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
21916 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
21917 class, most commonly using a subclass.
21918
21919 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
21920 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
21921 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
21922 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
21923
21924 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
21925 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
21926 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
21927 an exception is raised.
21928
21929 There is no support for multi-line commands.
21930
21931 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
21932 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
21933 new command in the help system.
21934
21935 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
21936 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
21937 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
21938 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
21939 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
21940 error will occur when completion is attempted.
21941
21942 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
21943 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
21944 registered.
21945
21946 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
21947 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
21948 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
21949 not documented.'' is used.
21950 @end defmethod
21951
21952 @cindex don't repeat Python command
21953 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
21954 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
21955 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
21956 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
21957 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
21958 @end defmethod
21959
21960 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
21961 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
21962
21963 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
21964 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
21965
21966 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
21967 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
21968 that the command came from elsewhere.
21969
21970 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
21971 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
21972
21973 @findex gdb.string_to_argv
21974 To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
21975 @code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
21976 @value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
21977 It is recommended to use this for consistency.
21978 Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
21979 Example:
21980
21981 @smallexample
21982 print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
21983 ['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
21984 @end smallexample
21985
21986 @end defmethod
21987
21988 @cindex completion of Python commands
21989 @defmethod Command complete text word
21990 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
21991 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
21992 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
21993 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
21994 complete}).
21995
21996 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
21997 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
21998 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
21999 using a word-breaking heuristic.
22000
22001 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
22002 @itemize @bullet
22003 @item
22004 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
22005 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
22006 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
22007 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
22008 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
22009 sequence are ignored.
22010
22011 @item
22012 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
22013 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
22014 function is invoked, and its result is used.
22015
22016 @item
22017 All other results are treated as though there were no available
22018 completions.
22019 @end itemize
22020 @end defmethod
22021
22022 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
22023 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
22024 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
22025 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
22026 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
22027 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22028
22029 @table @code
22030 @findex COMMAND_NONE
22031 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
22032 @item COMMAND_NONE
22033 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
22034 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
22035
22036 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
22037 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
22038 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
22039 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
22040 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
22041 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22042 commands in this category.
22043
22044 @findex COMMAND_DATA
22045 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
22046 @item COMMAND_DATA
22047 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
22048 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
22049 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
22050 in this category.
22051
22052 @findex COMMAND_STACK
22053 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
22054 @item COMMAND_STACK
22055 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
22056 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
22057 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
22058 list of commands in this category.
22059
22060 @findex COMMAND_FILES
22061 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
22062 @item COMMAND_FILES
22063 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
22064 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
22065 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22066 commands in this category.
22067
22068 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
22069 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
22070 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
22071 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
22072 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
22073 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
22074 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
22075 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22076 commands in this category.
22077
22078 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
22079 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
22080 @item COMMAND_STATUS
22081 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
22082 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
22083 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
22084 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
22085
22086 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22087 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22088 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22089 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
22090 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
22091 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
22092 this category.
22093
22094 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22095 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22096 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22097 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
22098 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
22099 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22100 commands in this category.
22101
22102 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
22103 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
22104 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
22105 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
22106 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
22107 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
22108 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
22109 category.
22110
22111 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22112 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22113 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22114 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
22115 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
22116 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22117 commands in this category.
22118 @end table
22119
22120 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
22121 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
22122 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
22123 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22124
22125 @table @code
22126 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
22127 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
22128 @item COMPLETE_NONE
22129 This constant means that no completion should be done.
22130
22131 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
22132 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
22133 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
22134 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
22135
22136 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
22137 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
22138 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
22139 This constant means that location completion should be done.
22140 @xref{Specify Location}.
22141
22142 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
22143 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
22144 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
22145 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
22146 command names.
22147
22148 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22149 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22150 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22151 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
22152 as the source.
22153 @end table
22154
22155 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
22156 implemented in Python:
22157
22158 @smallexample
22159 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
22160 """Greet the whole world."""
22161
22162 def __init__ (self):
22163 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
22164
22165 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
22166 print "Hello, World!"
22167
22168 HelloWorld ()
22169 @end smallexample
22170
22171 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
22172 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
22173 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
22174 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
22175
22176 @node Parameters In Python
22177 @subsubsection Parameters In Python
22178
22179 @cindex parameters in python
22180 @cindex python parameters
22181 @tindex gdb.Parameter
22182 @tindex Parameter
22183 You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
22184 parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
22185 class.
22186
22187 Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
22188 @code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
22189
22190 There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
22191 @value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
22192 @code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
22193 behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
22194 can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
22195
22196 @defmethod Parameter __init__ name @var{command-class} @var{parameter-class} @r{[}@var{enum-sequence}@r{]}
22197 The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
22198 parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
22199 from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
22200
22201 @var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
22202 of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
22203 parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
22204 @code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
22205 @code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
22206 parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
22207 @value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
22208
22209 If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
22210 can be found, an exception is raised.
22211
22212 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
22213 (@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
22214 categorize the new parameter in the help system.
22215
22216 @var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
22217 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
22218 parameter; this information is used for input validation and
22219 completion.
22220
22221 If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
22222 @var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
22223 represent the possible values for the parameter.
22224
22225 If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
22226 of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
22227
22228 The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
22229 documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
22230 there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
22231 @end defmethod
22232
22233 @defivar Parameter set_doc
22234 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
22235 the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
22236 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
22237 have no effect.
22238 @end defivar
22239
22240 @defivar Parameter show_doc
22241 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
22242 the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
22243 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
22244 have no effect.
22245 @end defivar
22246
22247 @defivar Parameter value
22248 The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
22249 parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
22250 attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
22251 @end defivar
22252
22253
22254 When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
22255 available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
22256 module:
22257
22258 @table @code
22259 @findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
22260 @findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
22261 @item PARAM_BOOLEAN
22262 The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
22263 and @code{False} are the only valid values.
22264
22265 @findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22266 @findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22267 @item PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22268 The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
22269 Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
22270 @samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
22271
22272 @findex PARAM_UINTEGER
22273 @findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
22274 @item PARAM_UINTEGER
22275 The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
22276 interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
22277
22278 @findex PARAM_INTEGER
22279 @findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
22280 @item PARAM_INTEGER
22281 The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
22282 to mean ``unlimited''.
22283
22284 @findex PARAM_STRING
22285 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
22286 @item PARAM_STRING
22287 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
22288 sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
22289 translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
22290 host charset.
22291
22292 @findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22293 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22294 @item PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22295 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
22296 passed through untranslated.
22297
22298 @findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22299 @findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22300 @item PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22301 The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
22302
22303 @findex PARAM_FILENAME
22304 @findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
22305 @item PARAM_FILENAME
22306 The value is a filename. This is just like
22307 @code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
22308
22309 @findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
22310 @findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
22311 @item PARAM_ZINTEGER
22312 The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
22313 is interpreted as itself.
22314
22315 @findex PARAM_ENUM
22316 @findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
22317 @item PARAM_ENUM
22318 The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
22319 constants provided when the parameter is created.
22320 @end table
22321
22322 @node Functions In Python
22323 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
22324
22325 @cindex writing convenience functions
22326 @cindex convenience functions in python
22327 @cindex python convenience functions
22328 @tindex gdb.Function
22329 @tindex Function
22330 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
22331 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
22332 class @code{gdb.Function}.
22333
22334 @defmethod Function __init__ name
22335 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
22336 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
22337 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
22338 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
22339 the given @var{name}.
22340
22341 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
22342 string for the new class.
22343 @end defmethod
22344
22345 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
22346 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
22347 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
22348 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
22349 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
22350 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
22351 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
22352 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
22353
22354 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
22355 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
22356 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
22357 @end defmethod
22358
22359 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
22360 be implemented in Python:
22361
22362 @smallexample
22363 class Greet (gdb.Function):
22364 """Return string to greet someone.
22365 Takes a name as argument."""
22366
22367 def __init__ (self):
22368 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
22369
22370 def invoke (self, name):
22371 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
22372
22373 Greet ()
22374 @end smallexample
22375
22376 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
22377 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
22378 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
22379 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
22380
22381 @node Progspaces In Python
22382 @subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
22383
22384 @cindex progspaces in python
22385 @tindex gdb.Progspace
22386 @tindex Progspace
22387 A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
22388 of an address space.
22389 It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
22390 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22391 @xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
22392 about program spaces.
22393
22394 The following progspace-related functions are available in the
22395 @code{gdb} module:
22396
22397 @findex gdb.current_progspace
22398 @defun current_progspace
22399 This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
22400 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
22401 @end defun
22402
22403 @findex gdb.progspaces
22404 @defun progspaces
22405 Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
22406 @end defun
22407
22408 Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
22409 class.
22410
22411 @defivar Progspace filename
22412 The file name of the progspace as a string.
22413 @end defivar
22414
22415 @defivar Progspace pretty_printers
22416 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
22417 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
22418 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
22419 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
22420 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
22421 information.
22422 @end defivar
22423
22424 @node Objfiles In Python
22425 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
22426
22427 @cindex objfiles in python
22428 @tindex gdb.Objfile
22429 @tindex Objfile
22430 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
22431 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
22432 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
22433 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
22434 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
22435
22436 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
22437 @code{gdb} module:
22438
22439 @findex gdb.current_objfile
22440 @defun current_objfile
22441 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
22442 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
22443 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
22444 this function returns @code{None}.
22445 @end defun
22446
22447 @findex gdb.objfiles
22448 @defun objfiles
22449 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
22450 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22451 @end defun
22452
22453 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
22454 class.
22455
22456 @defivar Objfile filename
22457 The file name of the objfile as a string.
22458 @end defivar
22459
22460 @defivar Objfile pretty_printers
22461 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
22462 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
22463 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
22464 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
22465 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
22466 information.
22467 @end defivar
22468
22469 @node Frames In Python
22470 @subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
22471
22472 @cindex frames in python
22473 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
22474 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
22475 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
22476 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
22477 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{gdb.error}
22478 exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
22479
22480 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
22481 operator, like:
22482
22483 @smallexample
22484 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
22485 True
22486 @end smallexample
22487
22488 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
22489
22490 @findex gdb.selected_frame
22491 @defun selected_frame
22492 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
22493 @end defun
22494
22495 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
22496 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
22497 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
22498 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
22499 @end defun
22500
22501 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
22502
22503 @table @code
22504 @defmethod Frame is_valid
22505 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
22506 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
22507 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
22508 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
22509 @end defmethod
22510
22511 @defmethod Frame name
22512 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
22513 obtained.
22514 @end defmethod
22515
22516 @defmethod Frame type
22517 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of
22518 @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, @code{gdb.DUMMY_FRAME}, @code{gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME}
22519 or @code{gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME}.
22520 @end defmethod
22521
22522 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
22523 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
22524 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
22525 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
22526 function to a string.
22527 @end defmethod
22528
22529 @defmethod Frame pc
22530 Returns the frame's resume address.
22531 @end defmethod
22532
22533 @defmethod Frame block
22534 Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
22535 @end defmethod
22536
22537 @defmethod Frame function
22538 Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
22539 @xref{Symbols In Python}.
22540 @end defmethod
22541
22542 @defmethod Frame older
22543 Return the frame that called this frame.
22544 @end defmethod
22545
22546 @defmethod Frame newer
22547 Return the frame called by this frame.
22548 @end defmethod
22549
22550 @defmethod Frame find_sal
22551 Return the frame's symtab and line object.
22552 @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
22553 @end defmethod
22554
22555 @defmethod Frame read_var variable @r{[}block@r{]}
22556 Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
22557 argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
22558 block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
22559 determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
22560 must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
22561 @code{gdb.Block} object.
22562 @end defmethod
22563
22564 @defmethod Frame select
22565 Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
22566 Stack}.
22567 @end defmethod
22568 @end table
22569
22570 @node Blocks In Python
22571 @subsubsection Accessing frame blocks from Python.
22572
22573 @cindex blocks in python
22574 @tindex gdb.Block
22575
22576 Within each frame, @value{GDBN} maintains information on each block
22577 stored in that frame. These blocks are organized hierarchically, and
22578 are represented individually in Python as a @code{gdb.Block}.
22579 Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more in-depth discussion on
22580 frames. Furthermore, see @ref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}, for more
22581 detailed technical information on @value{GDBN}'s book-keeping of the
22582 stack.
22583
22584 The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22585 module:
22586
22587 @findex gdb.block_for_pc
22588 @defun block_for_pc pc
22589 Return the @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc} value. If the
22590 block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified, the function
22591 will return @code{None}.
22592 @end defun
22593
22594 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
22595
22596 @table @code
22597 @defivar Block start
22598 The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
22599 @end defivar
22600
22601 @defivar Block end
22602 The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
22603 @end defivar
22604
22605 @defivar Block function
22606 The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
22607 block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
22608 attribute is not writable.
22609 @end defivar
22610
22611 @defivar Block superblock
22612 The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
22613 this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
22614 @end defivar
22615 @end table
22616
22617 @node Symbols In Python
22618 @subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
22619
22620 @cindex symbols in python
22621 @tindex gdb.Symbol
22622
22623 @value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
22624 entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
22625 Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
22626 @code{gdb.Symbol} object.
22627
22628 The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22629 module:
22630
22631 @findex gdb.lookup_symbol
22632 @defun lookup_symbol name [block] [domain]
22633 This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
22634 restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
22635 arguments.
22636
22637 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
22638 optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
22639 in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
22640 @code{gdb.Block} object. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
22641 the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
22642 domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
22643 in this chapter.
22644 @end defun
22645
22646 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
22647
22648 @table @code
22649 @defivar Symbol symtab
22650 The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
22651 represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
22652 Python}. This attribute is not writable.
22653 @end defivar
22654
22655 @defivar Symbol name
22656 The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
22657 @end defivar
22658
22659 @defivar Symbol linkage_name
22660 The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
22661 This attribute is not writable.
22662 @end defivar
22663
22664 @defivar Symbol print_name
22665 The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
22666 @code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
22667 asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
22668 @end defivar
22669
22670 @defivar Symbol addr_class
22671 The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
22672 of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
22673 @code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
22674 @end defivar
22675
22676 @defivar Symbol is_argument
22677 @code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
22678 @end defivar
22679
22680 @defivar Symbol is_constant
22681 @code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
22682 @end defivar
22683
22684 @defivar Symbol is_function
22685 @code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
22686 @end defivar
22687
22688 @defivar Symbol is_variable
22689 @code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
22690 @end defivar
22691 @end table
22692
22693 The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
22694 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
22695
22696 @table @code
22697 @findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22698 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22699 @item SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22700 This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
22701 following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
22702 in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
22703 @findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22704 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22705 @item SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22706 This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
22707 type values.
22708 @findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22709 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22710 @item SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22711 This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
22712 @findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22713 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22714 @item SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22715 This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
22716 @findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22717 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22718 @item SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22719 This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
22720 contains everything minus functions and types.
22721 @findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
22722 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
22723 @item SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
22724 This domain contains all functions.
22725 @findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22726 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22727 @item SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22728 This domain contains all types.
22729 @end table
22730
22731 The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
22732 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
22733
22734 @table @code
22735 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22736 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22737 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22738 If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
22739 the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
22740 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22741 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22742 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22743 Value is constant int.
22744 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22745 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22746 @item SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22747 Value is at a fixed address.
22748 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22749 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22750 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22751 Value is in a register.
22752 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22753 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22754 @item SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22755 Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
22756 symbol inside the frame's argument list.
22757 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22758 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22759 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22760 Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
22761 @code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
22762 offset, not the value itself.
22763 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22764 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22765 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22766 Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
22767 the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
22768 itself.
22769 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22770 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22771 @item SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22772 Value is a local variable.
22773 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22774 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22775 @item SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22776 Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
22777 have this class.
22778 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22779 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22780 @item SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22781 Value is a block.
22782 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22783 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22784 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22785 Value is a byte-sequence.
22786 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22787 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22788 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22789 Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
22790 determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
22791 referenced.
22792 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22793 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22794 @item SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22795 The value does not actually exist in the program.
22796 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22797 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22798 @item SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22799 The value's address is a computed location.
22800 @end table
22801
22802 @node Symbol Tables In Python
22803 @subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
22804
22805 @cindex symbol tables in python
22806 @tindex gdb.Symtab
22807 @tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
22808
22809 Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
22810 is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
22811 @code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
22812 from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
22813 @xref{Frames In Python}.
22814
22815 For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
22816 @ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
22817
22818 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
22819
22820 @table @code
22821 @defivar Symtab_and_line symtab
22822 The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
22823 This attribute is not writable.
22824 @end defivar
22825
22826 @defivar Symtab_and_line pc
22827 Indicates the current program counter address. This attribute is not
22828 writable.
22829 @end defivar
22830
22831 @defivar Symtab_and_line line
22832 Indicates the current line number for this object. This
22833 attribute is not writable.
22834 @end defivar
22835 @end table
22836
22837 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
22838
22839 @table @code
22840 @defivar Symtab filename
22841 The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
22842 @end defivar
22843
22844 @defivar Symtab objfile
22845 The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22846 This attribute is not writable.
22847 @end defivar
22848 @end table
22849
22850 The following methods are provided:
22851
22852 @table @code
22853 @defmethod Symtab fullname
22854 Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
22855 @end defmethod
22856 @end table
22857
22858 @node Breakpoints In Python
22859 @subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
22860
22861 @cindex breakpoints in python
22862 @tindex gdb.Breakpoint
22863
22864 Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
22865 class.
22866
22867 @defmethod Breakpoint __init__ spec @r{[}type@r{]} @r{[}wp_class@r{]} @r{[}internal@r{]}
22868 Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the
22869 location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a
22870 watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the
22871 @code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch}
22872 command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create
22873 from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be
22874 either: @code{BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
22875 defaults to @code{BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{internal} argument
22876 allows the breakpoint to become invisible to the user. The breakpoint
22877 will neither be reported when created, nor will it be listed in the
22878 output from @code{info breakpoints} (but will be listed with the
22879 @code{maint info breakpoints} command). The optional @var{wp_class}
22880 argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
22881 @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not provided, it is
22882 assumed to be a @var{WP_WRITE} class.
22883 @end defmethod
22884
22885 The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
22886 @code{gdb} module:
22887
22888 @table @code
22889 @findex WP_READ
22890 @findex gdb.WP_READ
22891 @item WP_READ
22892 Read only watchpoint.
22893
22894 @findex WP_WRITE
22895 @findex gdb.WP_WRITE
22896 @item WP_WRITE
22897 Write only watchpoint.
22898
22899 @findex WP_ACCESS
22900 @findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
22901 @item WP_ACCESS
22902 Read/Write watchpoint.
22903 @end table
22904
22905 @defmethod Breakpoint is_valid
22906 Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
22907 @code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
22908 if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
22909 exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
22910 watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
22911 inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
22912 @end defmethod
22913
22914 @defivar Breakpoint enabled
22915 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
22916 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
22917 @end defivar
22918
22919 @defivar Breakpoint silent
22920 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
22921 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
22922
22923 Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
22924 first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
22925 @code{silent} attribute.
22926 @end defivar
22927
22928 @defivar Breakpoint thread
22929 If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
22930 id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
22931 @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
22932 @end defivar
22933
22934 @defivar Breakpoint task
22935 If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
22936 id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
22937 language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
22938 is writable.
22939 @end defivar
22940
22941 @defivar Breakpoint ignore_count
22942 This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
22943 This attribute is writable.
22944 @end defivar
22945
22946 @defivar Breakpoint number
22947 This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
22948 the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
22949 @end defivar
22950
22951 @defivar Breakpoint type
22952 This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
22953 determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
22954 writable.
22955 @end defivar
22956
22957 @defivar Breakpoint visible
22958 This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user
22959 when set, or when the @samp{info breakpoints} command is run. This
22960 attribute is not writable.
22961 @end defivar
22962
22963 The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
22964 module:
22965
22966 @table @code
22967 @findex BP_BREAKPOINT
22968 @findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
22969 @item BP_BREAKPOINT
22970 Normal code breakpoint.
22971
22972 @findex BP_WATCHPOINT
22973 @findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
22974 @item BP_WATCHPOINT
22975 Watchpoint breakpoint.
22976
22977 @findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
22978 @findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
22979 @item BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
22980 Hardware assisted watchpoint.
22981
22982 @findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
22983 @findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
22984 @item BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
22985 Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
22986
22987 @findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
22988 @findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
22989 @item BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
22990 Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
22991 @end table
22992
22993 @defivar Breakpoint hit_count
22994 This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
22995 This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
22996 @end defivar
22997
22998 @defivar Breakpoint location
22999 This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
23000 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
23001 (that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
23002 attribute is not writable.
23003 @end defivar
23004
23005 @defivar Breakpoint expression
23006 This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
23007 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
23008 expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
23009 is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
23010 @end defivar
23011
23012 @defivar Breakpoint condition
23013 This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
23014 the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
23015 value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
23016 @end defivar
23017
23018 @defivar Breakpoint commands
23019 This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
23020 there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
23021 commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
23022 attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
23023 @end defivar
23024
23025 @node Lazy Strings In Python
23026 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
23027
23028 @cindex lazy strings in python
23029 @tindex gdb.LazyString
23030
23031 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
23032 encoded until it is needed.
23033
23034 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
23035 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
23036 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
23037 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
23038 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
23039 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
23040 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
23041 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
23042 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
23043
23044 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
23045
23046 @defmethod LazyString value
23047 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
23048 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
23049 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
23050 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
23051 @end defmethod
23052
23053 @defivar LazyString address
23054 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
23055 writable.
23056 @end defivar
23057
23058 @defivar LazyString length
23059 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
23060 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
23061 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
23062 @end defivar
23063
23064 @defivar LazyString encoding
23065 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
23066 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
23067 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
23068 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
23069 is not writable.
23070 @end defivar
23071
23072 @defivar LazyString type
23073 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
23074 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
23075 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
23076 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
23077 writable.
23078 @end defivar
23079
23080 @node Auto-loading
23081 @subsection Auto-loading
23082 @cindex auto-loading, Python
23083
23084 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23085 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23086 @value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
23087 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
23088
23089 @menu
23090 * objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
23091 * .debug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23092 * Which flavor to choose?::
23093 @end menu
23094
23095 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23096 debugging commands and scripts.
23097
23098 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled.
23099
23100 @table @code
23101 @kindex maint set python auto-load
23102 @item maint set python auto-load [yes|no]
23103 Enable or disable the Python auto-loading feature.
23104
23105 @kindex maint show python auto-load
23106 @item maint show python auto-load
23107 Show whether Python auto-loading is enabled or disabled.
23108 @end table
23109
23110 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
23111 @dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
23112 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
23113 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
23114
23115 @node objfile-gdb.py file
23116 @subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
23117 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23118
23119 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for
23120 a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
23121 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
23122 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
23123 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
23124 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
23125
23126 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
23127 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
23128 then @value{GDBN} will look for @var{real-name} in all of the
23129 directories mentioned in the value of @code{debug-file-directory}.
23130
23131 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23132 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
23133 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
23134 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
23135 is the object file's real name, as described above.
23136
23137 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23138 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23139 @var{objfile} is opened.
23140 So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23141 is evaluated more than once.
23142
23143 @node .debug_gdb_scripts section
23144 @subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23145 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23146
23147 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23148 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23149 it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23150 If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load.
23151
23152 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23153 current directory and then along the source search path
23154 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23155 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23156 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23157
23158 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23159 for example, this GCC macro:
23160
23161 @example
23162 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23163 #define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23164 asm("\
23165 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23166 .byte 1\n\
23167 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23168 .popsection \n\
23169 ");
23170 @end example
23171
23172 @noindent
23173 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23174
23175 @example
23176 DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23177 @end example
23178
23179 The script name may include directories if desired.
23180
23181 If the macro is put in a header, any application or library
23182 using this header will get a reference to the specified script.
23183
23184 @node Which flavor to choose?
23185 @subsubsection Which flavor to choose?
23186
23187 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always
23188 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23189
23190 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way:
23191
23192 @itemize @bullet
23193 @item
23194 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23195
23196 @item
23197 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23198
23199 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23200 in the source search path.
23201 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23202 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23203
23204 @item
23205 Doesn't require source code additions.
23206 @end itemize
23207
23208 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23209
23210 @itemize @bullet
23211 @item
23212 Works with static linking.
23213
23214 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to
23215 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23216 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23217 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script.
23218
23219 @item
23220 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23221
23222 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23223 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to.
23224
23225 @item
23226 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23227
23228 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23229 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23230 @file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23231 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23232 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23233 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23234 @end itemize
23235
23236 @node Python modules
23237 @subsection Python modules
23238 @cindex python modules
23239
23240 @value{GDBN} comes with a module to assist writing Python code.
23241
23242 @menu
23243 * gdb.printing:: Building and registering pretty-printers.
23244 * gdb.types:: Utilities for working with types.
23245 @end menu
23246
23247 @node gdb.printing
23248 @subsubsection gdb.printing
23249 @cindex gdb.printing
23250
23251 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
23252 pretty-printers.
23253
23254 @table @code
23255 @item PrettyPrinter (@var{name}, @var{subprinters}=None)
23256 This class specifies the API that makes @samp{info pretty-printer},
23257 @samp{enable pretty-printer} and @samp{disable pretty-printer} work.
23258 Pretty-printers should generally inherit from this class.
23259
23260 @item SubPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
23261 For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the
23262 corresponding API for the subprinters.
23263
23264 @item RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
23265 Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via
23266 regular expressions.
23267 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for an example.
23268
23269 @item register_pretty_printer (@var{obj}, @var{printer})
23270 Register @var{printer} with the pretty-printer list of @var{obj}.
23271 @end table
23272
23273 @node gdb.types
23274 @subsubsection gdb.types
23275 @cindex gdb.types
23276
23277 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
23278 @code{gdb.Types} objects.
23279
23280 @table @code
23281 @item get_basic_type (@var{type})
23282 Return @var{type} with const and volatile qualifiers stripped,
23283 and with typedefs and C@t{++} references converted to the underlying type.
23284
23285 C@t{++} example:
23286
23287 @smallexample
23288 typedef const int const_int;
23289 const_int foo (3);
23290 const_int& foo_ref (foo);
23291 int main () @{ return 0; @}
23292 @end smallexample
23293
23294 Then in gdb:
23295
23296 @smallexample
23297 (gdb) start
23298 (gdb) python import gdb.types
23299 (gdb) python foo_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo_ref")
23300 (gdb) python print gdb.types.get_basic_type(foo_ref.type)
23301 int
23302 @end smallexample
23303
23304 @item has_field (@var{type}, @var{field})
23305 Return @code{True} if @var{type}, assumed to be a type with fields
23306 (e.g., a structure or union), has field @var{field}.
23307
23308 @item make_enum_dict (@var{enum_type})
23309 Return a Python @code{dictionary} type produced from @var{enum_type}.
23310 @end table
23311
23312 @node Interpreters
23313 @chapter Command Interpreters
23314 @cindex command interpreters
23315
23316 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23317 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23318 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23319
23320 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23321 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23322 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23323 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23324
23325 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23326 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23327 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23328 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23329
23330 @table @code
23331 @item console
23332 @cindex console interpreter
23333 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23334 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23335 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23336
23337 @item mi
23338 @cindex mi interpreter
23339 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23340 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23341 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23342 Interface}.
23343
23344 @item mi2
23345 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23346 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23347
23348 @item mi1
23349 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23350 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23351
23352 @end table
23353
23354 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23355 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23356 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23357 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23358 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23359 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
23360 the IDE inoperable!
23361
23362 @kindex interpreter-exec
23363 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
23364 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
23365 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
23366 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
23367
23368 @smallexample
23369 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
23370 @end smallexample
23371
23372 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
23373 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
23374
23375 @node TUI
23376 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
23377 @cindex TUI
23378 @cindex Text User Interface
23379
23380 @menu
23381 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
23382 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
23383 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
23384 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
23385 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
23386 @end menu
23387
23388 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
23389 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
23390 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
23391 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
23392 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
23393 is available.
23394
23395 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
23396 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
23397 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
23398 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
23399 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
23400 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
23401
23402 @node TUI Overview
23403 @section TUI Overview
23404
23405 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
23406
23407 @table @emph
23408 @item command
23409 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
23410 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
23411 managed using readline.
23412
23413 @item source
23414 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
23415 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
23416
23417 @item assembly
23418 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
23419
23420 @item register
23421 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
23422 when their values change.
23423 @end table
23424
23425 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
23426 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
23427 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
23428 indicates the breakpoint type:
23429
23430 @table @code
23431 @item B
23432 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23433
23434 @item b
23435 Breakpoint which was never hit.
23436
23437 @item H
23438 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23439
23440 @item h
23441 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
23442 @end table
23443
23444 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
23445
23446 @table @code
23447 @item +
23448 Breakpoint is enabled.
23449
23450 @item -
23451 Breakpoint is disabled.
23452 @end table
23453
23454 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
23455 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
23456 changes.
23457
23458 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
23459 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
23460 layouts:
23461
23462 @itemize @bullet
23463 @item
23464 source only,
23465
23466 @item
23467 assembly only,
23468
23469 @item
23470 source and assembly,
23471
23472 @item
23473 source and registers, or
23474
23475 @item
23476 assembly and registers.
23477 @end itemize
23478
23479 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
23480
23481 @table @emph
23482 @item target
23483 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
23484 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
23485
23486 @item process
23487 Gives the current process or thread number.
23488 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
23489
23490 @item function
23491 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
23492 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
23493 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
23494 the string @code{??} is displayed.
23495
23496 @item line
23497 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
23498 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
23499
23500 @item pc
23501 Indicates the current program counter address.
23502 @end table
23503
23504 @node TUI Keys
23505 @section TUI Key Bindings
23506 @cindex TUI key bindings
23507
23508 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
23509 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23510 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
23511 @end ifset
23512 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23513 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
23514 @end ifclear
23515 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
23516 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
23517
23518 @table @kbd
23519 @kindex C-x C-a
23520 @item C-x C-a
23521 @kindex C-x a
23522 @itemx C-x a
23523 @kindex C-x A
23524 @itemx C-x A
23525 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
23526 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
23527 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
23528 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
23529 The screen is then refreshed.
23530
23531 @kindex C-x 1
23532 @item C-x 1
23533 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
23534 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
23535 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
23536
23537 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
23538
23539 @kindex C-x 2
23540 @item C-x 2
23541 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
23542 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
23543 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
23544 previous layout and the new one.
23545
23546 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
23547
23548 @kindex C-x o
23549 @item C-x o
23550 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
23551 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
23552 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
23553
23554 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
23555
23556 @kindex C-x s
23557 @item C-x s
23558 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
23559 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
23560 @end table
23561
23562 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
23563
23564 @table @asis
23565 @kindex PgUp
23566 @item @key{PgUp}
23567 Scroll the active window one page up.
23568
23569 @kindex PgDn
23570 @item @key{PgDn}
23571 Scroll the active window one page down.
23572
23573 @kindex Up
23574 @item @key{Up}
23575 Scroll the active window one line up.
23576
23577 @kindex Down
23578 @item @key{Down}
23579 Scroll the active window one line down.
23580
23581 @kindex Left
23582 @item @key{Left}
23583 Scroll the active window one column left.
23584
23585 @kindex Right
23586 @item @key{Right}
23587 Scroll the active window one column right.
23588
23589 @kindex C-L
23590 @item @kbd{C-L}
23591 Refresh the screen.
23592 @end table
23593
23594 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
23595 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
23596 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
23597 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
23598 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
23599
23600 @node TUI Single Key Mode
23601 @section TUI Single Key Mode
23602 @cindex TUI single key mode
23603
23604 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
23605 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
23606 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
23607
23608 @table @kbd
23609 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23610 @item c
23611 continue
23612
23613 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23614 @item d
23615 down
23616
23617 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23618 @item f
23619 finish
23620
23621 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23622 @item n
23623 next
23624
23625 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23626 @item q
23627 exit the SingleKey mode.
23628
23629 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23630 @item r
23631 run
23632
23633 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23634 @item s
23635 step
23636
23637 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23638 @item u
23639 up
23640
23641 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23642 @item v
23643 info locals
23644
23645 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23646 @item w
23647 where
23648 @end table
23649
23650 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
23651 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
23652 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
23653 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
23654 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
23655 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
23656
23657
23658 @node TUI Commands
23659 @section TUI-specific Commands
23660 @cindex TUI commands
23661
23662 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
23663 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
23664 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
23665 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
23666
23667 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
23668 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
23669 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
23670 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
23671 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
23672
23673 @table @code
23674 @item info win
23675 @kindex info win
23676 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
23677
23678 @item layout next
23679 @kindex layout
23680 Display the next layout.
23681
23682 @item layout prev
23683 Display the previous layout.
23684
23685 @item layout src
23686 Display the source window only.
23687
23688 @item layout asm
23689 Display the assembly window only.
23690
23691 @item layout split
23692 Display the source and assembly window.
23693
23694 @item layout regs
23695 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
23696
23697 @item focus next
23698 @kindex focus
23699 Make the next window active for scrolling.
23700
23701 @item focus prev
23702 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
23703
23704 @item focus src
23705 Make the source window active for scrolling.
23706
23707 @item focus asm
23708 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
23709
23710 @item focus regs
23711 Make the register window active for scrolling.
23712
23713 @item focus cmd
23714 Make the command window active for scrolling.
23715
23716 @item refresh
23717 @kindex refresh
23718 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
23719
23720 @item tui reg float
23721 @kindex tui reg
23722 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
23723
23724 @item tui reg general
23725 Show the general registers in the register window.
23726
23727 @item tui reg next
23728 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
23729 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
23730 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
23731 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
23732
23733 @item tui reg system
23734 Show the system registers in the register window.
23735
23736 @item update
23737 @kindex update
23738 Update the source window and the current execution point.
23739
23740 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
23741 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
23742 @kindex winheight
23743 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
23744 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
23745 decrease it.
23746
23747 @item tabset @var{nchars}
23748 @kindex tabset
23749 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
23750 @end table
23751
23752 @node TUI Configuration
23753 @section TUI Configuration Variables
23754 @cindex TUI configuration variables
23755
23756 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
23757
23758 @table @code
23759 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
23760 @kindex set tui border-kind
23761 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
23762 The possible values are the following:
23763 @table @code
23764 @item space
23765 Use a space character to draw the border.
23766
23767 @item ascii
23768 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
23769
23770 @item acs
23771 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
23772 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
23773 @end table
23774
23775 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
23776 @kindex set tui border-mode
23777 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
23778 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
23779 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
23780 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
23781 @table @code
23782 @item normal
23783 Use normal attributes to display the border.
23784
23785 @item standout
23786 Use standout mode.
23787
23788 @item reverse
23789 Use reverse video mode.
23790
23791 @item half
23792 Use half bright mode.
23793
23794 @item half-standout
23795 Use half bright and standout mode.
23796
23797 @item bold
23798 Use extra bright or bold mode.
23799
23800 @item bold-standout
23801 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
23802 @end table
23803 @end table
23804
23805 @node Emacs
23806 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
23807
23808 @cindex Emacs
23809 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
23810 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
23811 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
23812 @value{GDBN}.
23813
23814 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
23815 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
23816 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
23817 created Emacs buffer.
23818 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
23819
23820 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
23821 things:
23822
23823 @itemize @bullet
23824 @item
23825 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
23826 the GUD buffer.
23827
23828 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
23829 and output done by the program you are debugging.
23830
23831 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
23832 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
23833 in this way.
23834
23835 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
23836 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
23837 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
23838 stop.
23839
23840 @item
23841 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
23842
23843 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
23844 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
23845 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
23846 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
23847 and the source.
23848
23849 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
23850 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
23851 @end itemize
23852
23853 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
23854 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
23855 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
23856 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
23857
23858 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
23859 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
23860 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
23861 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
23862 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
23863 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
23864 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
23865 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
23866 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
23867
23868 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
23869 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
23870 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
23871 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23872
23873 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
23874 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
23875 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
23876 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
23877 one you want.
23878
23879 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
23880 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
23881
23882 @table @kbd
23883 @item C-h m
23884 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
23885
23886 @item C-c C-s
23887 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
23888 update the display window to show the current file and location.
23889
23890 @item C-c C-n
23891 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
23892 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
23893 to show the current file and location.
23894
23895 @item C-c C-i
23896 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
23897 display window accordingly.
23898
23899 @item C-c C-f
23900 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
23901 @code{finish} command.
23902
23903 @item C-c C-r
23904 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
23905 command.
23906
23907 @item C-c <
23908 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
23909 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
23910 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
23911
23912 @item C-c >
23913 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
23914 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
23915 @end table
23916
23917 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
23918 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
23919
23920 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
23921 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
23922 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
23923 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
23924 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
23925 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
23926 speedbar displays watch expressions.
23927
23928 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
23929 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
23930 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
23931 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
23932 frame.
23933
23934 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
23935 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
23936 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
23937 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
23938 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
23939 to correspond properly with the code.
23940
23941 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
23942 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
23943 Emacs Manual}).
23944
23945 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
23946 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
23947 @ignore
23948 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
23949 @kindex Epoch
23950 @kindex inspect
23951
23952 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
23953 called the @code{epoch}
23954 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
23955 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
23956 each value is printed in its own window.
23957 @end ignore
23958
23959
23960 @node GDB/MI
23961 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
23962
23963 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
23964
23965 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
23966 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
23967 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
23968 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
23969 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
23970 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
23971
23972 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
23973 in the form of a reference manual.
23974
23975 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
23976 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
23977 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
23978
23979 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
23980
23981 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
23982 This chapter uses the following notation:
23983
23984 @itemize @bullet
23985 @item
23986 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
23987
23988 @item
23989 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
23990 it may or may not be given.
23991
23992 @item
23993 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
23994 may repeat zero or more times.
23995
23996 @item
23997 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
23998 may repeat one or more times.
23999
24000 @item
24001 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24002 @end itemize
24003
24004 @ignore
24005 @heading Dependencies
24006 @end ignore
24007
24008 @menu
24009 * GDB/MI General Design::
24010 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24011 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24012 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24013 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24014 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24015 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24016 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24017 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24018 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24019 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24020 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24021 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24022 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24023 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24024 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24025 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24026 @ignore
24027 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24028 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24029 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24030 @end ignore
24031 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24032 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24033 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24034 @end menu
24035
24036 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24037 @node GDB/MI General Design
24038 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24039 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24040
24041 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24042 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24043 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24044 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24045 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24046 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24047 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24048 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24049 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24050 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24051
24052 The important examples of notifications are:
24053 @itemize @bullet
24054
24055 @item
24056 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24057 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24058 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24059 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24060 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24061 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24062 command itself was successfully executed.
24063
24064 @item
24065 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24066 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24067 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24068 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24069 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24070 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24071
24072 @item
24073 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24074 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24075 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24076 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24077 orthogonal frontend design.
24078
24079 @end itemize
24080
24081 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24082 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24083 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24084 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24085 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24086 the user interface.
24087
24088
24089 @menu
24090 * Context management::
24091 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24092 * Thread groups::
24093 @end menu
24094
24095 @node Context management
24096 @subsection Context management
24097
24098 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24099 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24100 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24101 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24102 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24103 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24104 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24105 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24106 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24107
24108 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24109 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24110 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24111 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24112 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24113 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24114 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24115 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24116 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24117 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24118 for thread and frame to operate on.
24119
24120 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24121 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24122 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24123 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24124 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24125 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24126 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24127 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24128 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24129 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24130
24131 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24132 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24133 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24134 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24135 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24136 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24137 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24138 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24139 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24140 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24141 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24142 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24143 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24144 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24145 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24146 @samp{--frame} options.
24147
24148 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24149 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24150
24151 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24152 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24153 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24154 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24155 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24156 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24157 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24158 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24159 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24160
24161 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24162 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24163 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24164 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24165 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24166 are running.
24167
24168 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24169 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24170 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24171 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24172 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24173 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24174 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24175 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24176 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24177 @samp{--thread} option).
24178
24179 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24180 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24181 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24182 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24183
24184 @node Thread groups
24185 @subsection Thread groups
24186 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24187 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24188 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24189 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24190 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24191
24192 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24193 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24194 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24195 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24196 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24197 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24198 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24199 into processes.
24200
24201 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24202 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24203 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24204 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24205 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24206 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24207 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24208 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24209 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24210 the members of specific thread group.
24211
24212 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24213 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24214 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24215 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24216 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24217 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24218 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24219 after attaching to that thread group.
24220
24221 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24222 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24223 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24224 such thread groups.
24225
24226 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24227 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24228 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24229
24230 @menu
24231 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24232 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24233 @end menu
24234
24235 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24236 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24237
24238 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24239 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24240 @table @code
24241 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24242 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24243
24244 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24245 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24246 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24247
24248 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24249 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24250 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24251
24252 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24253 "any sequence of digits"
24254
24255 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24256 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24257
24258 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24259 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24260
24261 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24262 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24263
24264 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24265 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24266 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24267
24268 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24269 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24270
24271 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24272 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24273 @end table
24274
24275 @noindent
24276 Notes:
24277
24278 @itemize @bullet
24279 @item
24280 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24281 output is described below.
24282
24283 @item
24284 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24285 finishes.
24286
24287 @item
24288 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24289 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24290 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24291 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24292 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24293 @end itemize
24294
24295 Pragmatics:
24296
24297 @itemize @bullet
24298 @item
24299 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24300
24301 @item
24302 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24303 @end itemize
24304
24305 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24306 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24307
24308 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24309 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24310 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24311 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24312 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24313 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24314
24315 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24316 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24317 @var{token}.
24318
24319 @table @code
24320 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24321 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24322
24323 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24324 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24325
24326 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
24327 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
24328
24329 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
24330 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
24331
24332 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
24333 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
24334
24335 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
24336 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
24337
24338 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
24339 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
24340
24341 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
24342 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24343
24344 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
24345 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
24346
24347 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
24348 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
24349 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
24350
24351 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
24352 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
24353
24354 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
24355 @code{ @var{string} }
24356
24357 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
24358 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
24359
24360 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
24361 @code{@var{c-string}}
24362
24363 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
24364 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
24365
24366 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
24367 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
24368 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
24369
24370 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
24371 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
24372
24373 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
24374 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
24375
24376 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
24377 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
24378
24379 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
24380 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
24381
24382 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24383 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24384
24385 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24386 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
24387 @end table
24388
24389 @noindent
24390 Notes:
24391
24392 @itemize @bullet
24393 @item
24394 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
24395
24396 @item
24397 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
24398 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
24399 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
24400 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
24401 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
24402 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
24403 prior command.
24404
24405 @item
24406 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24407 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
24408 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
24409 prefixed by @samp{+}.
24410
24411 @item
24412 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24413 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
24414 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
24415 @samp{*}.
24416
24417 @item
24418 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24419 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
24420 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
24421 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
24422
24423 @item
24424 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24425 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
24426 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
24427 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
24428
24429 @item
24430 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24431 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
24432 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
24433
24434 @item
24435 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24436 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
24437 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
24438 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
24439
24440 @item
24441 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24442 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
24443 @var{values}.
24444
24445
24446 @end itemize
24447
24448 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
24449 details about the various output records.
24450
24451 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24452 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
24453 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
24454
24455 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
24456 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
24457
24458 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
24459 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
24460 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
24461 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
24462 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
24463 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
24464
24465 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
24466 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
24467 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
24468
24469 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24470 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
24471 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
24472 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
24473
24474 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
24475 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
24476
24477 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
24478 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
24479 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
24480 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
24481 might change.
24482
24483 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
24484 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
24485 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
24486 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
24487
24488 @itemize @bullet
24489 @item
24490 New MI commands may be added.
24491
24492 @item
24493 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
24494
24495 @item
24496 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
24497 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
24498
24499 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
24500 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
24501
24502 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
24503 @c resolve inconsistencies.
24504 @end itemize
24505
24506 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
24507 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
24508 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
24509 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
24510 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
24511
24512 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
24513 @c version?
24514
24515 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
24516 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
24517 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
24518 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
24519 @cindex mailing lists
24520
24521 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24522 @node GDB/MI Output Records
24523 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
24524
24525 @menu
24526 * GDB/MI Result Records::
24527 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
24528 * GDB/MI Async Records::
24529 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
24530 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
24531 @end menu
24532
24533 @node GDB/MI Result Records
24534 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
24535
24536 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24537 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
24538 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
24539 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
24540
24541 @table @code
24542 @findex ^done
24543 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
24544 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
24545 values.
24546
24547 @item "^running"
24548 @findex ^running
24549 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
24550 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
24551 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
24552 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
24553 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
24554 which threads are resumed.
24555
24556 @item "^connected"
24557 @findex ^connected
24558 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
24559
24560 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
24561 @findex ^error
24562 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
24563 error message.
24564
24565 @item "^exit"
24566 @findex ^exit
24567 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
24568
24569 @end table
24570
24571 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
24572 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
24573
24574 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
24575 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24576 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
24577 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
24578 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
24579
24580 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
24581 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
24582 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
24583 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
24584 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
24585
24586 @table @code
24587 @item "~" @var{string-output}
24588 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
24589 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
24590
24591 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
24592 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
24593 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
24594 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
24595
24596 @item "&" @var{string-output}
24597 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
24598 internals.
24599 @end table
24600
24601 @node GDB/MI Async Records
24602 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
24603
24604 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24605 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
24606 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
24607 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
24608 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
24609 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
24610
24611 The following is the list of possible async records:
24612
24613 @table @code
24614
24615 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
24616 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
24617 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
24618 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
24619 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
24620 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
24621 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
24622 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
24623 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
24624 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
24625
24626 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
24627 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
24628 following values:
24629
24630 @table @code
24631 @item breakpoint-hit
24632 A breakpoint was reached.
24633 @item watchpoint-trigger
24634 A watchpoint was triggered.
24635 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
24636 A read watchpoint was triggered.
24637 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
24638 An access watchpoint was triggered.
24639 @item function-finished
24640 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
24641 @item location-reached
24642 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
24643 @item watchpoint-scope
24644 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
24645 @item end-stepping-range
24646 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
24647 similar CLI command was accomplished.
24648 @item exited-signalled
24649 The inferior exited because of a signal.
24650 @item exited
24651 The inferior exited.
24652 @item exited-normally
24653 The inferior exited normally.
24654 @item signal-received
24655 A signal was received by the inferior.
24656 @end table
24657
24658 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
24659 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
24660 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
24661 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
24662 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
24663 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
24664 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
24665 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
24666 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
24667 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
24668 if such information is not available.
24669
24670 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
24671 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
24672 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
24673 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
24674 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
24675 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
24676 cannot be used in any way.
24677
24678 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
24679 A thread group became associated with a running program,
24680 either because the program was just started or the thread group
24681 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
24682 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
24683 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
24684
24685 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
24686 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
24687 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
24688 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
24689 thread group.
24690
24691 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
24692 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
24693 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
24694 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
24695 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
24696
24697 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
24698 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
24699 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
24700 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
24701 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
24702 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
24703 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
24704
24705 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
24706 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
24707 that thread.
24708
24709 @item =library-loaded,...
24710 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
24711 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
24712 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
24713 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
24714 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
24715 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
24716 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
24717 @var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
24718 library are loaded. The @var{thread-group} field, if present,
24719 specifies the id of the thread group in whose context the library was loaded.
24720 If the field is absent, it means the library was loaded in the context
24721 of all present thread groups.
24722
24723 @item =library-unloaded,...
24724 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
24725 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
24726 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
24727 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
24728 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
24729 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
24730 thread groups.
24731
24732 @end table
24733
24734 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
24735 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
24736
24737 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
24738 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
24739 fields:
24740
24741 @table @code
24742 @item level
24743 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
24744 zero. This field is always present.
24745
24746 @item func
24747 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
24748 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
24749
24750 @item addr
24751 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
24752
24753 @item file
24754 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
24755 address. This field may be absent.
24756
24757 @item line
24758 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
24759 may be absent.
24760
24761 @item from
24762 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
24763 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
24764
24765 @end table
24766
24767 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
24768 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
24769
24770 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
24771 uses a tuple with the following fields:
24772
24773 @table @code
24774 @item id
24775 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
24776 always present.
24777
24778 @item target-id
24779 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
24780
24781 @item details
24782 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
24783 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
24784 frontend. This field is optional.
24785
24786 @item state
24787 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
24788 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
24789
24790 @item core
24791 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
24792 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
24793 @end table
24794
24795
24796 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24797 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
24798 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
24799 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
24800
24801 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
24802 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
24803 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
24804 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
24805
24806 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
24807 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
24808
24809 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
24810
24811 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
24812 information of the breakpoint.
24813
24814 @smallexample
24815 -> -break-insert main
24816 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
24817 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
24818 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
24819 <- (gdb)
24820 @end smallexample
24821
24822 @subheading Program Execution
24823
24824 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
24825 reason that execution stopped.
24826
24827 @smallexample
24828 -> -exec-run
24829 <- ^running
24830 <- (gdb)
24831 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
24832 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
24833 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
24834 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
24835 <- (gdb)
24836 -> -exec-continue
24837 <- ^running
24838 <- (gdb)
24839 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
24840 <- (gdb)
24841 @end smallexample
24842
24843 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
24844
24845 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
24846
24847 @smallexample
24848 -> (gdb)
24849 <- -gdb-exit
24850 <- ^exit
24851 @end smallexample
24852
24853 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
24854 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
24855 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
24856 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
24857 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
24858 fails to exit in reasonable time.
24859
24860 @subheading A Bad Command
24861
24862 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
24863
24864 @smallexample
24865 -> -rubbish
24866 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
24867 <- (gdb)
24868 @end smallexample
24869
24870
24871 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24872 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
24873 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
24874
24875 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
24876 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
24877
24878 @subheading Motivation
24879
24880 The motivation for this collection of commands.
24881
24882 @subheading Introduction
24883
24884 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
24885
24886 @subheading Commands
24887
24888 For each command in the block, the following is described:
24889
24890 @subsubheading Synopsis
24891
24892 @smallexample
24893 -command @var{args}@dots{}
24894 @end smallexample
24895
24896 @subsubheading Result
24897
24898 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24899
24900 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
24901
24902 @subsubheading Example
24903
24904 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
24905 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
24906
24907
24908 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24909 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
24910 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
24911
24912 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
24913 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
24914 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
24915 breakpoints.
24916
24917 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
24918 @findex -break-after
24919
24920 @subsubheading Synopsis
24921
24922 @smallexample
24923 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
24924 @end smallexample
24925
24926 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
24927 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
24928 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
24929 @samp{-break-list} command below.
24930
24931 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24932
24933 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
24934
24935 @subsubheading Example
24936
24937 @smallexample
24938 (gdb)
24939 -break-insert main
24940 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
24941 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
24942 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
24943 (gdb)
24944 -break-after 1 3
24945 ~
24946 ^done
24947 (gdb)
24948 -break-list
24949 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
24950 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24951 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24952 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24953 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24954 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24955 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24956 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24957 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
24958 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
24959 (gdb)
24960 @end smallexample
24961
24962 @ignore
24963 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
24964 @findex -break-catch
24965 @end ignore
24966
24967 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
24968 @findex -break-commands
24969
24970 @subsubheading Synopsis
24971
24972 @smallexample
24973 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
24974 @end smallexample
24975
24976 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
24977 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
24978 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
24979 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
24980 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
24981 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
24982
24983 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24984
24985 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
24986
24987 @subsubheading Example
24988
24989 @smallexample
24990 (gdb)
24991 -break-insert main
24992 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
24993 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
24994 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
24995 (gdb)
24996 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
24997 ^done
24998 (gdb)
24999 @end smallexample
25000
25001 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25002 @findex -break-condition
25003
25004 @subsubheading Synopsis
25005
25006 @smallexample
25007 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25008 @end smallexample
25009
25010 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25011 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25012 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25013 command below).
25014
25015 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25016
25017 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25018
25019 @subsubheading Example
25020
25021 @smallexample
25022 (gdb)
25023 -break-condition 1 1
25024 ^done
25025 (gdb)
25026 -break-list
25027 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25028 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25029 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25030 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25031 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25032 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25033 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25034 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25035 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25036 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25037 (gdb)
25038 @end smallexample
25039
25040 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25041 @findex -break-delete
25042
25043 @subsubheading Synopsis
25044
25045 @smallexample
25046 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25047 @end smallexample
25048
25049 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25050 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25051
25052 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25053
25054 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25055
25056 @subsubheading Example
25057
25058 @smallexample
25059 (gdb)
25060 -break-delete 1
25061 ^done
25062 (gdb)
25063 -break-list
25064 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25065 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25066 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25067 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25068 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25069 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25070 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25071 body=[]@}
25072 (gdb)
25073 @end smallexample
25074
25075 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25076 @findex -break-disable
25077
25078 @subsubheading Synopsis
25079
25080 @smallexample
25081 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25082 @end smallexample
25083
25084 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25085 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25086
25087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25088
25089 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25090
25091 @subsubheading Example
25092
25093 @smallexample
25094 (gdb)
25095 -break-disable 2
25096 ^done
25097 (gdb)
25098 -break-list
25099 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25100 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25101 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25102 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25103 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25104 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25105 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25106 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
25107 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25108 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
25109 (gdb)
25110 @end smallexample
25111
25112 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
25113 @findex -break-enable
25114
25115 @subsubheading Synopsis
25116
25117 @smallexample
25118 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25119 @end smallexample
25120
25121 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
25122
25123 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25124
25125 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
25126
25127 @subsubheading Example
25128
25129 @smallexample
25130 (gdb)
25131 -break-enable 2
25132 ^done
25133 (gdb)
25134 -break-list
25135 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25136 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25137 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25138 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25139 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25140 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25141 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25142 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25143 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25144 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
25145 (gdb)
25146 @end smallexample
25147
25148 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
25149 @findex -break-info
25150
25151 @subsubheading Synopsis
25152
25153 @smallexample
25154 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
25155 @end smallexample
25156
25157 @c REDUNDANT???
25158 Get information about a single breakpoint.
25159
25160 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25161
25162 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
25163
25164 @subsubheading Example
25165 N.A.
25166
25167 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
25168 @findex -break-insert
25169
25170 @subsubheading Synopsis
25171
25172 @smallexample
25173 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
25174 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
25175 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
25176 @end smallexample
25177
25178 @noindent
25179 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
25180
25181 @itemize @bullet
25182 @item function
25183 @c @item +offset
25184 @c @item -offset
25185 @c @item linenum
25186 @item filename:linenum
25187 @item filename:function
25188 @item *address
25189 @end itemize
25190
25191 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
25192
25193 @table @samp
25194 @item -t
25195 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
25196 @item -h
25197 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
25198 @item -c @var{condition}
25199 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
25200 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
25201 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
25202 @item -f
25203 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
25204 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
25205 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
25206 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
25207 cannot be parsed.
25208 @item -d
25209 Create a disabled breakpoint.
25210 @item -a
25211 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
25212 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
25213 @end table
25214
25215 @subsubheading Result
25216
25217 The result is in the form:
25218
25219 @smallexample
25220 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
25221 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
25222 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
25223 times="@var{times}"@}
25224 @end smallexample
25225
25226 @noindent
25227 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
25228 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
25229 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
25230 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
25231 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
25232 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
25233 which use the same output).
25234
25235 Note: this format is open to change.
25236 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
25237
25238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25239
25240 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
25241 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
25242
25243 @subsubheading Example
25244
25245 @smallexample
25246 (gdb)
25247 -break-insert main
25248 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
25249 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
25250 (gdb)
25251 -break-insert -t foo
25252 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
25253 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
25254 (gdb)
25255 -break-list
25256 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25257 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25258 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25259 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25260 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25261 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25262 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25263 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25264 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
25265 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
25266 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
25267 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
25268 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
25269 (gdb)
25270 -break-insert -r foo.*
25271 ~int foo(int, int);
25272 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
25273 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
25274 (gdb)
25275 @end smallexample
25276
25277 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
25278 @findex -break-list
25279
25280 @subsubheading Synopsis
25281
25282 @smallexample
25283 -break-list
25284 @end smallexample
25285
25286 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
25287
25288 @table @samp
25289 @item Number
25290 number of the breakpoint
25291 @item Type
25292 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
25293 @item Disposition
25294 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
25295 or @samp{nokeep}
25296 @item Enabled
25297 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
25298 @item Address
25299 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
25300 @item What
25301 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
25302 name, line number
25303 @item Times
25304 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
25305 @end table
25306
25307 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
25308 @code{body} field is an empty list.
25309
25310 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25311
25312 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
25313
25314 @subsubheading Example
25315
25316 @smallexample
25317 (gdb)
25318 -break-list
25319 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25320 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25321 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25322 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25323 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25324 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25325 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25326 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25327 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
25328 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25329 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25330 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
25331 (gdb)
25332 @end smallexample
25333
25334 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
25335
25336 @smallexample
25337 (gdb)
25338 -break-list
25339 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25340 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25341 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25342 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25343 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25344 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25345 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25346 body=[]@}
25347 (gdb)
25348 @end smallexample
25349
25350 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
25351 @findex -break-passcount
25352
25353 @subsubheading Synopsis
25354
25355 @smallexample
25356 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
25357 @end smallexample
25358
25359 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
25360 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
25361 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
25362 command @samp{passcount}.
25363
25364 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
25365 @findex -break-watch
25366
25367 @subsubheading Synopsis
25368
25369 @smallexample
25370 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
25371 @end smallexample
25372
25373 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
25374 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
25375 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
25376 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
25377 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
25378 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
25379 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
25380 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
25381
25382 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
25383 breakpoints inserted.
25384
25385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25386
25387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
25388 @samp{rwatch}.
25389
25390 @subsubheading Example
25391
25392 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
25393
25394 @smallexample
25395 (gdb)
25396 -break-watch x
25397 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
25398 (gdb)
25399 -exec-continue
25400 ^running
25401 (gdb)
25402 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
25403 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
25404 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
25405 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
25406 (gdb)
25407 @end smallexample
25408
25409 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
25410 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
25411 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
25412
25413 @smallexample
25414 (gdb)
25415 -break-watch C
25416 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
25417 (gdb)
25418 -exec-continue
25419 ^running
25420 (gdb)
25421 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
25422 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
25423 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
25424 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25425 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
25426 (gdb)
25427 -exec-continue
25428 ^running
25429 (gdb)
25430 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
25431 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
25432 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
25433 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25434 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
25435 (gdb)
25436 @end smallexample
25437
25438 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
25439 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
25440 deleted.
25441
25442 @smallexample
25443 (gdb)
25444 -break-watch C
25445 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
25446 (gdb)
25447 -break-list
25448 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25449 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25450 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25451 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25452 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25453 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25454 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25455 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25456 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25457 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25458 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
25459 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
25460 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
25461 (gdb)
25462 -exec-continue
25463 ^running
25464 (gdb)
25465 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
25466 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
25467 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
25468 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25469 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
25470 (gdb)
25471 -break-list
25472 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25473 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25474 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25475 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25476 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25477 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25478 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25479 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25480 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25481 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25482 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
25483 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
25484 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
25485 (gdb)
25486 -exec-continue
25487 ^running
25488 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
25489 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
25490 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
25491 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25492 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
25493 (gdb)
25494 -break-list
25495 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25496 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25497 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25498 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25499 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25500 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25501 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25502 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25503 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25504 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25505 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
25506 times="1"@}]@}
25507 (gdb)
25508 @end smallexample
25509
25510 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25511 @node GDB/MI Program Context
25512 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
25513
25514 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
25515 @findex -exec-arguments
25516
25517
25518 @subsubheading Synopsis
25519
25520 @smallexample
25521 -exec-arguments @var{args}
25522 @end smallexample
25523
25524 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
25525 @samp{-exec-run}.
25526
25527 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25528
25529 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
25530
25531 @subsubheading Example
25532
25533 @smallexample
25534 (gdb)
25535 -exec-arguments -v word
25536 ^done
25537 (gdb)
25538 @end smallexample
25539
25540
25541 @ignore
25542 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
25543 @findex -exec-show-arguments
25544
25545 @subsubheading Synopsis
25546
25547 @smallexample
25548 -exec-show-arguments
25549 @end smallexample
25550
25551 Print the arguments of the program.
25552
25553 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25554
25555 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
25556
25557 @subsubheading Example
25558 N.A.
25559 @end ignore
25560
25561
25562 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
25563 @findex -environment-cd
25564
25565 @subsubheading Synopsis
25566
25567 @smallexample
25568 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
25569 @end smallexample
25570
25571 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
25572
25573 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25574
25575 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
25576
25577 @subsubheading Example
25578
25579 @smallexample
25580 (gdb)
25581 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
25582 ^done
25583 (gdb)
25584 @end smallexample
25585
25586
25587 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
25588 @findex -environment-directory
25589
25590 @subsubheading Synopsis
25591
25592 @smallexample
25593 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
25594 @end smallexample
25595
25596 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
25597 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
25598 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
25599 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
25600 occurs as normal.
25601 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
25602 multiple directories in a single command
25603 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
25604 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
25605 If blanks are needed as
25606 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
25607 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
25608 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
25609 character must not be used
25610 in any directory name.
25611 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
25612
25613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25614
25615 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
25616
25617 @subsubheading Example
25618
25619 @smallexample
25620 (gdb)
25621 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
25622 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
25623 (gdb)
25624 -environment-directory ""
25625 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
25626 (gdb)
25627 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
25628 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
25629 (gdb)
25630 -environment-directory -r
25631 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
25632 (gdb)
25633 @end smallexample
25634
25635
25636 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
25637 @findex -environment-path
25638
25639 @subsubheading Synopsis
25640
25641 @smallexample
25642 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
25643 @end smallexample
25644
25645 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
25646 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
25647 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
25648 supplied in addition to the
25649 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
25650 occurs as normal.
25651 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
25652 multiple directories in a single command
25653 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
25654 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
25655 If blanks are needed as
25656 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
25657 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
25658 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
25659 character must not be used
25660 in any directory name.
25661 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
25662
25663
25664 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25665
25666 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
25667
25668 @subsubheading Example
25669
25670 @smallexample
25671 (gdb)
25672 -environment-path
25673 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
25674 (gdb)
25675 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
25676 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
25677 (gdb)
25678 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
25679 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
25680 (gdb)
25681 @end smallexample
25682
25683
25684 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
25685 @findex -environment-pwd
25686
25687 @subsubheading Synopsis
25688
25689 @smallexample
25690 -environment-pwd
25691 @end smallexample
25692
25693 Show the current working directory.
25694
25695 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25696
25697 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
25698
25699 @subsubheading Example
25700
25701 @smallexample
25702 (gdb)
25703 -environment-pwd
25704 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
25705 (gdb)
25706 @end smallexample
25707
25708 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25709 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
25710 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
25711
25712
25713 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
25714 @findex -thread-info
25715
25716 @subsubheading Synopsis
25717
25718 @smallexample
25719 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
25720 @end smallexample
25721
25722 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
25723 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
25724 threads. When printing information about all threads,
25725 also reports the current thread.
25726
25727 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25728
25729 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
25730 about all threads.
25731
25732 @subsubheading Example
25733
25734 @smallexample
25735 -thread-info
25736 ^done,threads=[
25737 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
25738 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
25739 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
25740 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
25741 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
25742 current-thread-id="1"
25743 (gdb)
25744 @end smallexample
25745
25746 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
25747
25748 @table @code
25749 @item stopped
25750 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
25751 threads.
25752
25753 @item running
25754 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
25755 threads.
25756
25757 @end table
25758
25759 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
25760 @findex -thread-list-ids
25761
25762 @subsubheading Synopsis
25763
25764 @smallexample
25765 -thread-list-ids
25766 @end smallexample
25767
25768 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
25769 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
25770
25771 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
25772 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
25773
25774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25775
25776 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
25777
25778 @subsubheading Example
25779
25780 @smallexample
25781 (gdb)
25782 -thread-list-ids
25783 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
25784 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
25785 (gdb)
25786 @end smallexample
25787
25788
25789 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
25790 @findex -thread-select
25791
25792 @subsubheading Synopsis
25793
25794 @smallexample
25795 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
25796 @end smallexample
25797
25798 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
25799 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
25800
25801 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
25802 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
25803
25804 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25805
25806 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
25807
25808 @subsubheading Example
25809
25810 @smallexample
25811 (gdb)
25812 -exec-next
25813 ^running
25814 (gdb)
25815 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
25816 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
25817 (gdb)
25818 -thread-list-ids
25819 ^done,
25820 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
25821 number-of-threads="3"
25822 (gdb)
25823 -thread-select 3
25824 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
25825 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
25826 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
25827 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
25828 (gdb)
25829 @end smallexample
25830
25831 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25832 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
25833 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
25834
25835 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
25836 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
25837 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
25838 other cases.
25839
25840 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
25841 @findex -exec-continue
25842
25843 @subsubheading Synopsis
25844
25845 @smallexample
25846 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
25847 @end smallexample
25848
25849 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
25850 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
25851 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
25852 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
25853 @itemize @bullet
25854 @item
25855 breakpoints or watchpoints
25856 @item
25857 signals or exceptions
25858 @item
25859 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
25860 @item
25861 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
25862 @end itemize
25863 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
25864 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
25865 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
25866 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
25867 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
25868 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
25869
25870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25871
25872 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
25873
25874 @subsubheading Example
25875
25876 @smallexample
25877 -exec-continue
25878 ^running
25879 (gdb)
25880 @@Hello world
25881 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
25882 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
25883 line="13"@}
25884 (gdb)
25885 @end smallexample
25886
25887
25888 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
25889 @findex -exec-finish
25890
25891 @subsubheading Synopsis
25892
25893 @smallexample
25894 -exec-finish [--reverse]
25895 @end smallexample
25896
25897 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
25898 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
25899 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
25900 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
25901 function was called.
25902
25903 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25904
25905 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
25906
25907 @subsubheading Example
25908
25909 Function returning @code{void}.
25910
25911 @smallexample
25912 -exec-finish
25913 ^running
25914 (gdb)
25915 @@hello from foo
25916 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
25917 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
25918 (gdb)
25919 @end smallexample
25920
25921 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
25922 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
25923 value itself.
25924
25925 @smallexample
25926 -exec-finish
25927 ^running
25928 (gdb)
25929 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
25930 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
25931 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25932 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
25933 (gdb)
25934 @end smallexample
25935
25936
25937 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
25938 @findex -exec-interrupt
25939
25940 @subsubheading Synopsis
25941
25942 @smallexample
25943 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
25944 @end smallexample
25945
25946 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
25947 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
25948 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
25949 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
25950 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
25951
25952 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
25953 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
25954 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
25955 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
25956
25957 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
25958 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
25959 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
25960 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
25961
25962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25963
25964 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
25965
25966 @subsubheading Example
25967
25968 @smallexample
25969 (gdb)
25970 111-exec-continue
25971 111^running
25972
25973 (gdb)
25974 222-exec-interrupt
25975 222^done
25976 (gdb)
25977 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
25978 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
25979 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
25980 (gdb)
25981
25982 (gdb)
25983 -exec-interrupt
25984 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
25985 (gdb)
25986 @end smallexample
25987
25988 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
25989 @findex -exec-jump
25990
25991 @subsubheading Synopsis
25992
25993 @smallexample
25994 -exec-jump @var{location}
25995 @end smallexample
25996
25997 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
25998 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
25999 different forms of @var{location}.
26000
26001 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26002
26003 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
26004
26005 @subsubheading Example
26006
26007 @smallexample
26008 -exec-jump foo.c:10
26009 *running,thread-id="all"
26010 ^running
26011 @end smallexample
26012
26013
26014 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
26015 @findex -exec-next
26016
26017 @subsubheading Synopsis
26018
26019 @smallexample
26020 -exec-next [--reverse]
26021 @end smallexample
26022
26023 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
26024 of the next source line is reached.
26025
26026 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
26027 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
26028 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
26029 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
26030 source line where the function was called.
26031
26032
26033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26034
26035 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
26036
26037 @subsubheading Example
26038
26039 @smallexample
26040 -exec-next
26041 ^running
26042 (gdb)
26043 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
26044 (gdb)
26045 @end smallexample
26046
26047
26048 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
26049 @findex -exec-next-instruction
26050
26051 @subsubheading Synopsis
26052
26053 @smallexample
26054 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
26055 @end smallexample
26056
26057 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
26058 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
26059 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
26060 printed as well.
26061
26062 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
26063 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
26064 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
26065 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
26066 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
26067
26068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26069
26070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
26071
26072 @subsubheading Example
26073
26074 @smallexample
26075 (gdb)
26076 -exec-next-instruction
26077 ^running
26078
26079 (gdb)
26080 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26081 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
26082 (gdb)
26083 @end smallexample
26084
26085
26086 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
26087 @findex -exec-return
26088
26089 @subsubheading Synopsis
26090
26091 @smallexample
26092 -exec-return
26093 @end smallexample
26094
26095 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
26096 Displays the new current frame.
26097
26098 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26099
26100 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
26101
26102 @subsubheading Example
26103
26104 @smallexample
26105 (gdb)
26106 200-break-insert callee4
26107 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
26108 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
26109 (gdb)
26110 000-exec-run
26111 000^running
26112 (gdb)
26113 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
26114 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26115 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26116 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
26117 (gdb)
26118 205-break-delete
26119 205^done
26120 (gdb)
26121 111-exec-return
26122 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
26123 args=[@{name="strarg",
26124 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26125 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26126 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26127 (gdb)
26128 @end smallexample
26129
26130
26131 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
26132 @findex -exec-run
26133
26134 @subsubheading Synopsis
26135
26136 @smallexample
26137 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N]
26138 @end smallexample
26139
26140 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
26141 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
26142 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
26143 the program has exited exceptionally.
26144
26145 When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
26146 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
26147 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
26148 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
26149
26150 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26151
26152 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
26153
26154 @subsubheading Examples
26155
26156 @smallexample
26157 (gdb)
26158 -break-insert main
26159 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
26160 (gdb)
26161 -exec-run
26162 ^running
26163 (gdb)
26164 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
26165 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26166 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
26167 (gdb)
26168 @end smallexample
26169
26170 @noindent
26171 Program exited normally:
26172
26173 @smallexample
26174 (gdb)
26175 -exec-run
26176 ^running
26177 (gdb)
26178 x = 55
26179 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26180 (gdb)
26181 @end smallexample
26182
26183 @noindent
26184 Program exited exceptionally:
26185
26186 @smallexample
26187 (gdb)
26188 -exec-run
26189 ^running
26190 (gdb)
26191 x = 55
26192 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
26193 (gdb)
26194 @end smallexample
26195
26196 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
26197 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
26198
26199 @smallexample
26200 (gdb)
26201 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
26202 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
26203 @end smallexample
26204
26205
26206 @c @subheading -exec-signal
26207
26208
26209 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
26210 @findex -exec-step
26211
26212 @subsubheading Synopsis
26213
26214 @smallexample
26215 -exec-step [--reverse]
26216 @end smallexample
26217
26218 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
26219 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
26220 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
26221 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
26222 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
26223 previously executed source line.
26224
26225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26226
26227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
26228
26229 @subsubheading Example
26230
26231 Stepping into a function:
26232
26233 @smallexample
26234 -exec-step
26235 ^running
26236 (gdb)
26237 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26238 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
26239 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
26240 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
26241 (gdb)
26242 @end smallexample
26243
26244 Regular stepping:
26245
26246 @smallexample
26247 -exec-step
26248 ^running
26249 (gdb)
26250 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
26251 (gdb)
26252 @end smallexample
26253
26254
26255 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
26256 @findex -exec-step-instruction
26257
26258 @subsubheading Synopsis
26259
26260 @smallexample
26261 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
26262 @end smallexample
26263
26264 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
26265 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
26266 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
26267 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
26268 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
26269 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
26270 as well.
26271
26272 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26273
26274 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
26275
26276 @subsubheading Example
26277
26278 @smallexample
26279 (gdb)
26280 -exec-step-instruction
26281 ^running
26282
26283 (gdb)
26284 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26285 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26286 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
26287 (gdb)
26288 -exec-step-instruction
26289 ^running
26290
26291 (gdb)
26292 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26293 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26294 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
26295 (gdb)
26296 @end smallexample
26297
26298
26299 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
26300 @findex -exec-until
26301
26302 @subsubheading Synopsis
26303
26304 @smallexample
26305 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
26306 @end smallexample
26307
26308 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
26309 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
26310 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
26311 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
26312
26313 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26314
26315 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
26316
26317 @subsubheading Example
26318
26319 @smallexample
26320 (gdb)
26321 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
26322 ^running
26323 (gdb)
26324 x = 55
26325 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
26326 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
26327 (gdb)
26328 @end smallexample
26329
26330 @ignore
26331 @subheading -file-clear
26332 Is this going away????
26333 @end ignore
26334
26335 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26336 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
26337 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
26338
26339
26340 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
26341 @findex -stack-info-frame
26342
26343 @subsubheading Synopsis
26344
26345 @smallexample
26346 -stack-info-frame
26347 @end smallexample
26348
26349 Get info on the selected frame.
26350
26351 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26352
26353 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
26354 (without arguments).
26355
26356 @subsubheading Example
26357
26358 @smallexample
26359 (gdb)
26360 -stack-info-frame
26361 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
26362 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26363 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
26364 (gdb)
26365 @end smallexample
26366
26367 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
26368 @findex -stack-info-depth
26369
26370 @subsubheading Synopsis
26371
26372 @smallexample
26373 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
26374 @end smallexample
26375
26376 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
26377 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
26378
26379 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26380
26381 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
26382
26383 @subsubheading Example
26384
26385 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
26386
26387 @smallexample
26388 (gdb)
26389 -stack-info-depth
26390 ^done,depth="12"
26391 (gdb)
26392 -stack-info-depth 4
26393 ^done,depth="4"
26394 (gdb)
26395 -stack-info-depth 12
26396 ^done,depth="12"
26397 (gdb)
26398 -stack-info-depth 11
26399 ^done,depth="11"
26400 (gdb)
26401 -stack-info-depth 13
26402 ^done,depth="12"
26403 (gdb)
26404 @end smallexample
26405
26406 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
26407 @findex -stack-list-arguments
26408
26409 @subsubheading Synopsis
26410
26411 @smallexample
26412 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
26413 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
26414 @end smallexample
26415
26416 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
26417 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
26418 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
26419 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
26420 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
26421 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
26422 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
26423 which case only existing frames will be returned.
26424
26425 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26426 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26427 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26428 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26429 structures and unions.
26430
26431 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
26432 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
26433
26434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26435
26436 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
26437 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
26438 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
26439
26440 @subsubheading Example
26441
26442 @smallexample
26443 (gdb)
26444 -stack-list-frames
26445 ^done,
26446 stack=[
26447 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26448 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26449 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
26450 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
26451 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26452 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
26453 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
26454 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26455 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
26456 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
26457 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26458 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
26459 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
26460 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26461 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
26462 (gdb)
26463 -stack-list-arguments 0
26464 ^done,
26465 stack-args=[
26466 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
26467 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
26468 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
26469 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
26470 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
26471 (gdb)
26472 -stack-list-arguments 1
26473 ^done,
26474 stack-args=[
26475 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
26476 frame=@{level="1",
26477 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
26478 frame=@{level="2",args=[
26479 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26480 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
26481 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
26482 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26483 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
26484 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
26485 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
26486 (gdb)
26487 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
26488 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
26489 (gdb)
26490 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
26491 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
26492 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26493 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
26494 (gdb)
26495 @end smallexample
26496
26497 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
26498
26499
26500 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
26501 @findex -stack-list-frames
26502
26503 @subsubheading Synopsis
26504
26505 @smallexample
26506 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
26507 @end smallexample
26508
26509 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
26510 following info:
26511
26512 @table @samp
26513 @item @var{level}
26514 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
26515 @item @var{addr}
26516 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
26517 @item @var{func}
26518 Function name.
26519 @item @var{file}
26520 File name of the source file where the function lives.
26521 @item @var{fullname}
26522 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
26523 @item @var{line}
26524 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
26525 @item @var{from}
26526 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
26527 if the frame's function is not known.
26528 @end table
26529
26530 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
26531 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
26532 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
26533 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
26534 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
26535 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
26536 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
26537
26538 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26539
26540 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
26541
26542 @subsubheading Example
26543
26544 Full stack backtrace:
26545
26546 @smallexample
26547 (gdb)
26548 -stack-list-frames
26549 ^done,stack=
26550 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
26551 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
26552 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26553 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26554 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26555 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26556 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26557 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26558 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26559 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26560 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26561 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26562 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26563 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26564 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26565 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26566 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26567 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26568 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26569 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26570 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26571 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26572 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
26573 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
26574 (gdb)
26575 @end smallexample
26576
26577 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
26578
26579 @smallexample
26580 (gdb)
26581 -stack-list-frames 3 5
26582 ^done,stack=
26583 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26584 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26585 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26586 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26587 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26588 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
26589 (gdb)
26590 @end smallexample
26591
26592 Show a single frame:
26593
26594 @smallexample
26595 (gdb)
26596 -stack-list-frames 3 3
26597 ^done,stack=
26598 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26599 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
26600 (gdb)
26601 @end smallexample
26602
26603
26604 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
26605 @findex -stack-list-locals
26606
26607 @subsubheading Synopsis
26608
26609 @smallexample
26610 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
26611 @end smallexample
26612
26613 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
26614 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26615 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26616 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26617 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26618 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
26619 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
26620 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
26621 more detail.
26622
26623 This command is deprecated in favor of the
26624 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
26625
26626 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26627
26628 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
26629
26630 @subsubheading Example
26631
26632 @smallexample
26633 (gdb)
26634 -stack-list-locals 0
26635 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
26636 (gdb)
26637 -stack-list-locals --all-values
26638 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
26639 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
26640 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
26641 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
26642 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
26643 (gdb)
26644 @end smallexample
26645
26646 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
26647 @findex -stack-list-variables
26648
26649 @subsubheading Synopsis
26650
26651 @smallexample
26652 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
26653 @end smallexample
26654
26655 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
26656 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26657 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26658 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26659 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26660 structures and unions.
26661
26662 @subsubheading Example
26663
26664 @smallexample
26665 (gdb)
26666 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
26667 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
26668 (gdb)
26669 @end smallexample
26670
26671
26672 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
26673 @findex -stack-select-frame
26674
26675 @subsubheading Synopsis
26676
26677 @smallexample
26678 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
26679 @end smallexample
26680
26681 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
26682 the stack.
26683
26684 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
26685 option to every command.
26686
26687 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26688
26689 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
26690 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
26691
26692 @subsubheading Example
26693
26694 @smallexample
26695 (gdb)
26696 -stack-select-frame 2
26697 ^done
26698 (gdb)
26699 @end smallexample
26700
26701 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26702 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
26703 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
26704
26705 @ignore
26706
26707 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
26708
26709 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
26710 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
26711 used by @code{Insight}.
26712
26713 The two main reasons for that are:
26714
26715 @enumerate 1
26716 @item
26717 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
26718
26719 @item
26720 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
26721 now).
26722 @end enumerate
26723
26724 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
26725 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
26726 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
26727 hints about their use.
26728
26729 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
26730 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
26731 least, the following operations:
26732
26733 @itemize @bullet
26734 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
26735 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
26736 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
26737 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
26738 @end itemize
26739
26740 @end ignore
26741
26742 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
26743
26744 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
26745
26746 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
26747 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
26748 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
26749 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
26750 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
26751 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
26752 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
26753 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
26754 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
26755 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
26756 object, or to change display format.
26757
26758 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
26759 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
26760 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
26761 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
26762 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
26763 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
26764 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
26765 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
26766 child will be created.
26767
26768 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
26769 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
26770 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
26771 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
26772 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
26773
26774 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
26775 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
26776 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
26777 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
26778 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
26779 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
26780 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
26781 variables that frontend has created.
26782
26783 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
26784 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
26785 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
26786 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
26787 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
26788 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
26789 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
26790 implicitly updated.
26791
26792 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
26793 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
26794 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
26795 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
26796 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
26797 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
26798 frame. Consider this example:
26799
26800 @smallexample
26801 void do_work(...)
26802 @{
26803 struct work_state state;
26804
26805 if (...)
26806 do_work(...);
26807 @}
26808 @end smallexample
26809
26810 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
26811 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
26812 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
26813 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
26814 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
26815
26816 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
26817 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
26818 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
26819 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
26820 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
26821 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
26822
26823 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
26824 access this functionality:
26825
26826 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
26827 @item @strong{Operation}
26828 @tab @strong{Description}
26829
26830 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
26831 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
26832 @item @code{-var-create}
26833 @tab create a variable object
26834 @item @code{-var-delete}
26835 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
26836 @item @code{-var-set-format}
26837 @tab set the display format of this variable
26838 @item @code{-var-show-format}
26839 @tab show the display format of this variable
26840 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
26841 @tab tells how many children this object has
26842 @item @code{-var-list-children}
26843 @tab return a list of the object's children
26844 @item @code{-var-info-type}
26845 @tab show the type of this variable object
26846 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
26847 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
26848 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
26849 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
26850 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
26851 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
26852 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
26853 @tab get the value of this variable
26854 @item @code{-var-assign}
26855 @tab set the value of this variable
26856 @item @code{-var-update}
26857 @tab update the variable and its children
26858 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
26859 @tab set frozeness attribute
26860 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
26861 @tab set range of children to display on update
26862 @end multitable
26863
26864 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
26865 how it can be used.
26866
26867 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
26868
26869 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
26870 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
26871
26872 @smallexample
26873 -enable-pretty-printing
26874 @end smallexample
26875
26876 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
26877 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
26878 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
26879 request that this functionality be enabled.
26880
26881 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
26882
26883 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
26884 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
26885
26886 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
26887 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
26888
26889 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
26890 @findex -var-create
26891
26892 @subsubheading Synopsis
26893
26894 @smallexample
26895 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
26896 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
26897 @end smallexample
26898
26899 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
26900 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
26901 register.
26902
26903 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
26904 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
26905 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
26906 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
26907 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
26908
26909 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
26910 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
26911 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
26912 object must be created.
26913
26914 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
26915 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
26916
26917 @itemize @bullet
26918 @item
26919 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
26920
26921 @item
26922 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
26923
26924 @item
26925 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
26926 @end itemize
26927
26928 @cindex dynamic varobj
26929 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
26930 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
26931 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
26932 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
26933 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
26934 compatibility for existing clients.
26935
26936 @subsubheading Result
26937
26938 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
26939 are:
26940
26941 @table @samp
26942 @item name
26943 The name of the varobj.
26944
26945 @item numchild
26946 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
26947 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
26948 @samp{has_more} attribute.
26949
26950 @item value
26951 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
26952 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
26953 will not be interesting.
26954
26955 @item type
26956 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
26957 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.
26958
26959 @item thread-id
26960 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
26961 thread's identifier.
26962
26963 @item has_more
26964 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
26965 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
26966
26967 @item dynamic
26968 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
26969 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
26970 then this attribute will not be present.
26971
26972 @item displayhint
26973 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
26974 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
26975 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
26976 @end table
26977
26978 Typical output will look like this:
26979
26980 @smallexample
26981 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
26982 has_more="@var{has_more}"
26983 @end smallexample
26984
26985
26986 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
26987 @findex -var-delete
26988
26989 @subsubheading Synopsis
26990
26991 @smallexample
26992 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
26993 @end smallexample
26994
26995 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
26996 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
26997
26998 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
26999
27000
27001 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
27002 @findex -var-set-format
27003
27004 @subsubheading Synopsis
27005
27006 @smallexample
27007 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
27008 @end smallexample
27009
27010 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
27011 @var{format-spec}.
27012
27013 @anchor{-var-set-format}
27014 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
27015
27016 @smallexample
27017 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
27018 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
27019 @end smallexample
27020
27021 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
27022 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
27023 for pointers, etc.).
27024
27025 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
27026 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
27027
27028 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
27029 @findex -var-show-format
27030
27031 @subsubheading Synopsis
27032
27033 @smallexample
27034 -var-show-format @var{name}
27035 @end smallexample
27036
27037 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
27038
27039 @smallexample
27040 @var{format} @expansion{}
27041 @var{format-spec}
27042 @end smallexample
27043
27044
27045 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
27046 @findex -var-info-num-children
27047
27048 @subsubheading Synopsis
27049
27050 @smallexample
27051 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
27052 @end smallexample
27053
27054 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
27055
27056 @smallexample
27057 numchild=@var{n}
27058 @end smallexample
27059
27060 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
27061 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
27062 be available.
27063
27064
27065 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
27066 @findex -var-list-children
27067
27068 @subsubheading Synopsis
27069
27070 @smallexample
27071 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
27072 @end smallexample
27073 @anchor{-var-list-children}
27074
27075 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
27076 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
27077 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
27078 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
27079 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
27080 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
27081 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
27082 and unions.
27083
27084 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
27085 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
27086 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
27087 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
27088 reported.
27089
27090 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
27091 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
27092 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
27093 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
27094 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
27095 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
27096 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
27097 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
27098 the visible items.
27099
27100 For each child the following results are returned:
27101
27102 @table @var
27103
27104 @item name
27105 Name of the variable object created for this child.
27106
27107 @item exp
27108 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
27109 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
27110
27111 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
27112 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
27113
27114 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
27115 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
27116 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
27117 type and value are not present.
27118
27119 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
27120 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
27121 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
27122
27123 @item numchild
27124 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
27125 0.
27126
27127 @item type
27128 The type of the child.
27129
27130 @item value
27131 If values were requested, this is the value.
27132
27133 @item thread-id
27134 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
27135 Otherwise this result is not present.
27136
27137 @item frozen
27138 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
27139 @end table
27140
27141 The result may have its own attributes:
27142
27143 @table @samp
27144 @item displayhint
27145 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
27146 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
27147 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
27148
27149 @item has_more
27150 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
27151 remaining after the end of the selected range.
27152 @end table
27153
27154 @subsubheading Example
27155
27156 @smallexample
27157 (gdb)
27158 -var-list-children n
27159 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
27160 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
27161 (gdb)
27162 -var-list-children --all-values n
27163 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
27164 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
27165 @end smallexample
27166
27167
27168 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
27169 @findex -var-info-type
27170
27171 @subsubheading Synopsis
27172
27173 @smallexample
27174 -var-info-type @var{name}
27175 @end smallexample
27176
27177 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
27178 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
27179 @value{GDBN} CLI:
27180
27181 @smallexample
27182 type=@var{typename}
27183 @end smallexample
27184
27185
27186 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
27187 @findex -var-info-expression
27188
27189 @subsubheading Synopsis
27190
27191 @smallexample
27192 -var-info-expression @var{name}
27193 @end smallexample
27194
27195 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
27196 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
27197 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
27198
27199 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
27200 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
27201
27202 @smallexample
27203 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
27204 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
27205 @end smallexample
27206
27207 @noindent
27208 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
27209
27210 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
27211 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
27212 is of limited use.
27213
27214 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
27215 @findex -var-info-path-expression
27216
27217 @subsubheading Synopsis
27218
27219 @smallexample
27220 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
27221 @end smallexample
27222
27223 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
27224 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
27225 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
27226 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
27227 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
27228 watchpoint from a variable object.
27229
27230 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
27231 and will give an error when invoked on one.
27232
27233 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
27234 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
27235 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
27236 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
27237 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
27238 @smallexample
27239 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
27240 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
27241 @end smallexample
27242
27243 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
27244 @findex -var-show-attributes
27245
27246 @subsubheading Synopsis
27247
27248 @smallexample
27249 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
27250 @end smallexample
27251
27252 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
27253
27254 @smallexample
27255 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
27256 @end smallexample
27257
27258 @noindent
27259 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
27260
27261 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
27262 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
27263
27264 @subsubheading Synopsis
27265
27266 @smallexample
27267 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
27268 @end smallexample
27269
27270 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
27271 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
27272 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
27273 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
27274 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
27275 the current display format will be used. The current display format
27276 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
27277
27278 @smallexample
27279 value=@var{value}
27280 @end smallexample
27281
27282 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
27283 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
27284
27285 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
27286 @findex -var-assign
27287
27288 @subsubheading Synopsis
27289
27290 @smallexample
27291 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
27292 @end smallexample
27293
27294 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
27295 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
27296 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
27297 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
27298
27299 @subsubheading Example
27300
27301 @smallexample
27302 (gdb)
27303 -var-assign var1 3
27304 ^done,value="3"
27305 (gdb)
27306 -var-update *
27307 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
27308 (gdb)
27309 @end smallexample
27310
27311 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
27312 @findex -var-update
27313
27314 @subsubheading Synopsis
27315
27316 @smallexample
27317 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
27318 @end smallexample
27319
27320 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
27321 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
27322 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
27323 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
27324 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
27325 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
27326 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
27327 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
27328 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
27329 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
27330 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
27331 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
27332 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
27333
27334 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
27335 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
27336 diagnostic.
27337
27338 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
27339 only the selected range of children will be reported.
27340
27341 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
27342 @samp{changelist}.
27343
27344 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
27345
27346 @table @samp
27347 @item name
27348 The name of the varobj.
27349
27350 @item value
27351 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
27352 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
27353
27354 @item in_scope
27355 @anchor{-var-update}
27356 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
27357
27358 @table @code
27359 @item "true"
27360 The variable object's current value is valid.
27361
27362 @item "false"
27363 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
27364 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
27365 scope.
27366
27367 @item "invalid"
27368 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
27369 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
27370 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
27371 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
27372 objects.
27373 @end table
27374
27375 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
27376 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
27377
27378 @item type_changed
27379 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
27380 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
27381 be @samp{false}.
27382
27383 @item new_type
27384 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
27385 hold the new type.
27386
27387 @item new_num_children
27388 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
27389 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
27390
27391 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
27392 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
27393 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
27394 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
27395 children which may be available.
27396
27397 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
27398 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
27399 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
27400 only happen at the end of the update range).
27401
27402 @item displayhint
27403 The display hint, if any.
27404
27405 @item has_more
27406 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
27407 available outside the varobj's update range.
27408
27409 @item dynamic
27410 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
27411 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
27412 then this attribute will not be present.
27413
27414 @item new_children
27415 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
27416 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
27417 be listed in this attribute.
27418 @end table
27419
27420 @subsubheading Example
27421
27422 @smallexample
27423 (gdb)
27424 -var-assign var1 3
27425 ^done,value="3"
27426 (gdb)
27427 -var-update --all-values var1
27428 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
27429 type_changed="false"@}]
27430 (gdb)
27431 @end smallexample
27432
27433 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
27434 @findex -var-set-frozen
27435 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
27436
27437 @subsubheading Synopsis
27438
27439 @smallexample
27440 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
27441 @end smallexample
27442
27443 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
27444 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
27445 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
27446 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
27447 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
27448 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
27449 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
27450 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
27451 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
27452 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
27453 @code{-var-update} does.
27454
27455 @subsubheading Example
27456
27457 @smallexample
27458 (gdb)
27459 -var-set-frozen V 1
27460 ^done
27461 (gdb)
27462 @end smallexample
27463
27464 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
27465 @findex -var-set-update-range
27466 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
27467
27468 @subsubheading Synopsis
27469
27470 @smallexample
27471 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
27472 @end smallexample
27473
27474 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
27475 @code{-var-update}.
27476
27477 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
27478 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
27479 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
27480 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
27481
27482 @subsubheading Example
27483
27484 @smallexample
27485 (gdb)
27486 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
27487 ^done
27488 @end smallexample
27489
27490 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
27491 @findex -var-set-visualizer
27492 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
27493
27494 @subsubheading Synopsis
27495
27496 @smallexample
27497 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
27498 @end smallexample
27499
27500 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
27501
27502 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
27503 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
27504
27505 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
27506 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
27507 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
27508 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
27509 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
27510 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
27511 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
27512
27513 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
27514 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
27515 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
27516 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
27517
27518 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
27519 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
27520 can be used to check this.
27521
27522 @subsubheading Example
27523
27524 Resetting the visualizer:
27525
27526 @smallexample
27527 (gdb)
27528 -var-set-visualizer V None
27529 ^done
27530 @end smallexample
27531
27532 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
27533
27534 @smallexample
27535 (gdb)
27536 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
27537 ^done
27538 @end smallexample
27539
27540 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
27541 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
27542
27543 @smallexample
27544 (gdb)
27545 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
27546 ^done
27547 @end smallexample
27548
27549 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27550 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
27551 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
27552
27553 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
27554 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
27555 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
27556 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
27557
27558 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
27559 @c @subheading -data-assign
27560 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
27561 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
27562 @c set variable
27563 @c @subsubheading Example
27564 @c N.A.
27565
27566 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
27567 @findex -data-disassemble
27568
27569 @subsubheading Synopsis
27570
27571 @smallexample
27572 -data-disassemble
27573 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
27574 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
27575 -- @var{mode}
27576 @end smallexample
27577
27578 @noindent
27579 Where:
27580
27581 @table @samp
27582 @item @var{start-addr}
27583 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
27584 @item @var{end-addr}
27585 is the end address
27586 @item @var{filename}
27587 is the name of the file to disassemble
27588 @item @var{linenum}
27589 is the line number to disassemble around
27590 @item @var{lines}
27591 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
27592 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
27593 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
27594 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
27595 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
27596 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
27597 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
27598 are displayed.
27599 @item @var{mode}
27600 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
27601 disassembly).
27602 @end table
27603
27604 @subsubheading Result
27605
27606 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
27607
27608 @itemize @bullet
27609 @item Address
27610 @item Func-name
27611 @item Offset
27612 @item Instruction
27613 @end itemize
27614
27615 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
27616 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
27617
27618 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27619
27620 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
27621
27622 @subsubheading Example
27623
27624 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
27625
27626 @smallexample
27627 (gdb)
27628 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
27629 ^done,
27630 asm_insns=[
27631 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27632 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27633 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27634 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27635 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
27636 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
27637 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
27638 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27639 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
27640 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
27641 (gdb)
27642 @end smallexample
27643
27644 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
27645 @code{main}.
27646
27647 @smallexample
27648 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
27649 ^done,asm_insns=[
27650 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27651 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
27652 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27653 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27654 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27655 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27656 [@dots{}]
27657 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
27658 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
27659 (gdb)
27660 @end smallexample
27661
27662 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
27663
27664 @smallexample
27665 (gdb)
27666 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
27667 ^done,asm_insns=[
27668 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27669 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
27670 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27671 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27672 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27673 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
27674 (gdb)
27675 @end smallexample
27676
27677 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
27678
27679 @smallexample
27680 (gdb)
27681 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
27682 ^done,asm_insns=[
27683 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
27684 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
27685 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
27686 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27687 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
27688 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
27689 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
27690 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
27691 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27692 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27693 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27694 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
27695 (gdb)
27696 @end smallexample
27697
27698
27699 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
27700 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
27701
27702 @subsubheading Synopsis
27703
27704 @smallexample
27705 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
27706 @end smallexample
27707
27708 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
27709 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
27710 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
27711
27712 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27713
27714 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
27715 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
27716 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
27717
27718 @subsubheading Example
27719
27720 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
27721 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
27722 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
27723 output.
27724
27725 @smallexample
27726 211-data-evaluate-expression A
27727 211^done,value="1"
27728 (gdb)
27729 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
27730 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
27731 (gdb)
27732 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
27733 411^done,value="4"
27734 (gdb)
27735 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
27736 511^done,value="4"
27737 (gdb)
27738 @end smallexample
27739
27740
27741 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
27742 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
27743
27744 @subsubheading Synopsis
27745
27746 @smallexample
27747 -data-list-changed-registers
27748 @end smallexample
27749
27750 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
27751
27752 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27753
27754 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
27755 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
27756
27757 @subsubheading Example
27758
27759 On a PPC MBX board:
27760
27761 @smallexample
27762 (gdb)
27763 -exec-continue
27764 ^running
27765
27766 (gdb)
27767 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
27768 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
27769 line="5"@}
27770 (gdb)
27771 -data-list-changed-registers
27772 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
27773 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
27774 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
27775 (gdb)
27776 @end smallexample
27777
27778
27779 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
27780 @findex -data-list-register-names
27781
27782 @subsubheading Synopsis
27783
27784 @smallexample
27785 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
27786 @end smallexample
27787
27788 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
27789 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
27790 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
27791 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
27792 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
27793 include empty register names.
27794
27795 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27796
27797 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
27798 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
27799 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
27800
27801 @subsubheading Example
27802
27803 For the PPC MBX board:
27804 @smallexample
27805 (gdb)
27806 -data-list-register-names
27807 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
27808 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
27809 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
27810 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
27811 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
27812 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
27813 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
27814 (gdb)
27815 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
27816 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
27817 (gdb)
27818 @end smallexample
27819
27820 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
27821 @findex -data-list-register-values
27822
27823 @subsubheading Synopsis
27824
27825 @smallexample
27826 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
27827 @end smallexample
27828
27829 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
27830 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
27831 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
27832 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
27833
27834 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
27835
27836 @table @code
27837 @item x
27838 Hexadecimal
27839 @item o
27840 Octal
27841 @item t
27842 Binary
27843 @item d
27844 Decimal
27845 @item r
27846 Raw
27847 @item N
27848 Natural
27849 @end table
27850
27851 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27852
27853 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
27854 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
27855
27856 @subsubheading Example
27857
27858 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
27859 don't appear in the actual output):
27860
27861 @smallexample
27862 (gdb)
27863 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
27864 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
27865 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
27866 (gdb)
27867 -data-list-register-values x
27868 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
27869 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
27870 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
27871 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
27872 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
27873 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
27874 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
27875 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
27876 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
27877 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
27878 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
27879 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
27880 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
27881 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
27882 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
27883 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
27884 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
27885 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
27886 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
27887 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
27888 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
27889 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
27890 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
27891 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
27892 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
27893 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
27894 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
27895 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
27896 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
27897 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
27898 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
27899 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
27900 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
27901 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
27902 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
27903 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
27904 (gdb)
27905 @end smallexample
27906
27907
27908 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
27909 @findex -data-read-memory
27910
27911 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
27912
27913 @subsubheading Synopsis
27914
27915 @smallexample
27916 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
27917 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
27918 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
27919 @end smallexample
27920
27921 @noindent
27922 where:
27923
27924 @table @samp
27925 @item @var{address}
27926 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
27927 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
27928 quoted using the C convention.
27929
27930 @item @var{word-format}
27931 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
27932 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
27933 ,Output Formats}).
27934
27935 @item @var{word-size}
27936 The size of each memory word in bytes.
27937
27938 @item @var{nr-rows}
27939 The number of rows in the output table.
27940
27941 @item @var{nr-cols}
27942 The number of columns in the output table.
27943
27944 @item @var{aschar}
27945 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
27946 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
27947 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
27948 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
27949
27950 @item @var{byte-offset}
27951 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
27952 @end table
27953
27954 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
27955 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
27956 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
27957 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
27958 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
27959 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
27960 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
27961 @samp{addr}.
27962
27963 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
27964 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
27965 @samp{prev-page}.
27966
27967 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27968
27969 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
27970 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
27971
27972 @subsubheading Example
27973
27974 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
27975 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
27976 word. Display each word in hex.
27977
27978 @smallexample
27979 (gdb)
27980 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
27981 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
27982 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
27983 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
27984 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
27985 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
27986 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
27987 (gdb)
27988 @end smallexample
27989
27990 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
27991 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
27992
27993 @smallexample
27994 (gdb)
27995 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
27996 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
27997 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
27998 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
27999 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
28000 (gdb)
28001 @end smallexample
28002
28003 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
28004 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
28005 used as the non-printable character.
28006
28007 @smallexample
28008 (gdb)
28009 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
28010 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
28011 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
28012 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
28013 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28014 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28015 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28016 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28017 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
28018 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
28019 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
28020 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
28021 (gdb)
28022 @end smallexample
28023
28024 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
28025 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
28026
28027 @subsubheading Synopsis
28028
28029 @smallexample
28030 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
28031 @var{address} @var{count}
28032 @end smallexample
28033
28034 @noindent
28035 where:
28036
28037 @table @samp
28038 @item @var{address}
28039 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28040 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28041 quoted using the C convention.
28042
28043 @item @var{count}
28044 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
28045
28046 @item @var{byte-offset}
28047 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
28048 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
28049 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
28050 perform address arithmetics itself.
28051
28052 @end table
28053
28054 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
28055 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
28056 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
28057 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
28058 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
28059 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
28060
28061 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
28062 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
28063 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
28064 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
28065 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
28066 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
28067 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
28068 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
28069
28070 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
28071 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
28072 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
28073 and has the following fields:
28074
28075 @table @code
28076 @item begin
28077 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
28078
28079 @item end
28080 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
28081
28082 @item offset
28083 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
28084 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
28085
28086 @item contents
28087 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
28088
28089 @end table
28090
28091
28092
28093 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28094
28095 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
28096
28097 @subsubheading Example
28098
28099 @smallexample
28100 (gdb)
28101 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
28102 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
28103 end="0xbffff15e",
28104 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
28105 (gdb)
28106 @end smallexample
28107
28108
28109 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
28110 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
28111
28112 @subsubheading Synopsis
28113
28114 @smallexample
28115 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
28116 @end smallexample
28117
28118 @noindent
28119 where:
28120
28121 @table @samp
28122 @item @var{address}
28123 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28124 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28125 quoted using the C convention.
28126
28127 @item @var{contents}
28128 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
28129
28130 @end table
28131
28132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28133
28134 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
28135
28136 @subsubheading Example
28137
28138 @smallexample
28139 (gdb)
28140 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
28141 ^done
28142 (gdb)
28143 @end smallexample
28144
28145
28146 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28147 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
28148 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
28149
28150 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
28151 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
28152
28153 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
28154 @findex -trace-find
28155
28156 @subsubheading Synopsis
28157
28158 @smallexample
28159 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
28160 @end smallexample
28161
28162 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
28163 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
28164 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
28165
28166 @table @samp
28167
28168 @item none
28169 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
28170
28171 @item frame-number
28172 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
28173 that index.
28174
28175 @item tracepoint-number
28176 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
28177 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
28178
28179 @item pc
28180 An address is required as parameter. Finds
28181 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
28182 address.
28183
28184 @item pc-inside-range
28185 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
28186 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
28187 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
28188
28189 @item pc-outside-range
28190 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
28191 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
28192 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
28193
28194 @item line
28195 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
28196 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
28197 the specified location.
28198
28199 @end table
28200
28201 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
28202 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
28203
28204 @table @samp
28205 @item found
28206 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
28207 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
28208
28209 @item traceframe
28210 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
28211 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
28212
28213 @item tracepoint
28214 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
28215 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
28216
28217 @item frame
28218 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
28219 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
28220 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
28221
28222 @end table
28223
28224 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28225
28226 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
28227
28228 @subheading -trace-define-variable
28229 @findex -trace-define-variable
28230
28231 @subsubheading Synopsis
28232
28233 @smallexample
28234 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
28235 @end smallexample
28236
28237 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
28238 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
28239 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
28240 with the @samp{$} character.
28241
28242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28243
28244 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
28245
28246 @subheading -trace-list-variables
28247 @findex -trace-list-variables
28248
28249 @subsubheading Synopsis
28250
28251 @smallexample
28252 -trace-list-variables
28253 @end smallexample
28254
28255 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
28256 table has the following fields:
28257
28258 @table @samp
28259 @item name
28260 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
28261
28262 @item initial
28263 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
28264 field is always present.
28265
28266 @item current
28267 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
28268 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
28269 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
28270 presently running.
28271
28272 @end table
28273
28274 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28275
28276 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
28277
28278 @subsubheading Example
28279
28280 @smallexample
28281 (gdb)
28282 -trace-list-variables
28283 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
28284 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
28285 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
28286 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
28287 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
28288 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
28289 (gdb)
28290 @end smallexample
28291
28292 @subheading -trace-save
28293 @findex -trace-save
28294
28295 @subsubheading Synopsis
28296
28297 @smallexample
28298 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
28299 @end smallexample
28300
28301 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
28302 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
28303 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
28304 to perform the save.
28305
28306 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28307
28308 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
28309
28310
28311 @subheading -trace-start
28312 @findex -trace-start
28313
28314 @subsubheading Synopsis
28315
28316 @smallexample
28317 -trace-start
28318 @end smallexample
28319
28320 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
28321 have any fields.
28322
28323 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28324
28325 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
28326
28327 @subheading -trace-status
28328 @findex -trace-status
28329
28330 @subsubheading Synopsis
28331
28332 @smallexample
28333 -trace-status
28334 @end smallexample
28335
28336 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
28337 the following fields:
28338
28339 @table @samp
28340
28341 @item supported
28342 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
28343 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
28344 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
28345 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
28346 started. This field is always present.
28347
28348 @item running
28349 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
28350 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
28351 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
28352
28353 @item stop-reason
28354 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
28355 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
28356 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
28357 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
28358 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
28359 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
28360 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
28361 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
28362 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
28363
28364 @item stopping-tracepoint
28365 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
28366 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
28367 @samp{passcount}.
28368
28369 @item frames
28370 @itemx frames-created
28371 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
28372 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
28373 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
28374 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
28375
28376 @item buffer-size
28377 @itemx buffer-free
28378 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
28379 remaining space. These fields are optional.
28380
28381 @item circular
28382 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
28383 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
28384 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
28385 and may fill up.
28386
28387 @item disconnected
28388 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
28389 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
28390 that the trace run will stop.
28391
28392 @end table
28393
28394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28395
28396 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
28397
28398 @subheading -trace-stop
28399 @findex -trace-stop
28400
28401 @subsubheading Synopsis
28402
28403 @smallexample
28404 -trace-stop
28405 @end smallexample
28406
28407 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
28408 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
28409 @samp{running} fields are not output.
28410
28411 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28412
28413 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
28414
28415
28416 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28417 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
28418 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
28419
28420
28421 @ignore
28422 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
28423 @findex -symbol-info-address
28424
28425 @subsubheading Synopsis
28426
28427 @smallexample
28428 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
28429 @end smallexample
28430
28431 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
28432
28433 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28434
28435 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
28436
28437 @subsubheading Example
28438 N.A.
28439
28440
28441 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
28442 @findex -symbol-info-file
28443
28444 @subsubheading Synopsis
28445
28446 @smallexample
28447 -symbol-info-file
28448 @end smallexample
28449
28450 Show the file for the symbol.
28451
28452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28453
28454 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
28455 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
28456
28457 @subsubheading Example
28458 N.A.
28459
28460
28461 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
28462 @findex -symbol-info-function
28463
28464 @subsubheading Synopsis
28465
28466 @smallexample
28467 -symbol-info-function
28468 @end smallexample
28469
28470 Show which function the symbol lives in.
28471
28472 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28473
28474 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
28475
28476 @subsubheading Example
28477 N.A.
28478
28479
28480 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
28481 @findex -symbol-info-line
28482
28483 @subsubheading Synopsis
28484
28485 @smallexample
28486 -symbol-info-line
28487 @end smallexample
28488
28489 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
28490
28491 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28492
28493 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
28494 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
28495
28496 @subsubheading Example
28497 N.A.
28498
28499
28500 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
28501 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
28502
28503 @subsubheading Synopsis
28504
28505 @smallexample
28506 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
28507 @end smallexample
28508
28509 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
28510
28511 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28512
28513 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
28514
28515 @subsubheading Example
28516 N.A.
28517
28518
28519 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
28520 @findex -symbol-list-functions
28521
28522 @subsubheading Synopsis
28523
28524 @smallexample
28525 -symbol-list-functions
28526 @end smallexample
28527
28528 List the functions in the executable.
28529
28530 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28531
28532 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
28533 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28534
28535 @subsubheading Example
28536 N.A.
28537 @end ignore
28538
28539
28540 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
28541 @findex -symbol-list-lines
28542
28543 @subsubheading Synopsis
28544
28545 @smallexample
28546 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
28547 @end smallexample
28548
28549 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
28550 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
28551 ascending PC order.
28552
28553 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28554
28555 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
28556
28557 @subsubheading Example
28558 @smallexample
28559 (gdb)
28560 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
28561 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
28562 (gdb)
28563 @end smallexample
28564
28565
28566 @ignore
28567 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
28568 @findex -symbol-list-types
28569
28570 @subsubheading Synopsis
28571
28572 @smallexample
28573 -symbol-list-types
28574 @end smallexample
28575
28576 List all the type names.
28577
28578 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28579
28580 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
28581 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28582
28583 @subsubheading Example
28584 N.A.
28585
28586
28587 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
28588 @findex -symbol-list-variables
28589
28590 @subsubheading Synopsis
28591
28592 @smallexample
28593 -symbol-list-variables
28594 @end smallexample
28595
28596 List all the global and static variable names.
28597
28598 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28599
28600 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28601
28602 @subsubheading Example
28603 N.A.
28604
28605
28606 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
28607 @findex -symbol-locate
28608
28609 @subsubheading Synopsis
28610
28611 @smallexample
28612 -symbol-locate
28613 @end smallexample
28614
28615 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28616
28617 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
28618
28619 @subsubheading Example
28620 N.A.
28621
28622
28623 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
28624 @findex -symbol-type
28625
28626 @subsubheading Synopsis
28627
28628 @smallexample
28629 -symbol-type @var{variable}
28630 @end smallexample
28631
28632 Show type of @var{variable}.
28633
28634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28635
28636 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
28637 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
28638
28639 @subsubheading Example
28640 N.A.
28641 @end ignore
28642
28643
28644 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28645 @node GDB/MI File Commands
28646 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
28647
28648 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
28649 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
28650
28651 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
28652 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
28653
28654 @subsubheading Synopsis
28655
28656 @smallexample
28657 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
28658 @end smallexample
28659
28660 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
28661 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
28662 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
28663 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
28664 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
28665 notification.
28666
28667 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28668
28669 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
28670
28671 @subsubheading Example
28672
28673 @smallexample
28674 (gdb)
28675 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
28676 ^done
28677 (gdb)
28678 @end smallexample
28679
28680
28681 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
28682 @findex -file-exec-file
28683
28684 @subsubheading Synopsis
28685
28686 @smallexample
28687 -file-exec-file @var{file}
28688 @end smallexample
28689
28690 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
28691 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
28692 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
28693 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
28694 notification.
28695
28696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28697
28698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
28699
28700 @subsubheading Example
28701
28702 @smallexample
28703 (gdb)
28704 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
28705 ^done
28706 (gdb)
28707 @end smallexample
28708
28709
28710 @ignore
28711 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
28712 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
28713
28714 @subsubheading Synopsis
28715
28716 @smallexample
28717 -file-list-exec-sections
28718 @end smallexample
28719
28720 List the sections of the current executable file.
28721
28722 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28723
28724 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
28725 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
28726 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
28727
28728 @subsubheading Example
28729 N.A.
28730 @end ignore
28731
28732
28733 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
28734 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
28735
28736 @subsubheading Synopsis
28737
28738 @smallexample
28739 -file-list-exec-source-file
28740 @end smallexample
28741
28742 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
28743 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
28744 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
28745 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
28746
28747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28748
28749 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
28750
28751 @subsubheading Example
28752
28753 @smallexample
28754 (gdb)
28755 123-file-list-exec-source-file
28756 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
28757 (gdb)
28758 @end smallexample
28759
28760
28761 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
28762 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
28763
28764 @subsubheading Synopsis
28765
28766 @smallexample
28767 -file-list-exec-source-files
28768 @end smallexample
28769
28770 List the source files for the current executable.
28771
28772 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
28773 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
28774
28775 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28776
28777 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
28778 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
28779
28780 @subsubheading Example
28781 @smallexample
28782 (gdb)
28783 -file-list-exec-source-files
28784 ^done,files=[
28785 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
28786 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
28787 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
28788 (gdb)
28789 @end smallexample
28790
28791 @ignore
28792 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
28793 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
28794
28795 @subsubheading Synopsis
28796
28797 @smallexample
28798 -file-list-shared-libraries
28799 @end smallexample
28800
28801 List the shared libraries in the program.
28802
28803 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28804
28805 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
28806
28807 @subsubheading Example
28808 N.A.
28809
28810
28811 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
28812 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
28813
28814 @subsubheading Synopsis
28815
28816 @smallexample
28817 -file-list-symbol-files
28818 @end smallexample
28819
28820 List symbol files.
28821
28822 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28823
28824 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
28825
28826 @subsubheading Example
28827 N.A.
28828 @end ignore
28829
28830
28831 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
28832 @findex -file-symbol-file
28833
28834 @subsubheading Synopsis
28835
28836 @smallexample
28837 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
28838 @end smallexample
28839
28840 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
28841 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
28842 produced, except for a completion notification.
28843
28844 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28845
28846 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
28847
28848 @subsubheading Example
28849
28850 @smallexample
28851 (gdb)
28852 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
28853 ^done
28854 (gdb)
28855 @end smallexample
28856
28857 @ignore
28858 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28859 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
28860 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
28861
28862 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
28863
28864 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
28865
28866 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
28867
28868 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
28869
28870 @c @subheading -overlay-map
28871
28872 @c @subheading -overlay-off
28873
28874 @c @subheading -overlay-on
28875
28876 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
28877
28878 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28879 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
28880 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
28881
28882 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
28883
28884 @c @subheading -signal-handle
28885
28886 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
28887
28888 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
28889 @end ignore
28890
28891
28892 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28893 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
28894 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
28895
28896
28897 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
28898 @findex -target-attach
28899
28900 @subsubheading Synopsis
28901
28902 @smallexample
28903 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
28904 @end smallexample
28905
28906 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
28907 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
28908 group, the id previously returned by
28909 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
28910
28911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28912
28913 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
28914
28915 @subsubheading Example
28916 @smallexample
28917 (gdb)
28918 -target-attach 34
28919 =thread-created,id="1"
28920 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
28921 ^done
28922 (gdb)
28923 @end smallexample
28924
28925 @ignore
28926 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
28927 @findex -target-compare-sections
28928
28929 @subsubheading Synopsis
28930
28931 @smallexample
28932 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
28933 @end smallexample
28934
28935 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
28936 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
28937
28938 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28939
28940 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
28941
28942 @subsubheading Example
28943 N.A.
28944 @end ignore
28945
28946
28947 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
28948 @findex -target-detach
28949
28950 @subsubheading Synopsis
28951
28952 @smallexample
28953 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
28954 @end smallexample
28955
28956 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
28957 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
28958 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
28959
28960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28961
28962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
28963
28964 @subsubheading Example
28965
28966 @smallexample
28967 (gdb)
28968 -target-detach
28969 ^done
28970 (gdb)
28971 @end smallexample
28972
28973
28974 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
28975 @findex -target-disconnect
28976
28977 @subsubheading Synopsis
28978
28979 @smallexample
28980 -target-disconnect
28981 @end smallexample
28982
28983 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
28984 generally not resumed.
28985
28986 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28987
28988 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
28989
28990 @subsubheading Example
28991
28992 @smallexample
28993 (gdb)
28994 -target-disconnect
28995 ^done
28996 (gdb)
28997 @end smallexample
28998
28999
29000 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
29001 @findex -target-download
29002
29003 @subsubheading Synopsis
29004
29005 @smallexample
29006 -target-download
29007 @end smallexample
29008
29009 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
29010 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
29011
29012 @table @samp
29013 @item section
29014 The name of the section.
29015 @item section-sent
29016 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
29017 @item section-size
29018 The size of the section.
29019 @item total-sent
29020 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
29021 @item total-size
29022 The size of the overall executable to download.
29023 @end table
29024
29025 @noindent
29026 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
29027 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
29028
29029 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
29030 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
29031
29032 @table @samp
29033 @item section
29034 The name of the section.
29035 @item section-size
29036 The size of the section.
29037 @item total-size
29038 The size of the overall executable to download.
29039 @end table
29040
29041 @noindent
29042 At the end, a summary is printed.
29043
29044 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29045
29046 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
29047
29048 @subsubheading Example
29049
29050 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
29051 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
29052
29053 @smallexample
29054 (gdb)
29055 -target-download
29056 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
29057 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
29058 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
29059 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
29060 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
29061 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
29062 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
29063 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
29064 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
29065 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
29066 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
29067 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
29068 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
29069 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
29070 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
29071 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
29072 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
29073 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
29074 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
29075 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
29076 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
29077 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
29078 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
29079 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
29080 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
29081 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
29082 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
29083 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
29084 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
29085 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
29086 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
29087 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
29088 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
29089 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
29090 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
29091 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
29092 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
29093 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
29094 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
29095 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
29096 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
29097 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
29098 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
29099 write-rate="429"
29100 (gdb)
29101 @end smallexample
29102
29103
29104 @ignore
29105 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
29106 @findex -target-exec-status
29107
29108 @subsubheading Synopsis
29109
29110 @smallexample
29111 -target-exec-status
29112 @end smallexample
29113
29114 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
29115 not, for instance).
29116
29117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29118
29119 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29120
29121 @subsubheading Example
29122 N.A.
29123
29124
29125 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
29126 @findex -target-list-available-targets
29127
29128 @subsubheading Synopsis
29129
29130 @smallexample
29131 -target-list-available-targets
29132 @end smallexample
29133
29134 List the possible targets to connect to.
29135
29136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29137
29138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
29139
29140 @subsubheading Example
29141 N.A.
29142
29143
29144 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
29145 @findex -target-list-current-targets
29146
29147 @subsubheading Synopsis
29148
29149 @smallexample
29150 -target-list-current-targets
29151 @end smallexample
29152
29153 Describe the current target.
29154
29155 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29156
29157 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
29158 other things).
29159
29160 @subsubheading Example
29161 N.A.
29162
29163
29164 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
29165 @findex -target-list-parameters
29166
29167 @subsubheading Synopsis
29168
29169 @smallexample
29170 -target-list-parameters
29171 @end smallexample
29172
29173 @c ????
29174 @end ignore
29175
29176 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29177
29178 No equivalent.
29179
29180 @subsubheading Example
29181 N.A.
29182
29183
29184 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
29185 @findex -target-select
29186
29187 @subsubheading Synopsis
29188
29189 @smallexample
29190 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
29191 @end smallexample
29192
29193 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
29194
29195 @table @samp
29196 @item @var{type}
29197 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
29198 @item @var{parameters}
29199 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
29200 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
29201 @end table
29202
29203 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
29204 which the target program is, in the following form:
29205
29206 @smallexample
29207 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
29208 args=[@var{arg list}]
29209 @end smallexample
29210
29211 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29212
29213 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
29214
29215 @subsubheading Example
29216
29217 @smallexample
29218 (gdb)
29219 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
29220 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
29221 (gdb)
29222 @end smallexample
29223
29224 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29225 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
29226 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
29227
29228
29229 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
29230 @findex -target-file-put
29231
29232 @subsubheading Synopsis
29233
29234 @smallexample
29235 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
29236 @end smallexample
29237
29238 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
29239 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
29240
29241 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29242
29243 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
29244
29245 @subsubheading Example
29246
29247 @smallexample
29248 (gdb)
29249 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
29250 ^done
29251 (gdb)
29252 @end smallexample
29253
29254
29255 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
29256 @findex -target-file-get
29257
29258 @subsubheading Synopsis
29259
29260 @smallexample
29261 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
29262 @end smallexample
29263
29264 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
29265 on the host system.
29266
29267 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29268
29269 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
29270
29271 @subsubheading Example
29272
29273 @smallexample
29274 (gdb)
29275 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
29276 ^done
29277 (gdb)
29278 @end smallexample
29279
29280
29281 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
29282 @findex -target-file-delete
29283
29284 @subsubheading Synopsis
29285
29286 @smallexample
29287 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
29288 @end smallexample
29289
29290 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
29291
29292 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29293
29294 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
29295
29296 @subsubheading Example
29297
29298 @smallexample
29299 (gdb)
29300 -target-file-delete remotefile
29301 ^done
29302 (gdb)
29303 @end smallexample
29304
29305
29306 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29307 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
29308 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
29309
29310 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
29311
29312 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
29313 @findex -gdb-exit
29314
29315 @subsubheading Synopsis
29316
29317 @smallexample
29318 -gdb-exit
29319 @end smallexample
29320
29321 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
29322
29323 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29324
29325 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
29326
29327 @subsubheading Example
29328
29329 @smallexample
29330 (gdb)
29331 -gdb-exit
29332 ^exit
29333 @end smallexample
29334
29335
29336 @ignore
29337 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
29338 @findex -exec-abort
29339
29340 @subsubheading Synopsis
29341
29342 @smallexample
29343 -exec-abort
29344 @end smallexample
29345
29346 Kill the inferior running program.
29347
29348 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29349
29350 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
29351
29352 @subsubheading Example
29353 N.A.
29354 @end ignore
29355
29356
29357 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
29358 @findex -gdb-set
29359
29360 @subsubheading Synopsis
29361
29362 @smallexample
29363 -gdb-set
29364 @end smallexample
29365
29366 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
29367 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
29368
29369 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29370
29371 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
29372
29373 @subsubheading Example
29374
29375 @smallexample
29376 (gdb)
29377 -gdb-set $foo=3
29378 ^done
29379 (gdb)
29380 @end smallexample
29381
29382
29383 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
29384 @findex -gdb-show
29385
29386 @subsubheading Synopsis
29387
29388 @smallexample
29389 -gdb-show
29390 @end smallexample
29391
29392 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
29393
29394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29395
29396 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
29397
29398 @subsubheading Example
29399
29400 @smallexample
29401 (gdb)
29402 -gdb-show annotate
29403 ^done,value="0"
29404 (gdb)
29405 @end smallexample
29406
29407 @c @subheading -gdb-source
29408
29409
29410 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
29411 @findex -gdb-version
29412
29413 @subsubheading Synopsis
29414
29415 @smallexample
29416 -gdb-version
29417 @end smallexample
29418
29419 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
29420
29421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29422
29423 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
29424 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
29425
29426 @subsubheading Example
29427
29428 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
29429 @c box in TeX.
29430 @smallexample
29431 (gdb)
29432 -gdb-version
29433 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
29434 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
29435 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
29436 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
29437 ~ certain conditions.
29438 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
29439 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
29440 ~ details.
29441 ~This GDB was configured as
29442 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
29443 ^done
29444 (gdb)
29445 @end smallexample
29446
29447 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
29448 @findex -list-features
29449
29450 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
29451 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
29452 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
29453 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
29454 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
29455 startup.
29456
29457 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
29458 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
29459 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
29460 is given below.
29461
29462 Example output:
29463
29464 @smallexample
29465 (gdb) -list-features
29466 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
29467 @end smallexample
29468
29469 The current list of features is:
29470
29471 @table @samp
29472 @item frozen-varobjs
29473 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
29474 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
29475 of @code{-varobj-create}.
29476 @item pending-breakpoints
29477 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
29478 @item python
29479 Indicates presence of Python scripting support, Python-based
29480 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
29481 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
29482 @item thread-info
29483 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
29484 @item data-read-memory-bytes
29485 Indicates presense of the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
29486 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
29487
29488 @end table
29489
29490 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
29491 @findex -list-target-features
29492
29493 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
29494 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
29495 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
29496 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
29497 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
29498 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
29499 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
29500 Example output:
29501
29502 @smallexample
29503 (gdb) -list-features
29504 ^done,result=["async"]
29505 @end smallexample
29506
29507 The current list of features is:
29508
29509 @table @samp
29510 @item async
29511 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
29512 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
29513 while the target is running.
29514
29515 @item reverse
29516 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
29517 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
29518
29519 @end table
29520
29521 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
29522 @findex -list-thread-groups
29523
29524 @subheading Synopsis
29525
29526 @smallexample
29527 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
29528 @end smallexample
29529
29530 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
29531 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
29532 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
29533 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
29534 top-level thread groups.
29535
29536 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
29537 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
29538 available on the target.
29539
29540 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
29541 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
29542 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
29543 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
29544 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
29545 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
29546 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
29547 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
29548
29549 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
29550 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
29551 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
29552 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
29553 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
29554 @samp{threads} field.
29555
29556 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
29557 the following caveats:
29558
29559 @itemize @bullet
29560 @item
29561 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
29562 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
29563 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
29564
29565 @item
29566 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
29567 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
29568 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
29569 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
29570 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
29571 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
29572
29573 @end itemize
29574
29575 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
29576 have the following fields:
29577
29578 @table @code
29579 @item id
29580 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
29581 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
29582 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
29583
29584 @item type
29585 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
29586 valid type.
29587
29588 @item pid
29589 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
29590 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
29591
29592 @item num_children
29593 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
29594 absent for an available thread group.
29595
29596 @item threads
29597 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
29598 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
29599 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
29600
29601 @item cores
29602 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
29603 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
29604 such information is not available.
29605
29606 @item executable
29607 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
29608 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
29609 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
29610
29611 @end table
29612
29613 @subheading Example
29614
29615 @smallexample
29616 @value{GDBP}
29617 -list-thread-groups
29618 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
29619 -list-thread-groups 17
29620 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29621 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
29622 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29623 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29624 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
29625 -list-thread-groups --available
29626 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
29627 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
29628 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
29629 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
29630 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
29631 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
29632 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
29633 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
29634 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
29635 @end smallexample
29636
29637
29638 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
29639 @findex -add-inferior
29640
29641 @subheading Synopsis
29642
29643 @smallexample
29644 -add-inferior
29645 @end smallexample
29646
29647 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
29648 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
29649 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
29650 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
29651 field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the
29652 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
29653
29654 @subheading Example
29655
29656 @smallexample
29657 @value{GDBP}
29658 -add-inferior
29659 ^done,thread-group="i3"
29660 @end smallexample
29661
29662 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
29663 @findex -interpreter-exec
29664
29665 @subheading Synopsis
29666
29667 @smallexample
29668 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
29669 @end smallexample
29670 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
29671
29672 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
29673
29674 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29675
29676 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
29677
29678 @subheading Example
29679
29680 @smallexample
29681 (gdb)
29682 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
29683 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
29684 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
29685 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
29686 ^done
29687 (gdb)
29688 @end smallexample
29689
29690 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
29691 @findex -inferior-tty-set
29692
29693 @subheading Synopsis
29694
29695 @smallexample
29696 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29697 @end smallexample
29698
29699 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
29700
29701 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29702
29703 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
29704
29705 @subheading Example
29706
29707 @smallexample
29708 (gdb)
29709 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29710 ^done
29711 (gdb)
29712 @end smallexample
29713
29714 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
29715 @findex -inferior-tty-show
29716
29717 @subheading Synopsis
29718
29719 @smallexample
29720 -inferior-tty-show
29721 @end smallexample
29722
29723 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
29724
29725 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29726
29727 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
29728
29729 @subheading Example
29730
29731 @smallexample
29732 (gdb)
29733 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29734 ^done
29735 (gdb)
29736 -inferior-tty-show
29737 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
29738 (gdb)
29739 @end smallexample
29740
29741 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
29742 @findex -enable-timings
29743
29744 @subheading Synopsis
29745
29746 @smallexample
29747 -enable-timings [yes | no]
29748 @end smallexample
29749
29750 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
29751 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
29752 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
29753 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
29754
29755 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29756
29757 No equivalent.
29758
29759 @subheading Example
29760
29761 @smallexample
29762 (gdb)
29763 -enable-timings
29764 ^done
29765 (gdb)
29766 -break-insert main
29767 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29768 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29769 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
29770 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
29771 (gdb)
29772 -enable-timings no
29773 ^done
29774 (gdb)
29775 -exec-run
29776 ^running
29777 (gdb)
29778 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
29779 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
29780 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
29781 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
29782 (gdb)
29783 @end smallexample
29784
29785 @node Annotations
29786 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
29787
29788 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
29789 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
29790 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
29791 relatively high level.
29792
29793 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
29794 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
29795
29796 @ignore
29797 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
29798 @end ignore
29799
29800 @menu
29801 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
29802 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
29803 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
29804 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
29805 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
29806 * Annotations for Running::
29807 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
29808 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
29809 @end menu
29810
29811 @node Annotations Overview
29812 @section What is an Annotation?
29813 @cindex annotations
29814
29815 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
29816 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
29817 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
29818 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
29819 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
29820 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
29821 cannot contain newline characters.
29822
29823 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
29824 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
29825 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
29826 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
29827 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
29828 means those three characters as output.
29829
29830 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
29831 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
29832 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
29833 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
29834 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
29835 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
29836 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
29837 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
29838 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
29839
29840 @table @code
29841 @kindex set annotate
29842 @item set annotate @var{level}
29843 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
29844 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
29845
29846 @item show annotate
29847 @kindex show annotate
29848 Show the current annotation level.
29849 @end table
29850
29851 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
29852
29853 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
29854
29855 @smallexample
29856 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
29857 GNU gdb 6.0
29858 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
29859 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
29860 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
29861 under certain conditions.
29862 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
29863 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
29864 for details.
29865 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
29866
29867 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
29868 (@value{GDBP})
29869 ^Z^Zprompt
29870 @kbd{quit}
29871
29872 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
29873 $
29874 @end smallexample
29875
29876 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
29877 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
29878 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
29879 output from @value{GDBN}.
29880
29881 @node Server Prefix
29882 @section The Server Prefix
29883 @cindex server prefix
29884
29885 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
29886 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
29887 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
29888 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
29889 a transparent manner.
29890
29891 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
29892 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
29893 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
29894 @code{print} command.
29895
29896 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
29897 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
29898
29899 @node Prompting
29900 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
29901
29902 @cindex annotations for prompts
29903 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
29904 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
29905 over, etc.
29906
29907 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
29908 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
29909 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
29910 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
29911 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
29912 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
29913 features the following annotations:
29914
29915 @smallexample
29916 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
29917 ^Z^Zprompt
29918 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
29919 @end smallexample
29920
29921 The input types are
29922
29923 @table @code
29924 @findex pre-prompt annotation
29925 @findex prompt annotation
29926 @findex post-prompt annotation
29927 @item prompt
29928 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
29929
29930 @findex pre-commands annotation
29931 @findex commands annotation
29932 @findex post-commands annotation
29933 @item commands
29934 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
29935 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
29936
29937 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
29938 @findex overload-choice annotation
29939 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
29940 @item overload-choice
29941 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
29942
29943 @findex pre-query annotation
29944 @findex query annotation
29945 @findex post-query annotation
29946 @item query
29947 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
29948
29949 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
29950 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
29951 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
29952 @item prompt-for-continue
29953 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
29954 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
29955 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
29956 presence of annotations.
29957 @end table
29958
29959 @node Errors
29960 @section Errors
29961 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
29962
29963 @findex quit annotation
29964 @smallexample
29965 ^Z^Zquit
29966 @end smallexample
29967
29968 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
29969
29970 @findex error annotation
29971 @smallexample
29972 ^Z^Zerror
29973 @end smallexample
29974
29975 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
29976
29977 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
29978 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
29979 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
29980 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
29981 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
29982 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
29983 to the top level.
29984
29985 @findex error-begin annotation
29986 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
29987
29988 @smallexample
29989 ^Z^Zerror-begin
29990 @end smallexample
29991
29992 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
29993 message.
29994
29995 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
29996 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
29997 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
29998
29999 @node Invalidation
30000 @section Invalidation Notices
30001
30002 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
30003 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
30004 changed.
30005
30006 @table @code
30007 @findex frames-invalid annotation
30008 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
30009
30010 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
30011 have changed.
30012
30013 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
30014 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
30015
30016 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
30017 deleted a breakpoint.
30018 @end table
30019
30020 @node Annotations for Running
30021 @section Running the Program
30022 @cindex annotations for running programs
30023
30024 @findex starting annotation
30025 @findex stopping annotation
30026 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
30027 @code{step} or @code{continue},
30028
30029 @smallexample
30030 ^Z^Zstarting
30031 @end smallexample
30032
30033 is output. When the program stops,
30034
30035 @smallexample
30036 ^Z^Zstopped
30037 @end smallexample
30038
30039 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
30040 annotations describe how the program stopped.
30041
30042 @table @code
30043 @findex exited annotation
30044 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
30045 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
30046 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
30047
30048 @findex signalled annotation
30049 @findex signal-name annotation
30050 @findex signal-name-end annotation
30051 @findex signal-string annotation
30052 @findex signal-string-end annotation
30053 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
30054 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
30055 annotation continues:
30056
30057 @smallexample
30058 @var{intro-text}
30059 ^Z^Zsignal-name
30060 @var{name}
30061 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
30062 @var{middle-text}
30063 ^Z^Zsignal-string
30064 @var{string}
30065 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
30066 @var{end-text}
30067 @end smallexample
30068
30069 @noindent
30070 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
30071 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
30072 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
30073 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
30074 user's benefit and have no particular format.
30075
30076 @findex signal annotation
30077 @item ^Z^Zsignal
30078 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
30079 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
30080 terminated with it.
30081
30082 @findex breakpoint annotation
30083 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
30084 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
30085
30086 @findex watchpoint annotation
30087 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
30088 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
30089 @end table
30090
30091 @node Source Annotations
30092 @section Displaying Source
30093 @cindex annotations for source display
30094
30095 @findex source annotation
30096 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
30097
30098 @smallexample
30099 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
30100 @end smallexample
30101
30102 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
30103 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
30104 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
30105 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
30106 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
30107 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
30108 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
30109 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
30110 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
30111 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
30112 depend on the language).
30113
30114 @node JIT Interface
30115 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
30116 @cindex just-in-time compilation
30117 @cindex JIT compilation interface
30118
30119 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
30120 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
30121 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
30122 performance while maintaining platform independence.
30123
30124 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
30125 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
30126 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
30127 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
30128 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
30129 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
30130
30131 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
30132 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
30133 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
30134 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
30135 LLVM JIT.
30136
30137 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
30138 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
30139 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
30140 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
30141 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
30142 out about additional code.
30143
30144 @menu
30145 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
30146 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
30147 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
30148 @end menu
30149
30150 @node Declarations
30151 @section JIT Declarations
30152
30153 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
30154 implement the interface:
30155
30156 @smallexample
30157 typedef enum
30158 @{
30159 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
30160 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
30161 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
30162 @} jit_actions_t;
30163
30164 struct jit_code_entry
30165 @{
30166 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
30167 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
30168 const char *symfile_addr;
30169 uint64_t symfile_size;
30170 @};
30171
30172 struct jit_descriptor
30173 @{
30174 uint32_t version;
30175 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
30176 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
30177 uint32_t action_flag;
30178 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
30179 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
30180 @};
30181
30182 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
30183 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
30184
30185 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
30186 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
30187 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
30188 @end smallexample
30189
30190 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
30191 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
30192 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
30193
30194 @node Registering Code
30195 @section Registering Code
30196
30197 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
30198
30199 @itemize @bullet
30200 @item
30201 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
30202 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
30203
30204 @item
30205 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
30206 file.
30207
30208 @item
30209 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
30210
30211 @item
30212 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
30213
30214 @item
30215 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
30216 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
30217 @end itemize
30218
30219 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
30220 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
30221 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
30222 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
30223
30224 @node Unregistering Code
30225 @section Unregistering Code
30226
30227 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
30228
30229 @itemize @bullet
30230 @item
30231 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
30232
30233 @item
30234 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
30235
30236 @item
30237 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
30238 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
30239 @end itemize
30240
30241 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
30242 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
30243
30244 @node GDB Bugs
30245 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
30246 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
30247 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
30248
30249 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
30250
30251 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
30252 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
30253 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
30254 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
30255
30256 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
30257 information that enables us to fix the bug.
30258
30259 @menu
30260 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
30261 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
30262 @end menu
30263
30264 @node Bug Criteria
30265 @section Have You Found a Bug?
30266 @cindex bug criteria
30267
30268 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
30269
30270 @itemize @bullet
30271 @cindex fatal signal
30272 @cindex debugger crash
30273 @cindex crash of debugger
30274 @item
30275 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
30276 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
30277
30278 @cindex error on valid input
30279 @item
30280 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
30281 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
30282 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
30283
30284 @cindex invalid input
30285 @item
30286 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
30287 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
30288 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
30289 for traditional practice''.
30290
30291 @item
30292 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
30293 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
30294 @end itemize
30295
30296 @node Bug Reporting
30297 @section How to Report Bugs
30298 @cindex bug reports
30299 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
30300
30301 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
30302 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
30303 contact that organization first.
30304
30305 You can find contact information for many support companies and
30306 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
30307 distribution.
30308 @c should add a web page ref...
30309
30310 @ifset BUGURL
30311 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
30312 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
30313 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
30314 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
30315 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
30316 be used.
30317
30318 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
30319 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
30320 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
30321 @samp{bug-gdb}.
30322
30323 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
30324 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
30325 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
30326 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
30327 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
30328 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
30329 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
30330 bug reports to the mailing list.
30331 @end ifset
30332 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
30333 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
30334 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
30335 @end ifclear
30336 @end ifset
30337
30338 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
30339 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
30340 fact or leave it out, state it!
30341
30342 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
30343 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
30344 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
30345 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
30346 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
30347 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
30348 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
30349 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
30350 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
30351
30352 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
30353 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
30354 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
30355 self-contained.
30356
30357 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
30358 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
30359 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
30360 bugs properly.
30361
30362 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
30363
30364 @itemize @bullet
30365 @item
30366 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
30367 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
30368 version}.
30369
30370 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
30371 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
30372
30373 @item
30374 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
30375 version number.
30376
30377 @item
30378 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
30379 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
30380
30381 @item
30382 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
30383 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
30384 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
30385 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
30386 those compilers.
30387
30388 @item
30389 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
30390 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
30391 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
30392 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
30393
30394 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
30395 and then we might not encounter the bug.
30396
30397 @item
30398 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
30399 reproduce the bug.
30400
30401 @item
30402 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
30403 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
30404
30405 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
30406 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
30407 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
30408 a chance to make a mistake.
30409
30410 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
30411 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
30412 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
30413 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
30414 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
30415 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
30416 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
30417 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
30418
30419 @pindex script
30420 @cindex recording a session script
30421 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
30422 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
30423 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
30424 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
30425
30426 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
30427 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
30428
30429 @item
30430 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
30431 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
30432 it by context, not by line number.
30433
30434 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
30435 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
30436
30437 @end itemize
30438
30439 Here are some things that are not necessary:
30440
30441 @itemize @bullet
30442 @item
30443 A description of the envelope of the bug.
30444
30445 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
30446 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
30447 changes will not affect it.
30448
30449 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
30450 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
30451 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
30452 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
30453
30454 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
30455 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
30456 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
30457 less time, and so on.
30458
30459 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
30460 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
30461
30462 @item
30463 A patch for the bug.
30464
30465 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
30466 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
30467 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
30468 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
30469
30470 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
30471 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
30472 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
30473 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
30474
30475 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
30476 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
30477 help us to understand.
30478
30479 @item
30480 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
30481
30482 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
30483 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
30484 @end itemize
30485
30486 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
30487 @c and consists of the two following files:
30488 @c rluser.texinfo
30489 @c inc-hist.texinfo
30490 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
30491 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
30492 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
30493 @include rluser.texi
30494 @include inc-hist.texinfo
30495 @end ifclear
30496
30497
30498 @node Formatting Documentation
30499 @appendix Formatting Documentation
30500
30501 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
30502 @cindex reference card
30503 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
30504 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
30505 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
30506 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
30507 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
30508 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
30509
30510 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
30511 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
30512
30513 @smallexample
30514 make refcard.dvi
30515 @end smallexample
30516
30517 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
30518 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
30519 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
30520 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
30521 your @sc{dvi} output program.
30522
30523 @cindex documentation
30524
30525 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
30526 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
30527 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
30528 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
30529 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
30530 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
30531
30532 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
30533 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
30534 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
30535 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
30536 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
30537 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
30538 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
30539 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
30540
30541 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
30542 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
30543 @code{makeinfo}.
30544
30545 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
30546 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
30547 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
30548
30549 @smallexample
30550 cd gdb
30551 make gdb.info
30552 @end smallexample
30553
30554 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
30555 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
30556 Texinfo definitions file.
30557
30558 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
30559 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
30560 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
30561 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
30562 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
30563 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
30564 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
30565
30566 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
30567 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
30568 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
30569 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
30570 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
30571 directory.
30572
30573 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
30574 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
30575 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
30576 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
30577
30578 @smallexample
30579 make gdb.dvi
30580 @end smallexample
30581
30582 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
30583
30584 @node Installing GDB
30585 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
30586 @cindex installation
30587
30588 @menu
30589 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
30590 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
30591 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
30592 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
30593 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
30594 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
30595 @end menu
30596
30597 @node Requirements
30598 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
30599 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
30600
30601 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
30602 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
30603
30604 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
30605 @table @asis
30606 @item ISO C90 compiler
30607 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
30608 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
30609
30610 @end table
30611
30612 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
30613 @table @asis
30614 @item Expat
30615 @anchor{Expat}
30616 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
30617 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
30618 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
30619 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
30620 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
30621 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
30622
30623 Expat is used for:
30624
30625 @itemize @bullet
30626 @item
30627 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
30628 @item
30629 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
30630 @item
30631 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
30632 @item
30633 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
30634 @end itemize
30635
30636 @item zlib
30637 @cindex compressed debug sections
30638 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
30639 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
30640 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
30641 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
30642 information in such binaries.
30643
30644 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
30645 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
30646 @url{http://zlib.net}.
30647
30648 @item iconv
30649 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
30650 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
30651 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
30652 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
30653
30654 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
30655 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
30656 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
30657
30658 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
30659 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
30660 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
30661 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
30662 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
30663 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
30664 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
30665 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
30666 @end table
30667
30668 @node Running Configure
30669 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
30670 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
30671 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
30672 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
30673 build the @code{gdb} program.
30674 @iftex
30675 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
30676 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
30677 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
30678 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
30679 @end iftex
30680
30681 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
30682 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
30683 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
30684
30685 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
30686 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
30687
30688 @table @code
30689 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
30690 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
30691
30692 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
30693 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
30694
30695 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
30696 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
30697
30698 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
30699 @sc{gnu} include files
30700
30701 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
30702 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
30703
30704 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
30705 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
30706
30707 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
30708 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
30709
30710 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
30711 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
30712
30713 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
30714 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
30715 @end table
30716
30717 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
30718 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
30719 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
30720
30721 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
30722 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
30723 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
30724 argument.
30725
30726 For example:
30727
30728 @smallexample
30729 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
30730 ./configure @var{host}
30731 make
30732 @end smallexample
30733
30734 @noindent
30735 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
30736 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
30737 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
30738 correct value by examining your system.)
30739
30740 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
30741 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
30742 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
30743 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
30744
30745 @need 750
30746 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
30747 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
30748 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
30749
30750 @smallexample
30751 sh configure @var{host}
30752 @end smallexample
30753
30754 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
30755 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
30756 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
30757 @file{configure}
30758 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
30759 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
30760
30761 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
30762 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
30763 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
30764 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
30765 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
30766 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
30767 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
30768 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
30769 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
30770
30771 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
30772 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
30773 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
30774 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
30775 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
30776
30777 @node Separate Objdir
30778 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
30779
30780 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
30781 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
30782 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
30783 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
30784 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
30785 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
30786 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
30787 program specified there.
30788
30789 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
30790 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
30791 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
30792 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
30793 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
30794 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
30795
30796 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
30797 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
30798
30799 @smallexample
30800 @group
30801 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
30802 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
30803 cd ../gdb-sun4
30804 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
30805 make
30806 @end group
30807 @end smallexample
30808
30809 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
30810 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
30811 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
30812 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
30813 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
30814 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
30815
30816 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
30817 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
30818 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
30819 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
30820 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
30821
30822 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
30823 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
30824 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
30825 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
30826 You specify a cross-debugging target by
30827 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
30828
30829 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
30830 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
30831 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
30832
30833 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
30834 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
30835 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
30836 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
30837 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
30838
30839 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
30840 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
30841 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
30842 with each other.
30843
30844 @node Config Names
30845 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
30846
30847 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
30848 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
30849 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
30850 of information in the following pattern:
30851
30852 @smallexample
30853 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
30854 @end smallexample
30855
30856 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
30857 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
30858 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
30859
30860 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
30861 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
30862 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
30863 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
30864 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
30865 abbreviations---for example:
30866
30867 @smallexample
30868 % sh config.sub i386-linux
30869 i386-pc-linux-gnu
30870 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
30871 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
30872 % sh config.sub hp9k700
30873 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
30874 % sh config.sub sun4
30875 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
30876 % sh config.sub sun3
30877 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
30878 % sh config.sub i986v
30879 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
30880 @end smallexample
30881
30882 @noindent
30883 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
30884 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
30885
30886 @node Configure Options
30887 @section @file{configure} Options
30888
30889 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
30890 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
30891 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
30892 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
30893
30894 @smallexample
30895 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
30896 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
30897 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
30898 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
30899 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
30900 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
30901 @var{host}
30902 @end smallexample
30903
30904 @noindent
30905 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
30906 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
30907 @samp{--}.
30908
30909 @table @code
30910 @item --help
30911 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
30912
30913 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
30914 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
30915 @file{@var{dir}}.
30916
30917 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
30918 Configure the source to install programs under directory
30919 @file{@var{dir}}.
30920
30921 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
30922 @need 2000
30923 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
30924 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
30925 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
30926 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
30927 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
30928 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
30929 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
30930 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
30931 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
30932 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
30933 @var{dirname}.
30934
30935 @item --norecursion
30936 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
30937 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
30938
30939 @item --target=@var{target}
30940 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
30941 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
30942 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
30943
30944 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
30945
30946 @item @var{host} @dots{}
30947 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
30948
30949 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
30950 @end table
30951
30952 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
30953 needed for special purposes only.
30954
30955 @node System-wide configuration
30956 @section System-wide configuration and settings
30957 @cindex system-wide init file
30958
30959 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
30960 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
30961 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
30962
30963 Here is the corresponding configure option:
30964
30965 @table @code
30966 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
30967 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
30968 @var{file}.
30969 @end table
30970
30971 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
30972 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
30973
30974 @itemize @bullet
30975 @item
30976 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
30977 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
30978 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
30979 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
30980 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
30981 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
30982
30983 @item
30984 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
30985 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
30986 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
30987 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
30988 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
30989 @end itemize
30990
30991 @node Maintenance Commands
30992 @appendix Maintenance Commands
30993 @cindex maintenance commands
30994 @cindex internal commands
30995
30996 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
30997 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
30998 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
30999 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
31000 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
31001
31002 @table @code
31003 @kindex maint agent
31004 @kindex maint agent-eval
31005 @item maint agent @var{expression}
31006 @itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
31007 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
31008 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
31009 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
31010 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
31011 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
31012 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
31013 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
31014 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
31015 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
31016 addition and return the sum.
31017
31018 @kindex maint info breakpoints
31019 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
31020 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
31021 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
31022 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
31023 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
31024 is shown:
31025
31026 @table @code
31027 @item breakpoint
31028 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
31029
31030 @item watchpoint
31031 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
31032
31033 @item longjmp
31034 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
31035 @code{longjmp} calls.
31036
31037 @item longjmp resume
31038 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
31039
31040 @item until
31041 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
31042
31043 @item finish
31044 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
31045
31046 @item shlib events
31047 Shared library events.
31048
31049 @end table
31050
31051 @kindex set displaced-stepping
31052 @kindex show displaced-stepping
31053 @cindex displaced stepping support
31054 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
31055 @item set displaced-stepping
31056 @itemx show displaced-stepping
31057 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
31058 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
31059 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
31060 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
31061 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
31062
31063 @table @code
31064 @item set displaced-stepping on
31065 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
31066 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
31067
31068 @item set displaced-stepping off
31069 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
31070 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
31071
31072 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
31073 @item set displaced-stepping auto
31074 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
31075 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
31076 architecture supports displaced stepping.
31077 @end table
31078
31079 @kindex maint check-symtabs
31080 @item maint check-symtabs
31081 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
31082
31083 @kindex maint cplus first_component
31084 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
31085 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
31086
31087 @kindex maint cplus namespace
31088 @item maint cplus namespace
31089 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
31090
31091 @kindex maint demangle
31092 @item maint demangle @var{name}
31093 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
31094
31095 @kindex maint deprecate
31096 @kindex maint undeprecate
31097 @cindex deprecated commands
31098 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
31099 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
31100 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
31101 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
31102 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
31103 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
31104 the replacement as part of the warning.
31105
31106 @kindex maint dump-me
31107 @item maint dump-me
31108 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
31109 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
31110 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
31111 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
31112
31113 @kindex maint internal-error
31114 @kindex maint internal-warning
31115 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
31116 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
31117 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
31118 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
31119 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
31120 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
31121 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
31122 @value{GDBN} session.
31123
31124 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
31125 used as the text of the error or warning message.
31126
31127 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
31128
31129 @smallexample
31130 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
31131 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
31132 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
31133 debugging may prove unreliable.
31134 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
31135 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
31136 (@value{GDBP})
31137 @end smallexample
31138
31139 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
31140 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
31141
31142 @kindex maint set internal-error
31143 @kindex maint show internal-error
31144 @kindex maint set internal-warning
31145 @kindex maint show internal-warning
31146 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
31147 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
31148 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
31149 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
31150 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
31151 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
31152 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
31153 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
31154 described in the table below.
31155
31156 @table @samp
31157 @item quit
31158 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
31159 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
31160
31161 @item corefile
31162 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
31163 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
31164 @end table
31165
31166 @kindex maint packet
31167 @item maint packet @var{text}
31168 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
31169 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
31170 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
31171 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
31172 checksum.
31173
31174 @kindex maint print architecture
31175 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31176 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
31177 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
31178
31179 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
31180 @item maint print c-tdesc
31181 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
31182 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
31183 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
31184
31185 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
31186 @item maint print dummy-frames
31187 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
31188
31189 @smallexample
31190 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
31191 @dots{}
31192 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
31193 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
31194 58 return (a + b);
31195 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
31196 @dots{}
31197 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
31198 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
31199 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
31200 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
31201 (@value{GDBP})
31202 @end smallexample
31203
31204 Takes an optional file parameter.
31205
31206 @kindex maint print registers
31207 @kindex maint print raw-registers
31208 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
31209 @kindex maint print register-groups
31210 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31211 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31212 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31213 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31214 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
31215
31216 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
31217 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
31218 includes the (cooked) value of all registers, including registers which
31219 aren't available on the target nor visible to user; and the
31220 command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
31221 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
31222 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
31223
31224 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
31225 write the information.
31226
31227 @kindex maint print reggroups
31228 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31229 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
31230 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
31231 information.
31232
31233 The register groups info looks like this:
31234
31235 @smallexample
31236 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
31237 Group Type
31238 general user
31239 float user
31240 all user
31241 vector user
31242 system user
31243 save internal
31244 restore internal
31245 @end smallexample
31246
31247 @kindex flushregs
31248 @item flushregs
31249 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
31250
31251 @kindex maint print objfiles
31252 @cindex info for known object files
31253 @item maint print objfiles
31254 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
31255 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
31256 and symtabs.
31257
31258 @kindex maint print section-scripts
31259 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
31260 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
31261 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
31262 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
31263 matching @var{regexp}.
31264 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
31265 and the full path if known.
31266 @xref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}.
31267
31268 @kindex maint print statistics
31269 @cindex bcache statistics
31270 @item maint print statistics
31271 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
31272 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
31273 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
31274 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
31275 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
31276 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
31277 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
31278 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
31279 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
31280 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
31281 lengths.
31282
31283 @kindex maint print target-stack
31284 @cindex target stack description
31285 @item maint print target-stack
31286 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
31287 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
31288 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
31289 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
31290 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
31291 address.
31292
31293 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
31294 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
31295
31296 @kindex maint print type
31297 @cindex type chain of a data type
31298 @item maint print type @var{expr}
31299 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
31300 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
31301 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
31302 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
31303 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
31304
31305 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
31306 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
31307 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
31308 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
31309 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
31310 information.
31311
31312 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
31313 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
31314 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
31315 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
31316 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
31317 always see the disassembly form.
31318
31319 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
31320
31321 @smallexample
31322 (gdb) info addr argc
31323 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
31324 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
31325 @end smallexample
31326
31327 For more information on these expressions, see
31328 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
31329
31330 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
31331 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
31332 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
31333 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
31334 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
31335
31336 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
31337 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
31338 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
31339 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
31340 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
31341 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
31342 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
31343 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
31344 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
31345
31346 @kindex maint set profile
31347 @kindex maint show profile
31348 @cindex profiling GDB
31349 @item maint set profile
31350 @itemx maint show profile
31351 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
31352
31353 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
31354 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
31355 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
31356 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
31357 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
31358 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
31359 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
31360
31361 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
31362 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
31363
31364 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
31365 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
31366 @cindex hardware debug registers
31367 @item maint set show-debug-regs
31368 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
31369 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
31370 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
31371 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
31372 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
31373 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
31374
31375 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
31376 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
31377 @item maint set show-all-tib
31378 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
31379 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
31380 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
31381 command.
31382
31383 @kindex maint space
31384 @cindex memory used by commands
31385 @item maint space
31386 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
31387 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
31388 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
31389 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
31390 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
31391
31392 @kindex maint time
31393 @cindex time of command execution
31394 @item maint time
31395 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
31396 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
31397 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
31398 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
31399 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
31400 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
31401 it's not possibly currently
31402 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
31403 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
31404
31405 @kindex maint translate-address
31406 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
31407 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
31408 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
31409 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
31410 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
31411 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
31412 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
31413
31414 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
31415 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
31416 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
31417
31418 @end table
31419
31420 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
31421 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
31422
31423 @table @code
31424 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
31425 @kindex set watchdog
31426 @cindex watchdog timer
31427 @cindex timeout for commands
31428 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
31429 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
31430 reports and error and the command is aborted.
31431
31432 @item show watchdog
31433 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
31434 @end table
31435
31436 @node Remote Protocol
31437 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
31438
31439 @menu
31440 * Overview::
31441 * Packets::
31442 * Stop Reply Packets::
31443 * General Query Packets::
31444 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
31445 * Tracepoint Packets::
31446 * Host I/O Packets::
31447 * Interrupts::
31448 * Notification Packets::
31449 * Remote Non-Stop::
31450 * Packet Acknowledgment::
31451 * Examples::
31452 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
31453 * Library List Format::
31454 * Memory Map Format::
31455 * Thread List Format::
31456 @end menu
31457
31458 @node Overview
31459 @section Overview
31460
31461 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
31462 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
31463 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
31464 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
31465
31466 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
31467 transmitted and received data, respectively.
31468
31469 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
31470 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
31471 @cindex remote serial protocol
31472 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
31473 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
31474 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
31475 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
31476 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
31477
31478 @smallexample
31479 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31480 @end smallexample
31481 @noindent
31482
31483 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
31484 @noindent
31485 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
31486 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
31487 eight bit unsigned checksum).
31488
31489 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
31490 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
31491
31492 @smallexample
31493 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31494 @end smallexample
31495
31496 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
31497 @noindent
31498 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
31499 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
31500 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
31501
31502 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
31503 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
31504 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
31505 retransmission):
31506
31507 @smallexample
31508 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31509 <- @code{+}
31510 @end smallexample
31511 @noindent
31512
31513 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
31514 once a connection is established.
31515 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
31516
31517 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
31518 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
31519 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
31520 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
31521 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
31522 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
31523 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
31524
31525 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
31526 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
31527 exceptions).
31528
31529 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
31530 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
31531 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
31532 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
31533
31534 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
31535 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
31536 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
31537
31538 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
31539 @anchor{Binary Data}
31540 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
31541 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
31542 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
31543 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
31544 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
31545 binary data.
31546
31547 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
31548 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
31549 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
31550 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
31551 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
31552 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
31553 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
31554 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
31555 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
31556 (described next).
31557
31558 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
31559 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
31560 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
31561 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
31562 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
31563 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
31564 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
31565 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
31566 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
31567 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
31568 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
31569 3}} more times.
31570
31571 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
31572 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
31573 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
31574 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
31575 @samp{0*"00}.
31576
31577 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
31578 error number. That number is not well defined.
31579
31580 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
31581 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
31582 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
31583 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
31584 on that response.
31585
31586 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
31587 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
31588 optional.
31589
31590 @node Packets
31591 @section Packets
31592
31593 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
31594 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
31595 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
31596 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
31597
31598 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
31599 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
31600 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
31601 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
31602 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
31603 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
31604 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
31605 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
31606 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
31607 @var{baz}.
31608
31609 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
31610 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
31611 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
31612 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
31613 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
31614 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
31615 pick any thread.
31616
31617 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
31618 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
31619 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
31620 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
31621 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
31622 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
31623 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
31624 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
31625 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
31626 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
31627 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
31628 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
31629 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
31630
31631 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
31632 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
31633 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
31634 more information.
31635
31636 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
31637 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
31638
31639 Here are the packet descriptions.
31640
31641 @table @samp
31642
31643 @item !
31644 @cindex @samp{!} packet
31645 @anchor{extended mode}
31646 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
31647 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
31648 debugged.
31649
31650 Reply:
31651 @table @samp
31652 @item OK
31653 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
31654 @end table
31655
31656 @item ?
31657 @cindex @samp{?} packet
31658 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
31659 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
31660 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
31661
31662 Reply:
31663 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31664
31665 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
31666 @cindex @samp{A} packet
31667 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
31668 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
31669 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
31670
31671 Reply:
31672 @table @samp
31673 @item OK
31674 The arguments were set.
31675 @item E @var{NN}
31676 An error occurred.
31677 @end table
31678
31679 @item b @var{baud}
31680 @cindex @samp{b} packet
31681 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
31682 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
31683
31684 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
31685 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
31686 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
31687
31688 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
31689 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
31690 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
31691 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
31692 of view, nothing actually happened.}
31693
31694 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
31695 @cindex @samp{B} packet
31696 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
31697 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
31698
31699 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
31700 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
31701
31702 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
31703 @anchor{bc}
31704 @item bc
31705 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
31706 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31707
31708 Reply:
31709 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31710
31711 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
31712 @anchor{bs}
31713 @item bs
31714 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
31715 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31716
31717 Reply:
31718 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31719
31720 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
31721 @cindex @samp{c} packet
31722 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
31723 resume at current address.
31724
31725 Reply:
31726 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31727
31728 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
31729 @cindex @samp{C} packet
31730 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
31731 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
31732
31733 Reply:
31734 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31735
31736 @item d
31737 @cindex @samp{d} packet
31738 Toggle debug flag.
31739
31740 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
31741 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
31742
31743 @item D
31744 @itemx D;@var{pid}
31745 @cindex @samp{D} packet
31746 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
31747 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
31748 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
31749
31750 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
31751 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
31752 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
31753 big-endian hex string.
31754
31755 Reply:
31756 @table @samp
31757 @item OK
31758 for success
31759 @item E @var{NN}
31760 for an error
31761 @end table
31762
31763 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
31764 @cindex @samp{F} packet
31765 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
31766 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
31767 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
31768
31769 @item g
31770 @anchor{read registers packet}
31771 @cindex @samp{g} packet
31772 Read general registers.
31773
31774 Reply:
31775 @table @samp
31776 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
31777 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
31778 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
31779 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
31780 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
31781 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
31782 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
31783 @item E @var{NN}
31784 for an error.
31785 @end table
31786
31787 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
31788 @cindex @samp{G} packet
31789 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
31790 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
31791
31792 Reply:
31793 @table @samp
31794 @item OK
31795 for success
31796 @item E @var{NN}
31797 for an error
31798 @end table
31799
31800 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
31801 @cindex @samp{H} packet
31802 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
31803 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
31804 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
31805 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
31806 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
31807
31808 Reply:
31809 @table @samp
31810 @item OK
31811 for success
31812 @item E @var{NN}
31813 for an error
31814 @end table
31815
31816 @c FIXME: JTC:
31817 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
31818 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
31819 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
31820 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
31821 @c described. For example:
31822 @c
31823 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
31824 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
31825 @c otherwise returns current registers.
31826 @c
31827 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
31828 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
31829 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
31830
31831 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
31832 @anchor{cycle step packet}
31833 @cindex @samp{i} packet
31834 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
31835 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
31836 step starting at that address.
31837
31838 @item I
31839 @cindex @samp{I} packet
31840 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
31841 step packet}.
31842
31843 @item k
31844 @cindex @samp{k} packet
31845 Kill request.
31846
31847 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
31848 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
31849 thread?)}.
31850
31851 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
31852 @cindex @samp{m} packet
31853 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
31854 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
31855
31856 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
31857 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
31858 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
31859 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
31860 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
31861 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
31862 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
31863 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
31864
31865 Reply:
31866 @table @samp
31867 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
31868 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
31869 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
31870 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
31871 @item E @var{NN}
31872 @var{NN} is errno
31873 @end table
31874
31875 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
31876 @cindex @samp{M} packet
31877 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
31878 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
31879 hexadecimal number.
31880
31881 Reply:
31882 @table @samp
31883 @item OK
31884 for success
31885 @item E @var{NN}
31886 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
31887 written).
31888 @end table
31889
31890 @item p @var{n}
31891 @cindex @samp{p} packet
31892 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
31893 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
31894 register value is encoded.
31895
31896 Reply:
31897 @table @samp
31898 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
31899 the register's value
31900 @item E @var{NN}
31901 for an error
31902 @item
31903 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
31904 @end table
31905
31906 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
31907 @anchor{write register packet}
31908 @cindex @samp{P} packet
31909 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
31910 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
31911 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
31912
31913 Reply:
31914 @table @samp
31915 @item OK
31916 for success
31917 @item E @var{NN}
31918 for an error
31919 @end table
31920
31921 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
31922 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
31923 @cindex @samp{q} packet
31924 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
31925 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
31926 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
31927
31928 @item r
31929 @cindex @samp{r} packet
31930 Reset the entire system.
31931
31932 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
31933
31934 @item R @var{XX}
31935 @cindex @samp{R} packet
31936 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
31937 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
31938
31939 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
31940
31941 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
31942 @cindex @samp{s} packet
31943 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
31944 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
31945
31946 Reply:
31947 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31948
31949 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
31950 @anchor{step with signal packet}
31951 @cindex @samp{S} packet
31952 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
31953 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
31954
31955 Reply:
31956 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31957
31958 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
31959 @cindex @samp{t} packet
31960 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
31961 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
31962 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
31963
31964 @item T @var{thread-id}
31965 @cindex @samp{T} packet
31966 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
31967
31968 Reply:
31969 @table @samp
31970 @item OK
31971 thread is still alive
31972 @item E @var{NN}
31973 thread is dead
31974 @end table
31975
31976 @item v
31977 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
31978 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
31979
31980 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
31981 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
31982 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
31983 The process ID is a
31984 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
31985 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
31986 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
31987
31988 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
31989 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
31990 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
31991 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
31992 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
31993 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
31994 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
31995 @c stopping or restarting threads.
31996
31997 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
31998
31999 Reply:
32000 @table @samp
32001 @item E @var{nn}
32002 for an error
32003 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32004 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32005 @item OK
32006 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
32007 @end table
32008
32009 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
32010 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
32011 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
32012 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
32013 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
32014 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
32015 in their current state in non-stop mode.
32016 Specifying multiple
32017 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
32018 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32019
32020 Currently supported actions are:
32021
32022 @table @samp
32023 @item c
32024 Continue.
32025 @item C @var{sig}
32026 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
32027 @item s
32028 Step.
32029 @item S @var{sig}
32030 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
32031 @item t
32032 Stop.
32033 @end table
32034
32035 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
32036 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
32037 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
32038
32039 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
32040 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
32041 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
32042 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
32043 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
32044 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
32045 as an implementation detail.
32046
32047 Reply:
32048 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32049
32050 @item vCont?
32051 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
32052 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
32053
32054 Reply:
32055 @table @samp
32056 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
32057 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
32058 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
32059 @item
32060 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
32061 @end table
32062
32063 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
32064 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
32065 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
32066 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
32067
32068 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
32069 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
32070 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
32071 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
32072 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
32073 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
32074 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
32075 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
32076 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
32077 packet is received.
32078
32079 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
32080 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
32081 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
32082 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
32083 @var{thread-id}.
32084
32085 Reply:
32086 @table @samp
32087 @item OK
32088 for success
32089 @item E @var{NN}
32090 for an error
32091 @end table
32092
32093 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32094 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
32095 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
32096 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
32097 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
32098 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
32099 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
32100 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
32101 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
32102 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
32103 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
32104 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
32105
32106
32107 Reply:
32108 @table @samp
32109 @item OK
32110 for success
32111 @item E.memtype
32112 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
32113 @item E @var{NN}
32114 for an error
32115 @end table
32116
32117 @item vFlashDone
32118 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
32119 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
32120 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
32121 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
32122 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
32123 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
32124 request is completed.
32125
32126 @item vKill;@var{pid}
32127 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
32128 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
32129 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
32130 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
32131 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
32132
32133 Reply:
32134 @table @samp
32135 @item E @var{nn}
32136 for an error
32137 @item OK
32138 for success
32139 @end table
32140
32141 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
32142 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
32143 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
32144 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
32145 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
32146 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
32147 state.
32148
32149 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
32150
32151 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
32152
32153 Reply:
32154 @table @samp
32155 @item E @var{nn}
32156 for an error
32157 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32158 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32159 @end table
32160
32161 @item vStopped
32162 @anchor{vStopped packet}
32163 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
32164
32165 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
32166 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
32167
32168 Reply:
32169 @table @samp
32170 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32171 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32172 @item OK
32173 if there are no unreported stop events
32174 @end table
32175
32176 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32177 @anchor{X packet}
32178 @cindex @samp{X} packet
32179 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
32180 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
32181 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
32182
32183 Reply:
32184 @table @samp
32185 @item OK
32186 for success
32187 @item E @var{NN}
32188 for an error
32189 @end table
32190
32191 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
32192 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
32193 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
32194 @cindex @samp{z} packet
32195 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
32196 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
32197 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
32198
32199 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
32200 separately.
32201
32202 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
32203 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
32204 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
32205 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
32206 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
32207 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
32208
32209 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32210 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32211 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
32212 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
32213 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
32214 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
32215
32216 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
32217 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
32218 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
32219 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
32220 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
32221 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
32222 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
32223
32224 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
32225 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
32226 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
32227 target, is not defined.}
32228
32229 Reply:
32230 @table @samp
32231 @item OK
32232 success
32233 @item
32234 not supported
32235 @item E @var{NN}
32236 for an error
32237 @end table
32238
32239 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32240 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32241 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
32242 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
32243 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
32244 address @var{addr}.
32245
32246 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
32247 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
32248 has the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
32249
32250 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
32251 movement.}
32252
32253 Reply:
32254 @table @samp
32255 @item OK
32256 success
32257 @item
32258 not supported
32259 @item E @var{NN}
32260 for an error
32261 @end table
32262
32263 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32264 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32265 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
32266 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
32267 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32268 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32269
32270 Reply:
32271 @table @samp
32272 @item OK
32273 success
32274 @item
32275 not supported
32276 @item E @var{NN}
32277 for an error
32278 @end table
32279
32280 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32281 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32282 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
32283 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
32284 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32285 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32286
32287 Reply:
32288 @table @samp
32289 @item OK
32290 success
32291 @item
32292 not supported
32293 @item E @var{NN}
32294 for an error
32295 @end table
32296
32297 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32298 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32299 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
32300 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
32301 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32302 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32303
32304 Reply:
32305 @table @samp
32306 @item OK
32307 success
32308 @item
32309 not supported
32310 @item E @var{NN}
32311 for an error
32312 @end table
32313
32314 @end table
32315
32316 @node Stop Reply Packets
32317 @section Stop Reply Packets
32318 @cindex stop reply packets
32319
32320 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
32321 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
32322 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
32323 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
32324 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
32325 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
32326 @value{GDBN} source code.
32327
32328 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
32329 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
32330 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
32331 components.
32332
32333 @table @samp
32334
32335 @item S @var{AA}
32336 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
32337 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
32338 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
32339
32340 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
32341 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
32342 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
32343 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
32344 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
32345 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
32346 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
32347 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
32348
32349 @itemize @bullet
32350 @item
32351 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
32352 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
32353 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
32354 two-digit hex number.
32355
32356 @item
32357 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
32358 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32359
32360 @item
32361 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
32362 the core on which the stop event was detected.
32363
32364 @item
32365 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
32366 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
32367 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
32368 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
32369
32370 @item
32371 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
32372 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
32373 future.
32374 @end itemize
32375
32376 The currently defined stop reasons are:
32377
32378 @table @samp
32379 @item watch
32380 @itemx rwatch
32381 @itemx awatch
32382 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
32383 hex.
32384
32385 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
32386 @item library
32387 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
32388 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
32389 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
32390
32391 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
32392 @item replaylog
32393 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
32394 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
32395 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
32396 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
32397 for more information.
32398 @end table
32399
32400 @item W @var{AA}
32401 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
32402 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
32403 applicable to certain targets.
32404
32405 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
32406 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
32407 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
32408 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
32409
32410 @item X @var{AA}
32411 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
32412 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
32413
32414 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
32415 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
32416 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
32417 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
32418
32419 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
32420 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
32421 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
32422 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
32423 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
32424
32425 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
32426 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
32427 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
32428 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
32429 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
32430 system calls.
32431
32432 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
32433 this very system call.
32434
32435 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
32436 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
32437 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
32438 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
32439 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
32440 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
32441
32442 @end table
32443
32444 @node General Query Packets
32445 @section General Query Packets
32446 @cindex remote query requests
32447
32448 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
32449 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
32450 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
32451 sending information to and from the stub.
32452
32453 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
32454 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
32455 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
32456 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
32457 conventions:
32458
32459 @itemize @bullet
32460 @item
32461 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
32462 @item
32463 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
32464 letter.
32465 @item
32466 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
32467 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
32468 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
32469 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
32470 @end itemize
32471
32472 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
32473 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
32474 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
32475 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
32476 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
32477 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
32478 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
32479 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
32480 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
32481 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
32482 packet.}.
32483
32484 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
32485 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
32486 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
32487 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
32488 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
32489
32490 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
32491
32492 @table @samp
32493
32494 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
32495 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
32496 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
32497 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
32498 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
32499 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
32500 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
32501 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
32502 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
32503 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
32504 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
32505
32506 @item qC
32507 @cindex current thread, remote request
32508 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
32509 Return the current thread ID.
32510
32511 Reply:
32512 @table @samp
32513 @item QC @var{thread-id}
32514 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
32515 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32516 @item @r{(anything else)}
32517 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
32518 @end table
32519
32520 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
32521 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
32522 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
32523 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
32524 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
32525 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
32526 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
32527
32528 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
32529 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
32530 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
32531 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
32532 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
32533 detect trailing zeros.
32534
32535 Reply:
32536 @table @samp
32537 @item E @var{NN}
32538 An error (such as memory fault)
32539 @item C @var{crc32}
32540 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
32541 @end table
32542
32543 @item qfThreadInfo
32544 @itemx qsThreadInfo
32545 @cindex list active threads, remote request
32546 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
32547 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
32548 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
32549 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
32550 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
32551 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
32552 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
32553 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
32554
32555 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
32556
32557 Reply:
32558 @table @samp
32559 @item m @var{thread-id}
32560 A single thread ID
32561 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
32562 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
32563 @item l
32564 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
32565 @end table
32566
32567 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
32568 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
32569 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
32570 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
32571 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
32572 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
32573 fields.
32574
32575 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
32576 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
32577 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
32578 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
32579 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
32580
32581 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
32582 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
32583
32584 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
32585 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
32586 information associated with the variable.)
32587
32588 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
32589 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
32590 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
32591 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
32592 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
32593 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
32594
32595 Reply:
32596 @table @samp
32597 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
32598 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
32599 local storage requested.
32600
32601 @item E @var{nn}
32602 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32603
32604 @item
32605 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
32606 @end table
32607
32608 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
32609 @cindex get thread information block address
32610 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
32611 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
32612
32613 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
32614
32615 Reply:
32616 @table @samp
32617 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
32618 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
32619 thread information block.
32620
32621 @item E @var{nn}
32622 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
32623 address could not be retrieved.
32624
32625 @item
32626 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
32627 @end table
32628
32629 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
32630 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
32631 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
32632 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
32633 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
32634 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
32635 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
32636
32637 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
32638
32639 Reply:
32640 @table @samp
32641 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
32642 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
32643 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
32644 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
32645 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
32646 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
32647 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
32648 @end table
32649
32650 @item qOffsets
32651 @cindex section offsets, remote request
32652 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
32653 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
32654 image.
32655
32656 Reply:
32657 @table @samp
32658 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
32659 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
32660 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
32661 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
32662 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
32663 segments by the supplied offsets.
32664
32665 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
32666 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
32667 to the @code{Bss} section.}
32668
32669 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
32670 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
32671 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
32672 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
32673 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
32674 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
32675 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
32676 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
32677 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
32678 @end table
32679
32680 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
32681 @cindex thread information, remote request
32682 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
32683 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
32684 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
32685 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
32686
32687 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
32688 (see below).
32689
32690 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
32691
32692 @item QNonStop:1
32693 @item QNonStop:0
32694 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
32695 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
32696 @anchor{QNonStop}
32697 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
32698 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
32699
32700 Reply:
32701 @table @samp
32702 @item OK
32703 The request succeeded.
32704
32705 @item E @var{nn}
32706 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32707
32708 @item
32709 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
32710 the stub.
32711 @end table
32712
32713 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
32714 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
32715 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
32716 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
32717
32718 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
32719 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
32720 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
32721 @anchor{QPassSignals}
32722 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
32723 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
32724 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
32725 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
32726 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
32727 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
32728 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
32729 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
32730 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
32731
32732 Reply:
32733 @table @samp
32734 @item OK
32735 The request succeeded.
32736
32737 @item E @var{nn}
32738 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32739
32740 @item
32741 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
32742 the stub.
32743 @end table
32744
32745 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
32746 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
32747 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
32748 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
32749
32750 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
32751 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
32752 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
32753 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
32754 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
32755 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
32756 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
32757 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
32758 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
32759
32760 Reply:
32761 @table @samp
32762 @item OK
32763 A command response with no output.
32764 @item @var{OUTPUT}
32765 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
32766 @item E @var{NN}
32767 Indicate a badly formed request.
32768 @item
32769 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
32770 @end table
32771
32772 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
32773 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
32774 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
32775 packets.)
32776
32777 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
32778 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
32779 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
32780 @anchor{qSearch memory}
32781 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
32782 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
32783 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
32784
32785 Reply:
32786 @table @samp
32787 @item 0
32788 The pattern was not found.
32789 @item 1,address
32790 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
32791 @item E @var{NN}
32792 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
32793 @item
32794 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
32795 @end table
32796
32797 @item QStartNoAckMode
32798 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
32799 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
32800 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
32801 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
32802
32803 Reply:
32804 @table @samp
32805 @item OK
32806 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
32807 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
32808 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
32809 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
32810 @item
32811 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
32812 @end table
32813
32814 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
32815 @cindex supported packets, remote query
32816 @cindex features of the remote protocol
32817 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
32818 @anchor{qSupported}
32819 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
32820 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
32821 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
32822 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
32823 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
32824 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
32825 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
32826 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
32827 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
32828 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
32829 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
32830 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
32831 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
32832 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
32833
32834 Reply:
32835 @table @samp
32836 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
32837 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
32838 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
32839 possible forms).
32840 @item
32841 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
32842 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
32843 @end table
32844
32845 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
32846 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
32847 are:
32848
32849 @table @samp
32850 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
32851 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
32852 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
32853 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
32854 @item @var{name}+
32855 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
32856 need an associated value.
32857 @item @var{name}-
32858 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
32859 @item @var{name}?
32860 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
32861 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
32862 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
32863 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
32864 @end table
32865
32866 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
32867 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
32868 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
32869 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
32870 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
32871
32872 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
32873 are defined:
32874
32875 @table @samp
32876 @item multiprocess
32877 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
32878 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
32879 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
32880 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
32881 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
32882
32883 @item xmlRegisters
32884 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
32885 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
32886 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
32887 description.
32888
32889 @item qRelocInsn
32890 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
32891 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
32892 instruction reply packet}).
32893 @end table
32894
32895 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
32896 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
32897 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
32898 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
32899 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
32900 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
32901 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
32902 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
32903 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
32904 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
32905 all the features it supports.
32906
32907 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
32908 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
32909
32910 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
32911 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
32912 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
32913 form response.
32914
32915 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
32916 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
32917 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
32918 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
32919
32920 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
32921 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
32922 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
32923 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
32924 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
32925
32926 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
32927
32928 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
32929 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
32930 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
32931 @item Feature Name
32932 @tab Value Required
32933 @tab Default
32934 @tab Probe Allowed
32935
32936 @item @samp{PacketSize}
32937 @tab Yes
32938 @tab @samp{-}
32939 @tab No
32940
32941 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
32942 @tab No
32943 @tab @samp{-}
32944 @tab Yes
32945
32946 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
32947 @tab No
32948 @tab @samp{-}
32949 @tab Yes
32950
32951 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
32952 @tab No
32953 @tab @samp{-}
32954 @tab Yes
32955
32956 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
32957 @tab No
32958 @tab @samp{-}
32959 @tab Yes
32960
32961 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
32962 @tab No
32963 @tab @samp{-}
32964 @tab Yes
32965
32966 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
32967 @tab No
32968 @tab @samp{-}
32969 @tab Yes
32970
32971 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
32972 @tab No
32973 @tab @samp{-}
32974 @tab Yes
32975
32976 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
32977 @tab No
32978 @tab @samp{-}
32979 @tab Yes
32980
32981 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
32982 @tab No
32983 @tab @samp{-}
32984 @tab Yes
32985
32986 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
32987 @tab No
32988 @tab @samp{-}
32989 @tab Yes
32990
32991
32992 @item @samp{QNonStop}
32993 @tab No
32994 @tab @samp{-}
32995 @tab Yes
32996
32997 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
32998 @tab No
32999 @tab @samp{-}
33000 @tab Yes
33001
33002 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
33003 @tab No
33004 @tab @samp{-}
33005 @tab Yes
33006
33007 @item @samp{multiprocess}
33008 @tab No
33009 @tab @samp{-}
33010 @tab No
33011
33012 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
33013 @tab No
33014 @tab @samp{-}
33015 @tab No
33016
33017 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
33018 @tab No
33019 @tab @samp{-}
33020 @tab No
33021
33022 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
33023 @tab No
33024 @tab @samp{-}
33025 @tab No
33026
33027 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
33028 @tab No
33029 @tab @samp{-}
33030 @tab No
33031
33032 @item @samp{QAllow}
33033 @tab No
33034 @tab @samp{-}
33035 @tab No
33036
33037 @end multitable
33038
33039 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
33040
33041 @table @samp
33042 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
33043 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
33044 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
33045 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
33046 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
33047 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
33048 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
33049 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
33050 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
33051 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
33052
33053 @item qXfer:auxv:read
33054 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
33055 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
33056
33057 @item qXfer:features:read
33058 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
33059 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
33060
33061 @item qXfer:libraries:read
33062 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
33063 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
33064
33065 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
33066 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
33067 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
33068
33069 @item qXfer:sdata:read
33070 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
33071 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
33072
33073 @item qXfer:spu:read
33074 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
33075 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
33076
33077 @item qXfer:spu:write
33078 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
33079 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
33080
33081 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
33082 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
33083 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
33084
33085 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
33086 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
33087 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
33088
33089 @item qXfer:threads:read
33090 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
33091 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
33092
33093 @item QNonStop
33094 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
33095 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
33096
33097 @item QPassSignals
33098 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
33099 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
33100
33101 @item QStartNoAckMode
33102 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
33103 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
33104
33105 @item multiprocess
33106 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
33107 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
33108 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
33109 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
33110 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
33111 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
33112 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
33113 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
33114 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
33115 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
33116 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
33117
33118 @item qXfer:osdata:read
33119 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
33120 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
33121
33122 @item ConditionalTracepoints
33123 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
33124 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
33125
33126 @item ReverseContinue
33127 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
33128 (@pxref{bc}).
33129
33130 @item ReverseStep
33131 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
33132 (@pxref{bs}).
33133
33134 @item TracepointSource
33135 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
33136 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
33137
33138 @item QAllow
33139 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
33140
33141 @item StaticTracepoint
33142 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
33143 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
33144
33145 @end table
33146
33147 @item qSymbol::
33148 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
33149 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
33150 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
33151 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
33152
33153 Reply:
33154 @table @samp
33155 @item OK
33156 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
33157 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
33158 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
33159 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
33160 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
33161 below.
33162 @end table
33163
33164 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
33165 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
33166
33167 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
33168 target has previously requested.
33169
33170 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
33171 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
33172 will be empty.
33173
33174 Reply:
33175 @table @samp
33176 @item OK
33177 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
33178 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
33179 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
33180 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
33181 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
33182 @end table
33183
33184 @item qTBuffer
33185 @item QTBuffer
33186 @item QTDisconnected
33187 @itemx QTDP
33188 @itemx QTDPsrc
33189 @itemx QTDV
33190 @itemx qTfP
33191 @itemx qTfV
33192 @itemx QTFrame
33193 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
33194
33195 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
33196 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
33197 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
33198 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
33199 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
33200 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
33201 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
33202 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
33203 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
33204 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
33205 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
33206
33207 Reply:
33208 @table @samp
33209 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
33210 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
33211 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
33212 the thread's attributes.
33213 @end table
33214
33215 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
33216 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
33217 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
33218 packets.)
33219
33220 @item QTSave
33221 @item qTsP
33222 @item qTsV
33223 @itemx QTStart
33224 @itemx QTStop
33225 @itemx QTinit
33226 @itemx QTro
33227 @itemx qTStatus
33228 @itemx qTV
33229 @itemx qTfSTM
33230 @itemx qTsSTM
33231 @itemx qTSTMat
33232 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
33233
33234 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33235 @cindex read special object, remote request
33236 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
33237 @anchor{qXfer read}
33238 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
33239 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
33240 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
33241 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
33242 additional details about what data to access.
33243
33244 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
33245 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
33246 formats, listed below.
33247
33248 @table @samp
33249 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33250 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
33251 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
33252 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
33253
33254 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33255 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33256
33257 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33258 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
33259 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
33260 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
33261 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
33262
33263 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33264 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33265
33266 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33267 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
33268 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
33269 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33270 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33271
33272 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
33273 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
33274 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
33275
33276 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33277 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33278
33279 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33280 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
33281 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
33282 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33283 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33284
33285 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33286 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33287
33288 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33289 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
33290
33291 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
33292 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
33293 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
33294 Action Lists}.
33295
33296 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33297 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33298 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33299
33300 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33301 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
33302 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
33303 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
33304 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33305
33306 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33307 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33308 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33309
33310 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33311 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
33312 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
33313 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
33314 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
33315 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
33316 in that context to be accessed.
33317
33318 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33319 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33320 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33321
33322 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33323 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
33324 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
33325 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33326 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33327
33328 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33329 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33330
33331 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33332 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
33333 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
33334 @xref{Operating System Information}.
33335
33336 @end table
33337
33338 Reply:
33339 @table @samp
33340 @item m @var{data}
33341 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
33342 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
33343 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
33344 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
33345 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
33346 request.
33347
33348 @item l @var{data}
33349 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
33350 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
33351 than the @var{length} in the request.
33352
33353 @item l
33354 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
33355 There is no more data to be read.
33356
33357 @item E00
33358 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
33359
33360 @item E @var{nn}
33361 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
33362 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
33363
33364 @item
33365 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
33366 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
33367 @end table
33368
33369 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33370 @cindex write data into object, remote request
33371 @anchor{qXfer write}
33372 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
33373 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
33374 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
33375 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
33376 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
33377 to access.
33378
33379 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
33380 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
33381 formats, listed below.
33382
33383 @table @samp
33384 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33385 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
33386 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
33387 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
33388 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
33389
33390 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33391 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33392 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33393
33394 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33395 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
33396 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
33397 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
33398 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
33399 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
33400 in that context to be accessed.
33401
33402 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33403 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33404 @end table
33405
33406 Reply:
33407 @table @samp
33408 @item @var{nn}
33409 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
33410 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
33411
33412 @item E00
33413 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
33414
33415 @item E @var{nn}
33416 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
33417 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
33418
33419 @item
33420 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
33421 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
33422 @end table
33423
33424 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
33425 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
33426 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
33427 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
33428 must respond with an empty packet.
33429
33430 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
33431 @cindex query attached, remote request
33432 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
33433 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
33434 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
33435 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
33436 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
33437 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
33438 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
33439
33440 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
33441 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
33442 the @code{quit} command.
33443
33444 Reply:
33445 @table @samp
33446 @item 1
33447 The remote server attached to an existing process.
33448 @item 0
33449 The remote server created a new process.
33450 @item E @var{NN}
33451 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
33452 @end table
33453
33454 @end table
33455
33456 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
33457 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
33458
33459 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
33460 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
33461 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
33462
33463 @subsection ARM
33464
33465 @subsubsection Breakpoint Kinds
33466
33467 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
33468
33469 @table @r
33470
33471 @item 2
33472 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
33473
33474 @item 3
33475 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
33476
33477 @item 4
33478 32-bit ARM mode breakpoint.
33479
33480 @end table
33481
33482 @subsection MIPS
33483
33484 @subsubsection Register Packet Format
33485
33486 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
33487 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
33488 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
33489 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
33490 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
33491 most-significant - least-significant.
33492
33493 @table @r
33494
33495 @item MIPS32
33496
33497 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
33498 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
33499 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
33500
33501 @item MIPS64
33502
33503 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
33504 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
33505 as @code{MIPS32}.
33506
33507 @end table
33508
33509 @node Tracepoint Packets
33510 @section Tracepoint Packets
33511 @cindex tracepoint packets
33512 @cindex packets, tracepoint
33513
33514 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
33515 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33516
33517 @table @samp
33518
33519 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
33520 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
33521 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
33522 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
33523 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
33524 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
33525 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
33526 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
33527 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
33528 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
33529 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
33530 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
33531 actions.
33532
33533 Replies:
33534 @table @samp
33535 @item OK
33536 The packet was understood and carried out.
33537 @item qRelocInsn
33538 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
33539 @item
33540 The packet was not recognized.
33541 @end table
33542
33543 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
33544 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
33545 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
33546 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
33547 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
33548 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
33549 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
33550
33551 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
33552 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
33553 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
33554 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
33555 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
33556 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
33557 tracepoint actions.
33558
33559 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
33560 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
33561 following forms:
33562
33563 @table @samp
33564
33565 @item R @var{mask}
33566 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
33567 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
33568 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
33569 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
33570 not fit in a 32-bit word.
33571
33572 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
33573 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
33574 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
33575 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
33576 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
33577 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
33578 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
33579
33580 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
33581 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
33582 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
33583 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
33584 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
33585 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
33586 packet).
33587
33588 @end table
33589
33590 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
33591 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
33592 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
33593 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
33594 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
33595 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
33596 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
33597 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
33598
33599 Replies:
33600 @table @samp
33601 @item OK
33602 The packet was understood and carried out.
33603 @item qRelocInsn
33604 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
33605 @item
33606 The packet was not recognized.
33607 @end table
33608
33609 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
33610 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
33611 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
33612 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
33613 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
33614 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
33615 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
33616 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
33617
33618 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
33619 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
33620 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
33621 fit in a single packet.
33622 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
33623 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
33624
33625 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
33626 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
33627 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
33628 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
33629
33630 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
33631 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
33632 query packets.
33633
33634 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
33635 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
33636 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
33637 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
33638 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
33639 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
33640 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
33641 be found.
33642
33643 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
33644 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
33645 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
33646 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
33647 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
33648 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
33649 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
33650 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
33651 mentioned in expressions.
33652
33653 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
33654 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
33655 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
33656 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
33657
33658 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
33659 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
33660 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
33661 one of the following forms:
33662
33663 @table @samp
33664 @item F @var{f}
33665 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
33666 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
33667 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
33668
33669 @item T @var{t}
33670 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
33671 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
33672
33673 @end table
33674
33675 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
33676 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33677 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
33678 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
33679
33680 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
33681 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33682 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
33683 is a hexadecimal number.
33684
33685 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
33686 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33687 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
33688 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
33689 numbers.
33690
33691 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
33692 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
33693 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
33694
33695 @item QTStart
33696 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
33697 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
33698 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
33699 instruction reply packet}).
33700
33701 @item QTStop
33702 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
33703
33704 @item QTinit
33705 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
33706
33707 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
33708 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
33709 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
33710 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
33711
33712 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
33713 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
33714 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
33715 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
33716
33717 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
33718 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
33719 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
33720 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
33721 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
33722
33723 @item qTStatus
33724 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
33725
33726 The reply has the form:
33727
33728 @table @samp
33729
33730 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
33731 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
33732 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
33733 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
33734
33735 @end table
33736
33737 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
33738 explanations as one of the optional fields:
33739
33740 @table @samp
33741
33742 @item tnotrun:0
33743 No trace has been run yet.
33744
33745 @item tstop:0
33746 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command.
33747
33748 @item tfull:0
33749 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
33750
33751 @item tdisconnected:0
33752 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
33753
33754 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
33755 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
33756
33757 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
33758 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
33759 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
33760 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
33761 @var{text} is hex encoded.
33762
33763 @item tunknown:0
33764 The trace stopped for some other reason.
33765
33766 @end table
33767
33768 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
33769 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
33770 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
33771 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
33772 trace.
33773
33774 @table @samp
33775
33776 @item tframes:@var{n}
33777 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
33778
33779 @item tcreated:@var{n}
33780 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
33781 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
33782
33783 @item tsize:@var{n}
33784 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
33785
33786 @item tfree:@var{n}
33787 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
33788
33789 @item circular:@var{n}
33790 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
33791 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
33792 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
33793 and may fill up.
33794
33795 @item disconn:@var{n}
33796 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
33797 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
33798 that the trace run will stop.
33799
33800 @end table
33801
33802 @item qTV:@var{var}
33803 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
33804 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
33805 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
33806
33807 Replies:
33808 @table @samp
33809 @item V@var{value}
33810 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
33811 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
33812 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
33813 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
33814 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
33815 program is running.
33816
33817 @item U
33818 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
33819 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
33820 was not collected.
33821 @end table
33822
33823 @item qTfP
33824 @itemx qTsP
33825 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
33826 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
33827 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
33828 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
33829 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
33830
33831 @item qTfV
33832 @itemx qTsV
33833 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
33834 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
33835 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
33836 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
33837 trace state variables.
33838
33839 @item qTfSTM
33840 @itemx qTsSTM
33841 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
33842 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
33843 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
33844 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
33845
33846 Reply:
33847 @table @samp
33848 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
33849 A single marker
33850 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
33851 a comma-separated list of markers
33852 @item l
33853 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
33854 @item E @var{nn}
33855 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
33856 @item
33857 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
33858 stub.
33859 @end table
33860
33861 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
33862 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
33863
33864 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
33865 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
33866 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
33867 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
33868 @dfn{last}).
33869
33870 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
33871 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
33872 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
33873 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
33874 tracepoint markers.
33875
33876 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
33877 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
33878 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
33879 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
33880 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
33881
33882 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
33883 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
33884 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
33885 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
33886 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
33887 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
33888 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
33889 available.
33890
33891 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
33892 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
33893 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
33894
33895 @end table
33896
33897 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
33898 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
33899 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
33900 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
33901 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
33902 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
33903 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
33904 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
33905 it had executed in the original location.
33906
33907 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
33908 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
33909 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
33910 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
33911 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
33912 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
33913 format of the request is:
33914
33915 @table @samp
33916 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
33917
33918 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
33919 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
33920 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
33921 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
33922 memory starting at @var{to}.
33923 @end table
33924
33925 Replies:
33926 @table @samp
33927 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
33928 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
33929 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
33930 @item E @var{NN}
33931 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
33932 relocating the instruction.
33933 @end table
33934
33935 @node Host I/O Packets
33936 @section Host I/O Packets
33937 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
33938 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
33939
33940 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
33941 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
33942 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
33943 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
33944 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
33945 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
33946 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
33947 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
33948 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
33949 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
33950
33951 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
33952 its arguments. They have this format:
33953
33954 @table @samp
33955
33956 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
33957 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
33958 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
33959 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
33960 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
33961 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
33962 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
33963 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
33964 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
33965
33966 @end table
33967
33968 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
33969
33970 @table @samp
33971
33972 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
33973 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
33974 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
33975 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
33976 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
33977 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
33978 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
33979 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
33980 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
33981 @var{attachment}.
33982
33983 @item
33984 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
33985
33986 @end table
33987
33988 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
33989
33990 @table @samp
33991 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
33992 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
33993 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
33994 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
33995 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
33996 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
33997 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
33998
33999 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
34000 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
34001 -1 if an error occurs.
34002
34003 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
34004 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
34005 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
34006 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
34007 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
34008 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
34009 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
34010 @var{count} was zero.
34011
34012 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
34013 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
34014 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
34015 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
34016 some characters were escaped.
34017
34018 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
34019 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
34020 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
34021 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
34022 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
34023 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
34024 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
34025 error occurred.
34026
34027 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
34028 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
34029 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
34030
34031 @end table
34032
34033 @node Interrupts
34034 @section Interrupts
34035 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
34036
34037 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
34038 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
34039 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
34040 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
34041
34042 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
34043 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
34044 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
34045 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
34046 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
34047
34048 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
34049 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
34050 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
34051 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
34052 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
34053 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
34054 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
34055 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
34056
34057 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
34058 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
34059 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
34060
34061 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
34062 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
34063 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
34064 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
34065 currently-executing threads and processes.
34066 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
34067 running program, it should send one of the stop
34068 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
34069 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
34070 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
34071 Interrupts received while the
34072 program is stopped are discarded.
34073
34074 @node Notification Packets
34075 @section Notification Packets
34076 @cindex notification packets
34077 @cindex packets, notification
34078
34079 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
34080 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
34081 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
34082 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
34083 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
34084 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
34085 is not a problem.
34086
34087 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
34088 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
34089 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
34090 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
34091 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
34092 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
34093 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
34094
34095 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
34096 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
34097
34098 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
34099 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
34100 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
34101 not they understand it.
34102
34103 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
34104 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
34105 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
34106 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
34107 recipients.
34108
34109 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
34110 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
34111 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
34112 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
34113 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
34114
34115 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
34116 defined:
34117
34118 @table @samp
34119 @item Stop: @var{reply}
34120 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
34121 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
34122 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
34123 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
34124 @value{GDBN}.
34125 @end table
34126
34127 @node Remote Non-Stop
34128 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
34129
34130 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
34131 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
34132 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
34133 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34134
34135 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
34136 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
34137 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
34138 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
34139 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
34140 probe the target state after a mode change.
34141
34142 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
34143 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
34144 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
34145 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
34146 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
34147 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
34148 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
34149 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
34150 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
34151 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
34152 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
34153
34154 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
34155 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
34156 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
34157 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
34158 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
34159 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
34160 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
34161 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
34162 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
34163 sending any queued stop events.
34164
34165 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
34166 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
34167 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
34168 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
34169 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
34170 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
34171 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
34172
34173 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
34174 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
34175 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
34176 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
34177 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
34178 process normally.
34179
34180 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
34181 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
34182 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
34183 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
34184 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
34185 should process normally.
34186
34187 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
34188 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
34189 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
34190 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
34191 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
34192
34193 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
34194 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
34195 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
34196 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
34197 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
34198 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
34199 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
34200 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
34201 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
34202 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
34203 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
34204 @samp{OK}.
34205
34206 @node Packet Acknowledgment
34207 @section Packet Acknowledgment
34208
34209 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
34210 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
34211 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
34212 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34213 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
34214 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
34215 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
34216
34217 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
34218 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
34219 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
34220 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
34221 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
34222
34223 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
34224 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
34225 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
34226 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
34227
34228 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
34229 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
34230 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
34231 @pxref{qSupported}.
34232 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
34233 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
34234 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
34235 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
34236 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
34237 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
34238 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
34239
34240 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
34241 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
34242 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
34243 connection.
34244 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
34245 new connection is established,
34246 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
34247 for the current connection, once disabled.
34248
34249 @node Examples
34250 @section Examples
34251
34252 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
34253 does not get any direct output:
34254
34255 @smallexample
34256 -> @code{R00}
34257 <- @code{+}
34258 @emph{target restarts}
34259 -> @code{?}
34260 <- @code{+}
34261 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
34262 -> @code{+}
34263 @end smallexample
34264
34265 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
34266
34267 @smallexample
34268 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
34269 <- @code{+}
34270 -> @code{s}
34271 <- @code{+}
34272 @emph{time passes}
34273 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
34274 -> @code{+}
34275 -> @code{g}
34276 <- @code{+}
34277 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
34278 -> @code{+}
34279 @end smallexample
34280
34281 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
34282 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
34283 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
34284
34285 @menu
34286 * File-I/O Overview::
34287 * Protocol Basics::
34288 * The F Request Packet::
34289 * The F Reply Packet::
34290 * The Ctrl-C Message::
34291 * Console I/O::
34292 * List of Supported Calls::
34293 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
34294 * Constants::
34295 * File-I/O Examples::
34296 @end menu
34297
34298 @node File-I/O Overview
34299 @subsection File-I/O Overview
34300 @cindex file-i/o overview
34301
34302 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
34303 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
34304 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
34305 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
34306 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
34307 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
34308
34309 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
34310 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
34311 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
34312 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
34313 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
34314
34315 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
34316 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34317 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
34318 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
34319 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
34320 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
34321 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
34322
34323 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
34324 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
34325 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
34326 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
34327 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
34328
34329 @smallexample
34330 (@value{GDBP}) continue
34331 <- target requests 'system call X'
34332 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
34333 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
34334 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
34335 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
34336 @end smallexample
34337
34338 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
34339 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
34340 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
34341 system are not supported by this protocol.
34342
34343 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
34344
34345 @node Protocol Basics
34346 @subsection Protocol Basics
34347 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
34348
34349 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
34350 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
34351 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
34352 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
34353 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
34354 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
34355 to call the appropriate host system call:
34356
34357 @itemize @bullet
34358 @item
34359 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
34360
34361 @item
34362 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
34363 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
34364 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
34365 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
34366
34367 @end itemize
34368
34369 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
34370
34371 @itemize @bullet
34372 @item
34373 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
34374 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
34375 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
34376 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
34377 packet.
34378
34379 @item
34380 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
34381 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
34382
34383 @item
34384 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
34385
34386 @item
34387 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
34388
34389 @item
34390 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
34391 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
34392 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
34393 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
34394 packet.
34395
34396 @end itemize
34397
34398 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
34399 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
34400
34401 @itemize @bullet
34402 @item
34403 Return value.
34404
34405 @item
34406 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
34407
34408 @item
34409 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
34410
34411 @end itemize
34412
34413 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
34414 the latest continue or step action.
34415
34416 @node The F Request Packet
34417 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
34418 @cindex file-i/o request packet
34419 @cindex @code{F} request packet
34420
34421 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
34422
34423 @table @samp
34424 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
34425
34426 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
34427 This is just the name of the function.
34428
34429 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
34430 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
34431 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
34432 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
34433 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
34434 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
34435 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
34436
34437 @end table
34438
34439
34440
34441 @node The F Reply Packet
34442 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
34443 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
34444 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
34445
34446 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
34447
34448 @table @samp
34449
34450 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
34451
34452 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
34453
34454 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
34455 representation.
34456 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
34457
34458 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
34459 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
34460 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
34461
34462 @smallexample
34463 F0,0,C
34464 @end smallexample
34465
34466 @noindent
34467 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
34468
34469 @smallexample
34470 F-1,4,C
34471 @end smallexample
34472
34473 @noindent
34474 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
34475
34476 @end table
34477
34478
34479 @node The Ctrl-C Message
34480 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
34481 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
34482
34483 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
34484 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
34485 the target should behave as if it had
34486 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
34487 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
34488 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
34489 packet.
34490
34491 It's important for the target to know in which
34492 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
34493
34494 @itemize @bullet
34495 @item
34496 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
34497
34498 @item
34499 The system call on the host has been finished.
34500
34501 @end itemize
34502
34503 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
34504 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
34505 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
34506 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
34507 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
34508 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
34509
34510 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
34511 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
34512 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
34513 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
34514 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
34515 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
34516 or the full action has been completed.
34517
34518 @node Console I/O
34519 @subsection Console I/O
34520 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
34521
34522 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
34523 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
34524 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
34525 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
34526 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
34527 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
34528 conditions is met:
34529
34530 @itemize @bullet
34531 @item
34532 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
34533 @code{read}
34534 system call is treated as finished.
34535
34536 @item
34537 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
34538 newline.
34539
34540 @item
34541 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
34542 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
34543
34544 @end itemize
34545
34546 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
34547 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
34548 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
34549 is stopped at the user's request.
34550
34551
34552 @node List of Supported Calls
34553 @subsection List of Supported Calls
34554 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
34555
34556 @menu
34557 * open::
34558 * close::
34559 * read::
34560 * write::
34561 * lseek::
34562 * rename::
34563 * unlink::
34564 * stat/fstat::
34565 * gettimeofday::
34566 * isatty::
34567 * system::
34568 @end menu
34569
34570 @node open
34571 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
34572 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
34573
34574 @table @asis
34575 @item Synopsis:
34576 @smallexample
34577 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
34578 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
34579 @end smallexample
34580
34581 @item Request:
34582 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
34583
34584 @noindent
34585 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
34586
34587 @table @code
34588 @item O_CREAT
34589 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
34590 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
34591 are concerned.
34592
34593 @item O_EXCL
34594 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
34595 an error and open() fails.
34596
34597 @item O_TRUNC
34598 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
34599 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
34600 truncated to zero length.
34601
34602 @item O_APPEND
34603 The file is opened in append mode.
34604
34605 @item O_RDONLY
34606 The file is opened for reading only.
34607
34608 @item O_WRONLY
34609 The file is opened for writing only.
34610
34611 @item O_RDWR
34612 The file is opened for reading and writing.
34613 @end table
34614
34615 @noindent
34616 Other bits are silently ignored.
34617
34618
34619 @noindent
34620 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
34621
34622 @table @code
34623 @item S_IRUSR
34624 User has read permission.
34625
34626 @item S_IWUSR
34627 User has write permission.
34628
34629 @item S_IRGRP
34630 Group has read permission.
34631
34632 @item S_IWGRP
34633 Group has write permission.
34634
34635 @item S_IROTH
34636 Others have read permission.
34637
34638 @item S_IWOTH
34639 Others have write permission.
34640 @end table
34641
34642 @noindent
34643 Other bits are silently ignored.
34644
34645
34646 @item Return value:
34647 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
34648 occurred.
34649
34650 @item Errors:
34651
34652 @table @code
34653 @item EEXIST
34654 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
34655
34656 @item EISDIR
34657 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
34658
34659 @item EACCES
34660 The requested access is not allowed.
34661
34662 @item ENAMETOOLONG
34663 @var{pathname} was too long.
34664
34665 @item ENOENT
34666 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
34667
34668 @item ENODEV
34669 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
34670
34671 @item EROFS
34672 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
34673 write access was requested.
34674
34675 @item EFAULT
34676 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
34677
34678 @item ENOSPC
34679 No space on device to create the file.
34680
34681 @item EMFILE
34682 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
34683
34684 @item ENFILE
34685 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
34686 has been reached.
34687
34688 @item EINTR
34689 The call was interrupted by the user.
34690 @end table
34691
34692 @end table
34693
34694 @node close
34695 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
34696 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
34697
34698 @table @asis
34699 @item Synopsis:
34700 @smallexample
34701 int close(int fd);
34702 @end smallexample
34703
34704 @item Request:
34705 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
34706
34707 @item Return value:
34708 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
34709
34710 @item Errors:
34711
34712 @table @code
34713 @item EBADF
34714 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
34715
34716 @item EINTR
34717 The call was interrupted by the user.
34718 @end table
34719
34720 @end table
34721
34722 @node read
34723 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
34724 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
34725
34726 @table @asis
34727 @item Synopsis:
34728 @smallexample
34729 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
34730 @end smallexample
34731
34732 @item Request:
34733 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
34734
34735 @item Return value:
34736 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
34737 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
34738 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
34739
34740 @item Errors:
34741
34742 @table @code
34743 @item EBADF
34744 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
34745 reading.
34746
34747 @item EFAULT
34748 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34749
34750 @item EINTR
34751 The call was interrupted by the user.
34752 @end table
34753
34754 @end table
34755
34756 @node write
34757 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
34758 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
34759
34760 @table @asis
34761 @item Synopsis:
34762 @smallexample
34763 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
34764 @end smallexample
34765
34766 @item Request:
34767 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
34768
34769 @item Return value:
34770 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
34771 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
34772 is returned.
34773
34774 @item Errors:
34775
34776 @table @code
34777 @item EBADF
34778 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
34779 writing.
34780
34781 @item EFAULT
34782 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34783
34784 @item EFBIG
34785 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
34786 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
34787
34788 @item ENOSPC
34789 No space on device to write the data.
34790
34791 @item EINTR
34792 The call was interrupted by the user.
34793 @end table
34794
34795 @end table
34796
34797 @node lseek
34798 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
34799 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
34800
34801 @table @asis
34802 @item Synopsis:
34803 @smallexample
34804 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
34805 @end smallexample
34806
34807 @item Request:
34808 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
34809
34810 @var{flag} is one of:
34811
34812 @table @code
34813 @item SEEK_SET
34814 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
34815
34816 @item SEEK_CUR
34817 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
34818 bytes.
34819
34820 @item SEEK_END
34821 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
34822 bytes.
34823 @end table
34824
34825 @item Return value:
34826 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
34827 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
34828 value of -1 is returned.
34829
34830 @item Errors:
34831
34832 @table @code
34833 @item EBADF
34834 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
34835
34836 @item ESPIPE
34837 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
34838
34839 @item EINVAL
34840 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
34841
34842 @item EINTR
34843 The call was interrupted by the user.
34844 @end table
34845
34846 @end table
34847
34848 @node rename
34849 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
34850 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
34851
34852 @table @asis
34853 @item Synopsis:
34854 @smallexample
34855 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
34856 @end smallexample
34857
34858 @item Request:
34859 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
34860
34861 @item Return value:
34862 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
34863
34864 @item Errors:
34865
34866 @table @code
34867 @item EISDIR
34868 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
34869 directory.
34870
34871 @item EEXIST
34872 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
34873
34874 @item EBUSY
34875 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
34876 process.
34877
34878 @item EINVAL
34879 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
34880 of itself.
34881
34882 @item ENOTDIR
34883 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
34884 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
34885 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
34886
34887 @item EFAULT
34888 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
34889
34890 @item EACCES
34891 No access to the file or the path of the file.
34892
34893 @item ENAMETOOLONG
34894
34895 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
34896
34897 @item ENOENT
34898 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
34899
34900 @item EROFS
34901 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
34902
34903 @item ENOSPC
34904 The device containing the file has no room for the new
34905 directory entry.
34906
34907 @item EINTR
34908 The call was interrupted by the user.
34909 @end table
34910
34911 @end table
34912
34913 @node unlink
34914 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
34915 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
34916
34917 @table @asis
34918 @item Synopsis:
34919 @smallexample
34920 int unlink(const char *pathname);
34921 @end smallexample
34922
34923 @item Request:
34924 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
34925
34926 @item Return value:
34927 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
34928
34929 @item Errors:
34930
34931 @table @code
34932 @item EACCES
34933 No access to the file or the path of the file.
34934
34935 @item EPERM
34936 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
34937
34938 @item EBUSY
34939 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
34940 being used by another process.
34941
34942 @item EFAULT
34943 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34944
34945 @item ENAMETOOLONG
34946 @var{pathname} was too long.
34947
34948 @item ENOENT
34949 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
34950
34951 @item ENOTDIR
34952 A component of the path is not a directory.
34953
34954 @item EROFS
34955 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
34956
34957 @item EINTR
34958 The call was interrupted by the user.
34959 @end table
34960
34961 @end table
34962
34963 @node stat/fstat
34964 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
34965 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
34966 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
34967
34968 @table @asis
34969 @item Synopsis:
34970 @smallexample
34971 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
34972 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
34973 @end smallexample
34974
34975 @item Request:
34976 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
34977 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
34978
34979 @item Return value:
34980 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
34981
34982 @item Errors:
34983
34984 @table @code
34985 @item EBADF
34986 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
34987
34988 @item ENOENT
34989 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
34990 path is an empty string.
34991
34992 @item ENOTDIR
34993 A component of the path is not a directory.
34994
34995 @item EFAULT
34996 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34997
34998 @item EACCES
34999 No access to the file or the path of the file.
35000
35001 @item ENAMETOOLONG
35002 @var{pathname} was too long.
35003
35004 @item EINTR
35005 The call was interrupted by the user.
35006 @end table
35007
35008 @end table
35009
35010 @node gettimeofday
35011 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
35012 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
35013
35014 @table @asis
35015 @item Synopsis:
35016 @smallexample
35017 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
35018 @end smallexample
35019
35020 @item Request:
35021 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
35022
35023 @item Return value:
35024 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
35025
35026 @item Errors:
35027
35028 @table @code
35029 @item EINVAL
35030 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
35031
35032 @item EFAULT
35033 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35034 @end table
35035
35036 @end table
35037
35038 @node isatty
35039 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
35040 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
35041
35042 @table @asis
35043 @item Synopsis:
35044 @smallexample
35045 int isatty(int fd);
35046 @end smallexample
35047
35048 @item Request:
35049 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
35050
35051 @item Return value:
35052 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
35053
35054 @item Errors:
35055
35056 @table @code
35057 @item EINTR
35058 The call was interrupted by the user.
35059 @end table
35060
35061 @end table
35062
35063 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
35064 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
35065 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
35066 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
35067 needed.
35068
35069
35070 @node system
35071 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
35072 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
35073
35074 @table @asis
35075 @item Synopsis:
35076 @smallexample
35077 int system(const char *command);
35078 @end smallexample
35079
35080 @item Request:
35081 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
35082
35083 @item Return value:
35084 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
35085 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
35086 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
35087 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
35088 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
35089 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
35090 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
35091
35092 @item Errors:
35093
35094 @table @code
35095 @item EINTR
35096 The call was interrupted by the user.
35097 @end table
35098
35099 @end table
35100
35101 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
35102 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
35103 the host is simplified before it's returned
35104 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
35105 is discarded, and the return value consists
35106 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
35107
35108 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
35109 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
35110 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
35111
35112 @table @code
35113 @item set remote system-call-allowed
35114 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
35115 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
35116 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
35117
35118 @item show remote system-call-allowed
35119 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
35120 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
35121 protocol.
35122 @end table
35123
35124 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
35125 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
35126 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
35127
35128 @menu
35129 * Integral Datatypes::
35130 * Pointer Values::
35131 * Memory Transfer::
35132 * struct stat::
35133 * struct timeval::
35134 @end menu
35135
35136 @node Integral Datatypes
35137 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
35138 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
35139
35140 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
35141 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
35142 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
35143
35144 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
35145 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
35146
35147 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
35148
35149 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
35150 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
35151
35152 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
35153
35154 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
35155 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
35156 byte order.
35157
35158 @node Pointer Values
35159 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
35160 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
35161
35162 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
35163 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
35164 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
35165 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
35166
35167 @smallexample
35168 @code{1aaf/12}
35169 @end smallexample
35170
35171 @noindent
35172 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
35173 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
35174 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
35175 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
35176
35177 @smallexample
35178 @code{123456/d}
35179 @end smallexample
35180
35181 @node Memory Transfer
35182 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
35183 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
35184
35185 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
35186 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
35187 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
35188 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
35189 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
35190 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
35191 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
35192
35193
35194 @node struct stat
35195 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
35196 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
35197
35198 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
35199 is defined as follows:
35200
35201 @smallexample
35202 struct stat @{
35203 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
35204 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
35205 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
35206 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
35207 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
35208 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
35209 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
35210 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
35211 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
35212 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
35213 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
35214 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
35215 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
35216 @};
35217 @end smallexample
35218
35219 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
35220 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
35221 structure is of size 64 bytes.
35222
35223 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
35224 range of values.
35225
35226 @table @code
35227
35228 @item st_dev
35229 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
35230
35231 @item st_ino
35232 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
35233
35234 @item st_mode
35235 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
35236 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
35237
35238 @item st_uid
35239 @itemx st_gid
35240 @itemx st_rdev
35241 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
35242
35243 @item st_atime
35244 @itemx st_mtime
35245 @itemx st_ctime
35246 These values have a host and file system dependent
35247 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
35248 support exact timing values.
35249 @end table
35250
35251 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
35252 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
35253 continuing.
35254
35255 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
35256 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
35257 get truncated on the target.
35258
35259 @node struct timeval
35260 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
35261 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
35262
35263 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
35264 is defined as follows:
35265
35266 @smallexample
35267 struct timeval @{
35268 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
35269 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
35270 @};
35271 @end smallexample
35272
35273 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
35274 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
35275 structure is of size 8 bytes.
35276
35277 @node Constants
35278 @subsection Constants
35279 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
35280
35281 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
35282 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
35283 values before and after the call as needed.
35284
35285 @menu
35286 * Open Flags::
35287 * mode_t Values::
35288 * Errno Values::
35289 * Lseek Flags::
35290 * Limits::
35291 @end menu
35292
35293 @node Open Flags
35294 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
35295 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
35296
35297 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
35298
35299 @smallexample
35300 O_RDONLY 0x0
35301 O_WRONLY 0x1
35302 O_RDWR 0x2
35303 O_APPEND 0x8
35304 O_CREAT 0x200
35305 O_TRUNC 0x400
35306 O_EXCL 0x800
35307 @end smallexample
35308
35309 @node mode_t Values
35310 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
35311 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
35312
35313 All values are given in octal representation.
35314
35315 @smallexample
35316 S_IFREG 0100000
35317 S_IFDIR 040000
35318 S_IRUSR 0400
35319 S_IWUSR 0200
35320 S_IXUSR 0100
35321 S_IRGRP 040
35322 S_IWGRP 020
35323 S_IXGRP 010
35324 S_IROTH 04
35325 S_IWOTH 02
35326 S_IXOTH 01
35327 @end smallexample
35328
35329 @node Errno Values
35330 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
35331 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
35332
35333 All values are given in decimal representation.
35334
35335 @smallexample
35336 EPERM 1
35337 ENOENT 2
35338 EINTR 4
35339 EBADF 9
35340 EACCES 13
35341 EFAULT 14
35342 EBUSY 16
35343 EEXIST 17
35344 ENODEV 19
35345 ENOTDIR 20
35346 EISDIR 21
35347 EINVAL 22
35348 ENFILE 23
35349 EMFILE 24
35350 EFBIG 27
35351 ENOSPC 28
35352 ESPIPE 29
35353 EROFS 30
35354 ENAMETOOLONG 91
35355 EUNKNOWN 9999
35356 @end smallexample
35357
35358 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
35359 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
35360
35361 @node Lseek Flags
35362 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
35363 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
35364
35365 @smallexample
35366 SEEK_SET 0
35367 SEEK_CUR 1
35368 SEEK_END 2
35369 @end smallexample
35370
35371 @node Limits
35372 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
35373 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
35374
35375 All values are given in decimal representation.
35376
35377 @smallexample
35378 INT_MIN -2147483648
35379 INT_MAX 2147483647
35380 UINT_MAX 4294967295
35381 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
35382 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
35383 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
35384 @end smallexample
35385
35386 @node File-I/O Examples
35387 @subsection File-I/O Examples
35388 @cindex file-i/o examples
35389
35390 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
35391 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
35392
35393 @smallexample
35394 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
35395 @emph{request memory read from target}
35396 -> @code{m1234,6}
35397 <- XXXXXX
35398 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
35399 -> @code{F6}
35400 @end smallexample
35401
35402 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
35403 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
35404
35405 @smallexample
35406 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35407 @emph{request memory write to target}
35408 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
35409 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
35410 -> @code{F6}
35411 @end smallexample
35412
35413 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
35414 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
35415
35416 @smallexample
35417 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35418 -> @code{F-1,9}
35419 @end smallexample
35420
35421 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
35422 host is called:
35423
35424 @smallexample
35425 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35426 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
35427 <- @code{T02}
35428 @end smallexample
35429
35430 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
35431 host is called:
35432
35433 @smallexample
35434 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35435 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
35436 <- @code{T02}
35437 @end smallexample
35438
35439 @node Library List Format
35440 @section Library List Format
35441 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
35442
35443 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
35444 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
35445 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
35446 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
35447 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
35448 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
35449 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35450 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
35451 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
35452 are loaded.
35453
35454 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
35455 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
35456 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
35457 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
35458
35459 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
35460 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
35461 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
35462 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
35463 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
35464 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
35465
35466 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35467 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
35468
35469 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
35470 offset, looks like this:
35471
35472 @smallexample
35473 <library-list>
35474 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
35475 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
35476 </library>
35477 </library-list>
35478 @end smallexample
35479
35480 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
35481 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
35482
35483 @smallexample
35484 <library-list>
35485 <library name="sharedlib.o">
35486 <section address="0x10000000"/>
35487 <section address="0x20000000"/>
35488 <section address="0x30000000"/>
35489 </library>
35490 </library-list>
35491 @end smallexample
35492
35493 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
35494
35495 @smallexample
35496 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
35497 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
35498 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
35499 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
35500 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
35501 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
35502 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
35503 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
35504 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
35505 @end smallexample
35506
35507 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
35508 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
35509 section for each library.
35510
35511 @node Memory Map Format
35512 @section Memory Map Format
35513 @cindex memory map format
35514
35515 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
35516 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
35517 memory map.
35518
35519 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35520 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
35521 lists memory regions.
35522
35523 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35524 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
35525
35526 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
35527
35528 @smallexample
35529 <?xml version="1.0"?>
35530 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
35531 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
35532 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
35533 <memory-map>
35534 region...
35535 </memory-map>
35536 @end smallexample
35537
35538 Each region can be either:
35539
35540 @itemize
35541
35542 @item
35543 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
35544 bytes from there:
35545
35546 @smallexample
35547 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
35548 @end smallexample
35549
35550
35551 @item
35552 A region of read-only memory:
35553
35554 @smallexample
35555 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
35556 @end smallexample
35557
35558
35559 @item
35560 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
35561 bytes in length:
35562
35563 @smallexample
35564 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
35565 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
35566 </memory>
35567 @end smallexample
35568
35569 @end itemize
35570
35571 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
35572 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
35573 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
35574
35575 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
35576
35577 @smallexample
35578 <!-- ................................................... -->
35579 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
35580 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
35581 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
35582 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
35583 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
35584 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
35585 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
35586 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
35587 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
35588 and its type, or device. -->
35589 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
35590 start CDATA #REQUIRED
35591 length CDATA #REQUIRED
35592 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
35593 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
35594 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
35595 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
35596 @end smallexample
35597
35598 @node Thread List Format
35599 @section Thread List Format
35600 @cindex thread list format
35601
35602 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
35603 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35604 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
35605 the following structure:
35606
35607 @smallexample
35608 <?xml version="1.0"?>
35609 <threads>
35610 <thread id="id" core="0">
35611 ... description ...
35612 </thread>
35613 </threads>
35614 @end smallexample
35615
35616 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
35617 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
35618 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
35619 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
35620 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
35621
35622 @include agentexpr.texi
35623
35624 @node Trace File Format
35625 @appendix Trace File Format
35626 @cindex trace file format
35627
35628 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
35629 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
35630
35631 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
35632 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
35633 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
35634 in the future.
35635
35636 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
35637 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
35638 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
35639 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
35640 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
35641 of this section.
35642
35643 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
35644
35645 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
35646 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
35647 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
35648 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
35649 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
35650 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
35651 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
35652 endianness.
35653
35654 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
35655
35656 @table @code
35657 @item R @var{bytes}
35658 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
35659 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
35660 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
35661 hexadecimal encoding.
35662
35663 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
35664 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
35665 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
35666 @var{length} bytes.
35667
35668 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
35669 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
35670 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
35671
35672 @end table
35673
35674 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
35675 of blocks.
35676
35677 @node Target Descriptions
35678 @appendix Target Descriptions
35679 @cindex target descriptions
35680
35681 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
35682 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
35683 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
35684
35685 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
35686 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
35687 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
35688 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
35689 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
35690 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
35691 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
35692
35693 @itemize @bullet
35694 @item
35695 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
35696 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
35697 @item
35698 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
35699 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
35700 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
35701 @item
35702 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
35703 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
35704 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
35705 @end itemize
35706
35707 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
35708 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
35709 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
35710 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
35711 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
35712
35713 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35714 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
35715
35716 @menu
35717 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
35718 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
35719 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
35720 descriptions.
35721 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
35722 @end menu
35723
35724 @node Retrieving Descriptions
35725 @section Retrieving Descriptions
35726
35727 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
35728 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
35729 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
35730 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
35731 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
35732 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
35733 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
35734 Format}.
35735
35736 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
35737 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
35738 specify a file are:
35739
35740 @table @code
35741 @cindex set tdesc filename
35742 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
35743 Read the target description from @var{path}.
35744
35745 @cindex unset tdesc filename
35746 @item unset tdesc filename
35747 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
35748 will use the description supplied by the current target.
35749
35750 @cindex show tdesc filename
35751 @item show tdesc filename
35752 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
35753 @end table
35754
35755
35756 @node Target Description Format
35757 @section Target Description Format
35758 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
35759
35760 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
35761 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
35762 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
35763 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
35764 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
35765 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
35766 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
35767
35768 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
35769 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
35770 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
35771 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
35772 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
35773
35774 Here is a simple target description:
35775
35776 @smallexample
35777 <target version="1.0">
35778 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
35779 </target>
35780 @end smallexample
35781
35782 @noindent
35783 This minimal description only says that the target uses
35784 the x86-64 architecture.
35785
35786 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
35787 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
35788 are explained further below.
35789
35790 @smallexample
35791 <?xml version="1.0"?>
35792 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
35793 <target version="1.0">
35794 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
35795 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
35796 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
35797 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
35798 </target>
35799 @end smallexample
35800
35801 @noindent
35802 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
35803 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
35804 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
35805 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
35806 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
35807 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
35808 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
35809 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
35810 the version mismatch.
35811
35812 @subsection Inclusion
35813 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
35814 @cindex XInclude
35815 @ifnotinfo
35816 @cindex <xi:include>
35817 @end ifnotinfo
35818
35819 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
35820 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
35821 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
35822 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
35823 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
35824
35825 @smallexample
35826 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
35827 @end smallexample
35828
35829 @noindent
35830 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
35831 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
35832 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
35833 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
35834 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
35835 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
35836 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
35837 original description.
35838
35839 @subsection Architecture
35840 @cindex <architecture>
35841
35842 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
35843
35844 @smallexample
35845 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
35846 @end smallexample
35847
35848 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
35849 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
35850
35851 @subsection OS ABI
35852 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
35853
35854 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
35855 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
35856
35857 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
35858
35859 @smallexample
35860 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
35861 @end smallexample
35862
35863 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
35864 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
35865
35866 @subsection Compatible Architecture
35867 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
35868
35869 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
35870 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
35871
35872 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
35873
35874 @smallexample
35875 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
35876 @end smallexample
35877
35878 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
35879 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
35880
35881 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
35882 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
35883 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
35884 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
35885 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
35886 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
35887 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
35888
35889 @smallexample
35890 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
35891 <compatible>spu</compatible>
35892 @end smallexample
35893
35894 @subsection Features
35895 @cindex <feature>
35896
35897 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
35898 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
35899 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
35900 has this form:
35901
35902 @smallexample
35903 <feature name="@var{name}">
35904 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
35905 @var{reg}@dots{}
35906 </feature>
35907 @end smallexample
35908
35909 @noindent
35910 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
35911 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
35912 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
35913 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
35914
35915 @subsection Types
35916
35917 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
35918 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
35919 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
35920 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
35921 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
35922
35923 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
35924 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
35925 Types must be defined before they are used.
35926
35927 @cindex <vector>
35928 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
35929 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
35930 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
35931 @var{count}:
35932
35933 @smallexample
35934 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
35935 @end smallexample
35936
35937 @cindex <union>
35938 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
35939 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
35940 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
35941 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
35942
35943 @smallexample
35944 <union id="@var{id}">
35945 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
35946 @dots{}
35947 </union>
35948 @end smallexample
35949
35950 @cindex <struct>
35951 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
35952 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
35953 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
35954 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
35955 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
35956 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
35957 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
35958 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
35959
35960 @smallexample
35961 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
35962 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
35963 @dots{}
35964 </struct>
35965 @end smallexample
35966
35967 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
35968 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
35969
35970 @smallexample
35971 <struct id="@var{id}">
35972 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
35973 @dots{}
35974 </struct>
35975 @end smallexample
35976
35977 @cindex <flags>
35978 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
35979 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
35980 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
35981 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
35982 are supported.
35983
35984 @smallexample
35985 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
35986 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
35987 @dots{}
35988 </flags>
35989 @end smallexample
35990
35991 @subsection Registers
35992 @cindex <reg>
35993
35994 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
35995
35996 @smallexample
35997 <reg name="@var{name}"
35998 bitsize="@var{size}"
35999 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
36000 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
36001 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
36002 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
36003 @end smallexample
36004
36005 @noindent
36006 The components are as follows:
36007
36008 @table @var
36009
36010 @item name
36011 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
36012
36013 @item bitsize
36014 The register's size, in bits.
36015
36016 @item regnum
36017 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
36018 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
36019 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
36020 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
36021 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
36022 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
36023 in order of increasing register number.
36024
36025 @item save-restore
36026 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
36027 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
36028 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
36029 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
36030 ABI.
36031
36032 @item type
36033 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
36034 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
36035 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
36036 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
36037 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
36038 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
36039
36040 @item group
36041 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
36042 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
36043 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
36044 in @code{info registers}.
36045
36046 @end table
36047
36048 @node Predefined Target Types
36049 @section Predefined Target Types
36050 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
36051
36052 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
36053 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
36054 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
36055 types. The currently supported types are:
36056
36057 @table @code
36058
36059 @item int8
36060 @itemx int16
36061 @itemx int32
36062 @itemx int64
36063 @itemx int128
36064 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
36065
36066 @item uint8
36067 @itemx uint16
36068 @itemx uint32
36069 @itemx uint64
36070 @itemx uint128
36071 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
36072
36073 @item code_ptr
36074 @itemx data_ptr
36075 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
36076 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
36077 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
36078 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
36079 may be marked as data pointers.
36080
36081 @item ieee_single
36082 Single precision IEEE floating point.
36083
36084 @item ieee_double
36085 Double precision IEEE floating point.
36086
36087 @item arm_fpa_ext
36088 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
36089
36090 @item i387_ext
36091 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
36092
36093 @item i386_eflags
36094 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
36095
36096 @item i386_mxcsr
36097 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
36098
36099 @end table
36100
36101 @node Standard Target Features
36102 @section Standard Target Features
36103 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
36104
36105 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
36106 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
36107 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
36108 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
36109 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
36110 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
36111 can recognize them.
36112
36113 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
36114 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
36115 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
36116 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
36117 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
36118 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
36119 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
36120 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
36121
36122 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
36123 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
36124 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
36125
36126 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
36127 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
36128 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
36129 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
36130
36131 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
36132 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
36133 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
36134
36135 @menu
36136 * ARM Features::
36137 * i386 Features::
36138 * MIPS Features::
36139 * M68K Features::
36140 * PowerPC Features::
36141 @end menu
36142
36143
36144 @node ARM Features
36145 @subsection ARM Features
36146 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
36147
36148 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
36149 ARM targets.
36150 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
36151 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
36152
36153 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
36154 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
36155 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
36156 and @samp{xpsr}.
36157
36158 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
36159 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
36160
36161 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
36162 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
36163 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
36164 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
36165
36166 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
36167 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
36168 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
36169 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
36170 halves of the double-precision registers.
36171
36172 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
36173 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
36174 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
36175 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
36176 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
36177 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
36178
36179 @node i386 Features
36180 @subsection i386 Features
36181 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
36182
36183 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
36184 targets. It should describe the following registers:
36185
36186 @itemize @minus
36187 @item
36188 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
36189 @item
36190 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
36191 @item
36192 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
36193 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
36194 @item
36195 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
36196 @item
36197 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
36198 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
36199 @end itemize
36200
36201 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
36202
36203 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
36204 describe registers:
36205
36206 @itemize @minus
36207 @item
36208 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
36209 @item
36210 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
36211 @item
36212 @samp{mxcsr}
36213 @end itemize
36214
36215 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
36216 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
36217 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
36218
36219 @itemize @minus
36220 @item
36221 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
36222 @item
36223 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
36224 @end itemize
36225
36226 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
36227 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
36228
36229 @node MIPS Features
36230 @subsection MIPS Features
36231 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
36232
36233 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
36234 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
36235 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
36236 on the target.
36237
36238 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
36239 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
36240 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36241
36242 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
36243 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
36244 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
36245 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36246
36247 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
36248 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
36249 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
36250
36251 @node M68K Features
36252 @subsection M68K Features
36253 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
36254
36255 @table @code
36256 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
36257 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
36258 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
36259 One of those features must be always present.
36260 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
36261 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
36262 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
36263 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
36264
36265 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
36266 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
36267 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
36268 @samp{fpiaddr}.
36269 @end table
36270
36271 @node PowerPC Features
36272 @subsection PowerPC Features
36273 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
36274
36275 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
36276 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
36277 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
36278 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36279
36280 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
36281 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
36282
36283 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
36284 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
36285 and @samp{vrsave}.
36286
36287 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
36288 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
36289 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
36290 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
36291 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
36292 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
36293
36294 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
36295 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
36296 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
36297 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
36298 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
36299 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
36300 user.
36301
36302 @node Operating System Information
36303 @appendix Operating System Information
36304 @cindex operating system information
36305
36306 @menu
36307 * Process list::
36308 @end menu
36309
36310 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
36311 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
36312 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
36313 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
36314 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
36315 on a different aspect of target.
36316
36317 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
36318 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
36319 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
36320 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
36321
36322 @node Process list
36323 @appendixsection Process list
36324 @cindex operating system information, process list
36325
36326 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
36327 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
36328 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
36329 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
36330
36331 An example document is:
36332
36333 @smallexample
36334 <?xml version="1.0"?>
36335 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
36336 <osdata type="processes">
36337 <item>
36338 <column name="pid">1</column>
36339 <column name="user">root</column>
36340 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
36341 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
36342 </item>
36343 </osdata>
36344 @end smallexample
36345
36346 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
36347 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
36348 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
36349 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
36350 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
36351 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
36352 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
36353
36354 @include gpl.texi
36355
36356 @node GNU Free Documentation License
36357 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36358 @include fdl.texi
36359
36360 @node Index
36361 @unnumbered Index
36362
36363 @printindex cp
36364
36365 @tex
36366 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
36367 % meantime:
36368 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
36369 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
36370 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
36371 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
36372 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
36373 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
36374 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
36375 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
36376 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
36377 \page\colophon
36378 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
36379 @end tex
36380
36381 @bye